* c-typeprint.c (find_typedef_for_canonicalize,
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-1996, 1998-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @include gdb-cfg.texi
10 @c
11 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
12 @setchapternewpage odd
13 @c %**end of header
14
15 @iftex
16 @c @smallbook
17 @c @cropmarks
18 @end iftex
19
20 @finalout
21 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
22 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
23 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
24 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
25 @syncodeindex ky fn
26 @syncodeindex tp fn
27
28 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
29 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
30 @syncodeindex vr fn
31 @syncodeindex fn fn
32
33 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
34 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
35 @set EDITION Tenth
36
37 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
38 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
39
40 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
41
42 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
43 @c manuals to an info tree.
44 @dircategory Software development
45 @direntry
46 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
47 @end direntry
48
49 @copying
50 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
51 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
52 2011, 2012
53 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @end copying
66
67 @ifnottex
68 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
69
70 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
71 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
72 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
73 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
74 @end ifset
75 Version @value{GDBVN}.
76
77 @insertcopying
78 @end ifnottex
79
80 @titlepage
81 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
82 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
83 @sp 1
84 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
85 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
86 @sp 1
87 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
88 @end ifset
89 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
90 @page
91 @tex
92 {\parskip=0pt
93 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
94 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
95 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
96 }
97 @end tex
98
99 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
100 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
101 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
102 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
103 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
104
105 @insertcopying
106 @end titlepage
107 @page
108
109 @ifnottex
110 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
111
112 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
113
114 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
115
116 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
117 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
118 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
119 @end ifset
120 Version @value{GDBVN}.
121
122 Copyright (C) 1988-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123
124 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
125 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
126 software in general. We will miss him.
127
128 @menu
129 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
130 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
131
132 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
133 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
134 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
135 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
136 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
137 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
138 * Stack:: Examining the stack
139 * Source:: Examining source files
140 * Data:: Examining data
141 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
142 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
143 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
144 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
145
146 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
147
148 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
149 * Altering:: Altering execution
150 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
151 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
152 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
153 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
154 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
155 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
156 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
157 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
158 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
159 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
160 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
161 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
162 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
163
164 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
165
166 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
167 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
168 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
169 @end ifset
170 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
171 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
172 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
173 @end ifclear
174 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
175 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
176 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
177 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
178 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
179 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
180 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
181 @value{GDBN}
182 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
183 the operating system
184 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
185 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
186 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
187 how you can copy and share GDB
188 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
189 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
190 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
191 functions, and Python data types
192 @end menu
193
194 @end ifnottex
195
196 @contents
197
198 @node Summary
199 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
200
201 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
202 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
203 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
204
205 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
206 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
207
208 @itemize @bullet
209 @item
210 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
211
212 @item
213 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
214
215 @item
216 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
217
218 @item
219 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
220 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
221 @end itemize
222
223 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
224 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
225 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
226
227 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
228 @ref{D,,D}.
229
230 @cindex Modula-2
231 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
232 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
233
234 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
235 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
236
237 @cindex Pascal
238 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
239 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
240 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
241 syntax.
242
243 @cindex Fortran
244 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
245 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
246 underscore.
247
248 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
249 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
250
251 @menu
252 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
253 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
254 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
255 @end menu
256
257 @node Free Software
258 @unnumberedsec Free Software
259
260 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
261 General Public License
262 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
263 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
264 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
265 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
266 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
267 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
268
269 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
270 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
271 from anyone else.
272
273 @node Free Documentation
274 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
275
276 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
277 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
278 include with the free software. Many of our most important
279 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
280 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
281 when an important free software package does not come with a free
282 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
283 gaps today.
284
285 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
286 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
287 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
288 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
289 them from the free software world.
290
291 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
292 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
293 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
294 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
295 contract to make it non-free.
296
297 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
298 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
299 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
300 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
301 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
302 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
303 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
304
305 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
306 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
307 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
308 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
309
310 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
311 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
312 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
313 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
314 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
315 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
316 community.
317
318 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
319 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
320 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
321 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
322 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
323 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
324 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
325 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
326 of the manual.
327
328 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
329 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
330 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
331 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
332 manual to replace it.
333
334 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
335 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
336 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
337 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
338 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
339 the free software community.
340
341 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
342 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
343 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
344 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
345 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
346 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
347 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
348 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
349 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
350
351 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
352 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
353 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
354 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
355 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
356 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
357 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
358 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
359
360 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
361 published by other publishers, at
362 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
363
364 @node Contributors
365 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
366
367 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
368 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
369 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
370 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
371 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
372 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
373 blow-by-blow account.
374
375 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
376
377 @quotation
378 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
379 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
380 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
381 @end quotation
382
383 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
384 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
385 releases:
386 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
387 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
388 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
389 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
390 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
391 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
392 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
393 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
394 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
395
396 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
397 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
398
399 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
400 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
401 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
402 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
403 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
404
405 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
406 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
407 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
408
409 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
410 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
411
412 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
413
414 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
415 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
416 support.
417 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
418 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
419 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
420 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
421 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
422 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
423 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
424 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
425 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
426 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
427 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
428 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
429 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
430 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
431 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
432 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
433
434 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
435
436 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
437 libraries.
438
439 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
440 about several machine instruction sets.
441
442 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
443 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
444 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
445 and RDI targets, respectively.
446
447 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
448 command-line editing and command history.
449
450 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
451 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
452
453 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
454 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
455 symbols.
456
457 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
458 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
459
460 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
461
462 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
463 processors.
464
465 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
466
467 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
468
469 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
470
471 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
472 watchpoints.
473
474 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
475
476 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
477
478 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
479 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
480
481 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
482 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
483 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
484 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
485 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
486 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
487 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
488
489 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
490 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
491
492 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
493 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
494 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
495 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
496 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
497 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
498 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
499 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
500 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
501 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
502 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
503 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
504 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
505 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
506 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
507
508 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
509 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
510
511 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
512 Hat.
513
514 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
515 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
516 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
517 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
518 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
519 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
520
521 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
522 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
523 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
524 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
525 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
526 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
527 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
528 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
529 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
530 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
531 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
532 Weigand.
533
534 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
535 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
536 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
537 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
538
539 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
540 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
541
542 @node Sample Session
543 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
544
545 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
546 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
547 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
548
549 @iftex
550 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
551 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
552 @end iftex
553
554 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
555 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
556
557 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
558 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
559 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
560 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
561 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
562 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
563 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
564 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
565 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
566
567 @smallexample
568 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
569 $ @b{./m4}
570 @b{define(foo,0000)}
571
572 @b{foo}
573 0000
574 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
575
576 @b{bar}
577 0000
578 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
579
580 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
581 @b{baz}
582 @b{Ctrl-d}
583 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
584 @end smallexample
585
586 @noindent
587 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
588
589 @smallexample
590 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
591 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
592 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
593 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
594 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
595 the conditions.
596 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
597 for details.
598
599 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
600 (@value{GDBP})
601 @end smallexample
602
603 @noindent
604 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
605 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
606 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
607 that examples fit in this manual.
608
609 @smallexample
610 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
611 @end smallexample
612
613 @noindent
614 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
615 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
616 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
617 @code{break} command.
618
619 @smallexample
620 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
621 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
622 @end smallexample
623
624 @noindent
625 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
626 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
627 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
628
629 @smallexample
630 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
631 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
632 @b{define(foo,0000)}
633
634 @b{foo}
635 0000
636 @end smallexample
637
638 @noindent
639 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
640 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
641 context where it stops.
642
643 @smallexample
644 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
645
646 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
647 at builtin.c:879
648 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
649 @end smallexample
650
651 @noindent
652 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
653 the next line of the current function.
654
655 @smallexample
656 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
657 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
658 : nil,
659 @end smallexample
660
661 @noindent
662 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
663 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
664 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
665 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
666
667 @smallexample
668 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
669 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
670 at input.c:530
671 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
672 @end smallexample
673
674 @noindent
675 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
676 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
677 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
678 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
679 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
680 stack frame for each active subroutine.
681
682 @smallexample
683 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
684 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
685 at input.c:530
686 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
687 at builtin.c:882
688 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
689 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
690 at macro.c:71
691 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
692 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
693 @end smallexample
694
695 @noindent
696 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
697 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
698 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
699
700 @smallexample
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
702 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
705 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
706 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
707 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
708 : xstrdup(rq);
709 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
710 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
711 @end smallexample
712
713 @noindent
714 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
715 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
716 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
717 (@code{print}) to see their values.
718
719 @smallexample
720 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
721 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
723 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
724 @end smallexample
725
726 @noindent
727 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
728 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
729 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
730
731 @smallexample
732 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
733 533 xfree(rquote);
734 534
735 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
736 : xstrdup (lq);
737 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
738 : xstrdup (rq);
739 537
740 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
741 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
742 540 @}
743 541
744 542 void
745 @end smallexample
746
747 @noindent
748 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
749 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
750
751 @smallexample
752 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
753 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 540 @}
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
757 $3 = 9
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
759 $4 = 7
760 @end smallexample
761
762 @noindent
763 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
764 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
765 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
766 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
767 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
768 assignments.
769
770 @smallexample
771 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
772 $5 = 7
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
774 $6 = 9
775 @end smallexample
776
777 @noindent
778 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
779 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
780 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
781 example that caused trouble initially:
782
783 @smallexample
784 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
785 Continuing.
786
787 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
788
789 baz
790 0000
791 @end smallexample
792
793 @noindent
794 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
795 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
796 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
797
798 @smallexample
799 @b{Ctrl-d}
800 Program exited normally.
801 @end smallexample
802
803 @noindent
804 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
805 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
806 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
807
808 @smallexample
809 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
810 @end smallexample
811
812 @node Invocation
813 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
814
815 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
816 The essentials are:
817 @itemize @bullet
818 @item
819 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
820 @item
821 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
822 @end itemize
823
824 @menu
825 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
826 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
827 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
828 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
829 @end menu
830
831 @node Invoking GDB
832 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
833
834 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
835 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
836
837 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
838 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
839
840 The command-line options described here are designed
841 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
842 options may effectively be unavailable.
843
844 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
845 specifying an executable program:
846
847 @smallexample
848 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
849 @end smallexample
850
851 @noindent
852 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
853 specified:
854
855 @smallexample
856 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
857 @end smallexample
858
859 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
860 to debug a running process:
861
862 @smallexample
863 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
864 @end smallexample
865
866 @noindent
867 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
868 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
869
870 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
871 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
872 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
873 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
874 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
875
876 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
877 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
878 option processing.
879 @smallexample
880 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
881 @end smallexample
882 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
883 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
884
885 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
886 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
887
888 @smallexample
889 @value{GDBP} -silent
890 @end smallexample
891
892 @noindent
893 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
894 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
895
896 @noindent
897 Type
898
899 @smallexample
900 @value{GDBP} -help
901 @end smallexample
902
903 @noindent
904 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
905 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
906
907 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
908 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
909 @samp{-x} option is used.
910
911
912 @menu
913 * File Options:: Choosing files
914 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
915 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
916 @end menu
917
918 @node File Options
919 @subsection Choosing Files
920
921 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
922 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
923 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
924 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
925 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
926 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
927 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
928 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
929 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
930 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
931 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
932 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
933 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
934
935 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
936 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
937 argument and ignore it.
938
939 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
940 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
941 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
942 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
943 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
944
945 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
946 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
947 @c it.
948
949 @table @code
950 @item -symbols @var{file}
951 @itemx -s @var{file}
952 @cindex @code{--symbols}
953 @cindex @code{-s}
954 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
955
956 @item -exec @var{file}
957 @itemx -e @var{file}
958 @cindex @code{--exec}
959 @cindex @code{-e}
960 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
961 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
962
963 @item -se @var{file}
964 @cindex @code{--se}
965 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
966 file.
967
968 @item -core @var{file}
969 @itemx -c @var{file}
970 @cindex @code{--core}
971 @cindex @code{-c}
972 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
973
974 @item -pid @var{number}
975 @itemx -p @var{number}
976 @cindex @code{--pid}
977 @cindex @code{-p}
978 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
979
980 @item -command @var{file}
981 @itemx -x @var{file}
982 @cindex @code{--command}
983 @cindex @code{-x}
984 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
985 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
986 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
987
988 @item -eval-command @var{command}
989 @itemx -ex @var{command}
990 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
991 @cindex @code{-ex}
992 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
993
994 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
995 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
996
997 @smallexample
998 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
999 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1000 @end smallexample
1001
1002 @item -init-command @var{file}
1003 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1004 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1005 @cindex @code{-ix}
1006 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1007 after loading gdbinit files).
1008 @xref{Startup}.
1009
1010 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1011 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1012 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1013 @cindex @code{-iex}
1014 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1015 after loading gdbinit files).
1016 @xref{Startup}.
1017
1018 @item -directory @var{directory}
1019 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1020 @cindex @code{--directory}
1021 @cindex @code{-d}
1022 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1023
1024 @item -r
1025 @itemx -readnow
1026 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1027 @cindex @code{-r}
1028 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1029 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1030 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1031
1032 @end table
1033
1034 @node Mode Options
1035 @subsection Choosing Modes
1036
1037 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1038 batch mode or quiet mode.
1039
1040 @table @code
1041 @anchor{-nx}
1042 @item -nx
1043 @itemx -n
1044 @cindex @code{--nx}
1045 @cindex @code{-n}
1046 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1047 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1048
1049 @table @code
1050 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1051 This is the system-wide init file.
1052 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1053 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1054 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1055 have been processed.
1056 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1057 This is the init file in your home directory.
1058 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1059 command options have been processed.
1060 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1061 This is the init file in the current directory.
1062 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1063 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1064 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1065 @end table
1066
1067 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1068 For documentation on how to write command files,
1069 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1070
1071 @anchor{-nh}
1072 @item -nh
1073 @cindex @code{--nh}
1074 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1075 in your home directory.
1076 @xref{Startup}.
1077
1078 @item -quiet
1079 @itemx -silent
1080 @itemx -q
1081 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1082 @cindex @code{--silent}
1083 @cindex @code{-q}
1084 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1085 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1086
1087 @item -batch
1088 @cindex @code{--batch}
1089 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1090 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1091 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1092 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1093 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1094 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1095 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1096
1097 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1098 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1099 make this more useful, the message
1100
1101 @smallexample
1102 Program exited normally.
1103 @end smallexample
1104
1105 @noindent
1106 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1107 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1108 mode.
1109
1110 @item -batch-silent
1111 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1112 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1113 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1114 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1115 for an interactive session.
1116
1117 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1118 messages, for example.
1119
1120 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1121 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1122
1123 @item -return-child-result
1124 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1125 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1126 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1127
1128 @itemize @bullet
1129 @item
1130 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1131 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1132 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1133 @item
1134 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1135 @item
1136 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1137 the exit code will be -1.
1138 @end itemize
1139
1140 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1141 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1142 interface.
1143
1144 @item -nowindows
1145 @itemx -nw
1146 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1147 @cindex @code{-nw}
1148 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1149 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1150 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1151
1152 @item -windows
1153 @itemx -w
1154 @cindex @code{--windows}
1155 @cindex @code{-w}
1156 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1157 used if possible.
1158
1159 @item -cd @var{directory}
1160 @cindex @code{--cd}
1161 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1162 instead of the current directory.
1163
1164 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1165 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1166 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1167 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1168 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1169
1170 @item -fullname
1171 @itemx -f
1172 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1173 @cindex @code{-f}
1174 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1175 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1176 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1177 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1178 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1179 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1180 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1181 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1182 frame.
1183
1184 @item -epoch
1185 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1186 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1187 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1188 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1189 separate window.
1190
1191 @item -annotate @var{level}
1192 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1193 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1194 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1195 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1196 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1197 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1198 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1199 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1200 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1201
1202 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1203 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1204
1205 @item --args
1206 @cindex @code{--args}
1207 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1208 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1209 This option stops option processing.
1210
1211 @item -baud @var{bps}
1212 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1213 @cindex @code{--baud}
1214 @cindex @code{-b}
1215 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1216 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1217
1218 @item -l @var{timeout}
1219 @cindex @code{-l}
1220 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1221 for remote debugging.
1222
1223 @item -tty @var{device}
1224 @itemx -t @var{device}
1225 @cindex @code{--tty}
1226 @cindex @code{-t}
1227 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1228 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1229
1230 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1231 @item -tui
1232 @cindex @code{--tui}
1233 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1234 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1235 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1236 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1237 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1238 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1239
1240 @c @item -xdb
1241 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1242 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1243 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1244 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1245 @c systems.
1246
1247 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1248 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1249 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1250 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1251 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1252 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1253
1254 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1255 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1256 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1257 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1258 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1259 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1260
1261 @item -write
1262 @cindex @code{--write}
1263 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1264 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1265 (@pxref{Patching}).
1266
1267 @item -statistics
1268 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1269 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1270 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1271
1272 @item -version
1273 @cindex @code{--version}
1274 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1275 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1276
1277 @end table
1278
1279 @node Startup
1280 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1281 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1282
1283 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1284
1285 @enumerate
1286 @item
1287 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1288 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1289
1290 @item
1291 @cindex init file
1292 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1293 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1294 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1295 that file.
1296
1297 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1298 @item
1299 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1300 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1301 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1302 that file.
1303
1304 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1305 @item
1306 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1307 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1308 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1309 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1310 gets loaded.
1311
1312 @item
1313 Processes command line options and operands.
1314
1315 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1316 @item
1317 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1318 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1319 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1320 This is only done if the current directory is
1321 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1322 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1323 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1324 @value{GDBN}.
1325
1326 @item
1327 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1328 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1329 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1330 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1331
1332 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1333 you must do something like the following:
1334
1335 @smallexample
1336 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1337 @end smallexample
1338
1339 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1340 off too late.
1341
1342 @item
1343 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1344 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1345 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1346
1347 @item
1348 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1349 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1350 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1351 @end enumerate
1352
1353 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1354 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1355 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1356 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1357 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1358 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1359
1360 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1361 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1362
1363 @cindex init file name
1364 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1365 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1366 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1367 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1368 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1369 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1370 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1371 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1372
1373
1374 @node Quitting GDB
1375 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1376 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1377 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1378
1379 @table @code
1380 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1381 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1382 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1383 @itemx q
1384 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1385 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1386 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1387 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1388 error code.
1389 @end table
1390
1391 @cindex interrupt
1392 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1393 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1394 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1395 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1396 until a time when it is safe.
1397
1398 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1399 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1400 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1401
1402 @node Shell Commands
1403 @section Shell Commands
1404
1405 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1406 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1407 just use the @code{shell} command.
1408
1409 @table @code
1410 @kindex shell
1411 @kindex !
1412 @cindex shell escape
1413 @item shell @var{command-string}
1414 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1415 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1416 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1417 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1418 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1419 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1420 @end table
1421
1422 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1423 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1424 @value{GDBN}:
1425
1426 @table @code
1427 @kindex make
1428 @cindex calling make
1429 @item make @var{make-args}
1430 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1431 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1432 @end table
1433
1434 @node Logging Output
1435 @section Logging Output
1436 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1437 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1438
1439 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1440 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1441
1442 @table @code
1443 @kindex set logging
1444 @item set logging on
1445 Enable logging.
1446 @item set logging off
1447 Disable logging.
1448 @cindex logging file name
1449 @item set logging file @var{file}
1450 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1451 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1452 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1453 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1454 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1455 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1456 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1457 @kindex show logging
1458 @item show logging
1459 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1460 @end table
1461
1462 @node Commands
1463 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1464
1465 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1466 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1467 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1468 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1469 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1470
1471 @menu
1472 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1473 * Completion:: Command completion
1474 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1475 @end menu
1476
1477 @node Command Syntax
1478 @section Command Syntax
1479
1480 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1481 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1482 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1483 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1484 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1485 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1486
1487 @cindex abbreviation
1488 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1489 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1490 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1491 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1492 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1493 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1494 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1495
1496 @cindex repeating commands
1497 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1498 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1499 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1500 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1501 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1502 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1503 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1504
1505 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1506 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1507 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1508
1509 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1510 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1511 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1512 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1513 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1514
1515 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1516 @cindex comment
1517 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1518 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1519 Files,,Command Files}).
1520
1521 @cindex repeating command sequences
1522 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1523 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1524 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1525 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1526 for editing.
1527
1528 @node Completion
1529 @section Command Completion
1530
1531 @cindex completion
1532 @cindex word completion
1533 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1534 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1535 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1536 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1537
1538 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1539 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1540 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1541 enter it). For example, if you type
1542
1543 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1544 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1545 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1546 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1547 @smallexample
1548 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1549 @end smallexample
1550
1551 @noindent
1552 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1553 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1554
1555 @smallexample
1556 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1557 @end smallexample
1558
1559 @noindent
1560 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1561 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1562 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1563 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1564 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1565 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1566
1567 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1568 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1569 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1570 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1571 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1572 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1573 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1574 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1575 example:
1576
1577 @smallexample
1578 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1579 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1580 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1581 make_abs_section make_function_type
1582 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1583 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1584 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1585 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1586 @end smallexample
1587
1588 @noindent
1589 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1590 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1591 command.
1592
1593 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1594 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1595 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1596 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1597 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1598
1599 @cindex quotes in commands
1600 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1601 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1602 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1603 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1604 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1605 @value{GDBN} commands.
1606
1607 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1608 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1609 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1610 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1611 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1612 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1613 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1614 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1615 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1616 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1617 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1618
1619 @smallexample
1620 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1621 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1622 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1623 @end smallexample
1624
1625 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1626 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1627 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1628 place:
1629
1630 @smallexample
1631 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1632 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1633 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1634 @end smallexample
1635
1636 @noindent
1637 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1638 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1639 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1640
1641 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1642 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1643 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1644 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1645
1646 @cindex completion of structure field names
1647 @cindex structure field name completion
1648 @cindex completion of union field names
1649 @cindex union field name completion
1650 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1651 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1652 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1653 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1654 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1655 left-hand-side:
1656
1657 @smallexample
1658 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1659 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1660 to_data to_isatty to_write
1661 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1662 to_flush to_read
1663 @end smallexample
1664
1665 @noindent
1666 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1667 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1668 follows:
1669
1670 @smallexample
1671 struct ui_file
1672 @{
1673 int *magic;
1674 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1675 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1676 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1677 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1678 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1679 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1680 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1681 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1682 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1683 void *to_data;
1684 @}
1685 @end smallexample
1686
1687
1688 @node Help
1689 @section Getting Help
1690 @cindex online documentation
1691 @kindex help
1692
1693 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1694 using the command @code{help}.
1695
1696 @table @code
1697 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1698 @item help
1699 @itemx h
1700 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1701 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1702
1703 @smallexample
1704 (@value{GDBP}) help
1705 List of classes of commands:
1706
1707 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1708 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1709 data -- Examining data
1710 files -- Specifying and examining files
1711 internals -- Maintenance commands
1712 obscure -- Obscure features
1713 running -- Running the program
1714 stack -- Examining the stack
1715 status -- Status inquiries
1716 support -- Support facilities
1717 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1718 stopping the program
1719 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1720
1721 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1722 commands in that class.
1723 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1724 documentation.
1725 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1726 (@value{GDBP})
1727 @end smallexample
1728 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1729
1730 @item help @var{class}
1731 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1732 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1733 help display for the class @code{status}:
1734
1735 @smallexample
1736 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1737 Status inquiries.
1738
1739 List of commands:
1740
1741 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1742 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1743 info -- Generic command for showing things
1744 about the program being debugged
1745 show -- Generic command for showing things
1746 about the debugger
1747
1748 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1749 documentation.
1750 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1751 (@value{GDBP})
1752 @end smallexample
1753
1754 @item help @var{command}
1755 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1756 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1757
1758 @kindex apropos
1759 @item apropos @var{args}
1760 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1761 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1762 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1763
1764 @smallexample
1765 apropos alias
1766 @end smallexample
1767
1768 @noindent
1769 results in:
1770
1771 @smallexample
1772 @c @group
1773 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1774 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1775 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1776 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1777 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1778 @c @end group
1779 @end smallexample
1780
1781 @kindex complete
1782 @item complete @var{args}
1783 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1784 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1785 command you want completed. For example:
1786
1787 @smallexample
1788 complete i
1789 @end smallexample
1790
1791 @noindent results in:
1792
1793 @smallexample
1794 @group
1795 if
1796 ignore
1797 info
1798 inspect
1799 @end group
1800 @end smallexample
1801
1802 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1803 @end table
1804
1805 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1806 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1807 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1808 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1809 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1810 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1811 Index}.
1812
1813 @c @group
1814 @table @code
1815 @kindex info
1816 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1817 @item info
1818 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1819 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1820 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1821 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1822 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1823 @w{@code{help info}}.
1824
1825 @kindex set
1826 @item set
1827 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1828 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1829 @code{set prompt $}.
1830
1831 @kindex show
1832 @item show
1833 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1834 @value{GDBN} itself.
1835 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1836 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1837 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1838 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1839
1840 @kindex info set
1841 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1842 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1843 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1844 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1845 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1846 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1847 @end table
1848 @c @end group
1849
1850 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1851 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1852
1853 @table @code
1854 @kindex show version
1855 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1856 @item show version
1857 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1858 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1859 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1860 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1861 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1862 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1863 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1864 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1865 @value{GDBN}.
1866
1867 @kindex show copying
1868 @kindex info copying
1869 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1870 @item show copying
1871 @itemx info copying
1872 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1873
1874 @kindex show warranty
1875 @kindex info warranty
1876 @item show warranty
1877 @itemx info warranty
1878 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1879 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1880
1881 @end table
1882
1883 @node Running
1884 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1885
1886 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1887 debugging information when you compile it.
1888
1889 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1890 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1891 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1892 kill a child process.
1893
1894 @menu
1895 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1896 * Starting:: Starting your program
1897 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1898 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1899
1900 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1901 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1902 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1903 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1904
1905 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1906 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1907 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1908 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1909 @end menu
1910
1911 @node Compilation
1912 @section Compiling for Debugging
1913
1914 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1915 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1916 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1917 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1918 and addresses in the executable code.
1919
1920 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1921 the compiler.
1922
1923 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1924 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1925 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1926 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1927 executables containing debugging information.
1928
1929 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1930 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1931 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1932 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1933 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1934
1935 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1936 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1937 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1938
1939 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1940 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1941 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1942 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1943 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1944 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1945
1946 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1947 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1948 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1949
1950 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1951 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1952 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1953 format in @value{GDBN}.
1954
1955 @need 2000
1956 @node Starting
1957 @section Starting your Program
1958 @cindex starting
1959 @cindex running
1960
1961 @table @code
1962 @kindex run
1963 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1964 @item run
1965 @itemx r
1966 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1967 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1968 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1969 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1970 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1971
1972 @end table
1973
1974 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1975 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1976 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1977 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1978 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1979 message like this one:
1980
1981 @smallexample
1982 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1983 Try "help target" or "continue".
1984 @end smallexample
1985
1986 @noindent
1987 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1988 first (@pxref{load}).
1989
1990 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1991 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1992 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1993 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1994 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1995 divided into four categories:
1996
1997 @table @asis
1998 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1999 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2000 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2001 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2002 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2003 the arguments.
2004 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2005 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
2006 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
2007
2008 @item The @emph{environment.}
2009 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2010 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2011 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2012 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2013
2014 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2015 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2016 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2017 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2018
2019 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2020 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2021 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2022 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2023 set a different device for your program.
2024 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2025
2026 @cindex pipes
2027 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2028 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2029 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2030 wrong program.
2031 @end table
2032
2033 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2034 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2035 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2036 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2037 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2038
2039 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2040 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2041 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2042 your current breakpoints.
2043
2044 @table @code
2045 @kindex start
2046 @item start
2047 @cindex run to main procedure
2048 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2049 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2050 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2051 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2052 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2053 procedure, depending on the language used.
2054
2055 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2056 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2057 the @samp{run} command.
2058
2059 @cindex elaboration phase
2060 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2061 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2062 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2063 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2064 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2065 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2066 will remain to halt execution.
2067
2068 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2069 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2070 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2071 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2072 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2073
2074 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2075 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2076 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2077 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2078 elaboration code before running your program.
2079
2080 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2081 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2082 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2083 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2084 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2085 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2086 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2087 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2088 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2089 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2090 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2091
2092 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2093 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2094 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2095 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2096
2097 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2098 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2099 environment:
2100
2101 @smallexample
2102 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2103 (@value{GDBP}) run
2104 @end smallexample
2105
2106 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2107 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2108
2109 @kindex set disable-randomization
2110 @item set disable-randomization
2111 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2112 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2113 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2114 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2115 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2116
2117 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2118 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2119
2120 @smallexample
2121 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2122 @end smallexample
2123
2124 @item set disable-randomization off
2125 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2126 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2127 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2128 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2129 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2130 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2131
2132 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2133 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2134 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2135 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2136 a code at its expected addresses.
2137
2138 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2139 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2140 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2141 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2142 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2143 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2144 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2145 a randomly chosen address.
2146
2147 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2148 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2149 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2150 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2151 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2152
2153 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2154 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2155
2156 @item show disable-randomization
2157 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2158 the virtual address space of the started program.
2159
2160 @end table
2161
2162 @node Arguments
2163 @section Your Program's Arguments
2164
2165 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2166 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2167 @code{run} command.
2168 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2169 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2170 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2171 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2172 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2173
2174 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2175 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2176 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2177 the program, not by the shell.
2178
2179 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2180 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2181
2182 @table @code
2183 @kindex set args
2184 @item set args
2185 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2186 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2187 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2188 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2189 it again without arguments.
2190
2191 @kindex show args
2192 @item show args
2193 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2194 @end table
2195
2196 @node Environment
2197 @section Your Program's Environment
2198
2199 @cindex environment (of your program)
2200 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2201 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2202 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2203 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2204 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2205 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2206 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2207
2208 @table @code
2209 @kindex path
2210 @item path @var{directory}
2211 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2212 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2213 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2214 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2215 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2216 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2217 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2218
2219 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2220 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2221 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2222 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2223 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2224 @var{directory} to the search path.
2225 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2226 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2227
2228 @kindex show paths
2229 @item show paths
2230 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2231 environment variable).
2232
2233 @kindex show environment
2234 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2235 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2236 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2237 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2238 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2239
2240 @kindex set environment
2241 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2242 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2243 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2244 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2245 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2246 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2247 null value.
2248 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2249 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2250
2251 For example, this command:
2252
2253 @smallexample
2254 set env USER = foo
2255 @end smallexample
2256
2257 @noindent
2258 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2259 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2260 are not actually required.)
2261
2262 @kindex unset environment
2263 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2264 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2265 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2266 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2267 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2268 @end table
2269
2270 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2271 the shell indicated
2272 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2273 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2274 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2275 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2276 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2277 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2278 @file{.profile}.
2279
2280 @node Working Directory
2281 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2282
2283 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2284 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2285 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2286 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2287 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2288 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2289
2290 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2291 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2292 Specify Files}.
2293
2294 @table @code
2295 @kindex cd
2296 @cindex change working directory
2297 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2298 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2299 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2300
2301 @kindex pwd
2302 @item pwd
2303 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2304 @end table
2305
2306 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2307 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2308 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2309 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2310 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2311 current working directory of the debuggee.
2312
2313 @node Input/Output
2314 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2315
2316 @cindex redirection
2317 @cindex i/o
2318 @cindex terminal
2319 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2320 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2321 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2322 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2323 running your program.
2324
2325 @table @code
2326 @kindex info terminal
2327 @item info terminal
2328 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2329 program is using.
2330 @end table
2331
2332 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2333 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2334
2335 @smallexample
2336 run > outfile
2337 @end smallexample
2338
2339 @noindent
2340 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2341
2342 @kindex tty
2343 @cindex controlling terminal
2344 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2345 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2346 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2347 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2348 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2349
2350 @smallexample
2351 tty /dev/ttyb
2352 @end smallexample
2353
2354 @noindent
2355 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2356 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2357 that as their controlling terminal.
2358
2359 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2360 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2361 terminal.
2362
2363 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2364 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2365 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2366 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2367
2368 @cindex inferior tty
2369 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2370 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2371 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2372 program.
2373
2374 @table @code
2375 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2376 @kindex set inferior-tty
2377 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2378
2379 @item show inferior-tty
2380 @kindex show inferior-tty
2381 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2382 @end table
2383
2384 @node Attach
2385 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2386 @kindex attach
2387 @cindex attach
2388
2389 @table @code
2390 @item attach @var{process-id}
2391 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2392 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2393 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2394 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2395 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2396
2397 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2398 executing the command.
2399 @end table
2400
2401 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2402 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2403 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2404 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2405
2406 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2407 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2408 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2409 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2410 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2411 Specify Files}.
2412
2413 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2414 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2415 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2416 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2417 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2418 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2419 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2420
2421 @table @code
2422 @kindex detach
2423 @item detach
2424 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2425 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2426 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2427 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2428 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2429 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2430 executing the command.
2431 @end table
2432
2433 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2434 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2435 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2436 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2437 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2438 Messages}).
2439
2440 @node Kill Process
2441 @section Killing the Child Process
2442
2443 @table @code
2444 @kindex kill
2445 @item kill
2446 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2447 @end table
2448
2449 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2450 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2451 is running.
2452
2453 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2454 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2455 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2456 outside the debugger.
2457
2458 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2459 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2460 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2461 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2462 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2463 breakpoint settings).
2464
2465 @node Inferiors and Programs
2466 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2467
2468 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2469 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2470 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2471 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2472 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2473 from multiple executables.
2474
2475 @cindex inferior
2476 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2477 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2478 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2479 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2480 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2481 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2482 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2483 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2484 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2485 threads running in it.
2486
2487 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2488 inferiors}}:
2489
2490 @table @code
2491 @kindex info inferiors
2492 @item info inferiors
2493 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2494
2495 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2496
2497 @enumerate
2498 @item
2499 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2500
2501 @item
2502 the target system's inferior identifier
2503
2504 @item
2505 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2506
2507 @end enumerate
2508
2509 @noindent
2510 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2511 indicates the current inferior.
2512
2513 For example,
2514 @end table
2515 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2516
2517 @smallexample
2518 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2519 Num Description Executable
2520 2 process 2307 hello
2521 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2522 @end smallexample
2523
2524 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2525
2526 @table @code
2527 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2528 @item inferior @var{infno}
2529 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2530 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2531 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2532 @end table
2533
2534
2535 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2536 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2537 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2538 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2539 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2540 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2541
2542 @table @code
2543 @kindex add-inferior
2544 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2545 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2546 executable. @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2547 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2548 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2549 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2550
2551 @kindex clone-inferior
2552 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2553 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2554 @var{infno}. @var{n} defaults to 1. @var{infno} defaults to the
2555 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2556 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2557
2558 @smallexample
2559 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2560 Num Description Executable
2561 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2562 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2563 Added inferior 2.
2564 1 inferiors added.
2565 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2566 Num Description Executable
2567 2 <null> helloworld
2568 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2569 @end smallexample
2570
2571 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2572
2573 @kindex remove-inferiors
2574 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2575 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2576 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2577 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2578
2579 @end table
2580
2581 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2582 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2583 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2584 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2585
2586 @table @code
2587 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2588 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2589 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2590 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2591 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2592 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2593
2594 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2595 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2596 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2597 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2598 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2599 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2600 @end table
2601
2602 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2603 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2604 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2605 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2606
2607
2608 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2609 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2610
2611 @table @code
2612 @kindex set print inferior-events
2613 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2614 @item set print inferior-events
2615 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2616 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2617 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2618 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2619 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2620 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2621
2622 @kindex show print inferior-events
2623 @item show print inferior-events
2624 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2625 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2626 @end table
2627
2628 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2629 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2630 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2631
2632
2633 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2634 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2635 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2636 info program-spaces}} command.
2637
2638 @table @code
2639 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2640 @item maint info program-spaces
2641 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2642 @value{GDBN}.
2643
2644 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2645
2646 @enumerate
2647 @item
2648 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2649
2650 @item
2651 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2652 the @code{file} command.
2653
2654 @end enumerate
2655
2656 @noindent
2657 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2658 indicates the current program space.
2659
2660 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2661 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2662 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2663
2664 @smallexample
2665 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2666 Id Executable
2667 2 goodbye
2668 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2669 * 1 hello
2670 @end smallexample
2671
2672 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2673 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2674 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2675 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2676 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2677
2678 @smallexample
2679 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2680 Id Executable
2681 * 1 vfork-test
2682 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2683 @end smallexample
2684
2685 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2686 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2687 @end table
2688
2689 @node Threads
2690 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2691
2692 @cindex threads of execution
2693 @cindex multiple threads
2694 @cindex switching threads
2695 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2696 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2697 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2698 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2699 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2700 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2701 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2702
2703 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2704 programs:
2705
2706 @itemize @bullet
2707 @item automatic notification of new threads
2708 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2709 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2710 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2711 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2712 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2713 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2714 messages on thread start and exit.
2715 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2716 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2717 isn't compatible with the program.
2718 @end itemize
2719
2720 @quotation
2721 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2722 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2723 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2724 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2725 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2726 like this:
2727
2728 @smallexample
2729 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2730 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2731 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2732 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2733 @end smallexample
2734 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2735 @c doesn't support threads"?
2736 @end quotation
2737
2738 @cindex focus of debugging
2739 @cindex current thread
2740 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2741 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2742 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2743 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2744 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2745
2746 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2747 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2748 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2749 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2750 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2751 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2752 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2753 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2754 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2755 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2756
2757 @smallexample
2758 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2759 @end smallexample
2760
2761 @noindent
2762 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2763 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2764 further qualifier.
2765
2766 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2767 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2768 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2769 @c program?
2770 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2771 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2772 @c threads ab initio?
2773
2774 @cindex thread number
2775 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2776 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2777 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2778
2779 @table @code
2780 @kindex info threads
2781 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2782 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2783 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2784 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2785 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2786
2787 @enumerate
2788 @item
2789 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2790
2791 @item
2792 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2793
2794 @item
2795 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2796 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2797 program itself.
2798
2799 @item
2800 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2801 @end enumerate
2802
2803 @noindent
2804 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2805 indicates the current thread.
2806
2807 For example,
2808 @end table
2809 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2810
2811 @smallexample
2812 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2813 Id Target Id Frame
2814 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2815 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2816 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2817 at threadtest.c:68
2818 @end smallexample
2819
2820 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2821 Solaris-specific command:
2822
2823 @table @code
2824 @item maint info sol-threads
2825 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2826 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2827 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2828 @end table
2829
2830 @table @code
2831 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2832 @item thread @var{threadno}
2833 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2834 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2835 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2836 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2837 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2838
2839 @smallexample
2840 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2841 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2842 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2843 8 printf ("hello\n");
2844 @end smallexample
2845
2846 @noindent
2847 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2848 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2849 threads.
2850
2851 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2852 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2853 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2854 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2855 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2856 information on convenience variables.
2857
2858 @kindex thread apply
2859 @cindex apply command to several threads
2860 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all] @var{command}
2861 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2862 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2863 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2864 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2865 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2866 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2867 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2868
2869 @kindex thread name
2870 @cindex name a thread
2871 @item thread name [@var{name}]
2872 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
2873 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
2874 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
2875
2876 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
2877 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
2878 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
2879 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
2880 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
2881
2882 @kindex thread find
2883 @cindex search for a thread
2884 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
2885 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
2886 matches the supplied regular expression.
2887
2888 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
2889 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
2890 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
2891 is the LWP id.
2892
2893 @smallexample
2894 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
2895 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
2896 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
2897 Id Target Id Frame
2898 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
2899 @end smallexample
2900
2901 @kindex set print thread-events
2902 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2903 @item set print thread-events
2904 @itemx set print thread-events on
2905 @itemx set print thread-events off
2906 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2907 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2908 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2909 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2910 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2911
2912 @kindex show print thread-events
2913 @item show print thread-events
2914 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2915 have started and exited.
2916 @end table
2917
2918 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2919 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2920 programs with multiple threads.
2921
2922 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2923 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2924
2925 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
2926 @table @code
2927 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
2928 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
2929 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
2930 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
2931 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
2932 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
2933 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
2934 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
2935 macro.
2936
2937 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
2938 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
2939 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2940 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
2941 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
2942 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
2943
2944 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2945 refers to the default system directories that are
2946 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
2947 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
2948 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
2949
2950 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2951 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
2952 was loaded in the inferior process.
2953
2954 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
2955 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
2956 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
2957 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
2958 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
2959 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
2960 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
2961
2962 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
2963 only on some platforms.
2964
2965 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
2966 @item show libthread-db-search-path
2967 Display current libthread_db search path.
2968
2969 @kindex set debug libthread-db
2970 @kindex show debug libthread-db
2971 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
2972 @item set debug libthread-db
2973 @itemx show debug libthread-db
2974 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
2975 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
2976 @end table
2977
2978 @node Forks
2979 @section Debugging Forks
2980
2981 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2982 @cindex multiple processes
2983 @cindex processes, multiple
2984 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2985 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2986 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2987 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2988 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2989 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2990 will cause it to terminate.
2991
2992 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2993 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2994 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2995 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2996 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2997 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2998 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2999 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3000 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3001 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3002
3003 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
3004 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
3005 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
3006 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
3007
3008 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3009 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3010
3011 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3012 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3013
3014 @table @code
3015 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3016 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3017 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3018 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3019 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3020
3021 @table @code
3022 @item parent
3023 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3024 unimpeded. This is the default.
3025
3026 @item child
3027 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3028 unimpeded.
3029
3030 @end table
3031
3032 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3033 @item show follow-fork-mode
3034 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3035 @end table
3036
3037 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3038 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3039 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3040
3041 @table @code
3042 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3043 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3044 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3045 retain debugger control over them both.
3046
3047 @table @code
3048 @item on
3049 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3050 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3051 independently. This is the default.
3052
3053 @item off
3054 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3055 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3056 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3057 is held suspended.
3058
3059 @end table
3060
3061 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3062 @item show detach-on-fork
3063 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3064 @end table
3065
3066 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3067 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3068 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3069 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3070 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3071 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3072
3073 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3074 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3075 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3076 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3077 and Programs}.
3078
3079 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3080 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3081 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3082 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3083 the child process's @code{main}.
3084
3085 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3086 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3087
3088 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3089 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3090 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3091 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3092 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3093 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3094 command.
3095
3096 @table @code
3097 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3098 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3099
3100 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3101 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3102
3103 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3104
3105 @table @code
3106 @item new
3107 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3108 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3109 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3110 original inferior.
3111
3112 For example:
3113
3114 @smallexample
3115 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3116 (gdb) info inferior
3117 Id Description Executable
3118 * 1 <null> prog1
3119 (@value{GDBP}) run
3120 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3121 Program exited normally.
3122 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3123 Id Description Executable
3124 * 2 <null> prog2
3125 1 <null> prog1
3126 @end smallexample
3127
3128 @item same
3129 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3130 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3131 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3132 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3133 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3134
3135 For example:
3136
3137 @smallexample
3138 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3139 Id Description Executable
3140 * 1 <null> prog1
3141 (@value{GDBP}) run
3142 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3143 Program exited normally.
3144 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3145 Id Description Executable
3146 * 1 <null> prog2
3147 @end smallexample
3148
3149 @end table
3150 @end table
3151
3152 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3153 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3154 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3155
3156 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3157 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3158
3159 @cindex checkpoint
3160 @cindex restart
3161 @cindex bookmark
3162 @cindex snapshot of a process
3163 @cindex rewind program state
3164
3165 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3166 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3167 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3168 later.
3169
3170 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3171 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3172 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3173 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3174 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3175
3176 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3177 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3178 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3179 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3180 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3181 start again from there.
3182
3183 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3184 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3185
3186 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3187
3188 @table @code
3189 @kindex checkpoint
3190 @item checkpoint
3191 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3192 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3193 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3194
3195 @kindex info checkpoints
3196 @item info checkpoints
3197 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3198 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3199 listed:
3200
3201 @table @code
3202 @item Checkpoint ID
3203 @item Process ID
3204 @item Code Address
3205 @item Source line, or label
3206 @end table
3207
3208 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3209 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3210 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3211 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3212 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3213 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3214 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3215
3216 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3217 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3218 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3219 the debugger.
3220
3221 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3222 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3223 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3224
3225 @end table
3226
3227 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3228 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3229 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3230 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3231 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3232 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3233 previously read data can be read again.
3234
3235 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3236 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3237 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3238 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3239 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3240 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3241
3242 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3243 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3244 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3245 different execution path this time.
3246
3247 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3248 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3249 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3250 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3251 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3252 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3253 potentially pose a problem.
3254
3255 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3256
3257 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3258 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3259 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3260 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3261 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3262 next.
3263
3264 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3265 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3266 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3267 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3268 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3269
3270 @node Stopping
3271 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3272
3273 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3274 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3275 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3276
3277 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3278 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3279 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3280 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3281 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3282 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3283 explicitly request this information at any time.
3284
3285 @table @code
3286 @kindex info program
3287 @item info program
3288 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3289 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3290 @end table
3291
3292 @menu
3293 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3294 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3295 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3296 Skipping over functions and files
3297 * Signals:: Signals
3298 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3299 @end menu
3300
3301 @node Breakpoints
3302 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3303
3304 @cindex breakpoints
3305 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3306 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3307 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3308 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3309 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3310 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3311 program.
3312
3313 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3314 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3315 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3316 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3317 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3318 call).
3319
3320 @cindex watchpoints
3321 @cindex data breakpoints
3322 @cindex memory tracing
3323 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3324 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3325 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3326 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3327 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3328 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3329 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3330 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3331 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3332 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3333 same commands.
3334
3335 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3336 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3337 Automatic Display}.
3338
3339 @cindex catchpoints
3340 @cindex breakpoint on events
3341 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3342 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3343 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3344 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3345 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3346 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3347 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3348
3349 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3350 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3351 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3352 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3353 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3354 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3355 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3356 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3357 enable it again.
3358
3359 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3360 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3361 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3362 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3363 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3364 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3365 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3366
3367 @menu
3368 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3369 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3370 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3371 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3372 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3373 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3374 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3375 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3376 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3377 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3378 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3379 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3380 @end menu
3381
3382 @node Set Breaks
3383 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3384
3385 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3386 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3387 @c
3388 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3389
3390 @kindex break
3391 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3392 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3393 @cindex latest breakpoint
3394 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3395 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3396 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3397 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3398 convenience variables.
3399
3400 @table @code
3401 @item break @var{location}
3402 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3403 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3404 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3405 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3406 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3407
3408 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3409 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3410 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3411 that situation.
3412
3413 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3414 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3415 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3416
3417 @item break
3418 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3419 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3420 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3421 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3422 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3423 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3424 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3425 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3426 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3427 inside loops.
3428
3429 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3430 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3431 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3432 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3433 existed when your program stopped.
3434
3435 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3436 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3437 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3438 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3439 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3440 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3441 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3442
3443 @kindex tbreak
3444 @item tbreak @var{args}
3445 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3446 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3447 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3448 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3449
3450 @kindex hbreak
3451 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3452 @item hbreak @var{args}
3453 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3454 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3455 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3456 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3457 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3458 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3459 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3460 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3461 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3462 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3463 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3464 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3465 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3466 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3467 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3468 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3469 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3470 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3471
3472 @kindex thbreak
3473 @item thbreak @var{args}
3474 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3475 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3476 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3477 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3478 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3479 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3480 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3481 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3482
3483 @kindex rbreak
3484 @cindex regular expression
3485 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3486 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3487 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3488 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3489 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3490 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3491 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3492 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3493 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3494
3495 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3496 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3497 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3498 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3499 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3500 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3501
3502 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3503 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3504 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3505 classes.
3506
3507 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3508 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3509 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3510
3511 @smallexample
3512 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3513 @end smallexample
3514
3515 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3516 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3517 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3518 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3519 every function in a given file:
3520
3521 @smallexample
3522 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3523 @end smallexample
3524
3525 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3526 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3527
3528 @kindex info breakpoints
3529 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3530 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3531 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3532 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3533 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3534 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3535 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3536
3537 @table @emph
3538 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3539 @item Type
3540 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3541 @item Disposition
3542 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3543 @item Enabled or Disabled
3544 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3545 that are not enabled.
3546 @item Address
3547 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3548 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3549 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3550 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3551 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3552 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3553 @item What
3554 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3555 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3556 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3557 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3558 @end table
3559
3560 @noindent
3561 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3562 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3563 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3564 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3565 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3566 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3567
3568 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3569 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3570 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3571 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3572
3573 @noindent
3574 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3575 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3576 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3577 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3578 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3579
3580 @noindent
3581 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3582 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3583 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3584 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3585 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3586 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3587
3588 @noindent
3589 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3590 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3591
3592 @end table
3593
3594 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3595 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3596 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3597 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3598
3599 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3600 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3601 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3602 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3603
3604 @itemize @bullet
3605 @item
3606 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3607
3608 @item
3609 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3610 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3611
3612 @item
3613 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3614 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3615
3616 @item
3617 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3618 several places where that function is inlined.
3619 @end itemize
3620
3621 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3622 the relevant locations.
3623
3624 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3625 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3626 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3627 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3628 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3629 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3630 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3631
3632 For example:
3633
3634 @smallexample
3635 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3636 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3637 stop only if i==1
3638 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3639 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3640 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3641 @end smallexample
3642
3643 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3644 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3645 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3646 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3647 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3648 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3649 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3650 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3651 that belong to that breakpoint.
3652
3653 @cindex pending breakpoints
3654 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3655 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3656 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3657 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3658 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3659 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3660 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3661 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3662 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3663 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3664 is not yet resolved.
3665
3666 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3667 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3668 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3669 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3670 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3671 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3672
3673 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3674 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3675 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3676 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3677
3678 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3679 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3680 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3681
3682 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3683 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3684 address specification to an address:
3685
3686 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3687 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3688 @table @code
3689 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3690 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3691 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3692
3693 @item set breakpoint pending on
3694 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3695 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3696
3697 @item set breakpoint pending off
3698 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3699 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3700 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3701
3702 @item show breakpoint pending
3703 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3704 @end table
3705
3706 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3707 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3708 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3709
3710 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3711 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3712 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3713 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3714 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3715 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3716 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3717 breakpoints.
3718
3719 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3720
3721 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3722 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3723 @table @code
3724 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3725 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3726 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3727 breakpoint must be used.
3728
3729 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3730 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3731 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3732 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3733 @end table
3734
3735 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3736 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3737 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3738 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3739 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3740 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3741 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3742 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3743 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3744
3745 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3746 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3747 @table @code
3748 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3749 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3750 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3751 removed from the target when it stops.
3752
3753 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3754 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3755 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3756 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3757 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3758
3759 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3760 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3761 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3762 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3763 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3764 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3765 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3766 @end table
3767
3768 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3769 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3770 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3771
3772 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3773 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3774
3775 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3776
3777 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3778 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3779 @table @code
3780 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3781 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3782 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3783 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
3784 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
3785
3786 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
3787 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
3788 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
3789 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
3790 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
3791 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
3792 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
3793 that is only known to the host. Examples include
3794 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
3795 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
3796 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
3797 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
3798 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
3799
3800 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
3801 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
3802 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
3803 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
3804 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
3805 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
3806 @end table
3807
3808
3809 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3810 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3811 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3812 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3813 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3814 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3815 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3816 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3817
3818
3819 @node Set Watchpoints
3820 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3821
3822 @cindex setting watchpoints
3823 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3824 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3825 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3826 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3827 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3828
3829 @itemize @bullet
3830 @item
3831 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3832
3833 @item
3834 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3835 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3836 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3837
3838 @item
3839 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3840 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3841 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3842 @end itemize
3843
3844 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3845 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3846 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3847 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3848 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3849 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3850 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3851 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3852 the expression changes.
3853
3854 @cindex software watchpoints
3855 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3856 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3857 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3858 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3859 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3860 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3861 culprit.)
3862
3863 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3864 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3865 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3866
3867 @table @code
3868 @kindex watch
3869 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3870 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3871 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3872 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3873 to watch the value of a single variable:
3874
3875 @smallexample
3876 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3877 @end smallexample
3878
3879 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3880 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3881 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3882 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3883 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3884 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3885
3886 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
3887 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
3888 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
3889 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
3890 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
3891 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
3892 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
3893 error.
3894
3895 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
3896 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
3897 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
3898 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
3899 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
3900 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
3901 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
3902 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
3903 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
3904 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
3905 Examples:
3906
3907 @smallexample
3908 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
3909 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
3910 @end smallexample
3911
3912 @kindex rwatch
3913 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3914 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3915 by the program.
3916
3917 @kindex awatch
3918 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3919 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3920 or written into by the program.
3921
3922 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3923 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3924 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
3925 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3926 @end table
3927
3928 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
3929 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
3930 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
3931 a never-changing value:
3932
3933 @smallexample
3934 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
3935 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
3936 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
3937 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
3938 @end smallexample
3939
3940 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3941 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3942 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3943 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3944 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3945 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3946
3947 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3948 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3949 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3950 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3951 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3952 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3953 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3954 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3955
3956 @table @code
3957 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3958 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3959 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3960
3961 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3962 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3963 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3964 @end table
3965
3966 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3967 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3968 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3969
3970 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3971
3972 @smallexample
3973 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3974 @end smallexample
3975
3976 @noindent
3977 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3978
3979 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3980 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3981 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3982 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3983 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3984 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3985 will print a message like this:
3986
3987 @smallexample
3988 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3989 @end smallexample
3990
3991 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3992 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3993 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3994 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3995 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3996 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3997 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3998 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3999
4000 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4001 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4002 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4003 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4004 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4005 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4006
4007 @smallexample
4008 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4009 @end smallexample
4010
4011 @noindent
4012 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4013
4014 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4015 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4016 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4017 expression with separately allocated resources.
4018
4019 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4020 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4021 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4022
4023 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4024 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4025 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4026 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4027 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4028 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4029 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4030 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4031 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4032
4033 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4034 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4035 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4036 watched expression from every thread.
4037
4038 @quotation
4039 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4040 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4041 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4042 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4043 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4044 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4045 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4046 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4047 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4048 @end quotation
4049
4050 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4051
4052 @node Set Catchpoints
4053 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4054 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4055 @cindex exception handlers
4056 @cindex event handling
4057
4058 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4059 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4060 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4061
4062 @table @code
4063 @kindex catch
4064 @item catch @var{event}
4065 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
4066 @table @code
4067 @item throw
4068 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4069 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
4070
4071 @item catch
4072 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4073
4074 @item exception
4075 @cindex Ada exception catching
4076 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4077 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4078 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4079 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4080 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4081
4082 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4083 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4084 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4085 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4086 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4087 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4088 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4089 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4090
4091 @item exception unhandled
4092 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4093
4094 @item assert
4095 A failed Ada assertion.
4096
4097 @item exec
4098 @cindex break on fork/exec
4099 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4100 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4101
4102 @item syscall
4103 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4104 @cindex break on a system call.
4105 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4106 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4107 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4108 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4109 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4110 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4111 will be caught.
4112
4113 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4114 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4115 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4116 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4117
4118 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4119 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4120 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4121 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4122
4123 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4124 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4125 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4126 available choices.
4127
4128 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4129 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4130 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4131 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4132 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4133 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4134 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4135 behind the OS upgrades).
4136
4137 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4138 arguments to it:
4139
4140 @smallexample
4141 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4142 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4143 (@value{GDBP}) r
4144 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4145
4146 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4147 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4148 (@value{GDBP}) c
4149 Continuing.
4150
4151 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4152 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4153 (@value{GDBP})
4154 @end smallexample
4155
4156 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4157
4158 @smallexample
4159 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4160 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4161 (@value{GDBP}) r
4162 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4163
4164 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4165 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4166 (@value{GDBP}) c
4167 Continuing.
4168
4169 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4170 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4171 (@value{GDBP})
4172 @end smallexample
4173
4174 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4175 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4176 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4177
4178 @smallexample
4179 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4180 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4181 (@value{GDBP}) r
4182 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4183
4184 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4185 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4186 (@value{GDBP}) c
4187 Continuing.
4188
4189 Program exited normally.
4190 (@value{GDBP})
4191 @end smallexample
4192
4193 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4194 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4195 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4196 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4197
4198 @smallexample
4199 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4200 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4201 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4202 (@value{GDBP})
4203 @end smallexample
4204
4205 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4206 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4207 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4208 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4209 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4210 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4211
4212 @smallexample
4213 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4214 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4215 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4216 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4217 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4218 (@value{GDBP})
4219 @end smallexample
4220
4221 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4222
4223 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4224 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4225
4226 @smallexample
4227 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4228 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4229 @end smallexample
4230
4231 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4232
4233 @item fork
4234 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4235 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4236
4237 @item vfork
4238 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4239 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4240
4241 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4242 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4243 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4244 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4245 matches one of the affected libraries.
4246
4247 @end table
4248
4249 @item tcatch @var{event}
4250 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4251 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4252
4253 @end table
4254
4255 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4256
4257 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
4258 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
4259
4260 @itemize @bullet
4261 @item
4262 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4263 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4264 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4265 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4266 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4267 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4268 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4269 disabled within interactive calls.
4270
4271 @item
4272 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4273
4274 @item
4275 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4276 @end itemize
4277
4278 @cindex raise exceptions
4279 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
4280 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
4281 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
4282 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
4283 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
4284 out where the exception was raised.
4285
4286 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
4287 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
4288 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
4289 which has the following ANSI C interface:
4290
4291 @smallexample
4292 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
4293 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
4294 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
4295 @end smallexample
4296
4297 @noindent
4298 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
4299 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
4300 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
4301
4302 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
4303 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
4304 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
4305 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
4306 raised.
4307
4308
4309 @node Delete Breaks
4310 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4311
4312 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4313 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4314 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4315 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4316 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4317 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4318
4319 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4320 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4321 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4322 their breakpoint numbers.
4323
4324 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4325 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4326 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4327
4328 @table @code
4329 @kindex clear
4330 @item clear
4331 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4332 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4333 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4334 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4335
4336 @item clear @var{location}
4337 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4338 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4339 most useful ones are listed below:
4340
4341 @table @code
4342 @item clear @var{function}
4343 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4344 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4345
4346 @item clear @var{linenum}
4347 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4348 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4349 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4350 @end table
4351
4352 @cindex delete breakpoints
4353 @kindex delete
4354 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4355 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4356 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4357 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4358 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4359 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4360 @end table
4361
4362 @node Disabling
4363 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4364
4365 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4366 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4367 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4368 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4369 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4370
4371 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4372 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4373 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4374 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4375 do not know which numbers to use.
4376
4377 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4378 affects all of its locations.
4379
4380 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4381 different states of enablement:
4382
4383 @itemize @bullet
4384 @item
4385 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4386 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4387 @item
4388 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4389 @item
4390 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4391 disabled.
4392 @item
4393 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4394 N times, then becomes disabled.
4395 @item
4396 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4397 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4398 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4399 @end itemize
4400
4401 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4402 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4403
4404 @table @code
4405 @kindex disable
4406 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4407 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4408 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4409 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4410 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4411 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4412 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4413
4414 @kindex enable
4415 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4416 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4417 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4418
4419 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4420 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4421 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4422
4423 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4424 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4425 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4426 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4427 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4428 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4429 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4430
4431 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4432 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4433 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4434 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4435 @end table
4436
4437 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4438 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4439 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4440 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4441 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4442 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4443 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4444 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4445 Stepping}.)
4446
4447 @node Conditions
4448 @subsection Break Conditions
4449 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4450 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4451
4452 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4453 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4454 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4455 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4456 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4457 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4458 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4459 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4460
4461 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4462 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4463 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4464 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4465 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4466
4467 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4468 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4469 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4470 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4471 one.
4472
4473 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4474 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4475 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4476 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4477 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4478 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4479 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4480 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4481 conditions for the
4482 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4483 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4484
4485 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4486 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4487 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4488 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4489 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4490 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4491
4492 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4493 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4494 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4495 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4496 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4497
4498 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4499 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4500 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4501 with the @code{condition} command.
4502
4503 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4504 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4505 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4506 catchpoint.
4507
4508 @table @code
4509 @kindex condition
4510 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4511 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4512 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4513 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4514 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4515 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4516 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4517 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4518 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4519 prints an error message:
4520
4521 @smallexample
4522 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4523 @end smallexample
4524
4525 @noindent
4526 @value{GDBN} does
4527 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4528 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4529 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4530
4531 @item condition @var{bnum}
4532 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4533 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4534 @end table
4535
4536 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4537 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4538 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4539 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4540 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4541 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4542 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4543 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4544 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4545 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4546 your program reaches it.
4547
4548 @table @code
4549 @kindex ignore
4550 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4551 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4552 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4553 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4554 takes no action.
4555
4556 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4557 a count of zero.
4558
4559 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4560 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4561 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4562 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4563
4564 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4565 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4566 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4567
4568 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4569 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4570 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4571 Variables}.
4572 @end table
4573
4574 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4575
4576
4577 @node Break Commands
4578 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4579
4580 @cindex breakpoint commands
4581 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4582 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4583 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4584 enable other breakpoints.
4585
4586 @table @code
4587 @kindex commands
4588 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4589 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4590 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4591 @itemx end
4592 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4593 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4594 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4595
4596 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4597 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4598
4599 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4600 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4601 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4602 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4603 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4604 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4605 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4606 Expressions}).
4607 @end table
4608
4609 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4610 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4611
4612 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4613 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4614 that resumes execution.
4615
4616 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4617 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4618 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4619 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4620 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4621
4622 @kindex silent
4623 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4624 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4625 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4626 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4627 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4628 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4629
4630 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4631 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4632 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4633
4634 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4635 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4636
4637 @smallexample
4638 break foo if x>0
4639 commands
4640 silent
4641 printf "x is %d\n",x
4642 cont
4643 end
4644 @end smallexample
4645
4646 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4647 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4648 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4649 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4650 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4651 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4652 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4653
4654 @smallexample
4655 break 403
4656 commands
4657 silent
4658 set x = y + 4
4659 cont
4660 end
4661 @end smallexample
4662
4663 @node Dynamic Printf
4664 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4665
4666 @cindex dynamic printf
4667 @cindex dprintf
4668 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4669 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4670 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4671 having to recompile it.
4672
4673 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4674 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4675 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4676 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4677 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4678 redirects to files and so forth.
4679
4680 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4681 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4682 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4683 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4684 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4685 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4686 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4687
4688 @table @code
4689 @kindex dprintf
4690 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4691 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4692 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4693 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4694
4695 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4696 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4697 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4698 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4699 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4700 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4701
4702 @item gdb
4703 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4704 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4705
4706 @item call
4707 @kindex dprintf-style call
4708 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4709 @code{printf}).
4710
4711 @item agent
4712 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4713 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4714 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4715 support running commands on the target.
4716
4717 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4718 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4719 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4720 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4721 command.
4722
4723 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4724 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4725 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4726 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4727 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4728 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4729
4730 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4731 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4732 you could do the following:
4733
4734 @example
4735 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4736 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4737 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4738 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4739 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4740 (gdb) info break
4741 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4742 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4743 continue
4744 (gdb)
4745 @end example
4746
4747 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
4748 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
4749 the variable settings.
4750
4751 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
4752 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
4753 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
4754 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
4755 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
4756 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
4757
4758 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
4759 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
4760 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
4761
4762 @end table
4763
4764 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
4765 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
4766 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
4767 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
4768 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
4769 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
4770
4771 @node Save Breakpoints
4772 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4773
4774 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4775 breakpoints}} command.
4776
4777 @table @code
4778 @kindex save breakpoints
4779 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4780 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4781 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4782 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4783 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4784 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4785 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4786 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4787 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4788 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4789 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4790 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4791 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4792 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4793 that can no longer be recreated.
4794 @end table
4795
4796 @node Static Probe Points
4797 @subsection Static Probe Points
4798
4799 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
4800 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
4801 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
4802 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations. They are
4803 usable from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages. See
4804 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
4805 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.
4806
4807 Currently, @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
4808 @acronym{SDT} probes are supported on ELF-compatible systems. See
4809 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
4810 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT} probes
4811 in your applications.
4812
4813 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
4814 Some probes have an associated semaphore variable; for instance, this
4815 happens automatically if you defined your probe using a DTrace-style
4816 @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore, @value{GDBN} will
4817 automatically enable it when you specify a breakpoint using the
4818 @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a breakpoint at a probe's
4819 location by some other method (e.g., @code{break file:line}), then
4820 @value{GDBN} will not automatically set the semaphore.
4821
4822 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
4823 probes}, with optional arguments:
4824
4825 @table @code
4826 @kindex info probes
4827 @item info probes stap @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
4828 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
4829 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
4830 probes from all providers are listed.
4831
4832 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
4833 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
4834 considered when deciding whether to display them.
4835
4836 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
4837 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
4838 given, all object files are considered.
4839
4840 @item info probes all
4841 List the available static probes, from all types.
4842 @end table
4843
4844 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
4845 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
4846 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
4847 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
4848 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
4849 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. Each probe argument is
4850 an integer of the appropriate size; types are not preserved. The
4851 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
4852 at the current probe point.
4853
4854 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
4855 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
4856 an error message.
4857
4858
4859 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4860 @node Error in Breakpoints
4861 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4862
4863 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4864 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4865
4866 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4867 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4868 @smallexample
4869 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4870 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4871 @end smallexample
4872
4873 @noindent
4874 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4875 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4876 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4877
4878 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4879 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4880
4881 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4882 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4883 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4884
4885 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4886 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4887 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4888 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4889
4890 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4891 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4892 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4893 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4894 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4895 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4896 first in the bundle.
4897
4898 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4899 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4900 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4901 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4902 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4903 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4904 is hit.
4905
4906 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4907 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4908
4909 @smallexample
4910 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4911 @end smallexample
4912
4913 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4914 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4915 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4916 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4917 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4918 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4919 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4920 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4921
4922 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4923 adjusted breakpoints:
4924
4925 @smallexample
4926 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4927 to 0x00010410.
4928 @end smallexample
4929
4930 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4931 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4932 frequently than expected.
4933
4934 @node Continuing and Stepping
4935 @section Continuing and Stepping
4936
4937 @cindex stepping
4938 @cindex continuing
4939 @cindex resuming execution
4940 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4941 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4942 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4943 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4944 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4945 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4946 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4947 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4948
4949 @table @code
4950 @kindex continue
4951 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4952 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4953 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4954 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4955 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4956 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4957 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4958 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4959 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4960 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4961
4962 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4963 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4964 @code{continue} is ignored.
4965
4966 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4967 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4968 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4969 @code{continue}.
4970 @end table
4971
4972 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4973 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4974 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4975 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4976
4977 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4978 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4979 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4980 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4981 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4982 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4983
4984 @table @code
4985 @kindex step
4986 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4987 @item step
4988 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4989 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4990 abbreviated @code{s}.
4991
4992 @quotation
4993 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4994 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4995 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4996 @c distinction here.
4997 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4998 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4999 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5000 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5001 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5002 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5003 below.
5004 @end quotation
5005
5006 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5007 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5008 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5009 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5010 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5011 called within the line.
5012
5013 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5014 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5015 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5016 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5017 was any debugging information about the routine.
5018
5019 @item step @var{count}
5020 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5021 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5022 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5023
5024 @kindex next
5025 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5026 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5027 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5028 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5029 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5030 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5031 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5032 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5033
5034 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5035
5036
5037 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5038 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5039 @c
5040 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5041 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5042 @c function are executed without stopping.
5043
5044 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5045 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5046 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5047
5048 @kindex set step-mode
5049 @item set step-mode
5050 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5051 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5052 @itemx set step-mode on
5053 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5054 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5055 information rather than stepping over it.
5056
5057 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5058 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5059 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5060
5061 @item set step-mode off
5062 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5063 debug information. This is the default.
5064
5065 @item show step-mode
5066 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5067 source line debug information.
5068
5069 @kindex finish
5070 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5071 @item finish
5072 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5073 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5074 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5075
5076 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5077 ,Returning from a Function}).
5078
5079 @kindex until
5080 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5081 @cindex run until specified location
5082 @item until
5083 @itemx u
5084 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5085 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5086 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5087 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5088 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5089 than the address of the jump.
5090
5091 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5092 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5093 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5094 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5095 through the next iteration.
5096
5097 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5098 stack frame.
5099
5100 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5101 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5102 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5103 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5104 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5105
5106 @smallexample
5107 (@value{GDBP}) f
5108 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5109 206 expand_input();
5110 (@value{GDBP}) until
5111 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5112 @end smallexample
5113
5114 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5115 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5116 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5117 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5118 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5119 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5120 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5121
5122 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5123 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5124 argument.
5125
5126 @item until @var{location}
5127 @itemx u @var{location}
5128 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
5129 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
5130 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5131 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5132 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5133 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5134 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5135 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5136 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5137 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5138 invocations have returned.
5139
5140 @smallexample
5141 94 int factorial (int value)
5142 95 @{
5143 96 if (value > 1) @{
5144 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5145 98 @}
5146 99 return (value);
5147 100 @}
5148 @end smallexample
5149
5150
5151 @kindex advance @var{location}
5152 @item advance @var{location}
5153 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5154 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5155 @ref{Specify Location}.
5156 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5157 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5158 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5159 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5160
5161
5162 @kindex stepi
5163 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5164 @item stepi
5165 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5166 @itemx si
5167 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5168
5169 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5170 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5171 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5172 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5173
5174 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5175
5176 @need 750
5177 @kindex nexti
5178 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5179 @item nexti
5180 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5181 @itemx ni
5182 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5183 proceed until the function returns.
5184
5185 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5186 @end table
5187
5188 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5189 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5190 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5191
5192 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5193 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5194 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
5195
5196 For example, consider the following C function:
5197
5198 @smallexample
5199 101 int func()
5200 102 @{
5201 103 foo(boring());
5202 104 bar(boring());
5203 105 @}
5204 @end smallexample
5205
5206 @noindent
5207 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5208 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5209 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5210 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5211
5212 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5213 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5214 is called from many places.
5215
5216 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5217 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5218 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5219 @code{foo}.
5220
5221 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
5222 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
5223
5224 @table @code
5225 @kindex skip function
5226 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5227 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5228 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5229 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5230 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5231
5232 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5233 will be skipped.
5234
5235 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5236 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5237
5238 @kindex skip file
5239 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5240 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5241 will be skipped over when stepping.
5242
5243 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5244 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5245 @end table
5246
5247 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5248 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5249
5250 @table @code
5251 @kindex info skip
5252 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5253 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5254 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5255 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5256
5257 @table @emph
5258 @item Identifier
5259 A number identifying this skip.
5260 @item Type
5261 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
5262 @item Enabled or Disabled
5263 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5264 @item Address
5265 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
5266 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
5267 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
5268 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
5269 address here.
5270 @item What
5271 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
5272 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
5273 where it is defined.
5274 @end table
5275
5276 @kindex skip delete
5277 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5278 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5279 skips.
5280
5281 @kindex skip enable
5282 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5283 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5284 skips.
5285
5286 @kindex skip disable
5287 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5288 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5289 skips.
5290
5291 @end table
5292
5293 @node Signals
5294 @section Signals
5295 @cindex signals
5296
5297 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5298 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5299 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5300 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5301 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5302 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5303 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5304 requested an alarm).
5305
5306 @cindex fatal signals
5307 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5308 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5309 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5310 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5311 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5312 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5313
5314 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5315 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5316 signal.
5317
5318 @cindex handling signals
5319 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5320 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5321 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5322 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5323 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5324
5325 @table @code
5326 @kindex info signals
5327 @kindex info handle
5328 @item info signals
5329 @itemx info handle
5330 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5331 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5332 the defined types of signals.
5333
5334 @item info signals @var{sig}
5335 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5336
5337 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5338
5339 @kindex handle
5340 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5341 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
5342 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5343 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5344 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5345 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5346 say what change to make.
5347 @end table
5348
5349 @c @group
5350 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5351 Their full names are:
5352
5353 @table @code
5354 @item nostop
5355 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5356 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5357
5358 @item stop
5359 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5360 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5361
5362 @item print
5363 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5364
5365 @item noprint
5366 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5367 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5368
5369 @item pass
5370 @itemx noignore
5371 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5372 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5373 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5374
5375 @item nopass
5376 @itemx ignore
5377 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5378 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5379 @end table
5380 @c @end group
5381
5382 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5383 program until you
5384 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5385 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5386 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5387 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5388 program sees that signal when you continue.
5389
5390 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5391 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5392 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5393 erroneous signals.
5394
5395 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5396 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5397 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5398 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5399 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5400 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5401 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5402 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5403 Program a Signal}.
5404
5405 @cindex extra signal information
5406 @anchor{extra signal information}
5407
5408 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5409 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5410 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5411 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5412 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5413 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5414 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5415 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5416 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5417 system header.
5418
5419 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5420 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5421
5422 @smallexample
5423 @group
5424 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5425 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5426 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5427 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5428 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5429 type = struct @{
5430 int si_signo;
5431 int si_errno;
5432 int si_code;
5433 union @{
5434 int _pad[28];
5435 struct @{...@} _kill;
5436 struct @{...@} _timer;
5437 struct @{...@} _rt;
5438 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5439 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5440 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5441 @} _sifields;
5442 @}
5443 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5444 type = struct @{
5445 void *si_addr;
5446 @}
5447 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5448 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5449 @end group
5450 @end smallexample
5451
5452 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5453
5454 @node Thread Stops
5455 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5456
5457 @cindex stopped threads
5458 @cindex threads, stopped
5459
5460 @cindex continuing threads
5461 @cindex threads, continuing
5462
5463 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5464 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5465 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5466 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5467 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5468 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5469 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5470 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5471 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5472
5473 @menu
5474 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5475 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5476 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5477 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5478 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5479 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5480 @end menu
5481
5482 @node All-Stop Mode
5483 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5484
5485 @cindex all-stop mode
5486
5487 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5488 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5489 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5490 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5491 underfoot.
5492
5493 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5494 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5495 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5496
5497 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5498 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5499 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5500 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5501 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5502 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5503 stops.
5504
5505 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5506 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5507 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5508 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5509
5510 @cindex automatic thread selection
5511 @cindex switching threads automatically
5512 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5513 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5514 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5515 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5516 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5517 thread.
5518
5519 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5520 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5521
5522 @table @code
5523 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5524 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5525 @cindex lock scheduler
5526 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5527 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5528 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5529 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5530 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5531 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5532 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
5533 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
5534 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
5535 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5536 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5537 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5538
5539 @item show scheduler-locking
5540 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5541 @end table
5542
5543 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5544 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5545 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5546 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5547 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5548 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5549 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5550 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5551 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5552 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5553 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5554 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5555 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5556 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5557
5558 @table @code
5559 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5560 @item set schedule-multiple
5561 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5562 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5563 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5564 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5565 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5566 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5567
5568 @item show schedule-multiple
5569 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5570 multiple processes.
5571 @end table
5572
5573 @node Non-Stop Mode
5574 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5575
5576 @cindex non-stop mode
5577
5578 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5579 @c with more details.
5580
5581 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5582 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5583 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5584 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5585 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5586 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5587
5588 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5589 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5590 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5591 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5592 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5593 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5594 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5595 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5596 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5597 independently and simultaneously.
5598
5599 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5600 or attach to your program:
5601
5602 @smallexample
5603 # Enable the async interface.
5604 set target-async 1
5605
5606 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5607 set pagination off
5608
5609 # Finally, turn it on!
5610 set non-stop on
5611 @end smallexample
5612
5613 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5614
5615 @table @code
5616 @kindex set non-stop
5617 @item set non-stop on
5618 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5619 @item set non-stop off
5620 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5621 @kindex show non-stop
5622 @item show non-stop
5623 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5624 @end table
5625
5626 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5627 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5628 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5629 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5630 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5631 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5632 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5633 default.
5634
5635 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5636 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5637 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5638
5639 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5640 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5641 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5642 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5643 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5644
5645 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5646 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5647 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5648 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5649 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5650
5651 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5652
5653 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5654 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5655 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5656 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5657 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5658 previously current thread.
5659
5660 @node Background Execution
5661 @subsection Background Execution
5662
5663 @cindex foreground execution
5664 @cindex background execution
5665 @cindex asynchronous execution
5666 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5667
5668 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5669 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5670 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5671 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5672 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5673 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5674
5675 You need to explicitly enable asynchronous mode before you can use
5676 background execution commands. You can use these commands to
5677 manipulate the asynchronous mode setting:
5678
5679 @table @code
5680 @kindex set target-async
5681 @item set target-async on
5682 Enable asynchronous mode.
5683 @item set target-async off
5684 Disable asynchronous mode.
5685 @kindex show target-async
5686 @item show target-async
5687 Show the current target-async setting.
5688 @end table
5689
5690 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5691 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5692
5693 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5694 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5695 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5696 are:
5697
5698 @table @code
5699 @kindex run&
5700 @item run
5701 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5702
5703 @item attach
5704 @kindex attach&
5705 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5706
5707 @item step
5708 @kindex step&
5709 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5710
5711 @item stepi
5712 @kindex stepi&
5713 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5714
5715 @item next
5716 @kindex next&
5717 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5718
5719 @item nexti
5720 @kindex nexti&
5721 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
5722
5723 @item continue
5724 @kindex continue&
5725 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
5726
5727 @item finish
5728 @kindex finish&
5729 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
5730
5731 @item until
5732 @kindex until&
5733 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
5734
5735 @end table
5736
5737 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
5738 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
5739 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
5740 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
5741 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
5742 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
5743
5744 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
5745 using the @code{interrupt} command.
5746
5747 @table @code
5748 @kindex interrupt
5749 @item interrupt
5750 @itemx interrupt -a
5751
5752 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
5753 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
5754 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
5755 use @code{interrupt -a}.
5756 @end table
5757
5758 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5759 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5760
5761 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
5762 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
5763 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
5764
5765 @table @code
5766 @cindex breakpoints and threads
5767 @cindex thread breakpoints
5768 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
5769 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
5770 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
5771 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
5772 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
5773 specify some source line.
5774
5775 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
5776 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
5777 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
5778 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
5779 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
5780
5781 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
5782 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
5783 program.
5784
5785 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
5786 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
5787 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
5788
5789 @smallexample
5790 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
5791 @end smallexample
5792
5793 @end table
5794
5795 @node Interrupted System Calls
5796 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
5797
5798 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
5799 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
5800 @cindex premature return from system calls
5801 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
5802 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
5803 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
5804 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
5805 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
5806 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
5807 stop execution.
5808
5809 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
5810 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
5811 style anyways.
5812
5813 For example, do not write code like this:
5814
5815 @smallexample
5816 sleep (10);
5817 @end smallexample
5818
5819 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
5820 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
5821
5822 Instead, write this:
5823
5824 @smallexample
5825 int unslept = 10;
5826 while (unslept > 0)
5827 unslept = sleep (unslept);
5828 @end smallexample
5829
5830 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
5831 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
5832 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
5833 @value{GDBN}.
5834
5835 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
5836 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
5837 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
5838 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
5839
5840 @node Observer Mode
5841 @subsection Observer Mode
5842
5843 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
5844 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
5845 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
5846 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
5847 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
5848
5849 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
5850 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
5851 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
5852 mode.
5853
5854 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
5855 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
5856 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
5857 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
5858 stream will still not be able to be placed.
5859
5860 @table @code
5861
5862 @kindex observer
5863 @item set observer on
5864 @itemx set observer off
5865 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
5866 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
5867 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
5868 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
5869
5870 @item show observer
5871 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
5872
5873 @kindex may-write-registers
5874 @item set may-write-registers on
5875 @itemx set may-write-registers off
5876 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
5877 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
5878 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
5879
5880 @item show may-write-registers
5881 Show the current permission to write registers.
5882
5883 @kindex may-write-memory
5884 @item set may-write-memory on
5885 @itemx set may-write-memory off
5886 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
5887 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
5888 defaults to @code{on}.
5889
5890 @item show may-write-memory
5891 Show the current permission to write memory.
5892
5893 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
5894 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
5895 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
5896 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
5897 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
5898 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5899
5900 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
5901 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
5902
5903 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
5904 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
5905 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
5906 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
5907 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
5908 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
5909 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5910
5911 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
5912 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
5913
5914 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
5915 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
5916 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
5917 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
5918 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
5919 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
5920 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5921
5922 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
5923 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
5924
5925 @kindex may-interrupt
5926 @item set may-interrupt on
5927 @itemx set may-interrupt off
5928 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
5929 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
5930 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
5931 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5932
5933 @item show may-interrupt
5934 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
5935
5936 @end table
5937
5938 @node Reverse Execution
5939 @chapter Running programs backward
5940 @cindex reverse execution
5941 @cindex running programs backward
5942
5943 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
5944 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
5945 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
5946 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
5947
5948 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
5949 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
5950 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
5951 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
5952 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
5953 all target environments can support reverse execution.
5954
5955 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
5956 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
5957 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
5958 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
5959 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
5960 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
5961 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
5962 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
5963 prior values@footnote{
5964 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
5965 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
5966 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
5967
5968 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
5969 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
5970 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
5971 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
5972 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
5973 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
5974 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
5975 }.
5976
5977 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
5978 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
5979
5980 @table @code
5981 @kindex reverse-continue
5982 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
5983 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5984 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5985 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
5986 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
5987 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
5988 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
5989
5990 @kindex reverse-step
5991 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
5992 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5993 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
5994 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
5995
5996 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
5997 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
5998 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
5999 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6000 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6001 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6002
6003 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6004 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6005
6006 @kindex reverse-stepi
6007 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6008 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6009 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6010 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6011 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6012 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6013 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6014
6015 @kindex reverse-next
6016 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6017 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6018 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6019 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6020 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6021 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6022 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6023 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6024 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6025 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6026
6027 @kindex reverse-nexti
6028 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6029 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6030 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6031 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6032 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6033 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6034 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6035 frame) is reached.
6036
6037 @kindex reverse-finish
6038 @item reverse-finish
6039 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6040 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6041 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6042 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6043
6044 @kindex set exec-direction
6045 @item set exec-direction
6046 Set the direction of target execution.
6047 @item set exec-direction reverse
6048 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6049 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6050 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6051 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6052 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6053 @item set exec-direction forward
6054 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6055 This is the default.
6056 @end table
6057
6058
6059 @node Process Record and Replay
6060 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6061 @cindex process record and replay
6062 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6063
6064 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6065 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6066 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6067
6068 @cindex replay mode
6069 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6070 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6071 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6072 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6073 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6074 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6075 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6076 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6077 execution log.
6078
6079 @cindex record mode
6080 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6081 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6082 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6083 for future replay.
6084
6085 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6086 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6087 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6088 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6089 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6090 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6091
6092 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6093 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6094 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6095 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6096
6097 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6098 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6099
6100 @table @code
6101 @kindex target record
6102 @kindex record
6103 @kindex rec
6104 @item target record
6105 This command starts the process record and replay target. The process
6106 record and replay target can only debug a process that is already
6107 running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with the
6108 @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording with
6109 the @kbd{target record} command.
6110
6111 Both @code{record} and @code{rec} are aliases of @code{target record}.
6112
6113 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6114 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6115 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6116 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6117 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6118
6119 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6120 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6121 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6122 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), the
6123 process record and replay target cannot be started because it doesn't
6124 support these two modes.
6125
6126 @kindex record stop
6127 @kindex rec s
6128 @item record stop
6129 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6130 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6131 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6132
6133 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6134 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6135 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6136 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6137 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6138
6139 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6140 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6141 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6142 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6143 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6144
6145 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6146 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6147
6148 @kindex record save
6149 @item record save @var{filename}
6150 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6151 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6152 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6153
6154 @kindex record restore
6155 @item record restore @var{filename}
6156 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6157 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6158
6159 @kindex set record insn-number-max
6160 @item set record insn-number-max @var{limit}
6161 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded. Default value is 200000.
6162
6163 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6164 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6165 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6166 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6167 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6168 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6169 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6170 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6171
6172 If @var{limit} is zero, @value{GDBN} will never delete recorded
6173 instructions from the execution log. The number of recorded
6174 instructions is unlimited in this case.
6175
6176 @kindex show record insn-number-max
6177 @item show record insn-number-max
6178 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded.
6179
6180 @kindex set record stop-at-limit
6181 @item set record stop-at-limit
6182 Control the behavior when the number of recorded instructions reaches
6183 the limit. If ON (the default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit
6184 is reached for the first time and ask you whether you want to stop the
6185 inferior or continue running it and recording the execution log. If
6186 you decide to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will
6187 cause the oldest one to be deleted.
6188
6189 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6190 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6191
6192 @kindex show record stop-at-limit
6193 @item show record stop-at-limit
6194 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6195
6196 @kindex set record memory-query
6197 @item set record memory-query
6198 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6199 changes caused by an instruction. If ON, @value{GDBN} will query
6200 whether to stop the inferior in that case.
6201
6202 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6203 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6204 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6205 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6206 results.
6207
6208 @kindex show record memory-query
6209 @item show record memory-query
6210 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6211
6212 @kindex info record
6213 @item info record
6214 Show various statistics about the state of process record and its
6215 in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6216
6217 @itemize @bullet
6218 @item
6219 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6220 @item
6221 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6222 @item
6223 Highest recorded instruction number.
6224 @item
6225 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6226 @item
6227 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6228 @item
6229 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6230 @end itemize
6231
6232 @kindex record delete
6233 @kindex rec del
6234 @item record delete
6235 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6236 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6237 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6238 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6239 @end table
6240
6241
6242 @node Stack
6243 @chapter Examining the Stack
6244
6245 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
6246 stopped and how it got there.
6247
6248 @cindex call stack
6249 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
6250 is generated.
6251 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
6252 the arguments of the call,
6253 and the local variables of the function being called.
6254 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
6255 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
6256 stack}.
6257
6258 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
6259 stack allow you to see all of this information.
6260
6261 @cindex selected frame
6262 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
6263 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
6264 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
6265 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
6266 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
6267 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6268
6269 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
6270 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
6271 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
6272
6273 @menu
6274 * Frames:: Stack frames
6275 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
6276 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
6277 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
6278
6279 @end menu
6280
6281 @node Frames
6282 @section Stack Frames
6283
6284 @cindex frame, definition
6285 @cindex stack frame
6286 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
6287 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
6288 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
6289 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
6290 which the function is executing.
6291
6292 @cindex initial frame
6293 @cindex outermost frame
6294 @cindex innermost frame
6295 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
6296 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
6297 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
6298 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
6299 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
6300 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
6301 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
6302 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
6303
6304 @cindex frame pointer
6305 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
6306 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
6307 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
6308 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
6309 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
6310 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
6311
6312 @cindex frame number
6313 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
6314 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
6315 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
6316 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
6317 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
6318
6319 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
6320 @c underflow problems.
6321 @cindex frameless execution
6322 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6323 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
6324 @smallexample
6325 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
6326 @end smallexample
6327 generates functions without a frame.)
6328 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
6329 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
6330 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
6331 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
6332 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
6333 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
6334 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
6335
6336 @table @code
6337 @kindex frame@r{, command}
6338 @cindex current stack frame
6339 @item frame @var{args}
6340 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
6341 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
6342 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
6343 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
6344
6345 @kindex select-frame
6346 @cindex selecting frame silently
6347 @item select-frame
6348 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
6349 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
6350 @code{frame}.
6351 @end table
6352
6353 @node Backtrace
6354 @section Backtraces
6355
6356 @cindex traceback
6357 @cindex call stack traces
6358 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
6359 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
6360 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
6361 stack.
6362
6363 @table @code
6364 @kindex backtrace
6365 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
6366 @item backtrace
6367 @itemx bt
6368 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
6369 frames in the stack.
6370
6371 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
6372 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
6373
6374 @item backtrace @var{n}
6375 @itemx bt @var{n}
6376 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
6377
6378 @item backtrace -@var{n}
6379 @itemx bt -@var{n}
6380 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
6381
6382 @item backtrace full
6383 @itemx bt full
6384 @itemx bt full @var{n}
6385 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
6386 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
6387 number of frames to print, as described above.
6388 @end table
6389
6390 @kindex where
6391 @kindex info stack
6392 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
6393 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
6394
6395 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
6396 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
6397 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
6398 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
6399 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
6400 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
6401 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
6402 multi-threaded program.
6403
6404 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
6405 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
6406 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
6407 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
6408 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
6409 line number.
6410
6411 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
6412 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
6413
6414 @smallexample
6415 @group
6416 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6417 at builtin.c:993
6418 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
6419 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
6420 at macro.c:71
6421 (More stack frames follow...)
6422 @end group
6423 @end smallexample
6424
6425 @noindent
6426 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
6427 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
6428 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
6429
6430 @noindent
6431 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
6432 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
6433 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
6434 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
6435 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
6436
6437 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
6438 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
6439 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
6440 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
6441 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
6442 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
6443 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
6444 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
6445 such a backtrace might look like:
6446
6447 @smallexample
6448 @group
6449 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6450 at builtin.c:993
6451 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
6452 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
6453 at macro.c:71
6454 (More stack frames follow...)
6455 @end group
6456 @end smallexample
6457
6458 @noindent
6459 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
6460 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
6461
6462 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
6463 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
6464 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
6465
6466 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
6467 @cindex program entry point
6468 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
6469 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
6470 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
6471 @code{main}@footnote{
6472 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
6473 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
6474 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
6475 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
6476 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
6477 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
6478
6479 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
6480 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
6481
6482 @table @code
6483 @item set backtrace past-main
6484 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
6485 @kindex set backtrace
6486 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
6487
6488 @item set backtrace past-main off
6489 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
6490 default.
6491
6492 @item show backtrace past-main
6493 @kindex show backtrace
6494 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
6495
6496 @item set backtrace past-entry
6497 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
6498 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
6499 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
6500 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
6501
6502 @item set backtrace past-entry off
6503 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
6504 application. This is the default.
6505
6506 @item show backtrace past-entry
6507 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
6508
6509 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
6510 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
6511 @cindex backtrace limit
6512 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
6513 unlimited.
6514
6515 @item show backtrace limit
6516 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
6517 @end table
6518
6519 @node Selection
6520 @section Selecting a Frame
6521
6522 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
6523 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
6524 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
6525 of the stack frame just selected.
6526
6527 @table @code
6528 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
6529 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
6530 @item frame @var{n}
6531 @itemx f @var{n}
6532 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
6533 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
6534 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
6535 @code{main}.
6536
6537 @item frame @var{addr}
6538 @itemx f @var{addr}
6539 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
6540 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
6541 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
6542 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
6543 switches between them.
6544
6545 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
6546 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
6547
6548 On the @acronym{MIPS} and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
6549 pointer and a program counter.
6550
6551 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
6552 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
6553
6554 @kindex up
6555 @item up @var{n}
6556 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
6557 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
6558 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
6559
6560 @kindex down
6561 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
6562 @item down @var{n}
6563 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
6564 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
6565 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
6566 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
6567 @end table
6568
6569 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
6570 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
6571 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
6572 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
6573
6574 @need 1000
6575 For example:
6576
6577 @smallexample
6578 @group
6579 (@value{GDBP}) up
6580 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
6581 at env.c:10
6582 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
6583 @end group
6584 @end smallexample
6585
6586 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
6587 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
6588 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
6589 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
6590 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
6591 for details.
6592
6593 @table @code
6594 @kindex down-silently
6595 @kindex up-silently
6596 @item up-silently @var{n}
6597 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
6598 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
6599 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
6600 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
6601 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
6602 distracting.
6603 @end table
6604
6605 @node Frame Info
6606 @section Information About a Frame
6607
6608 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
6609 stack frame.
6610
6611 @table @code
6612 @item frame
6613 @itemx f
6614 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
6615 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
6616 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
6617 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
6618 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6619
6620 @kindex info frame
6621 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
6622 @item info frame
6623 @itemx info f
6624 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
6625 including:
6626
6627 @itemize @bullet
6628 @item
6629 the address of the frame
6630 @item
6631 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
6632 @item
6633 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
6634 @item
6635 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
6636 @item
6637 the address of the frame's arguments
6638 @item
6639 the address of the frame's local variables
6640 @item
6641 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
6642 @item
6643 which registers were saved in the frame
6644 @end itemize
6645
6646 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
6647 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
6648 the usual conventions.
6649
6650 @item info frame @var{addr}
6651 @itemx info f @var{addr}
6652 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
6653 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
6654 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
6655 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
6656 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6657
6658 @kindex info args
6659 @item info args
6660 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
6661
6662 @item info locals
6663 @kindex info locals
6664 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
6665 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
6666 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
6667
6668 @end table
6669
6670
6671 @node Source
6672 @chapter Examining Source Files
6673
6674 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
6675 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
6676 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
6677 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
6678 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
6679 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
6680 source files by explicit command.
6681
6682 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
6683 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
6684 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
6685
6686 @menu
6687 * List:: Printing source lines
6688 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
6689 * Edit:: Editing source files
6690 * Search:: Searching source files
6691 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
6692 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
6693 @end menu
6694
6695 @node List
6696 @section Printing Source Lines
6697
6698 @kindex list
6699 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
6700 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
6701 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
6702 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
6703 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
6704
6705 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
6706
6707 @table @code
6708 @item list @var{linenum}
6709 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
6710 current source file.
6711
6712 @item list @var{function}
6713 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
6714 @var{function}.
6715
6716 @item list
6717 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
6718 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
6719 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
6720 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
6721 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
6722
6723 @item list -
6724 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6725 @end table
6726
6727 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
6728 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
6729 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
6730
6731 @table @code
6732 @kindex set listsize
6733 @item set listsize @var{count}
6734 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
6735 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
6736 Setting @var{count} to -1 means there's no limit and 0 means suppress
6737 display of source lines.
6738
6739 @kindex show listsize
6740 @item show listsize
6741 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
6742 @end table
6743
6744 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
6745 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
6746 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
6747 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
6748 each repetition moves up in the source file.
6749
6750 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
6751 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
6752 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
6753 to specify some source line.
6754
6755 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
6756
6757 @table @code
6758 @item list @var{linespec}
6759 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
6760
6761 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
6762 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
6763 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
6764 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
6765 the same source file as the first linespec.
6766
6767 @item list ,@var{last}
6768 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
6769
6770 @item list @var{first},
6771 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
6772
6773 @item list +
6774 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
6775
6776 @item list -
6777 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6778
6779 @item list
6780 As described in the preceding table.
6781 @end table
6782
6783 @node Specify Location
6784 @section Specifying a Location
6785 @cindex specifying location
6786 @cindex linespec
6787
6788 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
6789 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
6790 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
6791 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
6792
6793 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
6794 @value{GDBN} understands:
6795
6796 @table @code
6797 @item @var{linenum}
6798 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
6799
6800 @item -@var{offset}
6801 @itemx +@var{offset}
6802 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
6803 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
6804 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
6805 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
6806 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
6807 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
6808 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
6809 linespec.
6810
6811 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
6812 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
6813 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
6814 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
6815 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
6816 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
6817 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
6818
6819 @item @var{function}
6820 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
6821 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
6822
6823 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
6824 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
6825
6826 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
6827 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
6828 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
6829 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
6830 functions in different source files.
6831
6832 @item @var{label}
6833 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
6834 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
6835 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
6836 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
6837 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
6838
6839 @item *@var{address}
6840 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
6841 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
6842 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
6843 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
6844 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
6845 source files.
6846
6847 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
6848 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
6849 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
6850 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
6851 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
6852 of @var{address}:
6853
6854 @table @code
6855 @item @var{expression}
6856 Any expression valid in the current working language.
6857
6858 @item @var{funcaddr}
6859 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
6860 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
6861 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
6862 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
6863 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
6864 (although the Pascal form also works).
6865
6866 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
6867 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
6868
6869 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
6870 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
6871 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
6872 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
6873 functions with identical names in different source files.
6874 @end table
6875
6876 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
6877 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
6878 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
6879 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
6880 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
6881 specifies the location of such a static probe.
6882
6883 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
6884 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
6885 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
6886 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
6887 each one of those probes.
6888
6889 @end table
6890
6891
6892 @node Edit
6893 @section Editing Source Files
6894 @cindex editing source files
6895
6896 @kindex edit
6897 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
6898 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
6899 The editing program of your choice
6900 is invoked with the current line set to
6901 the active line in the program.
6902 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
6903 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
6904
6905 @table @code
6906 @item edit @var{location}
6907 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
6908 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
6909 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
6910 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
6911 command most commonly used:
6912
6913 @table @code
6914 @item edit @var{number}
6915 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
6916
6917 @item edit @var{function}
6918 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
6919 @end table
6920
6921 @end table
6922
6923 @subsection Choosing your Editor
6924 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
6925 @footnote{
6926 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
6927 following command-line syntax:
6928 @smallexample
6929 ex +@var{number} file
6930 @end smallexample
6931 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
6932 the file where to start editing.}.
6933 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
6934 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
6935 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
6936 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
6937 @smallexample
6938 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
6939 export EDITOR
6940 gdb @dots{}
6941 @end smallexample
6942 or in the @code{csh} shell,
6943 @smallexample
6944 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
6945 gdb @dots{}
6946 @end smallexample
6947
6948 @node Search
6949 @section Searching Source Files
6950 @cindex searching source files
6951
6952 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
6953 regular expression.
6954
6955 @table @code
6956 @kindex search
6957 @kindex forward-search
6958 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
6959 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
6960 @itemx search @var{regexp}
6961 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
6962 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
6963 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
6964 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
6965 @code{fo}.
6966
6967 @kindex reverse-search
6968 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
6969 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
6970 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
6971 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
6972 this command as @code{rev}.
6973 @end table
6974
6975 @node Source Path
6976 @section Specifying Source Directories
6977
6978 @cindex source path
6979 @cindex directories for source files
6980 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
6981 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
6982 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
6983 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
6984 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
6985 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
6986 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
6987
6988 For example, suppose an executable references the file
6989 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
6990 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
6991 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
6992 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
6993 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
6994 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
6995 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
6996 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
6997 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
6998 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
6999
7000 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
7001 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
7002 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
7003 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
7004 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
7005 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
7006
7007 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
7008 source files.
7009
7010 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
7011 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
7012 each line is in the file.
7013
7014 @kindex directory
7015 @kindex dir
7016 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
7017 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
7018 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
7019
7020 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
7021 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
7022
7023 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
7024 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
7025 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
7026 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
7027 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
7028 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
7029 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
7030 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
7031 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
7032 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
7033 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
7034 name to look up the sources.
7035
7036 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
7037 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
7038 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
7039 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
7040 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
7041 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
7042 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
7043 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
7044
7045 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
7046 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
7047 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
7048 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
7049 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
7050 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
7051 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
7052
7053 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
7054 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
7055 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
7056 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
7057 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
7058 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
7059 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
7060 command.
7061
7062 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
7063 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
7064 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
7065 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
7066 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
7067 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
7068 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
7069
7070 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
7071 @cindex default source path substitution
7072 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
7073 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
7074 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
7075 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
7076 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
7077 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
7078 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
7079 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
7080 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
7081 together.
7082
7083 @table @code
7084 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
7085 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
7086 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
7087 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
7088 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
7089 part of absolute file names) or
7090 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
7091 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
7092
7093 @kindex cdir
7094 @kindex cwd
7095 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
7096 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
7097 @cindex compilation directory
7098 @cindex current directory
7099 @cindex working directory
7100 @cindex directory, current
7101 @cindex directory, compilation
7102 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
7103 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
7104 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
7105 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
7106 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
7107 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
7108
7109 @item directory
7110 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
7111
7112 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
7113 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
7114
7115 @item set directories @var{path-list}
7116 @kindex set directories
7117 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
7118 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
7119
7120 @item show directories
7121 @kindex show directories
7122 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
7123
7124 @anchor{set substitute-path}
7125 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
7126 @kindex set substitute-path
7127 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
7128 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
7129 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
7130
7131 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
7132 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
7133
7134 @smallexample
7135 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
7136 @end smallexample
7137
7138 @noindent
7139 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
7140 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
7141 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
7142
7143 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
7144 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
7145 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
7146 the substitution.
7147
7148 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
7149
7150 @smallexample
7151 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
7152 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
7153 @end smallexample
7154
7155 @noindent
7156 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
7157 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
7158 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
7159 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
7160
7161
7162 @item unset substitute-path [path]
7163 @kindex unset substitute-path
7164 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
7165 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
7166 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
7167
7168 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
7169
7170 @item show substitute-path [path]
7171 @kindex show substitute-path
7172 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
7173 which would rewrite that path, if any.
7174
7175 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
7176 rules.
7177
7178 @end table
7179
7180 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
7181 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
7182 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
7183
7184 @enumerate
7185 @item
7186 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
7187
7188 @item
7189 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
7190 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
7191 directories in one command.
7192 @end enumerate
7193
7194 @node Machine Code
7195 @section Source and Machine Code
7196 @cindex source line and its code address
7197
7198 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
7199 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
7200 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
7201 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
7202 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
7203 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
7204 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
7205 well as hex.
7206
7207 @table @code
7208 @kindex info line
7209 @item info line @var{linespec}
7210 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
7211 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
7212 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
7213 @end table
7214
7215 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
7216 the object code for the first line of function
7217 @code{m4_changequote}:
7218
7219 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
7220 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
7221 @smallexample
7222 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
7223 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
7224 @end smallexample
7225
7226 @noindent
7227 @cindex code address and its source line
7228 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
7229 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
7230 @smallexample
7231 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
7232 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
7233 @end smallexample
7234
7235 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
7236 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
7237 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
7238 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
7239 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
7240 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
7241 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
7242 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7243 Variables}).
7244
7245 @table @code
7246 @kindex disassemble
7247 @cindex assembly instructions
7248 @cindex instructions, assembly
7249 @cindex machine instructions
7250 @cindex listing machine instructions
7251 @item disassemble
7252 @itemx disassemble /m
7253 @itemx disassemble /r
7254 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
7255 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
7256 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
7257 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
7258 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
7259 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
7260 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
7261 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
7262 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
7263 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
7264
7265 @table @code
7266 @item @var{start},@var{end}
7267 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
7268 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
7269 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
7270 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
7271 @end table
7272
7273 @noindent
7274 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
7275 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
7276
7277 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
7278 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
7279
7280 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
7281 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
7282 @end table
7283
7284 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
7285 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
7286
7287 @smallexample
7288 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
7289 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
7290 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
7291 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
7292 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7293 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
7294 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
7295 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
7296 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
7297 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7298 End of assembler dump.
7299 @end smallexample
7300
7301 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
7302 program is stopped just after function prologue:
7303
7304 @smallexample
7305 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
7306 Dump of assembler code for function main:
7307 5 @{
7308 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
7309 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
7310 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
7311 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
7312 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
7313
7314 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
7315 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
7316 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
7317
7318 7 return 0;
7319 8 @}
7320 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
7321 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
7322 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
7323
7324 End of assembler dump.
7325 @end smallexample
7326
7327 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
7328
7329 @smallexample
7330 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
7331 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
7332 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
7333 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
7334 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
7335 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
7336 End of assembler dump.
7337 @end smallexample
7338
7339 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
7340 mnemonics or other syntax.
7341
7342 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
7343 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
7344 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
7345 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
7346 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
7347
7348 @table @code
7349 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
7350 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
7351 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
7352 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
7353 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
7354 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
7355
7356 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
7357 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
7358 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
7359 assemblers for x86-based targets.
7360
7361 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
7362 @item show disassembly-flavor
7363 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
7364 @end table
7365
7366 @table @code
7367 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
7368 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
7369 @item set disassemble-next-line
7370 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
7371 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
7372 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
7373 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
7374 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
7375 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
7376 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
7377 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
7378 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
7379 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
7380 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
7381 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
7382 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
7383 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
7384 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
7385 instruction.
7386 @end table
7387
7388
7389 @node Data
7390 @chapter Examining Data
7391
7392 @cindex printing data
7393 @cindex examining data
7394 @kindex print
7395 @kindex inspect
7396 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
7397 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
7398 @c different window or something like that.
7399 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7400 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
7401 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
7402 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
7403 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
7404 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
7405
7406 @table @code
7407 @item print @var{expr}
7408 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
7409 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
7410 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
7411 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
7412 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
7413 Formats}.
7414
7415 @item print
7416 @itemx print /@var{f}
7417 @cindex reprint the last value
7418 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
7419 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
7420 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
7421 @end table
7422
7423 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
7424 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
7425 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7426
7427 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
7428 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
7429 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7430 Table}.
7431
7432 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
7433 @kindex explore
7434 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
7435 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
7436 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
7437 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
7438 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
7439 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
7440 embedded in the higher level data types.
7441
7442 @table @code
7443 @item explore @var{arg}
7444 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
7445 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
7446 @end table
7447
7448 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
7449 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
7450 C program as
7451
7452 @smallexample
7453 struct SimpleStruct
7454 @{
7455 int i;
7456 double d;
7457 @};
7458
7459 struct ComplexStruct
7460 @{
7461 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
7462 int arr[10];
7463 @};
7464 @end smallexample
7465
7466 @noindent
7467 followed by variable declarations as
7468
7469 @smallexample
7470 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
7471 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
7472 @end smallexample
7473
7474 @noindent
7475 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
7476 @code{explore} command as follows.
7477
7478 @smallexample
7479 (gdb) explore cs
7480 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
7481 the following fields:
7482
7483 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
7484 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
7485
7486 Enter the field number of choice:
7487 @end smallexample
7488
7489 @noindent
7490 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
7491 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
7492 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
7493 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
7494 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
7495 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
7496 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
7497 field will be explored as if it were an array.
7498
7499 @smallexample
7500 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
7501 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
7502 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
7503 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
7504
7505 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
7506 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
7507
7508 Press enter to return to parent value:
7509 @end smallexample
7510
7511 @noindent
7512 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
7513 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
7514 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
7515 to explore.
7516
7517 @smallexample
7518 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
7519 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
7520
7521 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
7522
7523 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
7524
7525 Press enter to return to parent value:
7526 @end smallexample
7527
7528 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
7529 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
7530 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
7531 level data structure).
7532
7533 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
7534 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
7535 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
7536 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
7537 same example as above, your can explore the type
7538 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
7539 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
7540
7541 @smallexample
7542 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
7543 @end smallexample
7544
7545 @noindent
7546 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
7547 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
7548 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
7549 example.
7550
7551 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
7552 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
7553 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
7554 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
7555 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
7556
7557 @table @code
7558 @item explore value @var{expr}
7559 @cindex explore value
7560 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
7561 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
7562 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
7563 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
7564 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
7565
7566 @item explore type @var{arg}
7567 @cindex explore type
7568 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
7569 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
7570 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
7571 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
7572 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
7573 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
7574 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
7575 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
7576 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
7577 @end table
7578
7579 @menu
7580 * Expressions:: Expressions
7581 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
7582 * Variables:: Program variables
7583 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
7584 * Output Formats:: Output formats
7585 * Memory:: Examining memory
7586 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
7587 * Print Settings:: Print settings
7588 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
7589 * Value History:: Value history
7590 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
7591 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
7592 * Registers:: Registers
7593 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
7594 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
7595 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
7596 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
7597 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
7598 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
7599 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
7600 character set than GDB does
7601 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
7602 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
7603 @end menu
7604
7605 @node Expressions
7606 @section Expressions
7607
7608 @cindex expressions
7609 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
7610 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
7611 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
7612 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
7613 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
7614 you compiled your program to include this information; see
7615 @ref{Compilation}.
7616
7617 @cindex arrays in expressions
7618 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
7619 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
7620 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
7621 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
7622 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
7623 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
7624
7625 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
7626 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
7627 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
7628 languages.
7629
7630 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
7631 expressions regardless of your programming language.
7632
7633 @cindex casts, in expressions
7634 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
7635 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
7636 at that address in memory.
7637 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
7638
7639 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
7640 to programming languages:
7641
7642 @table @code
7643 @item @@
7644 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
7645 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
7646
7647 @item ::
7648 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
7649 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
7650
7651 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
7652 @cindex type casting memory
7653 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
7654 @cindex casts, to view memory
7655 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
7656 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
7657 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
7658 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
7659 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
7660 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
7661 @end table
7662
7663 @node Ambiguous Expressions
7664 @section Ambiguous Expressions
7665 @cindex ambiguous expressions
7666
7667 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
7668 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
7669 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
7670 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
7671 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
7672 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
7673 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
7674
7675 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
7676 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
7677 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
7678 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
7679 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
7680 as well.
7681
7682 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
7683 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
7684 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
7685 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
7686 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
7687 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
7688 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
7689 choices.
7690
7691 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
7692 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
7693 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
7694
7695 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
7696 @smallexample
7697 @group
7698 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
7699 [0] cancel
7700 [1] all
7701 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
7702 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
7703 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
7704 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
7705 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
7706 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
7707 > 2 4 6
7708 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
7709 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
7710 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
7711 Multiple breakpoints were set.
7712 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
7713 breakpoints.
7714 (@value{GDBP})
7715 @end group
7716 @end smallexample
7717
7718 @table @code
7719 @kindex set multiple-symbols
7720 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
7721 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
7722
7723 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
7724 is ambiguous.
7725
7726 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
7727 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
7728 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
7729 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
7730 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
7731 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
7732 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
7733 in the use of the menu.
7734
7735 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
7736 when an ambiguity is detected.
7737
7738 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
7739 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
7740
7741 @kindex show multiple-symbols
7742 @item show multiple-symbols
7743 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
7744 @end table
7745
7746 @node Variables
7747 @section Program Variables
7748
7749 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
7750 in your program.
7751
7752 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
7753 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
7754
7755 @itemize @bullet
7756 @item
7757 global (or file-static)
7758 @end itemize
7759
7760 @noindent or
7761
7762 @itemize @bullet
7763 @item
7764 visible according to the scope rules of the
7765 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
7766 @end itemize
7767
7768 @noindent This means that in the function
7769
7770 @smallexample
7771 foo (a)
7772 int a;
7773 @{
7774 bar (a);
7775 @{
7776 int b = test ();
7777 bar (b);
7778 @}
7779 @}
7780 @end smallexample
7781
7782 @noindent
7783 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
7784 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
7785 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
7786 the block where @code{b} is declared.
7787
7788 @cindex variable name conflict
7789 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
7790 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
7791 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
7792 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
7793 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
7794 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
7795 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
7796
7797 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
7798 @ifnotinfo
7799 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
7800 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
7801 @end ifnotinfo
7802 @smallexample
7803 @var{file}::@var{variable}
7804 @var{function}::@var{variable}
7805 @end smallexample
7806
7807 @noindent
7808 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
7809 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
7810 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
7811 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
7812
7813 @smallexample
7814 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
7815 @end smallexample
7816
7817 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
7818 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
7819 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
7820 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
7821 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
7822
7823 @smallexample
7824 void
7825 foo (int a)
7826 @{
7827 if (a < 10)
7828 bar (a);
7829 else
7830 process (a); /* Stop here */
7831 @}
7832
7833 int
7834 bar (int a)
7835 @{
7836 foo (a + 5);
7837 @}
7838 @end smallexample
7839
7840 @noindent
7841 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
7842 here is what you might see
7843 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
7844
7845 @smallexample
7846 (@value{GDBP}) p a
7847 $1 = 10
7848 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
7849 $2 = 5
7850 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
7851 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
7852 (@value{GDBP}) p a
7853 $3 = 5
7854 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
7855 $4 = 0
7856 @end smallexample
7857
7858 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
7859 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very similar
7860 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
7861 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
7862 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
7863 @c conflict?? --mew
7864
7865 @cindex wrong values
7866 @cindex variable values, wrong
7867 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
7868 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
7869 @quotation
7870 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
7871 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
7872 scope, and just before exit.
7873 @end quotation
7874 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
7875 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
7876 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
7877 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
7878 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
7879 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
7880 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
7881 variable definitions may be gone.
7882
7883 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
7884 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
7885 when compiling.
7886
7887 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
7888 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
7889 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
7890 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
7891 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
7892 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
7893 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
7894
7895 @smallexample
7896 No symbol "foo" in current context.
7897 @end smallexample
7898
7899 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
7900 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
7901 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
7902 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
7903 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
7904
7905 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
7906 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
7907 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
7908 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
7909
7910 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
7911 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
7912 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
7913 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
7914 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
7915
7916 @smallexample
7917 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
7918 29 i++;
7919 (gdb) next
7920 30 e (i);
7921 (gdb) print i
7922 $1 = 31
7923 (gdb) print i@@entry
7924 $2 = 30
7925 @end smallexample
7926
7927 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
7928 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
7929 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
7930 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
7931 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
7932 For program code
7933
7934 @smallexample
7935 char var0[] = "A";
7936 signed char var1[] = "A";
7937 @end smallexample
7938
7939 You get during debugging
7940 @smallexample
7941 (gdb) print var0
7942 $1 = "A"
7943 (gdb) print var1
7944 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
7945 @end smallexample
7946
7947 @node Arrays
7948 @section Artificial Arrays
7949
7950 @cindex artificial array
7951 @cindex arrays
7952 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
7953 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
7954 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
7955 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
7956 program.
7957
7958 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
7959 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
7960 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
7961 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
7962 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
7963 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
7964 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
7965 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
7966 example. If a program says
7967
7968 @smallexample
7969 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
7970 @end smallexample
7971
7972 @noindent
7973 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
7974
7975 @smallexample
7976 p *array@@len
7977 @end smallexample
7978
7979 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
7980 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
7981 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
7982 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
7983 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
7984
7985 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
7986 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
7987 The value need not be in memory:
7988 @smallexample
7989 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
7990 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7991 @end smallexample
7992
7993 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
7994 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
7995 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
7996 @smallexample
7997 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
7998 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7999 @end smallexample
8000
8001 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
8002 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
8003 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
8004 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
8005 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8006 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
8007 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
8008 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
8009 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
8010 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
8011
8012 @smallexample
8013 set $i = 0
8014 p dtab[$i++]->fv
8015 @key{RET}
8016 @key{RET}
8017 @dots{}
8018 @end smallexample
8019
8020 @node Output Formats
8021 @section Output Formats
8022
8023 @cindex formatted output
8024 @cindex output formats
8025 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
8026 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
8027 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
8028 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
8029 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
8030
8031 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
8032 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
8033 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
8034 letters supported are:
8035
8036 @table @code
8037 @item x
8038 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
8039 hexadecimal.
8040
8041 @item d
8042 Print as integer in signed decimal.
8043
8044 @item u
8045 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
8046
8047 @item o
8048 Print as integer in octal.
8049
8050 @item t
8051 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
8052 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
8053 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
8054 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
8055
8056 @item a
8057 @cindex unknown address, locating
8058 @cindex locate address
8059 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
8060 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
8061 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
8062
8063 @smallexample
8064 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
8065 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
8066 @end smallexample
8067
8068 @noindent
8069 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
8070 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
8071
8072 @item c
8073 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
8074 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
8075 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
8076 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
8077
8078 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
8079 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
8080 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
8081 data.
8082
8083 @item f
8084 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
8085 using typical floating point syntax.
8086
8087 @item s
8088 @cindex printing strings
8089 @cindex printing byte arrays
8090 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
8091 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
8092 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
8093 natural types.
8094
8095 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
8096 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
8097 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
8098 array.
8099
8100 @item r
8101 @cindex raw printing
8102 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
8103 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
8104 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
8105 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
8106 pretty-printer which might exist.
8107 @end table
8108
8109 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
8110
8111 @smallexample
8112 p/x $pc
8113 @end smallexample
8114
8115 @noindent
8116 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
8117 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
8118
8119 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
8120 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
8121 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
8122
8123 @node Memory
8124 @section Examining Memory
8125
8126 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
8127 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
8128
8129 @cindex examining memory
8130 @table @code
8131 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
8132 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
8133 @itemx x @var{addr}
8134 @itemx x
8135 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
8136 @end table
8137
8138 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
8139 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
8140 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
8141 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
8142 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
8143
8144 @table @r
8145 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
8146 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
8147 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
8148 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
8149 @c 4.1.2.
8150
8151 @item @var{f}, the display format
8152 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
8153 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
8154 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
8155 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
8156 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
8157
8158 @item @var{u}, the unit size
8159 The unit size is any of
8160
8161 @table @code
8162 @item b
8163 Bytes.
8164 @item h
8165 Halfwords (two bytes).
8166 @item w
8167 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
8168 @item g
8169 Giant words (eight bytes).
8170 @end table
8171
8172 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
8173 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
8174 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
8175 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
8176 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
8177 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
8178 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
8179 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
8180 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
8181 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
8182 be altered.
8183
8184 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
8185 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
8186 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
8187 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
8188 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
8189 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
8190 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
8191 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
8192 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
8193 a value from memory).
8194 @end table
8195
8196 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
8197 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
8198 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
8199 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
8200 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
8201
8202 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
8203 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
8204 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
8205 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
8206 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
8207
8208 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
8209 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
8210 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
8211 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
8212 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
8213 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
8214 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
8215 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
8216 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
8217
8218 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
8219 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
8220 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
8221 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
8222 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
8223 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
8224 for successive uses of @code{x}.
8225
8226 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
8227 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
8228
8229 @smallexample
8230 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
8231 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
8232 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
8233 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
8234 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
8235 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
8236 @end smallexample
8237
8238 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
8239 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
8240 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
8241 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
8242 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
8243 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
8244 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
8245 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
8246 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
8247
8248 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
8249 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
8250 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
8251
8252 @cindex remote memory comparison
8253 @cindex verify remote memory image
8254 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
8255 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
8256 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
8257 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
8258 situations.
8259
8260 @table @code
8261 @kindex compare-sections
8262 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
8263 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
8264 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
8265 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
8266 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
8267 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
8268 remote request.
8269 @end table
8270
8271 @node Auto Display
8272 @section Automatic Display
8273 @cindex automatic display
8274 @cindex display of expressions
8275
8276 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
8277 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
8278 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
8279 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
8280 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
8281 The automatic display looks like this:
8282
8283 @smallexample
8284 2: foo = 38
8285 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
8286 @end smallexample
8287
8288 @noindent
8289 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
8290 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
8291 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
8292 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
8293 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
8294 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
8295
8296 @table @code
8297 @kindex display
8298 @item display @var{expr}
8299 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
8300 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8301
8302 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8303
8304 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
8305 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
8306 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
8307 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
8308 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
8309
8310 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
8311 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
8312 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
8313 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
8314 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8315 @end table
8316
8317 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
8318 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
8319 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
8320
8321 @table @code
8322 @kindex delete display
8323 @kindex undisplay
8324 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
8325 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8326 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
8327 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
8328 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
8329 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
8330 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8331
8332 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8333 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
8334
8335 @kindex disable display
8336 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8337 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
8338 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
8339 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
8340 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
8341 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
8342 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
8343 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8344
8345 @kindex enable display
8346 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8347 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
8348 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
8349 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
8350 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
8351 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
8352 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8353
8354 @item display
8355 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
8356 done when your program stops.
8357
8358 @kindex info display
8359 @item info display
8360 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
8361 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
8362 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
8363 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
8364 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
8365 @end table
8366
8367 @cindex display disabled out of scope
8368 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
8369 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
8370 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
8371 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
8372 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
8373 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
8374 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
8375 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
8376 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
8377 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
8378
8379 @node Print Settings
8380 @section Print Settings
8381
8382 @cindex format options
8383 @cindex print settings
8384 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
8385 and symbols are printed.
8386
8387 @noindent
8388 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
8389
8390 @table @code
8391 @kindex set print
8392 @item set print address
8393 @itemx set print address on
8394 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
8395 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
8396 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
8397 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
8398 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
8399 @code{set print address on}:
8400
8401 @smallexample
8402 @group
8403 (@value{GDBP}) f
8404 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
8405 at input.c:530
8406 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
8407 @end group
8408 @end smallexample
8409
8410 @item set print address off
8411 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
8412 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
8413
8414 @smallexample
8415 @group
8416 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
8417 (@value{GDBP}) f
8418 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
8419 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
8420 @end group
8421 @end smallexample
8422
8423 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
8424 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
8425 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
8426 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
8427
8428 @kindex show print
8429 @item show print address
8430 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
8431 @end table
8432
8433 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
8434 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
8435 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
8436 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
8437 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
8438 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
8439 it prints a symbolic address:
8440
8441 @table @code
8442 @item set print symbol-filename on
8443 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
8444 @cindex symbol, source file and line
8445 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
8446 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
8447
8448 @item set print symbol-filename off
8449 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
8450 default.
8451
8452 @item show print symbol-filename
8453 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
8454 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
8455 @end table
8456
8457 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
8458 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
8459 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
8460
8461 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
8462 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
8463
8464 @table @code
8465 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
8466 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
8467 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
8468 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
8469 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
8470 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
8471
8472 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
8473 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
8474 symbolic address.
8475 @end table
8476
8477 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
8478 @cindex pointer, finding referent
8479 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
8480 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
8481 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
8482 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
8483 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
8484 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
8485
8486 @smallexample
8487 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
8488 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
8489 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
8490 @end smallexample
8491
8492 @quotation
8493 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
8494 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
8495 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
8496 @end quotation
8497
8498 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
8499 @samp{set print symbol on}:
8500
8501 @table @code
8502 @item set print symbol on
8503 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
8504 one exists.
8505
8506 @item set print symbol off
8507 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
8508 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
8509 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
8510
8511 @item show print symbol
8512 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
8513 address.
8514 @end table
8515
8516 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
8517
8518 @table @code
8519 @item set print array
8520 @itemx set print array on
8521 @cindex pretty print arrays
8522 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
8523 but uses more space. The default is off.
8524
8525 @item set print array off
8526 Return to compressed format for arrays.
8527
8528 @item show print array
8529 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
8530 arrays.
8531
8532 @cindex print array indexes
8533 @item set print array-indexes
8534 @itemx set print array-indexes on
8535 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
8536 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
8537 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
8538
8539 @item set print array-indexes off
8540 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
8541
8542 @item show print array-indexes
8543 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
8544 arrays.
8545
8546 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
8547 @cindex number of array elements to print
8548 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
8549 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
8550 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
8551 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
8552 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
8553 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
8554 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
8555
8556 @item show print elements
8557 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
8558 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
8559
8560 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
8561 @kindex set print frame-arguments
8562 @cindex printing frame argument values
8563 @cindex print all frame argument values
8564 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
8565 @cindex do not print frame argument values
8566 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
8567 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
8568 values are:
8569
8570 @table @code
8571 @item all
8572 The values of all arguments are printed.
8573
8574 @item scalars
8575 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
8576 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
8577 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
8578 only scalar arguments are shown:
8579
8580 @smallexample
8581 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
8582 at frame-args.c:23
8583 @end smallexample
8584
8585 @item none
8586 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
8587 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
8588
8589 @smallexample
8590 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
8591 at frame-args.c:23
8592 @end smallexample
8593 @end table
8594
8595 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
8596 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
8597 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
8598 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
8599 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
8600 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
8601 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
8602 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
8603 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
8604 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
8605
8606 @item show print frame-arguments
8607 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
8608
8609 @anchor{set print entry-values}
8610 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
8611 @kindex set print entry-values
8612 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
8613 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
8614 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
8615 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
8616 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
8617
8618 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
8619 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
8620 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
8621 @code{no} setting.
8622
8623 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
8624 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
8625 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
8626 this information.
8627
8628 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
8629
8630 @table @code
8631 @item no
8632 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
8633 point.
8634 @smallexample
8635 #0 equal (val=5)
8636 #0 different (val=6)
8637 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
8638 #0 born (val=10)
8639 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
8640 @end smallexample
8641
8642 @item only
8643 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
8644 values are never printed.
8645 @smallexample
8646 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
8647 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
8648 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
8649 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
8650 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
8651 @end smallexample
8652
8653 @item preferred
8654 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
8655 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
8656 value for such parameter.
8657 @smallexample
8658 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
8659 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
8660 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
8661 #0 born (val=10)
8662 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
8663 @end smallexample
8664
8665 @item if-needed
8666 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
8667 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
8668 parameter.
8669 @smallexample
8670 #0 equal (val=5)
8671 #0 different (val=6)
8672 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
8673 #0 born (val=10)
8674 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
8675 @end smallexample
8676
8677 @item both
8678 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
8679 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
8680 optimizations.
8681 @smallexample
8682 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
8683 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
8684 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
8685 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
8686 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
8687 @end smallexample
8688
8689 @item compact
8690 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
8691 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
8692 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
8693 values are known and identical, print the shortened
8694 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
8695 @smallexample
8696 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
8697 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
8698 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
8699 #0 born (val=10)
8700 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
8701 @end smallexample
8702
8703 @item default
8704 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
8705 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
8706 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
8707 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
8708 @smallexample
8709 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
8710 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
8711 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
8712 #0 born (val=10)
8713 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
8714 @end smallexample
8715 @end table
8716
8717 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
8718 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
8719
8720 @item show print entry-values
8721 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
8722 entry.
8723
8724 @item set print repeats
8725 @cindex repeated array elements
8726 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
8727 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
8728 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
8729 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
8730 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
8731 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
8732 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
8733
8734 @item show print repeats
8735 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
8736 elements.
8737
8738 @item set print null-stop
8739 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
8740 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
8741 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
8742 contain only short strings.
8743 The default is off.
8744
8745 @item show print null-stop
8746 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
8747 @sc{null} character.
8748
8749 @item set print pretty on
8750 @cindex print structures in indented form
8751 @cindex indentation in structure display
8752 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
8753 per line, like this:
8754
8755 @smallexample
8756 @group
8757 $1 = @{
8758 next = 0x0,
8759 flags = @{
8760 sweet = 1,
8761 sour = 1
8762 @},
8763 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
8764 @}
8765 @end group
8766 @end smallexample
8767
8768 @item set print pretty off
8769 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
8770
8771 @smallexample
8772 @group
8773 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
8774 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
8775 @end group
8776 @end smallexample
8777
8778 @noindent
8779 This is the default format.
8780
8781 @item show print pretty
8782 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
8783
8784 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
8785 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
8786 @cindex octal escapes in strings
8787 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
8788 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
8789 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
8790 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
8791 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
8792
8793 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
8794 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
8795 international character sets, and is the default.
8796
8797 @item show print sevenbit-strings
8798 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
8799
8800 @item set print union on
8801 @cindex unions in structures, printing
8802 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
8803 and other unions. This is the default setting.
8804
8805 @item set print union off
8806 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
8807 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
8808 instead.
8809
8810 @item show print union
8811 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
8812 structures and other unions.
8813
8814 For example, given the declarations
8815
8816 @smallexample
8817 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
8818 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
8819 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
8820 Bug_forms;
8821
8822 struct thing @{
8823 Species it;
8824 union @{
8825 Tree_forms tree;
8826 Bug_forms bug;
8827 @} form;
8828 @};
8829
8830 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
8831 @end smallexample
8832
8833 @noindent
8834 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
8835
8836 @smallexample
8837 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
8838 @end smallexample
8839
8840 @noindent
8841 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
8842
8843 @smallexample
8844 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
8845 @end smallexample
8846
8847 @noindent
8848 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
8849 and in Pascal.
8850 @end table
8851
8852 @need 1000
8853 @noindent
8854 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
8855
8856 @table @code
8857 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
8858 @item set print demangle
8859 @itemx set print demangle on
8860 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
8861 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
8862 linkage. The default is on.
8863
8864 @item show print demangle
8865 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
8866
8867 @item set print asm-demangle
8868 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
8869 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
8870 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
8871 The default is off.
8872
8873 @item show print asm-demangle
8874 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
8875 or demangled form.
8876
8877 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
8878 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
8879 @kindex set demangle-style
8880 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
8881 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
8882 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
8883
8884 @table @code
8885 @item auto
8886 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
8887
8888 @item gnu
8889 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
8890 This is the default.
8891
8892 @item hp
8893 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
8894
8895 @item lucid
8896 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
8897
8898 @item arm
8899 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
8900 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
8901 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
8902 require further enhancement to permit that.
8903
8904 @end table
8905 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
8906
8907 @item show demangle-style
8908 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
8909
8910 @item set print object
8911 @itemx set print object on
8912 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
8913 @cindex display derived types
8914 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
8915 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
8916 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
8917 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
8918 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
8919 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
8920 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
8921
8922 @item set print object off
8923 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
8924 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
8925
8926 @item show print object
8927 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
8928
8929 @item set print static-members
8930 @itemx set print static-members on
8931 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
8932 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
8933
8934 @item set print static-members off
8935 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
8936
8937 @item show print static-members
8938 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
8939
8940 @item set print pascal_static-members
8941 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
8942 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
8943 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
8944 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
8945
8946 @item set print pascal_static-members off
8947 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
8948
8949 @item show print pascal_static-members
8950 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
8951
8952 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
8953 @item set print vtbl
8954 @itemx set print vtbl on
8955 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
8956 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
8957 @cindex VTBL display
8958 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
8959 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
8960 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
8961
8962 @item set print vtbl off
8963 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
8964
8965 @item show print vtbl
8966 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
8967 @end table
8968
8969 @node Pretty Printing
8970 @section Pretty Printing
8971
8972 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
8973 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
8974 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
8975
8976 @menu
8977 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
8978 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
8979 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
8980 @end menu
8981
8982 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
8983 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
8984
8985 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
8986 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
8987 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
8988
8989 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
8990 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
8991 pretty-printers with their names.
8992 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
8993 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
8994 Each such subprinter has its own name.
8995 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
8996
8997 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
8998 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
8999 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
9000 do anything special.
9001
9002 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
9003
9004 @itemize @bullet
9005 @item
9006 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
9007 all inferiors.
9008
9009 @item
9010 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
9011 when debugging that program.
9012 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
9013
9014 @item
9015 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
9016 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
9017 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
9018 @end itemize
9019
9020 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
9021 pretty-printers are selected,
9022
9023 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
9024 for new types.
9025
9026 @node Pretty-Printer Example
9027 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
9028
9029 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
9030
9031 @smallexample
9032 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9033 $1 = @{
9034 static npos = 4294967295,
9035 _M_dataplus = @{
9036 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
9037 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
9038 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
9039 @},
9040 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
9041 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
9042 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
9043 @}
9044 @}
9045 @end smallexample
9046
9047 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
9048
9049 @smallexample
9050 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9051 $2 = "abcd"
9052 @end smallexample
9053
9054 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
9055 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
9056 @cindex pretty-printer commands
9057
9058 @table @code
9059 @kindex info pretty-printer
9060 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9061 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
9062 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
9063
9064 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
9065 whose pretty-printers to list.
9066 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
9067 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
9068 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
9069 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
9070 looks up a printer from these three objects.
9071
9072 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
9073 to list.
9074
9075 @kindex disable pretty-printer
9076 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9077 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9078 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
9079
9080 @kindex enable pretty-printer
9081 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9082 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9083 @end table
9084
9085 Example:
9086
9087 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
9088 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
9089 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
9090 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
9091
9092 @smallexample
9093 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9094 library1.so:
9095 foo
9096 library2.so:
9097 bar
9098 bar1
9099 bar2
9100 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9101 library2.so:
9102 bar
9103 bar1
9104 bar2
9105 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
9106 1 printer disabled
9107 2 of 3 printers enabled
9108 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9109 library1.so:
9110 foo [disabled]
9111 library2.so:
9112 bar
9113 bar1
9114 bar2
9115 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
9116 1 printer disabled
9117 1 of 3 printers enabled
9118 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9119 library1.so:
9120 foo [disabled]
9121 library2.so:
9122 bar
9123 bar1 [disabled]
9124 bar2
9125 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
9126 1 printer disabled
9127 0 of 3 printers enabled
9128 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9129 library1.so:
9130 foo [disabled]
9131 library2.so:
9132 bar [disabled]
9133 bar1 [disabled]
9134 bar2
9135 @end smallexample
9136
9137 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
9138 as can each individual subprinter.
9139
9140 @node Value History
9141 @section Value History
9142
9143 @cindex value history
9144 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
9145 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
9146 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
9147 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
9148 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
9149 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
9150 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
9151 symbol table.
9152
9153 @cindex @code{$}
9154 @cindex @code{$$}
9155 @cindex history number
9156 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
9157 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
9158 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
9159 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
9160 history number.
9161
9162 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
9163 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
9164 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
9165 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
9166 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
9167 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
9168 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
9169
9170 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
9171 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
9172
9173 @smallexample
9174 p *$
9175 @end smallexample
9176
9177 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
9178 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
9179
9180 @smallexample
9181 p *$.next
9182 @end smallexample
9183
9184 @noindent
9185 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
9186 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
9187
9188 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
9189 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
9190
9191 @smallexample
9192 print x
9193 set x=5
9194 @end smallexample
9195
9196 @noindent
9197 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
9198 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
9199
9200 @table @code
9201 @kindex show values
9202 @item show values
9203 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
9204 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
9205 values} does not change the history.
9206
9207 @item show values @var{n}
9208 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
9209
9210 @item show values +
9211 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
9212 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
9213 @end table
9214
9215 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
9216 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
9217
9218 @node Convenience Vars
9219 @section Convenience Variables
9220
9221 @cindex convenience variables
9222 @cindex user-defined variables
9223 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
9224 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
9225 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
9226 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
9227 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
9228
9229 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
9230 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
9231 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9232 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
9233 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
9234
9235 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
9236 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
9237 For example:
9238
9239 @smallexample
9240 set $foo = *object_ptr
9241 @end smallexample
9242
9243 @noindent
9244 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
9245 @code{object_ptr}.
9246
9247 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
9248 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
9249 value with another assignment at any time.
9250
9251 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
9252 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
9253 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
9254 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
9255
9256 @table @code
9257 @kindex show convenience
9258 @cindex show all user variables and functions
9259 @item show convenience
9260 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
9261 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
9262 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
9263
9264 @kindex init-if-undefined
9265 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
9266 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
9267 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
9268 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
9269 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
9270 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
9271 override default values used in a command script.
9272
9273 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
9274 any side-effects do not occur.
9275 @end table
9276
9277 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
9278 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
9279 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
9280
9281 @smallexample
9282 set $i = 0
9283 print bar[$i++]->contents
9284 @end smallexample
9285
9286 @noindent
9287 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
9288
9289 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
9290 values likely to be useful.
9291
9292 @table @code
9293 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
9294 @item $_
9295 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
9296 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
9297 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
9298 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
9299 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
9300 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
9301 to the type of @code{$__}.
9302
9303 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
9304 @item $__
9305 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
9306 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
9307 to match the format in which the data was printed.
9308
9309 @item $_exitcode
9310 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
9311 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
9312 the program being debugged terminates.
9313
9314 @item $_probe_argc
9315 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
9316 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
9317
9318 @item $_sdata
9319 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
9320 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
9321 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
9322 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
9323 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
9324
9325 @item $_siginfo
9326 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
9327 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
9328 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
9329 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
9330 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
9331
9332 @item $_tlb
9333 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
9334 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
9335 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
9336 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
9337 @xref{General Query Packets}.
9338 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
9339
9340 @end table
9341
9342 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
9343 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
9344 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
9345
9346 @node Convenience Funs
9347 @section Convenience Functions
9348
9349 @cindex convenience functions
9350 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
9351 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
9352 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
9353 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
9354 @value{GDBN}.
9355
9356 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
9357 @code{Python} support.
9358
9359 @table @code
9360
9361 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
9362 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
9363 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
9364 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
9365 Otherwise it returns zero.
9366
9367 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
9368 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
9369 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
9370 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
9371 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
9372 regular expression support.
9373
9374 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
9375 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
9376 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
9377 Otherwise it returns zero.
9378
9379 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
9380 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
9381 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
9382
9383 @end table
9384
9385 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
9386 convenience functions.
9387
9388 @table @code
9389 @item help function
9390 @kindex help function
9391 @cindex show all convenience functions
9392 Print a list of all convenience functions.
9393 @end table
9394
9395 @node Registers
9396 @section Registers
9397
9398 @cindex registers
9399 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
9400 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
9401 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
9402 your machine.
9403
9404 @table @code
9405 @kindex info registers
9406 @item info registers
9407 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
9408 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
9409
9410 @kindex info all-registers
9411 @cindex floating point registers
9412 @item info all-registers
9413 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
9414 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
9415
9416 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
9417 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
9418 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
9419 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
9420 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
9421 @end table
9422
9423 @cindex stack pointer register
9424 @cindex program counter register
9425 @cindex process status register
9426 @cindex frame pointer register
9427 @cindex standard registers
9428 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
9429 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
9430 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
9431 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
9432 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
9433 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
9434 register that contains the processor status. For example,
9435 you could print the program counter in hex with
9436
9437 @smallexample
9438 p/x $pc
9439 @end smallexample
9440
9441 @noindent
9442 or print the instruction to be executed next with
9443
9444 @smallexample
9445 x/i $pc
9446 @end smallexample
9447
9448 @noindent
9449 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
9450 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
9451 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
9452 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
9453 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
9454 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
9455 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
9456
9457 @smallexample
9458 set $sp += 4
9459 @end smallexample
9460
9461 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
9462 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
9463 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
9464 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
9465 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
9466 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
9467 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
9468
9469 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
9470 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
9471 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
9472 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
9473 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
9474 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
9475 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
9476
9477 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
9478 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
9479 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
9480 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
9481 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
9482 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
9483 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
9484 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
9485 prints the data in both formats.
9486
9487 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
9488 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
9489 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
9490 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
9491 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
9492 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
9493 registers in @code{struct} notation:
9494
9495 @smallexample
9496 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
9497 $1 = @{
9498 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
9499 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
9500 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
9501 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
9502 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
9503 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
9504 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
9505 @}
9506 @end smallexample
9507
9508 @noindent
9509 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
9510 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
9511 value to a @code{struct} member:
9512
9513 @smallexample
9514 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
9515 @end smallexample
9516
9517 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
9518 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
9519 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
9520 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
9521 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
9522 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
9523
9524 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
9525 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
9526 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
9527 frame makes no difference.
9528
9529 @node Floating Point Hardware
9530 @section Floating Point Hardware
9531 @cindex floating point
9532
9533 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
9534 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
9535
9536 @table @code
9537 @kindex info float
9538 @item info float
9539 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
9540 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
9541 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
9542 the ARM and x86 machines.
9543 @end table
9544
9545 @node Vector Unit
9546 @section Vector Unit
9547 @cindex vector unit
9548
9549 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
9550 more information about the status of the vector unit.
9551
9552 @table @code
9553 @kindex info vector
9554 @item info vector
9555 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
9556 layout vary depending on the hardware.
9557 @end table
9558
9559 @node OS Information
9560 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
9561 @cindex OS information
9562
9563 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
9564 you debug your program.
9565
9566 @cindex auxiliary vector
9567 @cindex vector, auxiliary
9568 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
9569 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
9570 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
9571 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
9572 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
9573 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
9574 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
9575 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
9576 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
9577 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
9578 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
9579
9580 @table @code
9581 @kindex info auxv
9582 @item info auxv
9583 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
9584 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
9585 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
9586 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
9587 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
9588 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
9589 an unrecognized tag.
9590 @end table
9591
9592 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
9593 information and show it to you. The types of information available
9594 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
9595 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
9596 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
9597 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
9598 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
9599
9600 @table @code
9601 @kindex info os
9602 @item info os @var{infotype}
9603
9604 Display OS information of the requested type.
9605
9606 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
9607
9608 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
9609 @table @code
9610 @kindex info os processes
9611 @item processes
9612 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
9613 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
9614 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
9615 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
9616 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
9617 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
9618
9619 @kindex info os procgroups
9620 @item procgroups
9621 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
9622 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
9623 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
9624 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
9625 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
9626 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
9627 and the process group leader is listed first.
9628
9629 @kindex info os threads
9630 @item threads
9631 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
9632 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
9633 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
9634 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
9635 process is not listed.
9636
9637 @kindex info os files
9638 @item files
9639 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
9640 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
9641 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
9642 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
9643
9644 @kindex info os sockets
9645 @item sockets
9646 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
9647 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
9648 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
9649 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
9650 connection.
9651
9652 @kindex info os shm
9653 @item shm
9654 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
9655 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
9656 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
9657 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
9658 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
9659 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
9660 attached to, detach from, and changed.
9661
9662 @kindex info os semaphores
9663 @item semaphores
9664 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
9665 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
9666 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
9667 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
9668 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
9669
9670 @kindex info os msg
9671 @item msg
9672 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
9673 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
9674 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
9675 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
9676 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
9677 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
9678 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
9679 the message queue was last changed.
9680
9681 @kindex info os modules
9682 @item modules
9683 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
9684 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
9685 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
9686 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
9687 in memory.
9688 @end table
9689
9690 @item info os
9691 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
9692 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
9693 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
9694 types, this command will report an error.
9695 @end table
9696
9697 @node Memory Region Attributes
9698 @section Memory Region Attributes
9699 @cindex memory region attributes
9700
9701 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
9702 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
9703 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
9704 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
9705 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
9706 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
9707 user can override the fetched regions.
9708
9709 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
9710 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
9711 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
9712 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
9713 all memory.
9714
9715 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
9716 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
9717
9718 @table @code
9719 @kindex mem
9720 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
9721 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
9722 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
9723 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
9724 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
9725 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
9726
9727 @item mem auto
9728 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
9729 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
9730
9731 @kindex delete mem
9732 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
9733 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
9734 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
9735
9736 @kindex disable mem
9737 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
9738 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
9739 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
9740 It may be enabled again later.
9741
9742 @kindex enable mem
9743 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
9744 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
9745
9746 @kindex info mem
9747 @item info mem
9748 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
9749 for each region:
9750
9751 @table @emph
9752 @item Memory Region Number
9753 @item Enabled or Disabled.
9754 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
9755 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
9756
9757 @item Lo Address
9758 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
9759
9760 @item Hi Address
9761 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
9762
9763 @item Attributes
9764 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
9765 @end table
9766 @end table
9767
9768
9769 @subsection Attributes
9770
9771 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
9772 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
9773 write accesses to a memory region.
9774
9775 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
9776 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
9777 etc.@: from accessing memory.
9778
9779 @table @code
9780 @item ro
9781 Memory is read only.
9782 @item wo
9783 Memory is write only.
9784 @item rw
9785 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
9786 @end table
9787
9788 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
9789 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
9790 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
9791 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
9792 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
9793
9794 @table @code
9795 @item 8
9796 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
9797 @item 16
9798 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
9799 @item 32
9800 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
9801 @item 64
9802 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
9803 @end table
9804
9805 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
9806 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
9807 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
9808 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
9809 @c
9810 @c @table @code
9811 @c @item hwbreak
9812 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
9813 @c @item swbreak (default)
9814 @c @end table
9815
9816 @subsubsection Data Cache
9817 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
9818 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
9819 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
9820 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
9821 registers.
9822
9823 @table @code
9824 @item cache
9825 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
9826 @item nocache
9827 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
9828 @end table
9829
9830 @subsection Memory Access Checking
9831 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
9832 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
9833 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
9834 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
9835
9836 @table @code
9837 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
9838 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
9839 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
9840 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
9841 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
9842 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
9843 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
9844 The default value is @code{on}.
9845 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
9846 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
9847 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
9848 @end table
9849
9850
9851 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
9852 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
9853 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
9854 @c
9855 @c @table @code
9856 @c @item verify
9857 @c @item noverify (default)
9858 @c @end table
9859
9860 @node Dump/Restore Files
9861 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
9862 @cindex dump/restore files
9863 @cindex append data to a file
9864 @cindex dump data to a file
9865 @cindex restore data from a file
9866
9867 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
9868 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
9869 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
9870 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
9871 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
9872 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
9873 files.
9874
9875 @table @code
9876
9877 @kindex dump
9878 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
9879 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
9880 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
9881 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
9882
9883 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
9884 @table @code
9885 @item binary
9886 Raw binary form.
9887 @item ihex
9888 Intel hex format.
9889 @item srec
9890 Motorola S-record format.
9891 @item tekhex
9892 Tektronix Hex format.
9893 @end table
9894
9895 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
9896 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
9897 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
9898 form.
9899
9900 @kindex append
9901 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
9902 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
9903 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
9904 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
9905 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
9906
9907 @kindex restore
9908 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
9909 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
9910 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
9911 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
9912 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
9913
9914 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
9915 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
9916 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
9917 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
9918 from that location.
9919
9920 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
9921 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
9922 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
9923 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
9924
9925 @end table
9926
9927 @node Core File Generation
9928 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
9929 @cindex dump core from inferior
9930
9931 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
9932 image of a running process and its process status (register values
9933 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
9934 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
9935 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
9936 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
9937 the post-mortem debugging mode.
9938
9939 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
9940 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
9941 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
9942
9943 @table @code
9944 @kindex gcore
9945 @kindex generate-core-file
9946 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
9947 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
9948 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
9949 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
9950 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
9951 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
9952
9953 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
9954 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
9955 @end table
9956
9957 @node Character Sets
9958 @section Character Sets
9959 @cindex character sets
9960 @cindex charset
9961 @cindex translating between character sets
9962 @cindex host character set
9963 @cindex target character set
9964
9965 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
9966 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
9967 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
9968 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
9969 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
9970 @dfn{target character set}.
9971
9972 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
9973 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
9974 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
9975 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
9976 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
9977 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
9978 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
9979 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
9980 character and string literals in expressions.
9981
9982 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
9983 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
9984 target-charset} command, described below.
9985
9986 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
9987 support:
9988
9989 @table @code
9990 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
9991 @kindex set target-charset
9992 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
9993 list of supported target character sets, type
9994 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
9995
9996 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
9997 @kindex set host-charset
9998 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
9999
10000 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
10001 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
10002 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
10003 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
10004 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
10005
10006 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
10007 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10008 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
10009
10010 @item set charset @var{charset}
10011 @kindex set charset
10012 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
10013 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10014 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
10015 for both host and target.
10016
10017 @item show charset
10018 @kindex show charset
10019 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
10020
10021 @item show host-charset
10022 @kindex show host-charset
10023 Show the name of the current host character set.
10024
10025 @item show target-charset
10026 @kindex show target-charset
10027 Show the name of the current target character set.
10028
10029 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
10030 @kindex set target-wide-charset
10031 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
10032 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
10033 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
10034 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10035
10036 @item show target-wide-charset
10037 @kindex show target-wide-charset
10038 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
10039 @end table
10040
10041 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
10042 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
10043 @file{charset-test.c}:
10044
10045 @smallexample
10046 #include <stdio.h>
10047
10048 char ascii_hello[]
10049 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
10050 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
10051 char ibm1047_hello[]
10052 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
10053 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
10054
10055 main ()
10056 @{
10057 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
10058 @}
10059 @end smallexample
10060
10061 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
10062 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
10063 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
10064
10065 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
10066
10067 @smallexample
10068 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
10069 $ gdb -nw charset-test
10070 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
10071 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
10072 @dots{}
10073 (@value{GDBP})
10074 @end smallexample
10075
10076 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
10077 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
10078 strings:
10079
10080 @smallexample
10081 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10082 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
10083 (@value{GDBP})
10084 @end smallexample
10085
10086 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
10087 initial character set:
10088 @smallexample
10089 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
10090 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10091 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
10092 (@value{GDBP})
10093 @end smallexample
10094
10095 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
10096 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
10097 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
10098 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
10099 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
10100
10101 @smallexample
10102 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
10103 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
10104 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
10105 $2 = 72 'H'
10106 (@value{GDBP})
10107 @end smallexample
10108
10109 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
10110 literals you use in expressions:
10111
10112 @smallexample
10113 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
10114 $3 = 43 '+'
10115 (@value{GDBP})
10116 @end smallexample
10117
10118 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
10119 character.
10120
10121 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
10122 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
10123 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
10124
10125 @smallexample
10126 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
10127 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
10128 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
10129 $5 = 200 '\310'
10130 (@value{GDBP})
10131 @end smallexample
10132
10133 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
10134 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
10135
10136 @smallexample
10137 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
10138 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
10139 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
10140 @end smallexample
10141
10142 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
10143 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
10144 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
10145 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
10146 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
10147
10148 @smallexample
10149 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
10150 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10151 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
10152 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
10153 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
10154 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
10155 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
10156 $7 = 72 '\110'
10157 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
10158 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
10159 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
10160 $9 = 200 'H'
10161 (@value{GDBP})
10162 @end smallexample
10163
10164 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
10165 string literals you use in expressions:
10166
10167 @smallexample
10168 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
10169 $10 = 78 '+'
10170 (@value{GDBP})
10171 @end smallexample
10172
10173 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
10174 character.
10175
10176 @node Caching Remote Data
10177 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
10178 @cindex caching data of remote targets
10179
10180 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a
10181 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
10182 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
10183 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately, simply
10184 caching everything would lead to incorrect results, since @value{GDBN}
10185 does not necessarily know anything about volatile values, memory-mapped I/O
10186 addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode})
10187 memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command is executing.
10188 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
10189 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
10190 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
10191 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
10192 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.}.
10193 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
10194 cacheable; see @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
10195
10196 @table @code
10197 @kindex set remotecache
10198 @item set remotecache on
10199 @itemx set remotecache off
10200 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
10201 with old scripts.
10202
10203 @kindex show remotecache
10204 @item show remotecache
10205 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
10206
10207 @kindex set stack-cache
10208 @item set stack-cache on
10209 @itemx set stack-cache off
10210 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{ON}, use
10211 caching. By default, this option is @code{ON}.
10212
10213 @kindex show stack-cache
10214 @item show stack-cache
10215 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
10216
10217 @kindex info dcache
10218 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
10219 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
10220 information displayed includes the dcache width and depth, and for
10221 each cache line, its number, address, and how many times it was
10222 referenced. This command is useful for debugging the data cache
10223 operation.
10224
10225 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
10226 printed in hex.
10227
10228 @item set dcache size @var{size}
10229 @cindex dcache size
10230 @kindex set dcache size
10231 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
10232
10233 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
10234 @cindex dcache line-size
10235 @kindex set dcache line-size
10236 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
10237 Must be a power of 2.
10238
10239 @item show dcache size
10240 @kindex show dcache size
10241 Show maximum number of dcache entries. See also @ref{Caching Remote Data, info dcache}.
10242
10243 @item show dcache line-size
10244 @kindex show dcache line-size
10245 Show default size of dcache lines. See also @ref{Caching Remote Data, info dcache}.
10246
10247 @end table
10248
10249 @node Searching Memory
10250 @section Search Memory
10251 @cindex searching memory
10252
10253 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
10254 @code{find} command.
10255
10256 @table @code
10257 @kindex find
10258 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
10259 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
10260 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
10261 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
10262 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
10263 @end table
10264
10265 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
10266 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
10267
10268 @table @r
10269 @item @var{s}, search query size
10270 The size of each search query value.
10271
10272 @table @code
10273 @item b
10274 bytes
10275 @item h
10276 halfwords (two bytes)
10277 @item w
10278 words (four bytes)
10279 @item g
10280 giant words (eight bytes)
10281 @end table
10282
10283 All values are interpreted in the current language.
10284 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
10285 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
10286
10287 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
10288 value's type in the current language.
10289 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
10290 pattern as a mixture of types.
10291 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
10292 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
10293 which is typically four bytes.
10294
10295 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
10296 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
10297 @end table
10298
10299 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
10300 (@code{"}).
10301 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
10302 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
10303
10304 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
10305 number of matches found.
10306
10307 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
10308 @samp{$_}.
10309 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
10310
10311 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
10312
10313 @smallexample
10314 void
10315 hello ()
10316 @{
10317 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
10318 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
10319 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
10320 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
10321 printf ("%s\n", hello);
10322 @}
10323 @end smallexample
10324
10325 @noindent
10326 you get during debugging:
10327
10328 @smallexample
10329 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
10330 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
10331 1 pattern found
10332 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
10333 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
10334 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
10335 2 patterns found
10336 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
10337 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
10338 1 pattern found
10339 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
10340 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
10341 1 pattern found
10342 (gdb) print $numfound
10343 $1 = 1
10344 (gdb) print $_
10345 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
10346 @end smallexample
10347
10348 @node Optimized Code
10349 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
10350 @cindex optimized code, debugging
10351 @cindex debugging optimized code
10352
10353 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
10354 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
10355 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
10356 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
10357 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
10358 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
10359 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
10360
10361 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
10362 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
10363 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
10364 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
10365
10366 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
10367 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
10368 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
10369 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
10370 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
10371 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
10372
10373 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
10374 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
10375 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
10376 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
10377 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
10378
10379 @menu
10380 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
10381 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
10382 @end menu
10383
10384 @node Inline Functions
10385 @section Inline Functions
10386 @cindex inline functions, debugging
10387
10388 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
10389 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
10390 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
10391 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
10392 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
10393 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
10394 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
10395 @code{info frame} command.
10396
10397 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
10398 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
10399 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
10400 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
10401 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
10402 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
10403 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
10404 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
10405 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
10406 local variables in the caller.
10407
10408 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
10409 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
10410 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
10411 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
10412 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
10413 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
10414 instructions are executed.
10415
10416 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
10417 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
10418 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
10419 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
10420
10421 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
10422 function calls are the same as normal calls:
10423
10424 @itemize @bullet
10425 @item
10426 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
10427 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
10428 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
10429 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
10430 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
10431 or inside the inlined function instead.
10432
10433 @item
10434 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
10435 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
10436 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
10437 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
10438
10439 @end itemize
10440
10441 @node Tail Call Frames
10442 @section Tail Call Frames
10443 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
10444
10445 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
10446 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
10447 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
10448 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
10449 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
10450
10451 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
10452 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
10453 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
10454 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
10455 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
10456 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
10457 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
10458
10459 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
10460 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
10461 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
10462 this information.
10463
10464 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
10465 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
10466
10467 @smallexample
10468 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
10469 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
10470 (gdb) info frame
10471 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
10472 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
10473 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
10474 source language c++.
10475 Arglist at unknown address.
10476 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
10477 @end smallexample
10478
10479 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
10480 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
10481 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
10482 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
10483 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
10484 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
10485
10486 @table @code
10487 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
10488 @item set debug entry-values
10489 @kindex set debug entry-values
10490 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
10491 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
10492 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
10493 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
10494 result.
10495
10496 @item show debug entry-values
10497 @kindex show debug entry-values
10498 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
10499 values at function entry and tail calls.
10500 @end table
10501
10502 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
10503 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
10504 reference by variable @code{x}):
10505
10506 @smallexample
10507 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
10508 void (*x) (void) = c;
10509 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
10510 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
10511 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
10512
10513 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
10514 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
10515 a () at t.c:3
10516 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
10517 (gdb) bt
10518 #0 a () at t.c:3
10519 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
10520 @end smallexample
10521
10522 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
10523
10524 @smallexample
10525 int i;
10526 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
10527 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
10528 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
10529 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
10530 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
10531 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
10532 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
10533 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
10534
10535 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
10536 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
10537 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
10538 (gdb) bt
10539 #0 f () at t.c:2
10540 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
10541 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
10542 @end smallexample
10543
10544 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
10545 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
10546
10547 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
10548 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
10549 @set ARROW @click{}
10550 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
10551 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
10552 @end ifset
10553 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
10554 @set ARROW ->
10555 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
10556 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
10557 @end ifclear
10558
10559 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
10560 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
10561 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
10562
10563 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
10564 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
10565 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
10566 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
10567 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
10568 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
10569
10570 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
10571 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
10572 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
10573 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
10574 omitted.
10575
10576 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
10577 entry may fail:
10578
10579 @smallexample
10580 int v;
10581 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
10582 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
10583 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
10584 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
10585 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
10586 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
10587
10588 (gdb) bt
10589 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
10590 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
10591 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
10592 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
10593 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
10594 @end smallexample
10595
10596 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
10597 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
10598 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
10599 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
10600 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
10601
10602 @node Macros
10603 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
10604
10605 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
10606 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
10607 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
10608 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
10609 where it was defined.
10610
10611 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
10612 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
10613 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
10614 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
10615
10616 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
10617 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
10618 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
10619 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
10620 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
10621 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
10622 see @ref{List}.
10623
10624 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
10625 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
10626 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
10627
10628 @table @code
10629
10630 @kindex macro expand
10631 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
10632 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
10633 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
10634 @item macro expand @var{expression}
10635 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
10636 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
10637 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
10638 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
10639 it can be any string of tokens.
10640
10641 @kindex macro exp1
10642 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
10643 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
10644 @cindex expand macro once
10645 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
10646 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
10647 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
10648 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
10649 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
10650 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
10651 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
10652 can be any string of tokens.
10653
10654 @kindex info macro
10655 @cindex macro definition, showing
10656 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
10657 @cindex macros, from debug info
10658 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
10659 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
10660 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
10661 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
10662 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
10663 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
10664
10665 @kindex info macros
10666 @item info macros @var{linespec}
10667 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
10668 by @var{linespec}, and describe the source location or compiler
10669 command-line where those definitions were established.
10670
10671 @kindex macro define
10672 @cindex user-defined macros
10673 @cindex defining macros interactively
10674 @cindex macros, user-defined
10675 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
10676 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
10677 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
10678 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
10679 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
10680 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
10681 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
10682 @var{arglist}.
10683
10684 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
10685 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
10686 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
10687 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
10688 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
10689
10690 @kindex macro undef
10691 @item macro undef @var{macro}
10692 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
10693 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
10694 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
10695 in the program being debugged.
10696
10697 @kindex macro list
10698 @item macro list
10699 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
10700 @end table
10701
10702 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
10703 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
10704 show our source files:
10705
10706 @smallexample
10707 $ cat sample.c
10708 #include <stdio.h>
10709 #include "sample.h"
10710
10711 #define M 42
10712 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
10713
10714 main ()
10715 @{
10716 #define N 28
10717 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
10718 #undef N
10719 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
10720 #define N 1729
10721 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
10722 @}
10723 $ cat sample.h
10724 #define Q <
10725 $
10726 @end smallexample
10727
10728 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
10729 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
10730 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
10731 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
10732 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
10733 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
10734 information.
10735
10736 @smallexample
10737 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
10738 $
10739 @end smallexample
10740
10741 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
10742
10743 @smallexample
10744 $ gdb -nw sample
10745 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
10746 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
10747 GDB is free software, @dots{}
10748 (@value{GDBP})
10749 @end smallexample
10750
10751 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
10752 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
10753 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
10754
10755 @smallexample
10756 (@value{GDBP}) list main
10757 3
10758 4 #define M 42
10759 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
10760 6
10761 7 main ()
10762 8 @{
10763 9 #define N 28
10764 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
10765 11 #undef N
10766 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
10767 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
10768 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
10769 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
10770 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
10771 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
10772 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
10773 #define Q <
10774 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
10775 expands to: (42 + 1)
10776 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
10777 expands to: once (M + 1)
10778 (@value{GDBP})
10779 @end smallexample
10780
10781 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
10782 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
10783 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
10784 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
10785
10786 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
10787 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
10788
10789 @smallexample
10790 (@value{GDBP}) break main
10791 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
10792 (@value{GDBP}) run
10793 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
10794
10795 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
10796 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
10797 (@value{GDBP})
10798 @end smallexample
10799
10800 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
10801
10802 @smallexample
10803 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
10804 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
10805 #define N 28
10806 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
10807 expands to: 28 < 42
10808 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
10809 $1 = 1
10810 (@value{GDBP})
10811 @end smallexample
10812
10813 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
10814 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
10815 thereof) in force at each point:
10816
10817 @smallexample
10818 (@value{GDBP}) next
10819 Hello, world!
10820 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
10821 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
10822 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
10823 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
10824 (@value{GDBP}) next
10825 We're so creative.
10826 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
10827 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
10828 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
10829 #define N 1729
10830 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
10831 expands to: 1729 < 42
10832 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
10833 $2 = 0
10834 (@value{GDBP})
10835 @end smallexample
10836
10837 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
10838 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
10839 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
10840 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
10841
10842 @smallexample
10843 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
10844 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
10845 -D__STDC__=1
10846 (@value{GDBP})
10847 @end smallexample
10848
10849
10850 @node Tracepoints
10851 @chapter Tracepoints
10852 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
10853 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
10854
10855 @cindex tracepoints
10856 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
10857 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
10858 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
10859 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
10860 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
10861 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
10862 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
10863
10864 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
10865 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
10866 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
10867 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
10868 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
10869 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
10870 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
10871 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
10872 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
10873 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
10874 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
10875
10876 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
10877 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
10878 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
10879 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
10880 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
10881 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
10882 Packets}.
10883
10884 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
10885 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
10886 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
10887
10888 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
10889
10890 @menu
10891 * Set Tracepoints::
10892 * Analyze Collected Data::
10893 * Tracepoint Variables::
10894 * Trace Files::
10895 @end menu
10896
10897 @node Set Tracepoints
10898 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
10899
10900 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
10901 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
10902 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
10903 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
10904 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
10905 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
10906 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
10907
10908 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
10909 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
10910 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
10911 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
10912 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
10913 tracepoint was hit.
10914
10915 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
10916 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
10917 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
10918 either.
10919
10920 @cindex fast tracepoints
10921 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
10922 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
10923 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
10924
10925 @cindex static tracepoints
10926 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
10927 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
10928 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
10929 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
10930 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
10931 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
10932 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
10933 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
10934 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
10935 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
10936 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
10937 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
10938 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
10939 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
10940 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
10941 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
10942 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
10943 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
10944 static tracepoint marker.
10945
10946 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
10947 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
10948
10949 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
10950 conditions and actions.
10951
10952 @menu
10953 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
10954 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
10955 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
10956 * Tracepoint Conditions::
10957 * Trace State Variables::
10958 * Tracepoint Actions::
10959 * Listing Tracepoints::
10960 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
10961 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
10962 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
10963 @end menu
10964
10965 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
10966 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
10967
10968 @table @code
10969 @cindex set tracepoint
10970 @kindex trace
10971 @item trace @var{location}
10972 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
10973 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
10974 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
10975 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
10976 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
10977 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
10978 changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
10979 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
10980 in tracing}).
10981 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
10982 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
10983 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
10984 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
10985 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
10986 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
10987 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
10988 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
10989 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
10990 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
10991 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
10992 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
10993
10994 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
10995
10996 @smallexample
10997 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
10998
10999 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
11000
11001 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
11002
11003 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
11004
11005 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
11006 @end smallexample
11007
11008 @noindent
11009 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
11010
11011 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
11012 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
11013 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
11014 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
11015 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
11016 information on tracepoint conditions.
11017
11018 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
11019 @cindex set fast tracepoint
11020 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
11021 @kindex ftrace
11022 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
11023 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
11024 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
11025 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
11026 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
11027 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
11028 message.
11029
11030 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
11031 @code{trace}.
11032
11033 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
11034 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
11035 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
11036 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
11037 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
11038 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
11039 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
11040 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
11041
11042 @example
11043 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
11044 @end example
11045
11046 @noindent
11047 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
11048 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
11049
11050 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
11051 @cindex set static tracepoint
11052 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
11053 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
11054 @kindex strace
11055 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
11056 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
11057 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
11058 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
11059 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
11060
11061 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
11062 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
11063 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
11064 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
11065 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
11066 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
11067 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
11068 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
11069 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
11070 tracing engine:
11071
11072 @smallexample
11073 main ()
11074 @{
11075 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
11076 @}
11077 @end smallexample
11078
11079 @noindent
11080 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
11081 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
11082
11083 @smallexample
11084 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
11085 Cnt Enb ID Address What
11086 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
11087 Data: "str %s"
11088 [etc...]
11089 @end smallexample
11090
11091 @noindent
11092 so you may probe the marker above with:
11093
11094 @smallexample
11095 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
11096 @end smallexample
11097
11098 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
11099 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
11100 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
11101 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
11102 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
11103 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
11104 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
11105 the @samp{Data:} field.
11106
11107 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
11108 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
11109 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
11110
11111 @vindex $tpnum
11112 @cindex last tracepoint number
11113 @cindex recent tracepoint number
11114 @cindex tracepoint number
11115 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
11116 of the most recently set tracepoint.
11117
11118 @kindex delete tracepoint
11119 @cindex tracepoint deletion
11120 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11121 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
11122 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
11123 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
11124
11125 Examples:
11126
11127 @smallexample
11128 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
11129
11130 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
11131 @end smallexample
11132
11133 @noindent
11134 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
11135 @end table
11136
11137 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
11138 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
11139
11140 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
11141
11142 @table @code
11143 @kindex disable tracepoint
11144 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11145 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
11146 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
11147 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
11148 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
11149 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
11150 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
11151 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
11152 next trace experiment.
11153
11154 @kindex enable tracepoint
11155 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11156 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
11157 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
11158 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
11159 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
11160 next time a trace experiment is run.
11161 @end table
11162
11163 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
11164 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
11165
11166 @table @code
11167 @kindex passcount
11168 @cindex tracepoint pass count
11169 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
11170 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
11171 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
11172 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
11173 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
11174 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
11175 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
11176 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
11177 user.
11178
11179 Examples:
11180
11181 @smallexample
11182 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
11183 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
11184
11185 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
11186 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
11187 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
11188 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
11189 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
11190 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
11191 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
11192 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
11193 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
11194 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
11195 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
11196 @end smallexample
11197 @end table
11198
11199 @node Tracepoint Conditions
11200 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
11201 @cindex conditional tracepoints
11202 @cindex tracepoint conditions
11203
11204 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
11205 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
11206 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
11207 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
11208 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
11209 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
11210 is true.
11211
11212 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
11213 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
11214 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
11215 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
11216 just as with breakpoints.
11217
11218 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
11219 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
11220 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
11221 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
11222 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
11223 accesses, and so forth.
11224
11225 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
11226 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
11227 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
11228 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
11229 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
11230 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
11231 search through.
11232
11233 @smallexample
11234 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
11235 @end smallexample
11236
11237 @node Trace State Variables
11238 @subsection Trace State Variables
11239 @cindex trace state variables
11240
11241 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
11242 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
11243 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
11244 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
11245 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
11246 integers.
11247
11248 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
11249 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
11250 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
11251 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
11252
11253 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
11254 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
11255 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
11256 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
11257 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
11258 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
11259 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
11260 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
11261 variable with the same name.
11262
11263 @table @code
11264
11265 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
11266 @kindex tvariable
11267 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
11268 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
11269 @var{expression}. @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
11270 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
11271 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
11272 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
11273 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
11274 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
11275 value. The default initial value is 0.
11276
11277 @item info tvariables
11278 @kindex info tvariables
11279 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
11280 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
11281 currently running.
11282
11283 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
11284 @kindex delete tvariable
11285 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
11286 are specified.
11287
11288 @end table
11289
11290 @node Tracepoint Actions
11291 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
11292
11293 @table @code
11294 @kindex actions
11295 @cindex tracepoint actions
11296 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11297 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
11298 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
11299 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
11300 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
11301 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
11302 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
11303 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
11304 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
11305 @code{while-stepping}.
11306
11307 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
11308 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
11309 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
11310
11311 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
11312 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
11313 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
11314
11315 @smallexample
11316 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
11317
11318 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
11319
11320 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
11321 @end smallexample
11322
11323 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
11324 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
11325 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
11326 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
11327 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
11328 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
11329 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
11330 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
11331
11332 @smallexample
11333 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
11334 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
11335 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
11336 > collect bar,baz
11337 > collect $regs
11338 > while-stepping 12
11339 > collect $pc, arr[i]
11340 > end
11341 end
11342 @end smallexample
11343
11344 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
11345 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
11346 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
11347 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
11348 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
11349 special arguments are supported:
11350
11351 @table @code
11352 @item $regs
11353 Collect all registers.
11354
11355 @item $args
11356 Collect all function arguments.
11357
11358 @item $locals
11359 Collect all local variables.
11360
11361 @item $_ret
11362 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
11363 of a backtrace.
11364
11365 @item $_probe_argc
11366 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
11367 tracepoint is located.
11368 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
11369
11370 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
11371 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
11372 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
11373 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
11374
11375 @item $_sdata
11376 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
11377 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
11378 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
11379 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
11380 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
11381 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
11382 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
11383 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
11384 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
11385
11386 @smallexample
11387 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
11388 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
11389 @end smallexample
11390
11391 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
11392 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
11393 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
11394 @value{GDBN}.
11395 @end table
11396
11397 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
11398 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
11399 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
11400
11401 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
11402 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
11403 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
11404 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
11405 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
11406 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
11407 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
11408 @samp{mystr}.
11409
11410 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
11411 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
11412
11413 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
11414 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
11415 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
11416 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
11417 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
11418 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
11419 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
11420 action were used.
11421
11422 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
11423 @item while-stepping @var{n}
11424 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
11425 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
11426 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
11427 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
11428
11429 @smallexample
11430 > while-stepping 12
11431 > collect $regs, myglobal
11432 > end
11433 >
11434 @end smallexample
11435
11436 @noindent
11437 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
11438 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
11439 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
11440 @code{stepping}.
11441
11442 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
11443 @kindex set default-collect
11444 @cindex default collection action
11445 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
11446 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
11447 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
11448 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
11449 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
11450 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
11451
11452 @item show default-collect
11453 @kindex show default-collect
11454 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
11455 tracepoint hit.
11456
11457 @end table
11458
11459 @node Listing Tracepoints
11460 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
11461
11462 @table @code
11463 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
11464 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
11465 @cindex information about tracepoints
11466 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
11467 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
11468 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
11469 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
11470 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
11471 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
11472
11473 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
11474 tracing:
11475
11476 @itemize @bullet
11477 @item
11478 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
11479 @end itemize
11480
11481 @smallexample
11482 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
11483 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
11484 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
11485 while-stepping 20
11486 collect globfoo, $regs
11487 end
11488 collect globfoo2
11489 end
11490 pass count 1200
11491 (@value{GDBP})
11492 @end smallexample
11493
11494 @noindent
11495 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
11496 @end table
11497
11498 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
11499 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
11500
11501 @table @code
11502 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
11503 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
11504 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
11505 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
11506 program.
11507
11508 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
11509
11510 @table @emph
11511 @item Count
11512 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
11513 stable identifier.
11514 @item ID
11515 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
11516 @item Enabled or Disabled
11517 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
11518 that are not enabled.
11519 @item Address
11520 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
11521 @item What
11522 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
11523 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
11524 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
11525 will be left blank.
11526 @end table
11527
11528 @noindent
11529 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
11530
11531 @table @emph
11532 @item Data
11533 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
11534 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
11535 marker call.
11536 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
11537 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
11538 @end table
11539
11540 @smallexample
11541 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
11542 Cnt ID Enb Address What
11543 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
11544 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
11545 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
11546 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
11547 Data: str %s
11548 (@value{GDBP})
11549 @end smallexample
11550 @end table
11551
11552 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
11553 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
11554
11555 @table @code
11556 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
11557 @cindex start a new trace experiment
11558 @cindex collected data discarded
11559 @item tstart
11560 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
11561 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
11562 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
11563 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
11564 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
11565 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
11566 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
11567 information, and so forth.
11568
11569 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
11570 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
11571 @item tstop
11572 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
11573 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
11574 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
11575 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
11576 needs to be stopped quickly.
11577
11578 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
11579 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
11580 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
11581
11582 @kindex tstatus
11583 @cindex status of trace data collection
11584 @cindex trace experiment, status of
11585 @item tstatus
11586 This command displays the status of the current trace data
11587 collection.
11588 @end table
11589
11590 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
11591
11592 @smallexample
11593 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
11594 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
11595 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
11596 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
11597 > while-stepping 11
11598 > collect $regs
11599 > end
11600 > end
11601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
11602 [time passes @dots{}]
11603 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
11604 @end smallexample
11605
11606 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
11607 @cindex disconnected tracing
11608 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
11609 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
11610 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
11611 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
11612 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
11613 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
11614 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
11615 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
11616
11617 @table @code
11618 @item set disconnected-tracing on
11619 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
11620 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
11621 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
11622 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
11623 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
11624 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
11625 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
11626
11627 @item show disconnected-tracing
11628 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
11629 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
11630
11631 @end table
11632
11633 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
11634 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
11635 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
11636 it will continue after reconnection.
11637
11638 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
11639 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
11640 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
11641 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
11642 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
11643 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
11644 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
11645 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
11646 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
11647 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
11648
11649 @cindex circular trace buffer
11650 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
11651 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
11652 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
11653 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
11654 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
11655 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
11656 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
11657 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
11658 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
11659 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
11660 the next run.
11661
11662 @table @code
11663 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
11664 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
11665 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
11666 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
11667 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
11668 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
11669 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
11670
11671 @item show circular-trace-buffer
11672 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
11673 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
11674 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
11675 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
11676 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
11677
11678 @end table
11679
11680 @table @code
11681 @item set trace-user @var{text}
11682 @kindex set trace-user
11683
11684 @item show trace-user
11685 @kindex show trace-user
11686
11687 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
11688 @kindex set trace-notes
11689 Set the trace run's notes.
11690
11691 @item show trace-notes
11692 @kindex show trace-notes
11693 Show the trace run's notes.
11694
11695 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
11696 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
11697 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
11698 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
11699 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
11700
11701 @item show trace-stop-notes
11702 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
11703 Show the trace run's stop notes.
11704
11705 @end table
11706
11707 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
11708 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
11709
11710 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
11711 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
11712 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
11713 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
11714 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
11715 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
11716 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
11717 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
11718 mentioned here.
11719
11720 @itemize @bullet
11721
11722 @item
11723 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
11724 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
11725 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
11726 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
11727 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
11728 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
11729 cannot be collected either.
11730
11731 @item
11732 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
11733 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
11734 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
11735 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
11736 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
11737 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
11738 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
11739 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
11740 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
11741 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
11742
11743 @item
11744 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
11745 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
11746 in a misleading way.
11747
11748 @item
11749 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
11750 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
11751 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
11752 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
11753 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
11754 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
11755 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
11756 by @code{ptr}.
11757
11758 @item
11759 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
11760 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
11761 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
11762 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
11763 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
11764 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
11765 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
11766 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
11767 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
11768 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
11769 invalid address.
11770
11771 @item
11772 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
11773 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
11774 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
11775 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
11776 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
11777 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
11778 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
11779 it to zero.
11780
11781 @end itemize
11782
11783 @node Analyze Collected Data
11784 @section Using the Collected Data
11785
11786 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
11787 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
11788 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
11789 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
11790 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
11791 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
11792 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
11793 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
11794 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
11795 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
11796 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
11797 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
11798 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
11799 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
11800 the buffer will fail.
11801
11802 @menu
11803 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
11804 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
11805 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
11806 @end menu
11807
11808 @node tfind
11809 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
11810
11811 @kindex tfind
11812 @cindex select trace snapshot
11813 @cindex find trace snapshot
11814 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
11815 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
11816 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
11817 snapshot is selected.
11818
11819 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
11820
11821 @table @code
11822 @item tfind start
11823 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
11824 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
11825
11826 @item tfind none
11827 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
11828
11829 @item tfind end
11830 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
11831
11832 @item tfind
11833 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
11834
11835 @item tfind -
11836 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
11837 retracing earlier steps.
11838
11839 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
11840 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
11841 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
11842 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
11843 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
11844
11845 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
11846 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
11847 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
11848 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
11849 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
11850
11851 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
11852 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
11853 addresses (exclusive).
11854
11855 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
11856 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
11857 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
11858
11859 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
11860 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
11861 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
11862 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
11863 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
11864 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
11865 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
11866 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
11867 @end table
11868
11869 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
11870 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
11871 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
11872 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
11873 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
11874 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
11875 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
11876 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
11877 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
11878 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
11879 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
11880 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
11881 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
11882 tracepoint as the current one.
11883
11884 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
11885 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
11886 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
11887 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
11888 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
11889
11890 @smallexample
11891 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
11892 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
11893 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
11894 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
11895 > tfind
11896 > end
11897
11898 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
11899 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
11900 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
11901 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
11902 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
11903 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
11904 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
11905 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
11906 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
11907 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
11908 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
11909 @end smallexample
11910
11911 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
11912 the buffer:
11913
11914 @smallexample
11915 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
11916 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
11917 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
11918 > tfind line
11919 > end
11920
11921 Frame 0, X = 1
11922 Frame 7, X = 2
11923 Frame 13, X = 255
11924 @end smallexample
11925
11926 @node tdump
11927 @subsection @code{tdump}
11928 @kindex tdump
11929 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
11930 @cindex tracepoint data, display
11931
11932 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
11933 the current trace snapshot.
11934
11935 @smallexample
11936 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
11937 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
11938 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
11939 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
11940 > end
11941
11942 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
11943
11944 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
11945 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
11946 at gdb_test.c:444
11947 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
11948
11949 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
11950 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
11951 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
11952 d1 0x18 24
11953 d2 0x80 128
11954 d3 0x33 51
11955 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
11956 d5 0x22 34
11957 d6 0xe0 224
11958 d7 0x380035 3670069
11959 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
11960 a1 0x3000668 50333288
11961 a2 0x100 256
11962 a3 0x322000 3284992
11963 a4 0x3000698 50333336
11964 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
11965 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
11966 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
11967 ps 0x0 0
11968 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
11969 fpcontrol 0x0 0
11970 fpstatus 0x0 0
11971 fpiaddr 0x0 0
11972 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
11973 p1 = (void *) 0x11
11974 p2 = (void *) 0x22
11975 p3 = (void *) 0x33
11976 p4 = (void *) 0x44
11977 p5 = (void *) 0x55
11978 p6 = (void *) 0x66
11979 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
11980
11981 (@value{GDBP})
11982 @end smallexample
11983
11984 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
11985 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
11986 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
11987 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
11988
11989 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
11990 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
11991 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
11992 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
11993 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
11994 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
11995 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
11996 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
11997 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
11998 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
11999
12000 @node save tracepoints
12001 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
12002 @kindex save tracepoints
12003 @kindex save-tracepoints
12004 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
12005
12006 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
12007 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
12008 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
12009 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
12010 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
12011 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
12012
12013 @node Tracepoint Variables
12014 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
12015 @cindex tracepoint variables
12016 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
12017
12018 @table @code
12019 @vindex $trace_frame
12020 @item (int) $trace_frame
12021 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
12022 snapshot is selected.
12023
12024 @vindex $tracepoint
12025 @item (int) $tracepoint
12026 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
12027
12028 @vindex $trace_line
12029 @item (int) $trace_line
12030 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
12031
12032 @vindex $trace_file
12033 @item (char []) $trace_file
12034 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
12035
12036 @vindex $trace_func
12037 @item (char []) $trace_func
12038 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
12039 @end table
12040
12041 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
12042 use @code{output} instead.
12043
12044 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
12045 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
12046 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
12047 which are managed by the target.
12048
12049 @smallexample
12050 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12051
12052 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
12053 > output $trace_file
12054 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
12055 > tfind
12056 > end
12057 @end smallexample
12058
12059 @node Trace Files
12060 @section Using Trace Files
12061 @cindex trace files
12062
12063 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
12064 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
12065 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
12066 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
12067 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
12068
12069 @table @code
12070
12071 @kindex tsave
12072 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
12073 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
12074 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
12075 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
12076 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
12077 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
12078 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
12079 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
12080 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
12081
12082 @kindex target tfile
12083 @kindex tfile
12084 @item target tfile @var{filename}
12085 Use the file named @var{filename} as a source of trace data. Commands
12086 that examine data work as they do with a live target, but it is not
12087 possible to run any new trace experiments. @code{tstatus} will report
12088 the state of the trace run at the moment the data was saved, as well
12089 as the current trace frame you are examining. @var{filename} must be
12090 on a filesystem accessible to the host.
12091
12092 @end table
12093
12094 @node Overlays
12095 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
12096 @cindex overlays
12097
12098 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
12099 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
12100 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
12101 use overlays.
12102
12103 @menu
12104 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
12105 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
12106 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
12107 mapped by asking the inferior.
12108 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
12109 @end menu
12110
12111 @node How Overlays Work
12112 @section How Overlays Work
12113 @cindex mapped overlays
12114 @cindex unmapped overlays
12115 @cindex load address, overlay's
12116 @cindex mapped address
12117 @cindex overlay area
12118
12119 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
12120 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
12121 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
12122 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
12123 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
12124
12125 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
12126 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
12127 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
12128 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
12129 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
12130 largest overlay as well.
12131
12132 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
12133 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
12134 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
12135 there.
12136
12137 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
12138 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
12139 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
12140
12141 @smallexample
12142 @group
12143 Data Instruction Larger
12144 Address Space Address Space Address Space
12145 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
12146 | | | | | |
12147 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
12148 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
12149 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
12150 | and heap | | | | | |
12151 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
12152 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
12153 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
12154 | | | | | |
12155 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
12156 address | | | | | |
12157 | overlay | <-' | | |
12158 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
12159 | | <---. | | load address
12160 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
12161 | | | |
12162 +-----------+ | |
12163 +-----------+
12164 | |
12165 +-----------+
12166
12167 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
12168 @end group
12169 @end smallexample
12170
12171 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
12172 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
12173 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
12174 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
12175 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
12176 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
12177 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
12178 program and the overlay area.
12179
12180 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
12181 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
12182 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
12183 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
12184 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
12185 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
12186 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
12187
12188 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
12189 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
12190 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
12191
12192 @itemize @bullet
12193
12194 @item
12195 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
12196 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
12197 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
12198 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
12199
12200 @item
12201 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
12202 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
12203 your program's performance.
12204
12205 @item
12206 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
12207 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
12208 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
12209 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
12210 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
12211 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
12212 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
12213
12214 @item
12215 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
12216 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
12217 instruction and data spaces.
12218
12219 @end itemize
12220
12221 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
12222 improved in many ways:
12223
12224 @itemize @bullet
12225
12226 @item
12227 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
12228 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
12229 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
12230 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
12231 area in the usual way.
12232
12233 @item
12234 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
12235 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
12236
12237 @item
12238 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
12239 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
12240 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
12241 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
12242 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
12243 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
12244 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
12245
12246 @end itemize
12247
12248
12249 @node Overlay Commands
12250 @section Overlay Commands
12251
12252 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
12253 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
12254 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
12255 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
12256 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
12257 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
12258
12259 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
12260 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
12261
12262 @table @code
12263 @item overlay off
12264 @kindex overlay
12265 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
12266 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
12267 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
12268 overlay support is disabled.
12269
12270 @item overlay manual
12271 @cindex manual overlay debugging
12272 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
12273 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
12274 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
12275 commands described below.
12276
12277 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
12278 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
12279 @cindex map an overlay
12280 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
12281 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
12282 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
12283 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
12284 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
12285 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
12286
12287 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
12288 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
12289 @cindex unmap an overlay
12290 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
12291 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
12292 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
12293 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
12294
12295 @item overlay auto
12296 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
12297 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
12298 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
12299 Overlay Debugging}.
12300
12301 @item overlay load-target
12302 @itemx overlay load
12303 @cindex reloading the overlay table
12304 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
12305 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
12306 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
12307 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
12308 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
12309
12310 @item overlay list-overlays
12311 @itemx overlay list
12312 @cindex listing mapped overlays
12313 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
12314 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
12315
12316 @end table
12317
12318 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
12319 of the function the address falls in:
12320
12321 @smallexample
12322 (@value{GDBP}) print main
12323 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
12324 @end smallexample
12325 @noindent
12326 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
12327 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
12328 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
12329 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
12330
12331 @smallexample
12332 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
12333 No sections are mapped.
12334 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
12335 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
12336 @end smallexample
12337 @noindent
12338 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
12339 name normally:
12340
12341 @smallexample
12342 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
12343 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
12344 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
12345 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
12346 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
12347 @end smallexample
12348
12349 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
12350 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
12351 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
12352 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
12353 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
12354
12355 @itemize @bullet
12356 @item
12357 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
12358 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
12359 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
12360 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
12361 @item
12362 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
12363 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
12364 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
12365 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
12366 breakpoints properly.
12367 @end itemize
12368
12369
12370 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
12371 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
12372 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
12373
12374 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
12375 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
12376 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
12377 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
12378 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
12379 current state of the overlays.
12380
12381 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
12382 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
12383
12384 @table @asis
12385
12386 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
12387 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
12388
12389 @smallexample
12390 struct
12391 @{
12392 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
12393 unsigned long vma;
12394
12395 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
12396 unsigned long size;
12397
12398 /* The overlay's load address. */
12399 unsigned long lma;
12400
12401 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
12402 zero otherwise. */
12403 unsigned long mapped;
12404 @}
12405 @end smallexample
12406
12407 @item @code{_novlys}:
12408 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
12409 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
12410
12411 @end table
12412
12413 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
12414 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
12415 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
12416 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
12417 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
12418 currently mapped.
12419
12420 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
12421 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
12422 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
12423 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
12424 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
12425 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
12426 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
12427 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
12428 are not being executed.
12429
12430 @node Overlay Sample Program
12431 @section Overlay Sample Program
12432 @cindex overlay example program
12433
12434 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
12435 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
12436 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
12437 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
12438 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
12439 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
12440 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
12441
12442 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
12443 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
12444 suite. The program consists of the following files from
12445 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
12446
12447 @table @file
12448 @item overlays.c
12449 The main program file.
12450 @item ovlymgr.c
12451 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
12452 @item foo.c
12453 @itemx bar.c
12454 @itemx baz.c
12455 @itemx grbx.c
12456 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
12457 @item d10v.ld
12458 @itemx m32r.ld
12459 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
12460 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
12461 @end table
12462
12463 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
12464 cross-compiler like this:
12465
12466 @smallexample
12467 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
12468 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
12469 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
12470 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
12471 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
12472 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
12473 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
12474 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
12475 @end smallexample
12476
12477 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
12478 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
12479 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
12480
12481
12482 @node Languages
12483 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
12484 @cindex languages
12485
12486 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
12487 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
12488 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
12489 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
12490 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
12491 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
12492
12493 @cindex working language
12494 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
12495 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
12496 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
12497 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
12498 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
12499 language}.
12500
12501 @menu
12502 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
12503 * Show:: Displaying the language
12504 * Checks:: Type and range checks
12505 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
12506 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
12507 @end menu
12508
12509 @node Setting
12510 @section Switching Between Source Languages
12511
12512 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
12513 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
12514 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
12515 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
12516 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
12517 are printed, etc.
12518
12519 In addition to the working language, every source file that
12520 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
12521 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
12522 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
12523 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
12524 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
12525 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
12526 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
12527 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
12528 Displaying the Language}.
12529
12530 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
12531 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
12532 another language. In that case, make the
12533 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
12534 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
12535 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
12536
12537 @menu
12538 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
12539 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
12540 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
12541 @end menu
12542
12543 @node Filenames
12544 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
12545
12546 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
12547 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
12548
12549 @table @file
12550 @item .ada
12551 @itemx .ads
12552 @itemx .adb
12553 @itemx .a
12554 Ada source file.
12555
12556 @item .c
12557 C source file
12558
12559 @item .C
12560 @itemx .cc
12561 @itemx .cp
12562 @itemx .cpp
12563 @itemx .cxx
12564 @itemx .c++
12565 C@t{++} source file
12566
12567 @item .d
12568 D source file
12569
12570 @item .m
12571 Objective-C source file
12572
12573 @item .f
12574 @itemx .F
12575 Fortran source file
12576
12577 @item .mod
12578 Modula-2 source file
12579
12580 @item .s
12581 @itemx .S
12582 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
12583 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
12584 @end table
12585
12586 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
12587 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
12588
12589 @node Manually
12590 @subsection Setting the Working Language
12591
12592 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
12593 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
12594 your program.
12595
12596 @kindex set language
12597 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
12598 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
12599 a language, such as
12600 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
12601 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
12602
12603 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
12604 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
12605 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
12606 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
12607 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
12608 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
12609 command such as:
12610
12611 @smallexample
12612 print a = b + c
12613 @end smallexample
12614
12615 @noindent
12616 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
12617 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
12618 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
12619 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
12620
12621 @node Automatically
12622 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
12623
12624 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
12625 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
12626 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
12627 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
12628 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
12629 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
12630 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
12631 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
12632 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
12633
12634 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
12635 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
12636 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
12637 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
12638 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
12639
12640 @node Show
12641 @section Displaying the Language
12642
12643 The following commands help you find out which language is the
12644 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
12645
12646 @table @code
12647 @item show language
12648 @kindex show language
12649 Display the current working language. This is the
12650 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
12651 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
12652
12653 @item info frame
12654 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
12655 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
12656 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
12657 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
12658 information listed here.
12659
12660 @item info source
12661 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
12662 Display the source language of this source file.
12663 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
12664 information listed here.
12665 @end table
12666
12667 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
12668 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
12669 with a language explicitly:
12670
12671 @table @code
12672 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
12673 @kindex set extension-language
12674 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
12675 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
12676
12677 @item info extensions
12678 @kindex info extensions
12679 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
12680 @end table
12681
12682 @node Checks
12683 @section Type and Range Checking
12684
12685 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
12686 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
12687 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
12688 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
12689 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
12690 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
12691 errors when your program is running.
12692
12693 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
12694 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
12695 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
12696 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
12697
12698 @menu
12699 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
12700 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
12701 @end menu
12702
12703 @cindex type checking
12704 @cindex checks, type
12705 @node Type Checking
12706 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
12707
12708 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
12709 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
12710 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
12711 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
12712
12713 @smallexample
12714 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
12715
12716 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
12717 $1 = 2
12718 @exdent but
12719 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
12720 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
12721 @end smallexample
12722
12723 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
12724 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
12725
12726 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
12727 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
12728 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
12729 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
12730 expressions like the second example above.
12731
12732 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
12733 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
12734 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
12735 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
12736 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
12737 little sense to evaluate anyway.
12738
12739 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
12740
12741 @kindex set check type
12742 @kindex show check type
12743 @table @code
12744 @item set check type on
12745 @itemx set check type off
12746 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
12747 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
12748 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
12749
12750 @item show check type
12751 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
12752 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
12753 @end table
12754
12755 @cindex range checking
12756 @cindex checks, range
12757 @node Range Checking
12758 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
12759
12760 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
12761 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
12762 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
12763 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
12764 not exceed the bounds of the array.
12765
12766 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
12767 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
12768 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
12769 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
12770
12771 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
12772 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
12773 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
12774 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
12775 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
12776 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
12777
12778 @smallexample
12779 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
12780 @end smallexample
12781
12782 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
12783 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
12784 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
12785
12786 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
12787
12788 @kindex set check range
12789 @kindex show check range
12790 @table @code
12791 @item set check range auto
12792 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
12793 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
12794 each language.
12795
12796 @item set check range on
12797 @itemx set check range off
12798 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
12799 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
12800 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
12801 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
12802
12803 @item set check range warn
12804 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
12805 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
12806 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
12807 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
12808 systems).
12809
12810 @item show range
12811 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
12812 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
12813 @end table
12814
12815 @node Supported Languages
12816 @section Supported Languages
12817
12818 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
12819 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
12820 @c This is false ...
12821 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
12822 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
12823 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
12824 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
12825 language.
12826
12827 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
12828 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
12829 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
12830 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
12831 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
12832 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
12833 language reference or tutorial.
12834
12835 @menu
12836 * C:: C and C@t{++}
12837 * D:: D
12838 * Go:: Go
12839 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
12840 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
12841 * Fortran:: Fortran
12842 * Pascal:: Pascal
12843 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
12844 * Ada:: Ada
12845 @end menu
12846
12847 @node C
12848 @subsection C and C@t{++}
12849
12850 @cindex C and C@t{++}
12851 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
12852
12853 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
12854 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
12855 together.
12856
12857 @cindex C@t{++}
12858 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
12859 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
12860 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
12861 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
12862 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
12863 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
12864 compiler (@code{aCC}).
12865
12866 @menu
12867 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
12868 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
12869 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
12870 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
12871 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
12872 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
12873 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
12874 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
12875 @end menu
12876
12877 @node C Operators
12878 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
12879
12880 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
12881
12882 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
12883 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
12884 often defined on groups of types.
12885
12886 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
12887
12888 @itemize @bullet
12889
12890 @item
12891 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
12892 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
12893
12894 @item
12895 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
12896 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
12897
12898 @item
12899 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
12900
12901 @item
12902 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
12903
12904 @end itemize
12905
12906 @noindent
12907 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
12908 in order of increasing precedence:
12909
12910 @table @code
12911 @item ,
12912 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
12913 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
12914 expression being the last expression evaluated.
12915
12916 @item =
12917 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
12918 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
12919
12920 @item @var{op}=
12921 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
12922 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
12923 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
12924 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
12925 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
12926
12927 @item ?:
12928 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
12929 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
12930 integral type.
12931
12932 @item ||
12933 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
12934
12935 @item &&
12936 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
12937
12938 @item |
12939 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
12940
12941 @item ^
12942 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
12943
12944 @item &
12945 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
12946
12947 @item ==@r{, }!=
12948 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
12949 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
12950
12951 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
12952 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
12953 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
12954 and non-zero for true.
12955
12956 @item <<@r{, }>>
12957 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
12958
12959 @item @@
12960 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
12961
12962 @item +@r{, }-
12963 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
12964 pointer types.
12965
12966 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
12967 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
12968 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
12969 integral types.
12970
12971 @item ++@r{, }--
12972 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
12973 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
12974 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
12975 operation takes place.
12976
12977 @item *
12978 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
12979 @code{++}.
12980
12981 @item &
12982 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
12983
12984 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
12985 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
12986 to examine the address
12987 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
12988 stored.
12989
12990 @item -
12991 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
12992 precedence as @code{++}.
12993
12994 @item !
12995 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
12996 @code{++}.
12997
12998 @item ~
12999 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
13000 @code{++}.
13001
13002
13003 @item .@r{, }->
13004 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
13005 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
13006 pointer based on the stored type information.
13007 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
13008
13009 @item .*@r{, }->*
13010 Dereferences of pointers to members.
13011
13012 @item []
13013 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
13014 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
13015
13016 @item ()
13017 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
13018
13019 @item ::
13020 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
13021 and @code{class} types.
13022
13023 @item ::
13024 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
13025 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
13026 above.
13027 @end table
13028
13029 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
13030 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
13031 predefined meaning.
13032
13033 @node C Constants
13034 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
13035
13036 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
13037
13038 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
13039 following ways:
13040
13041 @itemize @bullet
13042 @item
13043 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
13044 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
13045 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
13046 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
13047 @code{long} value.
13048
13049 @item
13050 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
13051 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
13052 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
13053 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
13054 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
13055 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
13056 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
13057 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
13058 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
13059 constant.
13060
13061 @item
13062 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
13063 integral equivalents.
13064
13065 @item
13066 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
13067 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
13068 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
13069 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
13070 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
13071 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
13072 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
13073 @samp{\n} for newline.
13074
13075 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
13076 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
13077 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
13078 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
13079
13080 @item
13081 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
13082 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
13083 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
13084 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
13085 characters.
13086
13087 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
13088 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
13089 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
13090
13091 @item
13092 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
13093 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
13094
13095 @item
13096 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
13097 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
13098 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
13099 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
13100 @end itemize
13101
13102 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
13103 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
13104
13105 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
13106 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
13107
13108 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
13109 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
13110 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
13111 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
13112 @quotation
13113 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
13114 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
13115 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
13116 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
13117 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
13118 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
13119 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
13120 code. @xref{Compilation}.
13121 @end quotation
13122
13123 @enumerate
13124
13125 @cindex member functions
13126 @item
13127 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
13128
13129 @smallexample
13130 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
13131 @end smallexample
13132
13133 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
13134 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
13135 @item
13136 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
13137 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
13138 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
13139 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
13140 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
13141
13142 @cindex call overloaded functions
13143 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
13144 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
13145 @item
13146 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
13147 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
13148 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
13149 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
13150 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
13151 default arguments.
13152
13153 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
13154 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
13155 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
13156 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
13157 number of function arguments.
13158
13159 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
13160 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
13161 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
13162
13163 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
13164 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
13165 @smallexample
13166 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
13167 @end smallexample
13168
13169 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
13170 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
13171
13172 @cindex reference declarations
13173 @item
13174 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
13175 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
13176 dereferenced.
13177
13178 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
13179 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
13180 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
13181 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
13182 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
13183
13184 @item
13185 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
13186 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
13187 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
13188 necessary, for example in an expression like
13189 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
13190 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
13191 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
13192
13193 @item
13194 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
13195 specification.
13196 @end enumerate
13197
13198 @node C Defaults
13199 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
13200
13201 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
13202
13203 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
13204 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
13205 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
13206 selects the working language.
13207
13208 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
13209 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
13210 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
13211 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
13212 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
13213 for further details.
13214
13215 @node C Checks
13216 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
13217
13218 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
13219
13220 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
13221 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
13222 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
13223 constants to pointers.
13224
13225 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
13226 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
13227 that is not itself an array.
13228
13229 @node Debugging C
13230 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
13231
13232 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
13233 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
13234 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
13235 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
13236
13237 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
13238 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
13239 ,Expressions}.
13240
13241 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
13242 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
13243
13244 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
13245
13246 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
13247 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
13248
13249 @table @code
13250 @cindex break in overloaded functions
13251 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
13252 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
13253 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
13254 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
13255 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
13256
13257 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
13258 @item rbreak @var{regex}
13259 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
13260 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
13261 classes.
13262 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
13263
13264 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
13265 @item catch throw
13266 @itemx catch catch
13267 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
13268 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
13269
13270 @cindex inheritance
13271 @item ptype @var{typename}
13272 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
13273 @var{typename}.
13274 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
13275
13276 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
13277 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
13278 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
13279 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
13280 multiple inheritance is in use.
13281
13282 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
13283 @item set print demangle
13284 @itemx show print demangle
13285 @itemx set print asm-demangle
13286 @itemx show print asm-demangle
13287 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
13288 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
13289 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
13290
13291 @item set print object
13292 @itemx show print object
13293 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
13294 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
13295
13296 @item set print vtbl
13297 @itemx show print vtbl
13298 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
13299 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
13300 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
13301 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
13302
13303 @kindex set overload-resolution
13304 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
13305 @item set overload-resolution on
13306 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
13307 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
13308 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
13309 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
13310 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
13311 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
13312
13313 @item set overload-resolution off
13314 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
13315 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
13316 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
13317 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
13318 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
13319 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
13320 argument types.
13321
13322 @kindex show overload-resolution
13323 @item show overload-resolution
13324 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
13325
13326 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
13327 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
13328 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
13329 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
13330 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
13331 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
13332 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
13333 @end table
13334
13335 @node Decimal Floating Point
13336 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
13337 @cindex decimal floating point format
13338
13339 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
13340 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
13341 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
13342 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
13343
13344 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
13345 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
13346 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
13347 target.
13348
13349 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
13350 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
13351 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
13352
13353 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
13354 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
13355 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
13356
13357 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
13358 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
13359 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
13360
13361 @node D
13362 @subsection D
13363
13364 @cindex D
13365 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
13366 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
13367 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
13368
13369 @node Go
13370 @subsection Go
13371
13372 @cindex Go (programming language)
13373 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
13374 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
13375
13376 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
13377
13378 @table @code
13379 @cindex current Go package
13380 @item The current Go package
13381 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
13382 specifying global variables and functions.
13383
13384 For example, given the program:
13385
13386 @example
13387 package main
13388 var myglob = "Shall we?"
13389 func main () @{
13390 // ...
13391 @}
13392 @end example
13393
13394 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
13395
13396 @example
13397 (gdb) p myglob
13398 (gdb) p main.myglob
13399 @end example
13400
13401 @cindex builtin Go types
13402 @item Builtin Go types
13403 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
13404 as a string.
13405
13406 @cindex builtin Go functions
13407 @item Builtin Go functions
13408 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
13409 function and handles it internally.
13410
13411 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
13412 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
13413 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
13414 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
13415 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
13416 @end table
13417
13418 @node Objective-C
13419 @subsection Objective-C
13420
13421 @cindex Objective-C
13422 This section provides information about some commands and command
13423 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
13424 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
13425 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
13426
13427 @menu
13428 * Method Names in Commands::
13429 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
13430 @end menu
13431
13432 @node Method Names in Commands
13433 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
13434
13435 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
13436 names as line specifications:
13437
13438 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
13439 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
13440 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
13441 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
13442 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
13443 @itemize
13444 @item @code{clear}
13445 @item @code{break}
13446 @item @code{info line}
13447 @item @code{jump}
13448 @item @code{list}
13449 @end itemize
13450
13451 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
13452
13453 @smallexample
13454 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
13455 @end smallexample
13456
13457 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
13458 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
13459 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
13460 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
13461 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
13462 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
13463 debugged, enter:
13464
13465 @smallexample
13466 break -[Fruit create]
13467 @end smallexample
13468
13469 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
13470 enter:
13471
13472 @smallexample
13473 list +[NSText initialize]
13474 @end smallexample
13475
13476 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
13477 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
13478 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
13479 is also possible to specify just a method name:
13480
13481 @smallexample
13482 break create
13483 @end smallexample
13484
13485 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
13486 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
13487 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
13488 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
13489 none apply.
13490
13491 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
13492 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
13493
13494 @smallexample
13495 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
13496 @end smallexample
13497
13498 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
13499 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
13500 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
13501 @kindex print-object
13502 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
13503
13504 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
13505
13506 @smallexample
13507 print -[@var{object} hash]
13508 @end smallexample
13509
13510 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
13511 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
13512 @noindent
13513 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
13514 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
13515 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
13516 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
13517 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
13518 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
13519
13520 @node OpenCL C
13521 @subsection OpenCL C
13522
13523 @cindex OpenCL C
13524 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
13525
13526 @menu
13527 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
13528 * OpenCL C Expressions::
13529 * OpenCL C Operators::
13530 @end menu
13531
13532 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
13533 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
13534
13535 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
13536 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
13537 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
13538 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
13539 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
13540
13541 @node OpenCL C Expressions
13542 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
13543
13544 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
13545 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
13546 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
13547 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
13548
13549 @node OpenCL C Operators
13550 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
13551
13552 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
13553 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
13554 vector data types.
13555
13556 @node Fortran
13557 @subsection Fortran
13558 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
13559
13560 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
13561 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
13562
13563 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
13564 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
13565 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
13566 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
13567 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
13568 underscore.
13569
13570 @menu
13571 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
13572 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
13573 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
13574 @end menu
13575
13576 @node Fortran Operators
13577 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
13578
13579 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
13580
13581 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
13582 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
13583 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
13584
13585 @table @code
13586 @item **
13587 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
13588 of the second one.
13589
13590 @item :
13591 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
13592 represent a section of array.
13593
13594 @item %
13595 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
13596 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
13597 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
13598 union type.
13599 @end table
13600
13601 @node Fortran Defaults
13602 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
13603
13604 @cindex Fortran Defaults
13605
13606 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
13607 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
13608 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
13609 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
13610
13611 @node Special Fortran Commands
13612 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
13613
13614 @cindex Special Fortran commands
13615
13616 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
13617 such as displaying common blocks.
13618
13619 @table @code
13620 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
13621 @kindex info common
13622 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
13623 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
13624 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
13625 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
13626 printed.
13627 @end table
13628
13629 @node Pascal
13630 @subsection Pascal
13631
13632 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
13633 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
13634 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
13635 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
13636 syntax.
13637
13638 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
13639 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
13640 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
13641
13642 @node Modula-2
13643 @subsection Modula-2
13644
13645 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
13646
13647 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
13648 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
13649 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
13650 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
13651 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
13652 table.
13653
13654 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
13655 @menu
13656 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
13657 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
13658 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
13659 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
13660 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
13661 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
13662 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
13663 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
13664 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
13665 @end menu
13666
13667 @node M2 Operators
13668 @subsubsection Operators
13669 @cindex Modula-2 operators
13670
13671 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
13672 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
13673 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
13674 following definitions hold:
13675
13676 @itemize @bullet
13677
13678 @item
13679 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
13680 their subranges.
13681
13682 @item
13683 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
13684
13685 @item
13686 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
13687
13688 @item
13689 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
13690 @var{type}}.
13691
13692 @item
13693 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
13694
13695 @item
13696 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
13697
13698 @item
13699 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
13700 @end itemize
13701
13702 @noindent
13703 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
13704 increasing precedence:
13705
13706 @table @code
13707 @item ,
13708 Function argument or array index separator.
13709
13710 @item :=
13711 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
13712 @var{value}.
13713
13714 @item <@r{, }>
13715 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
13716 types.
13717
13718 @item <=@r{, }>=
13719 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
13720 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
13721 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
13722
13723 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
13724 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
13725 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
13726 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
13727 comment character.
13728
13729 @item IN
13730 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
13731 Same precedence as @code{<}.
13732
13733 @item OR
13734 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
13735
13736 @item AND@r{, }&
13737 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
13738
13739 @item @@
13740 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
13741
13742 @item +@r{, }-
13743 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
13744 and difference on set types.
13745
13746 @item *
13747 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
13748 on set types.
13749
13750 @item /
13751 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
13752 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
13753
13754 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
13755 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
13756 precedence as @code{*}.
13757
13758 @item -
13759 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
13760
13761 @item ^
13762 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
13763
13764 @item NOT
13765 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
13766 @code{^}.
13767
13768 @item .
13769 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
13770 precedence as @code{^}.
13771
13772 @item []
13773 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
13774
13775 @item ()
13776 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
13777 as @code{^}.
13778
13779 @item ::@r{, }.
13780 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
13781 @end table
13782
13783 @quotation
13784 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
13785 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
13786 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
13787 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
13788 @end quotation
13789
13790
13791 @node Built-In Func/Proc
13792 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
13793 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
13794
13795 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
13796 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
13797
13798 @table @var
13799
13800 @item a
13801 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
13802
13803 @item c
13804 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
13805
13806 @item i
13807 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
13808
13809 @item m
13810 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
13811 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
13812 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
13813
13814 @item n
13815 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
13816
13817 @item r
13818 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
13819
13820 @item t
13821 represents a type.
13822
13823 @item v
13824 represents a variable.
13825
13826 @item x
13827 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
13828 explanation of the function for details.
13829 @end table
13830
13831 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
13832
13833 @table @code
13834 @item ABS(@var{n})
13835 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
13836
13837 @item CAP(@var{c})
13838 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
13839 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
13840
13841 @item CHR(@var{i})
13842 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
13843
13844 @item DEC(@var{v})
13845 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
13846
13847 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
13848 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
13849 new value.
13850
13851 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
13852 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
13853 set.
13854
13855 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
13856 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
13857
13858 @item HIGH(@var{a})
13859 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
13860
13861 @item INC(@var{v})
13862 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
13863
13864 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
13865 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
13866 new value.
13867
13868 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
13869 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
13870 there. Returns the new set.
13871
13872 @item MAX(@var{t})
13873 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
13874
13875 @item MIN(@var{t})
13876 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
13877
13878 @item ODD(@var{i})
13879 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
13880
13881 @item ORD(@var{x})
13882 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
13883 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
13884 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
13885 integral, character and enumerated types.
13886
13887 @item SIZE(@var{x})
13888 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
13889
13890 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
13891 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
13892
13893 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
13894 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
13895
13896 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
13897 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
13898 @end table
13899
13900 @quotation
13901 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
13902 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
13903 an error.
13904 @end quotation
13905
13906 @cindex Modula-2 constants
13907 @node M2 Constants
13908 @subsubsection Constants
13909
13910 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
13911 ways:
13912
13913 @itemize @bullet
13914
13915 @item
13916 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
13917 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
13918 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
13919 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
13920
13921 @item
13922 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
13923 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
13924 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
13925 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
13926 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
13927 digits.
13928
13929 @item
13930 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
13931 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
13932 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
13933 followed by a @samp{C}.
13934
13935 @item
13936 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
13937 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
13938 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
13939 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
13940 sequences.
13941
13942 @item
13943 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
13944
13945 @item
13946 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
13947 @code{FALSE}.
13948
13949 @item
13950 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
13951
13952 @item
13953 Set constants are not yet supported.
13954 @end itemize
13955
13956 @node M2 Types
13957 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
13958 @cindex Modula-2 types
13959
13960 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
13961 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
13962 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
13963 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
13964 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
13965 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
13966
13967 The first example contains the following section of code:
13968
13969 @smallexample
13970 VAR
13971 s: SET OF CHAR ;
13972 r: [20..40] ;
13973 @end smallexample
13974
13975 @noindent
13976 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
13977 @code{r} and @code{s}.
13978
13979 @smallexample
13980 (@value{GDBP}) print s
13981 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
13982 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
13983 SET OF CHAR
13984 (@value{GDBP}) print r
13985 21
13986 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
13987 [20..40]
13988 @end smallexample
13989
13990 @noindent
13991 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
13992
13993 @smallexample
13994 VAR
13995 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
13996 @end smallexample
13997
13998 @noindent
13999 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
14000
14001 @smallexample
14002 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14003 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
14004 @end smallexample
14005
14006 @noindent
14007 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
14008 expressions using the debugger.
14009
14010 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
14011 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
14012
14013 @smallexample
14014 VAR
14015 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
14016 @end smallexample
14017
14018 @smallexample
14019 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14020 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
14021 @end smallexample
14022
14023 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
14024 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
14025 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
14026 above.
14027
14028 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
14029
14030 @smallexample
14031 TYPE
14032 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
14033 t = [blue..yellow] ;
14034 VAR
14035 s: t ;
14036 BEGIN
14037 s := blue ;
14038 @end smallexample
14039
14040 @noindent
14041 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
14042 and value of a variable.
14043
14044 @smallexample
14045 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14046 $1 = blue
14047 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
14048 type = [blue..yellow]
14049 @end smallexample
14050
14051 @noindent
14052 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
14053 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
14054 their @code{C} counterparts.
14055
14056 @smallexample
14057 VAR
14058 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
14059 BEGIN
14060 s[1] := 1 ;
14061 @end smallexample
14062
14063 @smallexample
14064 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14065 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
14066 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14067 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
14068 @end smallexample
14069
14070 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
14071 pointer types as shown in this example:
14072
14073 @smallexample
14074 VAR
14075 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
14076 BEGIN
14077 NEW(s) ;
14078 s^[1] := 1 ;
14079 @end smallexample
14080
14081 @noindent
14082 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
14083
14084 @smallexample
14085 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14086 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
14087 @end smallexample
14088
14089 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
14090 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
14091 types:
14092
14093 @smallexample
14094 TYPE
14095 foo = RECORD
14096 f1: CARDINAL ;
14097 f2: CHAR ;
14098 f3: myarray ;
14099 END ;
14100
14101 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
14102 myrange = [-2..2] ;
14103 VAR
14104 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
14105 @end smallexample
14106
14107 @noindent
14108 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
14109 below.
14110
14111 @smallexample
14112 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14113 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
14114 f1 : CARDINAL;
14115 f2 : CHAR;
14116 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
14117 END
14118 @end smallexample
14119
14120 @node M2 Defaults
14121 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
14122 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
14123
14124 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
14125 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
14126 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14127 selected the working language.
14128
14129 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
14130 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
14131 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
14132 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
14133
14134 @node Deviations
14135 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
14136 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
14137
14138 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
14139 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
14140
14141 @itemize @bullet
14142 @item
14143 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
14144 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
14145 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
14146 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
14147 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
14148 returned a pointer.)
14149
14150 @item
14151 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
14152 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
14153 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
14154 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
14155
14156 @item
14157 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
14158 argument.
14159
14160 @item
14161 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
14162 @end itemize
14163
14164 @node M2 Checks
14165 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
14166 @cindex Modula-2 checks
14167
14168 @quotation
14169 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
14170 range checking.
14171 @end quotation
14172 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
14173
14174 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
14175
14176 @itemize @bullet
14177 @item
14178 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
14179 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
14180
14181 @item
14182 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
14183 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
14184 @end itemize
14185
14186 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
14187 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
14188
14189 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
14190 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
14191
14192 @node M2 Scope
14193 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14194 @cindex scope
14195 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
14196 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
14197 @ifinfo
14198 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
14199 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
14200 @end ifinfo
14201 @ifnotinfo
14202 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
14203 @end ifnotinfo
14204
14205 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
14206 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
14207 similar syntax:
14208
14209 @smallexample
14210
14211 @var{module} . @var{id}
14212 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
14213 @end smallexample
14214
14215 @noindent
14216 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
14217 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
14218 identifier within your program, except another module.
14219
14220 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
14221 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
14222 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
14223 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
14224
14225 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
14226 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
14227 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
14228 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
14229 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
14230 @var{module}.
14231
14232 @node GDB/M2
14233 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14234
14235 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
14236 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
14237 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
14238 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
14239 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
14240 analogue in Modula-2.
14241
14242 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
14243 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
14244 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
14245 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
14246 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
14247 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
14248
14249 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
14250 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
14251 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
14252
14253 @node Ada
14254 @subsection Ada
14255 @cindex Ada
14256
14257 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
14258 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
14259 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
14260 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
14261 to be difficult.
14262
14263
14264 @cindex expressions in Ada
14265 @menu
14266 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
14267 and semantics supported by Ada mode
14268 in @value{GDBN}.
14269 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
14270 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
14271 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
14272 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
14273 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
14274 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
14275 Profile
14276 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
14277 @end menu
14278
14279 @node Ada Mode Intro
14280 @subsubsection Introduction
14281 @cindex Ada mode, general
14282
14283 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
14284 syntax, with some extensions.
14285 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
14286
14287 @itemize @bullet
14288 @item
14289 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
14290 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
14291 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
14292 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
14293
14294 @item
14295 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
14296 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
14297
14298 @item
14299 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
14300 @end itemize
14301
14302 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
14303 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
14304 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
14305 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
14306 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
14307
14308 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
14309 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
14310 was translated from an Ada source file.
14311
14312 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
14313 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
14314 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
14315 middle (to allow based literals).
14316
14317 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
14318 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
14319 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
14320 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
14321 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
14322 functions to procedures elsewhere.
14323
14324 @node Omissions from Ada
14325 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
14326 @cindex Ada, omissions from
14327
14328 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
14329
14330 @itemize @bullet
14331 @item
14332 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
14333
14334 @itemize @minus
14335 @item
14336 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
14337 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
14338
14339 @item
14340 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
14341
14342 @item
14343 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
14344
14345 @item
14346 @t{'Tag}.
14347
14348 @item
14349 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
14350 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
14351
14352 @item
14353 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
14354 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
14355
14356 @item
14357 @t{'Address}.
14358 @end itemize
14359
14360 @item
14361 The names in
14362 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
14363 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
14364 not currently available.
14365
14366 @item
14367 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
14368 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
14369 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
14370 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
14371 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
14372 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
14373 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
14374 indeterminate values.
14375
14376 @item
14377 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
14378 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
14379 are not implemented.
14380
14381 @item
14382 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
14383 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
14384 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
14385 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
14386 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
14387
14388 @smallexample
14389 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
14390 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
14391 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
14392 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
14393 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
14394 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
14395 @end smallexample
14396
14397 Changing a
14398 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
14399 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
14400 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
14401 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
14402 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
14403 declared to have a type such as:
14404
14405 @smallexample
14406 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
14407 Id : Integer;
14408 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
14409 end record;
14410 @end smallexample
14411
14412 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
14413 assignments:
14414
14415 @smallexample
14416 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
14417 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
14418 @end smallexample
14419
14420 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
14421 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
14422 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
14423 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
14424 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
14425 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
14426 redundant component associations, although which component values are
14427 assigned in such cases is not defined.
14428
14429 @item
14430 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
14431
14432 @item
14433 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
14434 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
14435 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
14436 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
14437 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
14438 the proper resolution.
14439
14440 @item
14441 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
14442
14443 @item
14444 Entry calls are not implemented.
14445
14446 @item
14447 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
14448 formats are not supported.
14449
14450 @item
14451 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
14452
14453 @item
14454 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
14455 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
14456 context.
14457 Should your program
14458 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
14459 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
14460 @end itemize
14461
14462 @node Additions to Ada
14463 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
14464 @cindex Ada, deviations from
14465
14466 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
14467 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
14468
14469 @itemize @bullet
14470 @item
14471 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
14472 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
14473 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
14474 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
14475 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
14476 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
14477 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
14478 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
14479
14480 @item
14481 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
14482 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
14483 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
14484
14485 @item
14486 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
14487 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
14488
14489 @item
14490 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
14491 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
14492 @end itemize
14493
14494 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
14495 additions specific to Ada:
14496
14497 @itemize @bullet
14498 @item
14499 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
14500 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
14501
14502 @smallexample
14503 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
14504 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
14505 @end smallexample
14506
14507 @item
14508 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
14509 the value of its right-hand operand.
14510 This allows, for example,
14511 complex conditional breaks:
14512
14513 @smallexample
14514 (@value{GDBP}) break f
14515 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
14516 @end smallexample
14517
14518 @item
14519 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
14520 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
14521 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
14522 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
14523 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
14524 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
14525 in strings. For example,
14526 @smallexample
14527 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
14528 @end smallexample
14529 @noindent
14530 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
14531 after each period.
14532
14533 @item
14534 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
14535 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
14536 to write
14537
14538 @smallexample
14539 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
14540 @end smallexample
14541
14542 @item
14543 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
14544 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
14545 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
14546 of 3 might print as
14547
14548 @smallexample
14549 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
14550 @end smallexample
14551
14552 @noindent
14553 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
14554 clause.
14555
14556 @item
14557 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
14558 multi-character subsequence of
14559 their names (an exact match gets preference).
14560 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
14561 in place of @t{a'length}.
14562
14563 @item
14564 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
14565 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
14566 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
14567 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
14568 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
14569 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
14570 For example,
14571 @smallexample
14572 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
14573 @end smallexample
14574
14575 @item
14576 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
14577 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
14578 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
14579 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
14580 object.
14581
14582 @end itemize
14583
14584 @node Stopping Before Main Program
14585 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
14586
14587 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
14588 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
14589 before reaching the main procedure.
14590 As defined in the Ada Reference
14591 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
14592 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
14593 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
14594 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
14595
14596 @node Ada Tasks
14597 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
14598 @cindex Ada, tasking
14599
14600 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
14601 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
14602
14603 @table @code
14604 @kindex info tasks
14605 @item info tasks
14606 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
14607
14608
14609 @smallexample
14610 @iftex
14611 @leftskip=0.5cm
14612 @end iftex
14613 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
14614 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
14615 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
14616 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
14617 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
14618 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
14619
14620 @end smallexample
14621
14622 @noindent
14623 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
14624 task currently being inspected.
14625
14626 @table @asis
14627 @item ID
14628 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
14629
14630 @item TID
14631 The Ada task ID.
14632
14633 @item P-ID
14634 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
14635
14636 @item Pri
14637 The base priority of the task.
14638
14639 @item State
14640 Current state of the task.
14641
14642 @table @code
14643 @item Unactivated
14644 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
14645 executing.
14646
14647 @item Runnable
14648 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
14649 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
14650
14651 @item Terminated
14652 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
14653 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
14654 terminated themselves.
14655
14656 @item Child Activation Wait
14657 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
14658
14659 @item Accept Statement
14660 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
14661
14662 @item Waiting on entry call
14663 The task is waiting on an entry call.
14664
14665 @item Async Select Wait
14666 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
14667 select statement.
14668
14669 @item Delay Sleep
14670 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
14671 alternative open.
14672
14673 @item Child Termination Wait
14674 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
14675 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
14676 waiting on a terminate Phase.
14677
14678 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
14679 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
14680 finish terminating.
14681
14682 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
14683 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
14684 @end table
14685
14686 @item Name
14687 Name of the task in the program.
14688
14689 @end table
14690
14691 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
14692 @item info task @var{taskno}
14693 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
14694 the following example:
14695 @smallexample
14696 @iftex
14697 @leftskip=0.5cm
14698 @end iftex
14699 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
14700 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
14701 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
14702 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
14703 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
14704 Ada Task: 0x807c468
14705 Name: task_1
14706 Thread: 0x807f378
14707 Parent: 1 (main_task)
14708 Base Priority: 15
14709 State: Runnable
14710 @end smallexample
14711
14712 @item task
14713 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
14714 @cindex current Ada task ID
14715 This command prints the ID of the current task.
14716
14717 @smallexample
14718 @iftex
14719 @leftskip=0.5cm
14720 @end iftex
14721 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
14722 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
14723 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
14724 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
14725 (@value{GDBP}) task
14726 [Current task is 2]
14727 @end smallexample
14728
14729 @item task @var{taskno}
14730 @cindex Ada task switching
14731 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
14732 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
14733 from the current task to the given task.
14734
14735 @smallexample
14736 @iftex
14737 @leftskip=0.5cm
14738 @end iftex
14739 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
14740 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
14741 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
14742 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
14743 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
14744 [Switching to task 1]
14745 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
14746 (@value{GDBP}) bt
14747 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
14748 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
14749 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
14750 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
14751 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
14752 @end smallexample
14753
14754 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
14755 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
14756 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
14757 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
14758 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
14759 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
14760 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}).
14761 @var{linespec} specifies source lines, as described
14762 in @ref{Specify Location}.
14763
14764 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
14765 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
14766 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. @var{taskno} is one of the
14767 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
14768 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
14769
14770 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
14771 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
14772 program.
14773
14774 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
14775 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
14776 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
14777
14778 For example,
14779
14780 @smallexample
14781 @iftex
14782 @leftskip=0.5cm
14783 @end iftex
14784 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
14785 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
14786 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
14787 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
14788 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
14789 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
14790 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
14791 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
14792 (@value{GDBP}) cont
14793 Continuing.
14794 task # 1 running
14795 task # 2 running
14796
14797 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
14798 15 flush;
14799 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
14800 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
14801 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
14802 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
14803 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
14804 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
14805 @end smallexample
14806 @end table
14807
14808 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
14809 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
14810 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
14811
14812 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
14813 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
14814 the platform being used.
14815 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
14816 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
14817 as usual.
14818
14819 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
14820 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
14821 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
14822 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
14823 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
14824 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
14825
14826 @node Ravenscar Profile
14827 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
14828 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
14829
14830 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
14831 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
14832 requirements.
14833
14834 @table @code
14835 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
14836 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
14837 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
14838 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
14839 Profile. This is the default.
14840
14841 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
14842 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
14843 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
14844 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
14845 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
14846 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
14847 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
14848
14849 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
14850 @item show ravenscar task-switching
14851 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
14852 using the Ravenscar Profile.
14853
14854 @end table
14855
14856 @node Ada Glitches
14857 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
14858 @cindex Ada, problems
14859
14860 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
14861 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
14862 @value{GDBN},
14863 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
14864 and the GNU Ada compiler.
14865
14866 @itemize @bullet
14867 @item
14868 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
14869 storage are invisible to the debugger.
14870
14871 @item
14872 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
14873 argument lists are treated as positional).
14874
14875 @item
14876 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
14877
14878 @item
14879 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
14880 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
14881 the host machine.
14882
14883 @item
14884 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
14885 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
14886 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
14887 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
14888 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
14889 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
14890 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
14891 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
14892 you can usually resolve the confusion
14893 by qualifying the problematic names with package
14894 @code{Standard} explicitly.
14895 @end itemize
14896
14897 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
14898 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
14899 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
14900 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
14901 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
14902 enabled.
14903
14904 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
14905 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
14906 @table @code
14907
14908 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
14909 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
14910 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
14911 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
14912 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
14913 This is the default.
14914
14915 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
14916 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
14917 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
14918 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
14919 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
14920 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
14921 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
14922
14923 @end table
14924
14925 @node Unsupported Languages
14926 @section Unsupported Languages
14927
14928 @cindex unsupported languages
14929 @cindex minimal language
14930 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
14931 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
14932 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
14933 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
14934 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
14935 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
14936
14937 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
14938 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
14939 language.
14940
14941 @node Symbols
14942 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
14943
14944 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
14945 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
14946 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
14947 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
14948 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
14949 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
14950 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
14951
14952 @cindex symbol names
14953 @cindex names of symbols
14954 @cindex quoting names
14955 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
14956 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
14957 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
14958 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
14959 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
14960 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
14961 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
14962 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
14963
14964 @smallexample
14965 p 'foo.c'::x
14966 @end smallexample
14967
14968 @noindent
14969 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
14970
14971 @table @code
14972 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
14973 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
14974 @kindex set case-sensitive
14975 @item set case-sensitive on
14976 @itemx set case-sensitive off
14977 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
14978 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
14979 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
14980 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
14981 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
14982 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
14983 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
14984 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
14985 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
14986 case-insensitive matches.
14987
14988 @kindex show case-sensitive
14989 @item show case-sensitive
14990 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
14991 lookups.
14992
14993 @kindex set print type methods
14994 @item set print type methods
14995 @itemx set print type methods on
14996 @itemx set print type methods off
14997 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
14998 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
14999 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
15000 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
15001 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
15002 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
15003
15004 @kindex show print type methods
15005 @item show print type methods
15006 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
15007 classes.
15008
15009 @kindex set print type typedefs
15010 @item set print type typedefs
15011 @itemx set print type typedefs on
15012 @itemx set print type typedefs off
15013
15014 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
15015 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
15016 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
15017 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
15018 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
15019 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
15020 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
15021 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
15022 types.
15023
15024 @kindex show print type typedefs
15025 @item show print type typedefs
15026 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
15027 printing classes.
15028
15029 @kindex info address
15030 @cindex address of a symbol
15031 @item info address @var{symbol}
15032 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
15033 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
15034 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
15035 is always stored.
15036
15037 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
15038 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
15039 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
15040
15041 @kindex info symbol
15042 @cindex symbol from address
15043 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
15044 @item info symbol @var{addr}
15045 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
15046 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
15047 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
15048
15049 @smallexample
15050 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
15051 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
15052 @end smallexample
15053
15054 @noindent
15055 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
15056 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
15057
15058 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
15059 library containing the symbol is also printed:
15060
15061 @smallexample
15062 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
15063 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
15064 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
15065 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
15066 @end smallexample
15067
15068 @kindex whatis
15069 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
15070 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
15071 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
15072 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
15073
15074 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
15075 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
15076 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
15077
15078 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
15079 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
15080 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
15081 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
15082 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
15083 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
15084 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
15085 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
15086 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
15087
15088 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
15089 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
15090 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
15091 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
15092 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
15093 unroll it.
15094
15095 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
15096 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
15097 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
15098
15099 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
15100 Available flags are:
15101
15102 @table @code
15103 @item r
15104 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
15105 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
15106 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
15107
15108 @item m
15109 Do not print methods defined in the class.
15110
15111 @item M
15112 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
15113 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
15114
15115 @item t
15116 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
15117 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
15118 names are substituted when printing other types.
15119
15120 @item T
15121 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
15122 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
15123 @end table
15124
15125 @kindex ptype
15126 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
15127 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
15128 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
15129 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
15130
15131 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
15132 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
15133 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
15134 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
15135 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
15136 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
15137 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
15138 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
15139
15140 For example, for this variable declaration:
15141
15142 @smallexample
15143 typedef double real_t;
15144 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
15145 typedef struct complex complex_t;
15146 complex_t var;
15147 real_t *real_pointer_var;
15148 @end smallexample
15149
15150 @noindent
15151 the two commands give this output:
15152
15153 @smallexample
15154 @group
15155 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
15156 type = complex_t
15157 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
15158 type = struct complex @{
15159 real_t real;
15160 double imag;
15161 @}
15162 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
15163 type = struct complex
15164 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
15165 type = struct complex
15166 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
15167 type = struct complex @{
15168 real_t real;
15169 double imag;
15170 @}
15171 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
15172 type = real_t *
15173 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
15174 type = double *
15175 @end group
15176 @end smallexample
15177
15178 @noindent
15179 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
15180 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
15181
15182 @cindex incomplete type
15183 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
15184 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
15185 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
15186 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
15187 given these declarations:
15188
15189 @smallexample
15190 struct foo;
15191 struct foo *fooptr;
15192 @end smallexample
15193
15194 @noindent
15195 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
15196
15197 @smallexample
15198 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
15199 $1 = <incomplete type>
15200 @end smallexample
15201
15202 @noindent
15203 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
15204 completely specified.
15205
15206 @kindex info types
15207 @item info types @var{regexp}
15208 @itemx info types
15209 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
15210 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
15211 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
15212 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
15213 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
15214 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
15215 name is @code{value}.
15216
15217 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
15218 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
15219 lists all source files where a type is defined.
15220
15221 @kindex info scope
15222 @cindex local variables
15223 @item info scope @var{location}
15224 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
15225 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
15226 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
15227 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
15228 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
15229
15230 @smallexample
15231 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
15232 Scope for command_line_handler:
15233 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
15234 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
15235 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
15236 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
15237 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
15238 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
15239 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
15240 @end smallexample
15241
15242 @noindent
15243 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
15244 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
15245 collect}.
15246
15247 @kindex info source
15248 @item info source
15249 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
15250 the function containing the current point of execution:
15251 @itemize @bullet
15252 @item
15253 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
15254 @item
15255 the directory it was compiled in,
15256 @item
15257 its length, in lines,
15258 @item
15259 which programming language it is written in,
15260 @item
15261 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
15262 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
15263 @item
15264 whether the debugging information includes information about
15265 preprocessor macros.
15266 @end itemize
15267
15268
15269 @kindex info sources
15270 @item info sources
15271 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
15272 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
15273 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
15274
15275 @kindex info functions
15276 @item info functions
15277 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
15278
15279 @item info functions @var{regexp}
15280 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
15281 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
15282 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
15283 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
15284 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
15285 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
15286 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
15287
15288 @kindex info variables
15289 @item info variables
15290 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
15291 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
15292
15293 @item info variables @var{regexp}
15294 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
15295 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
15296 @var{regexp}.
15297
15298 @kindex info classes
15299 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
15300 @item info classes
15301 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
15302 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
15303 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
15304 expression.
15305
15306 @kindex info selectors
15307 @item info selectors
15308 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
15309 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
15310 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
15311 expression.
15312
15313 @ignore
15314 This was never implemented.
15315 @kindex info methods
15316 @item info methods
15317 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
15318 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
15319 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
15320 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
15321 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
15322 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
15323 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
15324 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
15325 @end ignore
15326
15327 @cindex opaque data types
15328 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
15329 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
15330 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
15331 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
15332 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
15333 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
15334 another source file. The default is on.
15335
15336 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
15337 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
15338
15339 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
15340 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
15341 is printed as follows:
15342 @smallexample
15343 @{<no data fields>@}
15344 @end smallexample
15345
15346 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
15347 @item show opaque-type-resolution
15348 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
15349
15350 @kindex maint print symbols
15351 @cindex symbol dump
15352 @kindex maint print psymbols
15353 @cindex partial symbol dump
15354 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
15355 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
15356 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
15357 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
15358 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
15359 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
15360 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
15361 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
15362 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
15363 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
15364 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
15365 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
15366 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
15367 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
15368 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
15369 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
15370 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
15371
15372 @kindex maint info symtabs
15373 @kindex maint info psymtabs
15374 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
15375 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
15376 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
15377 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
15378 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
15379 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
15380
15381 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
15382 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
15383 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
15384 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
15385 structure in more detail. For example:
15386
15387 @smallexample
15388 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
15389 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
15390 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
15391 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
15392 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
15393 readin no
15394 fullname (null)
15395 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
15396 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
15397 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
15398 dependencies (none)
15399 @}
15400 @}
15401 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
15402 (@value{GDBP})
15403 @end smallexample
15404 @noindent
15405 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
15406 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
15407 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
15408 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
15409 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
15410
15411 @smallexample
15412 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
15413 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
15414 line 1574.
15415 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
15416 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
15417 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
15418 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
15419 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
15420 dirname (null)
15421 fullname (null)
15422 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
15423 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
15424 debugformat DWARF 2
15425 @}
15426 @}
15427 (@value{GDBP})
15428 @end smallexample
15429 @end table
15430
15431
15432 @node Altering
15433 @chapter Altering Execution
15434
15435 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
15436 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
15437 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
15438 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
15439 program.
15440
15441 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
15442 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
15443 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
15444
15445 @menu
15446 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
15447 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
15448 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
15449 * Returning:: Returning from a function
15450 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
15451 * Patching:: Patching your program
15452 @end menu
15453
15454 @node Assignment
15455 @section Assignment to Variables
15456
15457 @cindex assignment
15458 @cindex setting variables
15459 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
15460 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
15461
15462 @smallexample
15463 print x=4
15464 @end smallexample
15465
15466 @noindent
15467 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
15468 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
15469 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
15470 information on operators in supported languages.
15471
15472 @kindex set variable
15473 @cindex variables, setting
15474 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
15475 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
15476 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
15477 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
15478 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
15479
15480 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
15481 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
15482 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
15483 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
15484 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
15485 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
15486 command @code{set width}:
15487
15488 @smallexample
15489 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
15490 type = double
15491 (@value{GDBP}) p width
15492 $4 = 13
15493 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
15494 Invalid syntax in expression.
15495 @end smallexample
15496
15497 @noindent
15498 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
15499 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
15500
15501 @smallexample
15502 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
15503 @end smallexample
15504
15505 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
15506 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
15507 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
15508 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
15509 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
15510 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
15511
15512 @smallexample
15513 @group
15514 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
15515 type = double
15516 (@value{GDBP}) p g
15517 $1 = 1
15518 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
15519 (@value{GDBP}) p g
15520 $2 = 1
15521 (@value{GDBP}) r
15522 The program being debugged has been started already.
15523 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
15524 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
15525 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
15526 Invalid bfd target.
15527 (@value{GDBP}) show g
15528 The current BFD target is "=4".
15529 @end group
15530 @end smallexample
15531
15532 @noindent
15533 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
15534 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
15535 @code{g}, use
15536
15537 @smallexample
15538 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
15539 @end smallexample
15540
15541 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
15542 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
15543 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
15544 same length or shorter.
15545 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
15546 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
15547
15548 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
15549 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
15550 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
15551 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
15552 and representation in memory), and
15553
15554 @smallexample
15555 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
15556 @end smallexample
15557
15558 @noindent
15559 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
15560
15561 @node Jumping
15562 @section Continuing at a Different Address
15563
15564 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
15565 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
15566 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
15567
15568 @table @code
15569 @kindex jump
15570 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
15571 @item jump @var{linespec}
15572 @itemx j @var{linespec}
15573 @itemx jump @var{location}
15574 @itemx j @var{location}
15575 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
15576 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
15577 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
15578 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
15579 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
15580 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
15581
15582 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
15583 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
15584 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
15585 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
15586 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
15587 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
15588 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
15589 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
15590 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
15591 @end table
15592
15593 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
15594 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
15595 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
15596 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
15597 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
15598 example,
15599
15600 @smallexample
15601 set $pc = 0x485
15602 @end smallexample
15603
15604 @noindent
15605 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
15606 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
15607 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
15608
15609 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
15610 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
15611 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
15612 detail.
15613
15614 @c @group
15615 @node Signaling
15616 @section Giving your Program a Signal
15617 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
15618
15619 @table @code
15620 @kindex signal
15621 @item signal @var{signal}
15622 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
15623 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
15624 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
15625 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
15626
15627 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
15628 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
15629 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
15630 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
15631 signal.
15632
15633 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
15634 after executing the command.
15635 @end table
15636 @c @end group
15637
15638 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
15639 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
15640 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
15641 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
15642 passes the signal directly to your program.
15643
15644
15645 @node Returning
15646 @section Returning from a Function
15647
15648 @table @code
15649 @cindex returning from a function
15650 @kindex return
15651 @item return
15652 @itemx return @var{expression}
15653 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
15654 command. If you give an
15655 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
15656 value.
15657 @end table
15658
15659 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
15660 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
15661 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
15662 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
15663
15664 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
15665 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
15666 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
15667 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
15668 of functions.
15669
15670 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
15671 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
15672 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
15673 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
15674 selected stack frame returns naturally.
15675
15676 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
15677 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
15678 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
15679 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
15680 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
15681 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
15682 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
15683 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
15684 assignment into the right register(s).
15685
15686 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
15687 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
15688 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
15689 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
15690 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
15691 into a @code{long long int}:
15692
15693 @smallexample
15694 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
15695 29 return 31;
15696 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
15697 Make func return now? (y or n) y
15698 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
15699 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
15700 (@value{GDBP})
15701 @end smallexample
15702
15703 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
15704 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
15705 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
15706 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
15707 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
15708 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
15709 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
15710 an appropriate cast explicitly:
15711
15712 @smallexample
15713 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
15714 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
15715 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
15716 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
15717 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
15718 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
15719 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
15720 (@value{GDBP})
15721 @end smallexample
15722
15723 @node Calling
15724 @section Calling Program Functions
15725
15726 @table @code
15727 @cindex calling functions
15728 @cindex inferior functions, calling
15729 @item print @var{expr}
15730 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
15731 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
15732 debugged.
15733
15734 @kindex call
15735 @item call @var{expr}
15736 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
15737 returned values.
15738
15739 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
15740 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
15741 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
15742 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
15743 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
15744 value history.
15745 @end table
15746
15747 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
15748 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
15749 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
15750 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
15751
15752 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
15753 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
15754 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
15755 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
15756 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
15757 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
15758 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
15759 in that case is controlled by the
15760 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
15761
15762 @table @code
15763 @item set unwindonsignal
15764 @kindex set unwindonsignal
15765 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
15766 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
15767 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
15768 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
15769 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
15770 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
15771 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
15772 received.
15773
15774 @item show unwindonsignal
15775 @kindex show unwindonsignal
15776 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
15777 @value{GDBN}.
15778
15779 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
15780 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
15781 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
15782 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
15783 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
15784 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
15785 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
15786 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
15787 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
15788 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
15789
15790 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
15791 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
15792 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
15793 @value{GDBN}.
15794
15795 @end table
15796
15797 @cindex weak alias functions
15798 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
15799 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
15800 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
15801 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
15802 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
15803 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
15804 function instead.
15805
15806 @node Patching
15807 @section Patching Programs
15808
15809 @cindex patching binaries
15810 @cindex writing into executables
15811 @cindex writing into corefiles
15812
15813 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
15814 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
15815 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
15816 patching your program's binary.
15817
15818 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
15819 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
15820 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
15821 repairs.
15822
15823 @table @code
15824 @kindex set write
15825 @item set write on
15826 @itemx set write off
15827 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
15828 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
15829 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
15830
15831 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
15832 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
15833 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
15834
15835 @item show write
15836 @kindex show write
15837 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
15838 as well as reading.
15839 @end table
15840
15841 @node GDB Files
15842 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
15843
15844 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
15845 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
15846 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
15847 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
15848
15849 @menu
15850 * Files:: Commands to specify files
15851 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
15852 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
15853 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
15854 * Data Files:: GDB data files
15855 @end menu
15856
15857 @node Files
15858 @section Commands to Specify Files
15859
15860 @cindex symbol table
15861 @cindex core dump file
15862
15863 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
15864 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
15865 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
15866 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
15867
15868 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
15869 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
15870 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
15871 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
15872 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
15873 new files are useful.
15874
15875 @table @code
15876 @cindex executable file
15877 @kindex file
15878 @item file @var{filename}
15879 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
15880 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
15881 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
15882 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
15883 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
15884 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
15885 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
15886 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
15887
15888 @cindex unlinked object files
15889 @cindex patching object files
15890 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
15891 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
15892 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
15893 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
15894 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
15895 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
15896 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
15897 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
15898
15899 @item file
15900 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
15901 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
15902
15903 @kindex exec-file
15904 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
15905 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
15906 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
15907 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
15908 discard information on the executable file.
15909
15910 @kindex symbol-file
15911 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
15912 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
15913 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
15914 table and program to run from the same file.
15915
15916 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
15917 program's symbol table.
15918
15919 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
15920 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
15921 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
15922 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
15923 @value{GDBN}.
15924
15925 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
15926 executing it once.
15927
15928 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
15929 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
15930 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
15931 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
15932 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
15933 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
15934 optimized code.
15935
15936 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
15937 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
15938 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
15939 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
15940 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
15941
15942 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
15943 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
15944 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
15945 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
15946 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
15947 Warnings and Messages}.)
15948
15949 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
15950 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
15951 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
15952 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
15953 in stabs format.
15954
15955 @kindex readnow
15956 @cindex reading symbols immediately
15957 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
15958 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
15959 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
15960 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
15961 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
15962 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
15963 entire symbol table available.
15964
15965 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
15966 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
15967 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
15968 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
15969 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
15970 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
15971 @c files.
15972
15973 @kindex core-file
15974 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
15975 @itemx core
15976 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
15977 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
15978 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
15979 executable file itself for other parts.
15980
15981 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
15982 to be used.
15983
15984 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
15985 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
15986 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
15987 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
15988 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
15989
15990 @kindex add-symbol-file
15991 @cindex dynamic linking
15992 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
15993 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
15994 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
15995 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
15996 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
15997 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
15998 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
15999 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
16000 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
16001 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
16002 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
16003 @var{address} as an expression.
16004
16005 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
16006 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
16007 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
16008 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
16009 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
16010
16011 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
16012 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
16013 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
16014 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
16015 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
16016 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
16017 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
16018 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
16019 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
16020
16021 @itemize @bullet
16022 @item
16023 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
16024 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
16025 @item
16026 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
16027 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
16028 @item
16029 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
16030 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
16031 @end itemize
16032
16033 @noindent
16034 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
16035 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
16036 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
16037 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
16038 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
16039 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
16040 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
16041 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
16042 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
16043 way.
16044
16045 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
16046
16047 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
16048 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
16049 @cindex load symbols from memory
16050 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
16051 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
16052 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
16053 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
16054 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
16055 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
16056 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
16057 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
16058 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
16059
16060 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
16061 @kindex assf
16062 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
16063 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
16064 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
16065 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
16066 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
16067 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
16068 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
16069 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
16070 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
16071 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
16072
16073 @kindex section
16074 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
16075 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
16076 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
16077 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
16078 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
16079 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
16080 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
16081 their addresses.
16082
16083 @kindex info files
16084 @kindex info target
16085 @item info files
16086 @itemx info target
16087 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
16088 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
16089 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
16090 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
16091 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
16092 current ones.
16093
16094 @kindex maint info sections
16095 @item maint info sections
16096 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
16097 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
16098 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
16099 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
16100 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
16101 may be arbitrarily combined):
16102
16103 @table @code
16104 @item ALLOBJ
16105 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
16106 @item @var{sections}
16107 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
16108 @item @var{section-flags}
16109 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
16110 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
16111 @table @code
16112 @item ALLOC
16113 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
16114 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
16115 @item LOAD
16116 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
16117 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
16118 @item RELOC
16119 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
16120 @item READONLY
16121 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
16122 @item CODE
16123 Section contains executable code only.
16124 @item DATA
16125 Section contains data only (no executable code).
16126 @item ROM
16127 Section will reside in ROM.
16128 @item CONSTRUCTOR
16129 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
16130 @item HAS_CONTENTS
16131 Section is not empty.
16132 @item NEVER_LOAD
16133 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
16134 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
16135 A notification to the linker that the section contains
16136 COFF shared library information.
16137 @item IS_COMMON
16138 Section contains common symbols.
16139 @end table
16140 @end table
16141 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
16142 @cindex read-only sections
16143 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
16144 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
16145 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
16146 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
16147 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
16148 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
16149 enhancement to debugging performance.
16150
16151 The default is off.
16152
16153 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
16154 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
16155 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
16156 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
16157
16158 @item show trust-readonly-sections
16159 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
16160 @end table
16161
16162 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
16163 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
16164 name and remembers it that way.
16165
16166 @cindex shared libraries
16167 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
16168 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
16169 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
16170
16171 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
16172 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
16173
16174 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
16175 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
16176 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
16177 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
16178 debugging a core file).
16179
16180 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
16181 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
16182
16183 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
16184 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
16185 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
16186
16187 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
16188 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
16189 particularly large or there are many of them.
16190
16191 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
16192 commands:
16193
16194 @table @code
16195 @kindex set auto-solib-add
16196 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
16197 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
16198 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
16199 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
16200 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
16201 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
16202 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
16203
16204 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
16205 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
16206 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
16207 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
16208 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
16209 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
16210 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
16211 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
16212 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
16213
16214 @kindex show auto-solib-add
16215 @item show auto-solib-add
16216 Display the current autoloading mode.
16217 @end table
16218
16219 @cindex load shared library
16220 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
16221 command:
16222
16223 @table @code
16224 @kindex info sharedlibrary
16225 @kindex info share
16226 @item info share @var{regex}
16227 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
16228 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
16229 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
16230 all shared libraries that are loaded.
16231
16232 @kindex sharedlibrary
16233 @kindex share
16234 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
16235 @itemx share @var{regex}
16236 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
16237 Unix regular expression.
16238 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
16239 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
16240 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
16241 loaded.
16242
16243 @item nosharedlibrary
16244 @kindex nosharedlibrary
16245 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
16246 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
16247 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
16248 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
16249 discarded.
16250 @end table
16251
16252 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
16253 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
16254 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
16255 Catchpoints}).
16256
16257 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
16258 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
16259 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
16260 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
16261
16262 @table @code
16263 @item set stop-on-solib-events
16264 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
16265 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
16266 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
16267 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
16268 shared library.
16269
16270 @item show stop-on-solib-events
16271 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
16272 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
16273 library events happen.
16274 @end table
16275
16276 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
16277 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
16278 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
16279 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
16280 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
16281 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
16282 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
16283 not.
16284
16285 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
16286 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
16287 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
16288 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
16289 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
16290
16291 @table @code
16292 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
16293 @cindex system root, alternate
16294 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
16295 @kindex set sysroot
16296 @item set sysroot @var{path}
16297 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
16298 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
16299 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
16300 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
16301 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
16302 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
16303 under @var{path}.
16304
16305 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
16306 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
16307 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
16308 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
16309 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
16310 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
16311 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
16312 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
16313 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
16314
16315 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
16316 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
16317 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
16318 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
16319 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
16320
16321 @smallexample
16322 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
16323 @end smallexample
16324
16325 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
16326 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
16327 system:
16328
16329 @smallexample
16330 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
16331 @end smallexample
16332
16333 If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing
16334 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
16335 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
16336 colons:
16337
16338 @smallexample
16339 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
16340 @end smallexample
16341
16342 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
16343 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
16344 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
16345 @samp{z}):
16346
16347 @smallexample
16348 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
16349 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
16350 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
16351 @end smallexample
16352
16353 @noindent
16354 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
16355 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
16356 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
16357
16358 If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries
16359 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
16360
16361 @smallexample
16362 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
16363 @end smallexample
16364
16365 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
16366 if you don't want or need to.
16367
16368 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
16369 sysroot}.
16370
16371 @cindex default system root
16372 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
16373 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
16374 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
16375 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
16376 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
16377 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
16378 location.
16379
16380 @kindex show sysroot
16381 @item show sysroot
16382 Display the current shared library prefix.
16383
16384 @kindex set solib-search-path
16385 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
16386 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
16387 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
16388 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
16389 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
16390 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
16391 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
16392 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
16393 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
16394 of shared library symbols.
16395
16396 @kindex show solib-search-path
16397 @item show solib-search-path
16398 Display the current shared library search path.
16399
16400 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
16401 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
16402 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
16403 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
16404 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
16405
16406 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
16407 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
16408 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
16409 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
16410 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
16411 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
16412 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
16413 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
16414 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
16415 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
16416 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
16417 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
16418 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
16419 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
16420 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
16421 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
16422 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
16423 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
16424 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
16425 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
16426 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
16427 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
16428
16429 @table @code
16430 @item unix
16431 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
16432 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
16433 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
16434 the forward slash.
16435
16436 @item dos-based
16437 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
16438 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
16439 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
16440 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
16441 considered directory separators.
16442
16443 @item auto
16444 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
16445 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
16446 This is the default.
16447 @end table
16448 @end table
16449
16450 @cindex file name canonicalization
16451 @cindex base name differences
16452 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
16453 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
16454 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
16455 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
16456 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
16457 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
16458 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
16459 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
16460 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
16461 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
16462 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
16463 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
16464 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
16465 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
16466 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
16467
16468 @table @code
16469 @item set basenames-may-differ
16470 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
16471 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
16472
16473 @item show basenames-may-differ
16474 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
16475 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
16476 @end table
16477
16478 @node Separate Debug Files
16479 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
16480 @cindex separate debugging information files
16481 @cindex debugging information in separate files
16482 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
16483 @cindex debugging information directory, global
16484 @cindex global debugging information directories
16485 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
16486 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
16487
16488 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
16489 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
16490 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
16491 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
16492 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
16493 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
16494 install only when they need to debug a problem.
16495
16496 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
16497 file:
16498
16499 @itemize @bullet
16500 @item
16501 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
16502 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
16503 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
16504 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
16505 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
16506 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
16507 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
16508 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
16509
16510 @item
16511 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
16512 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
16513 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
16514 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
16515 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
16516 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
16517 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
16518 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
16519 below.
16520 @end itemize
16521
16522 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
16523 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
16524
16525 @itemize @bullet
16526 @item
16527 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
16528 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
16529 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
16530 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
16531 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
16532
16533 @item
16534 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
16535 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
16536 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
16537 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
16538 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
16539 hex characters, not 10.)
16540 @end itemize
16541
16542 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
16543 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
16544 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
16545 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
16546 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
16547 debug information files, in the indicated order:
16548
16549 @itemize @minus
16550 @item
16551 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
16552 @item
16553 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
16554 @item
16555 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
16556 @item
16557 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
16558 @end itemize
16559
16560 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
16561 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
16562 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
16563 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
16564 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
16565
16566 @table @code
16567
16568 @kindex set debug-file-directory
16569 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
16570 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
16571 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
16572 concatenating them by a path separator.
16573
16574 @kindex show debug-file-directory
16575 @item show debug-file-directory
16576 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
16577 information files.
16578
16579 @end table
16580
16581 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
16582 @cindex debug link sections
16583 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
16584 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
16585
16586 @itemize
16587 @item
16588 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
16589 a zero byte,
16590 @item
16591 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
16592 boundary within the section, and
16593 @item
16594 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
16595 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
16596 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
16597 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
16598 @end itemize
16599
16600 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
16601 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
16602 described above.
16603
16604 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
16605 @cindex build ID sections
16606 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
16607 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
16608 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
16609 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
16610 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
16611 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
16612 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
16613 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
16614 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
16615
16616 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
16617 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
16618 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
16619 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
16620 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
16621 in an ordinary executable.
16622
16623 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
16624 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
16625 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
16626 following commands:
16627
16628 @smallexample
16629 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
16630 @kbd{strip -g foo}
16631 @end smallexample
16632
16633 @noindent
16634 These commands remove the debugging
16635 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
16636 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
16637 two files:
16638
16639 @itemize @bullet
16640 @item
16641 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
16642 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
16643
16644 @smallexample
16645 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
16646 @end smallexample
16647
16648 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
16649 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
16650 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
16651 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
16652
16653 @item
16654 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
16655 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
16656 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
16657 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
16658 @end itemize
16659
16660 @noindent
16661
16662 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
16663 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
16664 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
16665
16666 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
16667 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
16668 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
16669 @c different ways!
16670 @ifhtml
16671 @display
16672 @html
16673 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
16674 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
16675 @end html
16676 @end display
16677 @end ifhtml
16678 @ifnothtml
16679 @display
16680 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
16681 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
16682 @end display
16683 @end ifnothtml
16684
16685 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
16686 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
16687 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
16688 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
16689 CRC.
16690
16691 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
16692 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{Remote Protocol,
16693 , @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol}). However in the
16694 case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed @emph{most}
16695 significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so trailing
16696 zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
16697
16698 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
16699 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
16700 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
16701 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
16702 @code{0xffffffff}.
16703
16704 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
16705 @smallexample
16706 unsigned long
16707 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
16708 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
16709 @{
16710 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
16711 @{
16712 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
16713 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
16714 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
16715 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
16716 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
16717 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
16718 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
16719 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
16720 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
16721 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
16722 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
16723 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
16724 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
16725 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
16726 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
16727 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
16728 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
16729 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
16730 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
16731 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
16732 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
16733 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
16734 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
16735 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
16736 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
16737 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
16738 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
16739 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
16740 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
16741 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
16742 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
16743 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
16744 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
16745 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
16746 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
16747 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
16748 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
16749 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
16750 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
16751 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
16752 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
16753 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
16754 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
16755 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
16756 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
16757 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
16758 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
16759 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
16760 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
16761 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
16762 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
16763 0x2d02ef8d
16764 @};
16765 unsigned char *end;
16766
16767 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
16768 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
16769 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
16770 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
16771 @}
16772 @end smallexample
16773
16774 @noindent
16775 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
16776
16777
16778 @node Index Files
16779 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
16780 @cindex index files
16781 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
16782
16783 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
16784 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
16785 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
16786 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
16787 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
16788 startup.
16789
16790 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
16791 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
16792 using @command{objcopy}.
16793
16794 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
16795
16796 @table @code
16797 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
16798 @kindex save gdb-index
16799 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
16800 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
16801 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
16802 @var{directory}.
16803 @end table
16804
16805 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
16806 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
16807
16808 @smallexample
16809 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
16810 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
16811 @end smallexample
16812
16813 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
16814 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
16815 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
16816 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
16817 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
16818 The default is @code{off}.
16819 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
16820 @xref{Index Section Format}.
16821
16822 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
16823 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
16824
16825 @smallexample
16826 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
16827 @end smallexample
16828
16829 Instead you must do, for example,
16830
16831 @smallexample
16832 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
16833 @end smallexample
16834
16835 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
16836 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
16837 currently work for programs using Ada.
16838
16839 @node Symbol Errors
16840 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
16841
16842 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
16843 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
16844 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
16845 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
16846 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
16847 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
16848 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
16849 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
16850 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
16851 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
16852 Messages}).
16853
16854 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
16855
16856 @table @code
16857 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
16858
16859 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
16860 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
16861 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
16862 in its outer scope blocks.
16863
16864 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
16865 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
16866 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
16867 function.
16868
16869 @item block at @var{address} out of order
16870
16871 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
16872 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
16873 do so.
16874
16875 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
16876 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
16877 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
16878 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
16879 Messages}.)
16880
16881 @item bad block start address patched
16882
16883 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
16884 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
16885 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
16886
16887 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
16888 starting on the previous source line.
16889
16890 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
16891
16892 @cindex foo
16893 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
16894 larger than the size of the string table.
16895
16896 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
16897 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
16898 with this name.
16899
16900 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
16901
16902 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
16903 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
16904 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
16905
16906 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
16907 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
16908 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
16909 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
16910 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
16911 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
16912
16913 @item stub type has NULL name
16914
16915 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
16916
16917 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
16918 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
16919 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
16920 it.
16921
16922 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
16923
16924 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
16925
16926 @end table
16927
16928 @node Data Files
16929 @section GDB Data Files
16930
16931 @cindex prefix for data files
16932 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
16933 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
16934
16935 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
16936 is currently using.
16937
16938 @table @code
16939 @kindex set data-directory
16940 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
16941 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
16942 to @var{directory}.
16943
16944 @kindex show data-directory
16945 @item show data-directory
16946 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
16947 @end table
16948
16949 @cindex default data directory
16950 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
16951 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
16952 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
16953 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
16954 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
16955 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
16956 location.
16957
16958 The data directory may also be specified with the
16959 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
16960 @xref{Mode Options}.
16961
16962 @node Targets
16963 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
16964
16965 @cindex debugging target
16966 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
16967
16968 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
16969 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
16970 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
16971 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
16972 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
16973 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
16974 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
16975 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
16976
16977 @cindex target architecture
16978 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
16979 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
16980 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
16981 command.
16982
16983 @table @code
16984 @kindex set architecture
16985 @kindex show architecture
16986 @item set architecture @var{arch}
16987 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
16988 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
16989 supported architectures.
16990
16991 @item show architecture
16992 Show the current target architecture.
16993
16994 @item set processor
16995 @itemx processor
16996 @kindex set processor
16997 @kindex show processor
16998 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
16999 and @code{show architecture}.
17000 @end table
17001
17002 @menu
17003 * Active Targets:: Active targets
17004 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
17005 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
17006 @end menu
17007
17008 @node Active Targets
17009 @section Active Targets
17010
17011 @cindex stacking targets
17012 @cindex active targets
17013 @cindex multiple targets
17014
17015 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
17016 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
17017 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
17018 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
17019 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
17020 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
17021 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
17022 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
17023 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
17024
17025 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
17026 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
17027 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
17028 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
17029
17030 @node Target Commands
17031 @section Commands for Managing Targets
17032
17033 @table @code
17034 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
17035 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
17036 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
17037 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
17038 protocol of the target machine.
17039
17040 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
17041 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
17042 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
17043
17044 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
17045 after executing the command.
17046
17047 @kindex help target
17048 @item help target
17049 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
17050 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
17051 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
17052
17053 @item help target @var{name}
17054 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
17055 select it.
17056
17057 @kindex set gnutarget
17058 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
17059 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
17060 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
17061 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
17062 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
17063 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
17064
17065 @quotation
17066 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
17067 you must know the actual BFD name.
17068 @end quotation
17069
17070 @noindent
17071 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
17072
17073 @kindex show gnutarget
17074 @item show gnutarget
17075 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
17076 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
17077 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
17078 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
17079 @end table
17080
17081 @cindex common targets
17082 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
17083 configuration):
17084
17085 @table @code
17086 @kindex target
17087 @item target exec @var{program}
17088 @cindex executable file target
17089 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
17090 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
17091
17092 @item target core @var{filename}
17093 @cindex core dump file target
17094 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
17095 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
17096
17097 @item target remote @var{medium}
17098 @cindex remote target
17099 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
17100 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
17101 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
17102
17103 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
17104 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
17105
17106 @smallexample
17107 target remote /dev/ttya
17108 @end smallexample
17109
17110 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
17111 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
17112 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
17113 clobbered by the download.
17114
17115 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
17116 @cindex built-in simulator target
17117 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
17118 In general,
17119 @smallexample
17120 target sim
17121 load
17122 run
17123 @end smallexample
17124 @noindent
17125 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
17126 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
17127 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
17128 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
17129 Processors}.
17130
17131 @end table
17132
17133 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
17134
17135 @table @code
17136
17137 @item target nrom @var{dev}
17138 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
17139 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
17140
17141 @end table
17142
17143 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
17144 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
17145
17146 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
17147 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
17148 various aspects of this process.
17149
17150 @table @code
17151
17152 @item set hash
17153 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
17154 @cindex hash mark while downloading
17155 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
17156 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
17157 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
17158 monitor.
17159
17160 @item show hash
17161 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
17162 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
17163
17164 @item set debug monitor
17165 @kindex set debug monitor
17166 @cindex display remote monitor communications
17167 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
17168 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
17169
17170 @item show debug monitor
17171 @kindex show debug monitor
17172 Show the current status of displaying communications between
17173 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
17174 @end table
17175
17176 @table @code
17177
17178 @kindex load @var{filename}
17179 @item load @var{filename}
17180 @anchor{load}
17181 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
17182 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
17183 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
17184 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
17185 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
17186 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
17187
17188 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
17189 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
17190 target is @dots{}}''
17191
17192 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
17193 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
17194 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
17195 specifies a fixed address.
17196 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
17197
17198 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
17199 load programs into flash memory.
17200
17201 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
17202 @end table
17203
17204 @node Byte Order
17205 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
17206
17207 @cindex choosing target byte order
17208 @cindex target byte order
17209
17210 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
17211 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
17212 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
17213 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
17214 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
17215 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
17216
17217 @table @code
17218 @kindex set endian
17219 @item set endian big
17220 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
17221
17222 @item set endian little
17223 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
17224
17225 @item set endian auto
17226 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
17227 executable.
17228
17229 @item show endian
17230 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
17231
17232 @end table
17233
17234 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
17235 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
17236 target system.
17237
17238
17239 @node Remote Debugging
17240 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
17241 @cindex remote debugging
17242
17243 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
17244 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
17245 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
17246 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
17247 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
17248
17249 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
17250 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
17251 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
17252 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
17253 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
17254 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
17255
17256 Other remote targets may be available in your
17257 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
17258
17259 @menu
17260 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
17261 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
17262 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
17263 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
17264 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
17265 @end menu
17266
17267 @node Connecting
17268 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
17269
17270 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
17271 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
17272 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
17273 program as the first argument.
17274
17275 @cindex @code{target remote}
17276 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
17277 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
17278 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
17279 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
17280 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
17281 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
17282
17283 @table @code
17284
17285 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
17286 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
17287 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
17288 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
17289
17290 @smallexample
17291 target remote /dev/ttyb
17292 @end smallexample
17293
17294 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
17295 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
17296 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
17297 @code{target} command.
17298
17299 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
17300 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
17301 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
17302 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
17303 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
17304 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
17305 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
17306 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
17307 target.
17308
17309 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
17310 @code{manyfarms}:
17311
17312 @smallexample
17313 target remote manyfarms:2828
17314 @end smallexample
17315
17316 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
17317 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
17318 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
17319 port 1234 on your local machine:
17320
17321 @smallexample
17322 target remote :1234
17323 @end smallexample
17324 @noindent
17325
17326 Note that the colon is still required here.
17327
17328 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
17329 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
17330 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
17331 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
17332
17333 @smallexample
17334 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
17335 @end smallexample
17336
17337 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
17338 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
17339 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
17340 cause havoc with your debugging session.
17341
17342 @item target remote | @var{command}
17343 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
17344 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
17345 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
17346 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
17347 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
17348 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
17349 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
17350 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
17351
17352 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
17353 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
17354 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
17355
17356 @end table
17357
17358 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
17359 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
17360 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
17361 need to use @kbd{run}.
17362
17363 @cindex interrupting remote programs
17364 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
17365 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
17366 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
17367 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
17368 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
17369 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
17370
17371 @smallexample
17372 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
17373 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
17374 @end smallexample
17375
17376 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
17377 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
17378 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
17379 goes back to waiting.
17380
17381 @table @code
17382 @kindex detach (remote)
17383 @item detach
17384 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
17385 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
17386 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
17387 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
17388 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
17389
17390 @kindex disconnect
17391 @item disconnect
17392 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
17393 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
17394 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
17395 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
17396 another target.
17397
17398 @cindex send command to remote monitor
17399 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
17400 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
17401 @kindex monitor
17402 @item monitor @var{cmd}
17403 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
17404 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
17405 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
17406 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
17407 and implement.
17408 @end table
17409
17410 @node File Transfer
17411 @section Sending files to a remote system
17412 @cindex remote target, file transfer
17413 @cindex file transfer
17414 @cindex sending files to remote systems
17415
17416 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
17417 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
17418 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
17419 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
17420 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
17421 the only way to upload or download files.
17422
17423 Not all remote targets support these commands.
17424
17425 @table @code
17426 @kindex remote put
17427 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
17428 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
17429 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
17430
17431 @kindex remote get
17432 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
17433 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
17434 on the host system.
17435
17436 @kindex remote delete
17437 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
17438 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
17439
17440 @end table
17441
17442 @node Server
17443 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
17444
17445 @kindex gdbserver
17446 @cindex remote connection without stubs
17447 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
17448 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
17449 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
17450
17451 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
17452 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
17453 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
17454 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
17455 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
17456 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
17457 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
17458 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
17459 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
17460 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
17461 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
17462 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
17463 choice for debugging.
17464
17465 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
17466 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
17467 protocol.
17468
17469 @quotation
17470 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
17471 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
17472 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
17473 target system with the same privileges as the user running
17474 @code{gdbserver}.
17475 @end quotation
17476
17477 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
17478 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
17479 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
17480
17481 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
17482 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
17483 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
17484 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
17485 system does all the symbol handling.
17486
17487 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
17488 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
17489 syntax is:
17490
17491 @smallexample
17492 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
17493 @end smallexample
17494
17495 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
17496 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
17497 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
17498 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
17499 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
17500 @file{/dev/com1}:
17501
17502 @smallexample
17503 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
17504 @end smallexample
17505
17506 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
17507 with it.
17508
17509 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
17510
17511 @smallexample
17512 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
17513 @end smallexample
17514
17515 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
17516 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
17517 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
17518 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
17519 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
17520 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
17521 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
17522 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
17523 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
17524 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
17525 @code{target remote} command.
17526
17527 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
17528 with ssh:
17529
17530 @smallexample
17531 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
17532 @end smallexample
17533
17534 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
17535 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
17536 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
17537 You could elide it if you want to.
17538
17539 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
17540 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
17541 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
17542 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
17543
17544 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
17545 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
17546 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
17547
17548 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
17549 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
17550
17551 @smallexample
17552 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
17553 @end smallexample
17554
17555 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
17556 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
17557
17558 @pindex pidof
17559 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
17560 @code{pidof} utility:
17561
17562 @smallexample
17563 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
17564 @end smallexample
17565
17566 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
17567 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
17568 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
17569
17570 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
17571 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, multiple processes
17572 @cindex multiple processes with @code{gdbserver}
17573
17574 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
17575 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
17576 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
17577 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
17578
17579 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
17580 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
17581 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
17582 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
17583 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
17584 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
17585 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
17586 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
17587 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
17588
17589 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
17590 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
17591 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
17592 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
17593 the program you want to debug.
17594
17595 In multi-process mode @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit unless you
17596 use the option @option{--once}. You can terminate it by using
17597 @code{monitor exit} (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). Note that the
17598 conditions under which @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN}
17599 connects to it (@kbd{target remote} or @kbd{target extended-remote}). The
17600 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
17601
17602 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
17603
17604 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP port.
17605
17606 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
17607 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
17608 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
17609 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
17610 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
17611 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
17612 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
17613 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
17614
17615 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
17616 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
17617 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
17618
17619 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
17620 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
17621 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
17622 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
17623 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
17624 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
17625 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
17626 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
17627 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
17628 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
17629 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
17630 instance closes its port after the first connection.
17631
17632 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
17633
17634 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
17635 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
17636 status information about the debugging process.
17637 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
17638 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
17639 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
17640 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
17641
17642 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
17643 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
17644 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
17645 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
17646 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
17647
17648 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
17649 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
17650 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
17651 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
17652
17653 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
17654 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
17655 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
17656 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
17657
17658 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
17659 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
17660 environment:
17661
17662 @smallexample
17663 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
17664 @end smallexample
17665
17666 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
17667
17668 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
17669
17670 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
17671 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
17672 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
17673 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
17674
17675 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
17676 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
17677 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
17678 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
17679 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
17680 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
17681 programs.
17682
17683 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
17684 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
17685 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
17686 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
17687 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
17688 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
17689 already on the target.
17690
17691 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
17692 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
17693 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
17694
17695 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
17696 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
17697 Here are the available commands.
17698
17699 @table @code
17700 @item monitor help
17701 List the available monitor commands.
17702
17703 @item monitor set debug 0
17704 @itemx monitor set debug 1
17705 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
17706
17707 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
17708 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
17709 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
17710 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
17711
17712 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
17713 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
17714 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
17715 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
17716 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
17717 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
17718
17719 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
17720 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
17721
17722 @item monitor exit
17723 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
17724 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
17725 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
17726 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
17727 of a multi-process mode debug session.
17728
17729 @end table
17730
17731 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
17732 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
17733
17734 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
17735 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
17736
17737 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
17738 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
17739 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
17740 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
17741 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
17742 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
17743 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
17744 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
17745 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
17746 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
17747 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
17748 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
17749
17750 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
17751
17752 @table @code
17753 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
17754
17755 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
17756 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
17757 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
17758
17759 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
17760
17761 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
17762 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
17763 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
17764 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
17765 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
17766 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
17767
17768 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
17769
17770 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
17771 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
17772 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
17773 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
17774 command for that. For example:
17775
17776 @smallexample
17777 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
17778 @end smallexample
17779
17780 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
17781 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
17782 @end table
17783
17784 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
17785 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
17786 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
17787 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
17788 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
17789 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
17790 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
17791 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
17792 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
17793 @code{gdbserver} like so:
17794
17795 @smallexample
17796 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
17797 @end smallexample
17798
17799 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
17800
17801 @smallexample
17802 $ gdb myprogram
17803 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
17804 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
17805 (@value{GDBP}) b main
17806 (@value{GDBP}) continue
17807 @end smallexample
17808
17809 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
17810 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
17811 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
17812 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
17813 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
17814 tracing.
17815
17816 @node Remote Configuration
17817 @section Remote Configuration
17818
17819 @kindex set remote
17820 @kindex show remote
17821 This section documents the configuration options available when
17822 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
17823 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
17824 system-call-allowed}.
17825
17826 @table @code
17827 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
17828 @cindex address size for remote targets
17829 @cindex bits in remote address
17830 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
17831 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
17832 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
17833 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
17834
17835 @item show remoteaddresssize
17836 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
17837
17838 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
17839 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
17840 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
17841 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
17842 remote targets.
17843
17844 @item show remotebaud
17845 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
17846
17847 @item set remotebreak
17848 @cindex interrupt remote programs
17849 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
17850 @anchor{set remotebreak}
17851 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
17852 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
17853 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
17854 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
17855 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
17856
17857 @item show remotebreak
17858 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
17859 interrupt the remote program.
17860
17861 @item set remoteflow on
17862 @itemx set remoteflow off
17863 @kindex set remoteflow
17864 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
17865 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
17866
17867 @item show remoteflow
17868 @kindex show remoteflow
17869 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
17870
17871 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
17872 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
17873 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
17874 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
17875 @code{ascii}.
17876
17877 @item show remotelogbase
17878 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
17879 protocol.
17880
17881 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
17882 @cindex record serial communications on file
17883 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
17884 default is not to record at all.
17885
17886 @item show remotelogfile.
17887 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
17888 serial communications.
17889
17890 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
17891 @cindex timeout for serial communications
17892 @cindex remote timeout
17893 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
17894 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
17895
17896 @item show remotetimeout
17897 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
17898 responses.
17899
17900 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
17901 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
17902 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
17903 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
17904 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
17905 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
17906 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
17907 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
17908
17909 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
17910 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
17911 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
17912 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
17913 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
17914 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
17915 as unlimited.
17916
17917 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
17918 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
17919 a remote hardware watchpoint.
17920
17921 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
17922 @itemx show remote exec-file
17923 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
17924 @cindex executable file, for remote target
17925 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
17926 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
17927 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
17928 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
17929
17930 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
17931 @cindex interrupt remote programs
17932 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
17933 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
17934 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
17935 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
17936 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
17937 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
17938 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
17939 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
17940
17941 @item show interrupt-sequence
17942 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
17943 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
17944 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
17945 also known as Magic SysRq g.
17946
17947 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
17948 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
17949 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
17950 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
17951 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
17952 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
17953
17954 @item show interrupt-on-connect
17955 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
17956 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
17957
17958 @kindex set tcp
17959 @kindex show tcp
17960 @item set tcp auto-retry on
17961 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
17962 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
17963 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
17964 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
17965 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
17966 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
17967 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
17968 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
17969
17970 @item set tcp auto-retry off
17971 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
17972
17973 @item show tcp auto-retry
17974 Show the current auto-retry setting.
17975
17976 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
17977 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
17978 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
17979 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
17980 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
17981 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
17982 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
17983 value.
17984
17985 @item show tcp connect-timeout
17986 Show the current connection timeout setting.
17987 @end table
17988
17989 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
17990 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
17991 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
17992 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
17993 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
17994 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
17995 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
17996 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
17997 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
17998
17999 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
18000 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
18001 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
18002 @value{GDBN} developers.
18003
18004 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
18005 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
18006 are:
18007
18008 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
18009 @item Command Name
18010 @tab Remote Packet
18011 @tab Related Features
18012
18013 @item @code{fetch-register}
18014 @tab @code{p}
18015 @tab @code{info registers}
18016
18017 @item @code{set-register}
18018 @tab @code{P}
18019 @tab @code{set}
18020
18021 @item @code{binary-download}
18022 @tab @code{X}
18023 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
18024
18025 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
18026 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
18027 @tab @code{info auxv}
18028
18029 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
18030 @tab @code{qSymbol}
18031 @tab Detecting multiple threads
18032
18033 @item @code{attach}
18034 @tab @code{vAttach}
18035 @tab @code{attach}
18036
18037 @item @code{verbose-resume}
18038 @tab @code{vCont}
18039 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
18040
18041 @item @code{run}
18042 @tab @code{vRun}
18043 @tab @code{run}
18044
18045 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
18046 @tab @code{Z0}
18047 @tab @code{break}
18048
18049 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
18050 @tab @code{Z1}
18051 @tab @code{hbreak}
18052
18053 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
18054 @tab @code{Z2}
18055 @tab @code{watch}
18056
18057 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
18058 @tab @code{Z3}
18059 @tab @code{rwatch}
18060
18061 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
18062 @tab @code{Z4}
18063 @tab @code{awatch}
18064
18065 @item @code{target-features}
18066 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
18067 @tab @code{set architecture}
18068
18069 @item @code{library-info}
18070 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
18071 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
18072
18073 @item @code{memory-map}
18074 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
18075 @tab @code{info mem}
18076
18077 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
18078 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
18079 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
18080
18081 @item @code{read-spu-object}
18082 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
18083 @tab @code{info spu}
18084
18085 @item @code{write-spu-object}
18086 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
18087 @tab @code{info spu}
18088
18089 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
18090 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
18091 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
18092
18093 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
18094 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
18095 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
18096
18097 @item @code{threads}
18098 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
18099 @tab @code{info threads}
18100
18101 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
18102 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
18103 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
18104
18105 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
18106 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
18107 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
18108
18109 @item @code{search-memory}
18110 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
18111 @tab @code{find}
18112
18113 @item @code{supported-packets}
18114 @tab @code{qSupported}
18115 @tab Remote communications parameters
18116
18117 @item @code{pass-signals}
18118 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
18119 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
18120
18121 @item @code{program-signals}
18122 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
18123 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
18124
18125 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
18126 @tab @code{vFile:close}
18127 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
18128
18129 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
18130 @tab @code{vFile:open}
18131 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
18132
18133 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
18134 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
18135 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
18136
18137 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
18138 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
18139 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
18140
18141 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
18142 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
18143 @tab @code{remote delete}
18144
18145 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
18146 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
18147 @tab Host I/O
18148
18149 @item @code{noack-packet}
18150 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
18151 @tab Packet acknowledgment
18152
18153 @item @code{osdata}
18154 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
18155 @tab @code{info os}
18156
18157 @item @code{query-attached}
18158 @tab @code{qAttached}
18159 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
18160
18161 @item @code{traceframe-info}
18162 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
18163 @tab Traceframe info
18164
18165 @item @code{install-in-trace}
18166 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
18167 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
18168
18169 @item @code{disable-randomization}
18170 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
18171 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
18172
18173 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
18174 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
18175 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
18176 @end multitable
18177
18178 @node Remote Stub
18179 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
18180
18181 @cindex debugging stub, example
18182 @cindex remote stub, example
18183 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
18184 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
18185 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
18186 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
18187 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
18188 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
18189 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
18190 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
18191
18192 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
18193 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
18194 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
18195 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
18196 program, you need:
18197
18198 @enumerate
18199 @item
18200 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
18201 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
18202 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
18203
18204 @item
18205 A C subroutine library to support your program's
18206 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
18207
18208 @item
18209 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
18210 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
18211 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
18212 documentation.
18213 @end enumerate
18214
18215 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
18216 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
18217 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
18218
18219 @table @emph
18220 @item On the host,
18221 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
18222 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
18223 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
18224
18225 @item On the target,
18226 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
18227 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
18228 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
18229
18230 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
18231 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
18232 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
18233 @end table
18234
18235 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
18236 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
18237 @sc{sparc} boards.
18238
18239 @cindex remote serial stub list
18240 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
18241
18242 @table @code
18243
18244 @item i386-stub.c
18245 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
18246 @cindex Intel
18247 @cindex i386
18248 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
18249
18250 @item m68k-stub.c
18251 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
18252 @cindex Motorola 680x0
18253 @cindex m680x0
18254 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
18255
18256 @item sh-stub.c
18257 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
18258 @cindex Renesas
18259 @cindex SH
18260 For Renesas SH architectures.
18261
18262 @item sparc-stub.c
18263 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
18264 @cindex Sparc
18265 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
18266
18267 @item sparcl-stub.c
18268 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
18269 @cindex Fujitsu
18270 @cindex SparcLite
18271 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
18272
18273 @end table
18274
18275 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
18276 recently added stubs.
18277
18278 @menu
18279 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
18280 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
18281 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
18282 @end menu
18283
18284 @node Stub Contents
18285 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
18286
18287 @cindex remote serial stub
18288 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
18289 subroutines:
18290
18291 @table @code
18292 @item set_debug_traps
18293 @findex set_debug_traps
18294 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
18295 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
18296 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
18297 program's startup code.
18298
18299 @item handle_exception
18300 @findex handle_exception
18301 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
18302 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
18303 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
18304 run when a trap is triggered.
18305
18306 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
18307 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
18308 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
18309 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
18310 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
18311 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
18312 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
18313 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
18314 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
18315 machine.
18316
18317 @item breakpoint
18318 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
18319 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
18320 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
18321 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
18322 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
18323 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
18324 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
18325 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
18326 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
18327 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
18328 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
18329
18330 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
18331 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
18332 start of your debugging session.
18333 @end table
18334
18335 @node Bootstrapping
18336 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
18337
18338 @cindex remote stub, support routines
18339 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
18340 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
18341 debugging target machine.
18342
18343 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
18344 serial port.
18345
18346 @table @code
18347 @item int getDebugChar()
18348 @findex getDebugChar
18349 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
18350 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
18351 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
18352
18353 @item void putDebugChar(int)
18354 @findex putDebugChar
18355 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
18356 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
18357 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
18358 @end table
18359
18360 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
18361 @cindex interrupting remote targets
18362 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
18363 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
18364 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
18365 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
18366 remote system to stop.
18367
18368 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
18369 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
18370 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
18371 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
18372
18373 Other routines you need to supply are:
18374
18375 @table @code
18376 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
18377 @findex exceptionHandler
18378 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
18379 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
18380 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
18381 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
18382 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
18383 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
18384 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
18385 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
18386 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
18387 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
18388 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
18389 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
18390 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
18391
18392 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
18393 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
18394 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
18395 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
18396 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
18397
18398 @item void flush_i_cache()
18399 @findex flush_i_cache
18400 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
18401 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
18402 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
18403
18404 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
18405 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
18406 @end table
18407
18408 @noindent
18409 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
18410
18411 @table @code
18412 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
18413 @findex memset
18414 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
18415 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
18416 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
18417 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
18418 @end table
18419
18420 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
18421 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
18422 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
18423 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
18424
18425
18426 @node Debug Session
18427 @subsection Putting it All Together
18428
18429 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
18430 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
18431 steps.
18432
18433 @enumerate
18434 @item
18435 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
18436 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
18437 @display
18438 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
18439 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
18440 @end display
18441
18442 @item
18443 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
18444 procedure is called:
18445
18446 @smallexample
18447 set_debug_traps();
18448 breakpoint();
18449 @end smallexample
18450
18451 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
18452 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
18453 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
18454 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
18455 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
18456 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
18457 progress.
18458
18459 @item
18460 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
18461 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
18462
18463 @smallexample
18464 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
18465 @end smallexample
18466
18467 @noindent
18468 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
18469 function in your program, that function is called when
18470 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
18471 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
18472 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
18473
18474 @item
18475 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
18476 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
18477
18478 @item
18479 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
18480 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
18481
18482 @item
18483 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
18484 @c document that. FIXME.
18485 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
18486 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
18487
18488 @item
18489 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
18490 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
18491
18492 @end enumerate
18493
18494 @node Configurations
18495 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
18496
18497 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
18498 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
18499 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
18500
18501 There are three major categories of configurations: native
18502 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
18503 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
18504 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
18505 are quite different from each other.
18506
18507 @menu
18508 * Native::
18509 * Embedded OS::
18510 * Embedded Processors::
18511 * Architectures::
18512 @end menu
18513
18514 @node Native
18515 @section Native
18516
18517 This section describes details specific to particular native
18518 configurations.
18519
18520 @menu
18521 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
18522 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
18523 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
18524 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
18525 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
18526 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
18527 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
18528 @end menu
18529
18530 @node HP-UX
18531 @subsection HP-UX
18532
18533 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
18534 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
18535 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
18536
18537
18538 @node BSD libkvm Interface
18539 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
18540
18541 @cindex libkvm
18542 @cindex kernel memory image
18543 @cindex kernel crash dump
18544
18545 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
18546 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
18547 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
18548 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
18549 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
18550 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
18551 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
18552 @code{kvm} target:
18553
18554 @smallexample
18555 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
18556 @end smallexample
18557
18558 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
18559 argument:
18560
18561 @smallexample
18562 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
18563 @end smallexample
18564
18565 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
18566 available:
18567
18568 @table @code
18569 @kindex kvm
18570 @item kvm pcb
18571 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
18572
18573 @item kvm proc
18574 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
18575 modern FreeBSD systems.
18576 @end table
18577
18578 @node SVR4 Process Information
18579 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
18580 @cindex /proc
18581 @cindex examine process image
18582 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
18583
18584 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
18585 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
18586 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
18587 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
18588 proc} is available to report information about the process running
18589 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
18590 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
18591 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
18592 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
18593
18594 @table @code
18595 @kindex info proc
18596 @cindex process ID
18597 @item info proc
18598 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
18599 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
18600 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
18601 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
18602 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
18603 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
18604 executable file's absolute file name.
18605
18606 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
18607 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
18608 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
18609 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
18610 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
18611 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
18612
18613 @item info proc mappings
18614 @cindex memory address space mappings
18615 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
18616 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
18617 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
18618 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
18619 memory access rights to that range.
18620
18621 @item info proc stat
18622 @itemx info proc status
18623 @cindex process detailed status information
18624 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
18625 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
18626 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
18627 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
18628 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
18629 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
18630 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
18631
18632 @item info proc all
18633 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
18634 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
18635
18636 @ignore
18637 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
18638 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
18639 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
18640 @kindex info proc times
18641 @item info proc times
18642 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
18643 its children.
18644
18645 @kindex info proc id
18646 @item info proc id
18647 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
18648 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
18649 @end ignore
18650
18651 @item set procfs-trace
18652 @kindex set procfs-trace
18653 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
18654 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
18655
18656 @item show procfs-trace
18657 @kindex show procfs-trace
18658 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
18659
18660 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
18661 @kindex set procfs-file
18662 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
18663 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
18664 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
18665 standard output.
18666
18667 @item show procfs-file
18668 @kindex show procfs-file
18669 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
18670
18671 @item proc-trace-entry
18672 @itemx proc-trace-exit
18673 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
18674 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
18675 @kindex proc-trace-entry
18676 @kindex proc-trace-exit
18677 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
18678 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
18679 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
18680 from the @code{syscall} interface.
18681
18682 @item info pidlist
18683 @kindex info pidlist
18684 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
18685 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
18686 processes and all the threads within each process.
18687
18688 @item info meminfo
18689 @kindex info meminfo
18690 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
18691 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
18692 @end table
18693
18694 @node DJGPP Native
18695 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
18696 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
18697 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
18698 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
18699
18700 @cindex DPMI
18701 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
18702 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
18703 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
18704 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
18705
18706 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
18707 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
18708 subsection describes those commands.
18709
18710 @table @code
18711 @kindex info dos
18712 @item info dos
18713 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
18714 information about the target system and important OS structures.
18715
18716 @kindex sysinfo
18717 @cindex MS-DOS system info
18718 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
18719 @item info dos sysinfo
18720 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
18721 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
18722 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
18723
18724 @cindex GDT
18725 @cindex LDT
18726 @cindex IDT
18727 @cindex segment descriptor tables
18728 @cindex descriptor tables display
18729 @item info dos gdt
18730 @itemx info dos ldt
18731 @itemx info dos idt
18732 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
18733 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
18734 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
18735 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
18736 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
18737 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
18738 rights.
18739
18740 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
18741 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
18742 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
18743 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
18744 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
18745
18746 @cindex garbled pointers
18747 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
18748 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
18749 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
18750 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
18751 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
18752 debugged program's data segment:
18753
18754 @smallexample
18755 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
18756 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
18757 @end smallexample
18758
18759 @noindent
18760 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
18761 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
18762
18763 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
18764 @item info dos pde
18765 @itemx info dos pte
18766 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
18767 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
18768 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
18769 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
18770 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
18771 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
18772 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
18773 that is currently in use.
18774
18775 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
18776 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
18777 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
18778 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
18779 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
18780 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
18781 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
18782
18783 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
18784 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
18785 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
18786 controller.
18787
18788 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
18789
18790 @cindex physical address from linear address
18791 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
18792 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
18793 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
18794 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
18795 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
18796 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
18797 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
18798
18799 @smallexample
18800 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
18801 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
18802 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
18803 @end smallexample
18804
18805 @noindent
18806 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
18807 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
18808 attributes of that page.
18809
18810 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
18811 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
18812 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
18813 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
18814 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
18815 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
18816
18817 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
18818 transfer buffer:
18819
18820 @smallexample
18821 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
18822 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
18823 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
18824 @end smallexample
18825
18826 @noindent
18827 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
18828 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
18829 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
18830 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
18831 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
18832
18833 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
18834 @end table
18835
18836 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
18837 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
18838 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
18839 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
18840
18841 @table @code
18842 @kindex set com1base
18843 @kindex set com1irq
18844 @kindex set com2base
18845 @kindex set com2irq
18846 @kindex set com3base
18847 @kindex set com3irq
18848 @kindex set com4base
18849 @kindex set com4irq
18850 @item set com1base @var{addr}
18851 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
18852 port.
18853
18854 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
18855 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
18856 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
18857
18858 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
18859 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
18860 other 3 COM ports.
18861
18862 @kindex show com1base
18863 @kindex show com1irq
18864 @kindex show com2base
18865 @kindex show com2irq
18866 @kindex show com3base
18867 @kindex show com3irq
18868 @kindex show com4base
18869 @kindex show com4irq
18870 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
18871 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
18872 lines used by the COM ports.
18873
18874 @item info serial
18875 @kindex info serial
18876 @cindex DOS serial port status
18877 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
18878 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
18879 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
18880 counts of various errors encountered so far.
18881 @end table
18882
18883
18884 @node Cygwin Native
18885 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
18886 @cindex MS Windows debugging
18887 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
18888 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
18889
18890 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
18891 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
18892
18893 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
18894 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
18895 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
18896 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
18897 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
18898 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
18899 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
18900 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
18901
18902 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
18903 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
18904 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
18905
18906 @table @code
18907 @kindex info w32
18908 @item info w32
18909 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
18910 information about the target system and important OS structures.
18911
18912 @item info w32 selector
18913 This command displays information returned by
18914 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
18915 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
18916 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
18917 Without argument, this command displays information
18918 about the six segment registers.
18919
18920 @item info w32 thread-information-block
18921 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
18922 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
18923 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
18924
18925 @kindex info dll
18926 @item info dll
18927 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
18928
18929 @kindex dll-symbols
18930 @item dll-symbols
18931 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
18932 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
18933
18934 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
18935 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
18936 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
18937 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
18938 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
18939 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
18940 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
18941 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
18942 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
18943 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
18944 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
18945
18946 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
18947 @item show cygwin-exceptions
18948 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
18949 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
18950
18951 @kindex set new-console
18952 @item set new-console @var{mode}
18953 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
18954 be started in a new console on next start.
18955 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
18956 be started in the same console as the debugger.
18957
18958 @kindex show new-console
18959 @item show new-console
18960 Displays whether a new console is used
18961 when the debuggee is started.
18962
18963 @kindex set new-group
18964 @item set new-group @var{mode}
18965 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
18966 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
18967 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
18968 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
18969
18970 @kindex show new-group
18971 @item show new-group
18972 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
18973
18974 @kindex set debugevents
18975 @item set debugevents
18976 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
18977 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
18978 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
18979 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
18980 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
18981
18982 @kindex set debugexec
18983 @item set debugexec
18984 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
18985 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
18986
18987 @kindex set debugexceptions
18988 @item set debugexceptions
18989 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
18990 debuggee seen by the debugger.
18991
18992 @kindex set debugmemory
18993 @item set debugmemory
18994 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
18995 and writes by the debugger.
18996
18997 @kindex set shell
18998 @item set shell
18999 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
19000 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
19001
19002 @kindex show shell
19003 @item show shell
19004 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
19005
19006 @end table
19007
19008 @menu
19009 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
19010 @end menu
19011
19012 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
19013 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
19014 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
19015 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
19016
19017 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
19018 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
19019 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
19020 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
19021 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
19022 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
19023 ``minimal symbols''.
19024
19025 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
19026 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
19027 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
19028 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
19029 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
19030 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
19031 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
19032 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
19033 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
19034 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
19035
19036 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
19037
19038 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
19039 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
19040 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
19041 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
19042 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
19043 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
19044 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
19045 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
19046 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
19047
19048 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
19049 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
19050 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
19051 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
19052 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
19053 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
19054
19055 @smallexample
19056 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
19057 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
19058
19059 Non-debugging symbols:
19060 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
19061 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
19062 @end smallexample
19063
19064 @smallexample
19065 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
19066 All functions matching regular expression "!":
19067
19068 Non-debugging symbols:
19069 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
19070 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
19071 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
19072 [etc...]
19073 @end smallexample
19074
19075 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
19076
19077 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
19078 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
19079 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
19080 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
19081 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
19082 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
19083 a function within a DLL without a running program.
19084
19085 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
19086 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
19087 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
19088 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
19089 problem:
19090
19091 @smallexample
19092 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
19093 $1 = 268572168
19094 @end smallexample
19095
19096 @smallexample
19097 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
19098 0x10021610: "\230y\""
19099 @end smallexample
19100
19101 And two possible solutions:
19102
19103 @smallexample
19104 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
19105 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
19106 @end smallexample
19107
19108 @smallexample
19109 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
19110 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
19111 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
19112 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
19113 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
19114 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
19115 @end smallexample
19116
19117 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
19118 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
19119 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
19120 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
19121 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
19122
19123 @smallexample
19124 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
19125 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
19126 @end smallexample
19127
19128 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
19129 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
19130 safe.
19131
19132 @node Hurd Native
19133 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
19134 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
19135
19136 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
19137 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
19138
19139 @table @code
19140 @item set signals
19141 @itemx set sigs
19142 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
19143 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
19144 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
19145 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
19146 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
19147 @code{signals}.
19148
19149 @item show signals
19150 @itemx show sigs
19151 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
19152 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
19153 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
19154
19155 @item set signal-thread
19156 @itemx set sigthread
19157 @kindex set signal-thread
19158 @kindex set sigthread
19159 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
19160 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
19161 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
19162 signal-thread}.
19163
19164 @item show signal-thread
19165 @itemx show sigthread
19166 @kindex show signal-thread
19167 @kindex show sigthread
19168 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
19169 delivered a signal.
19170
19171 @item set stopped
19172 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
19173 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
19174 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
19175 continued by delivering a signal to it.
19176
19177 @item show stopped
19178 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
19179 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
19180 stopped.
19181
19182 @item set exceptions
19183 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
19184 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
19185 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
19186 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
19187 trapping on.
19188
19189 @item show exceptions
19190 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
19191 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
19192
19193 @item set task pause
19194 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
19195 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
19196 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
19197 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
19198 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
19199 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
19200 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
19201 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
19202 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
19203
19204 @item show task pause
19205 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
19206 Show the current state of task suspension.
19207
19208 @item set task detach-suspend-count
19209 @cindex task suspend count
19210 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
19211 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
19212 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
19213
19214 @item show task detach-suspend-count
19215 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
19216
19217 @item set task exception-port
19218 @itemx set task excp
19219 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
19220 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
19221 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
19222 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
19223
19224 @item set noninvasive
19225 @cindex noninvasive task options
19226 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
19227 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
19228 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
19229 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
19230
19231 @item info send-rights
19232 @itemx info receive-rights
19233 @itemx info port-rights
19234 @itemx info port-sets
19235 @itemx info dead-names
19236 @itemx info ports
19237 @itemx info psets
19238 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
19239 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
19240 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
19241 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
19242 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
19243 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
19244 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
19245 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
19246 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
19247
19248 @item set thread pause
19249 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
19250 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
19251 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
19252 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
19253 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
19254 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
19255 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
19256 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
19257 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
19258 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
19259 only the current thread.
19260
19261 @item show thread pause
19262 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
19263 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
19264
19265 @item set thread run
19266 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
19267
19268 @item show thread run
19269 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
19270
19271 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
19272 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
19273 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
19274 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
19275 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
19276 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
19277 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
19278
19279 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
19280 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
19281 detaching.
19282
19283 @item set thread exception-port
19284 @itemx set thread excp
19285 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
19286 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
19287 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
19288
19289 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
19290 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
19291 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
19292 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
19293
19294 @item set thread default
19295 @itemx show thread default
19296 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
19297 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
19298 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
19299 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
19300 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
19301 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
19302 the non-default commands.
19303 @end table
19304
19305 @node Darwin
19306 @subsection Darwin
19307 @cindex Darwin
19308
19309 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
19310
19311 @table @code
19312 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
19313 @kindex set debug darwin
19314 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
19315 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
19316
19317 @item show debug darwin
19318 @kindex show debug darwin
19319 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
19320
19321 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
19322 @kindex set debug mach-o
19323 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
19324 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
19325 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
19326 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
19327 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
19328 usage.
19329
19330 @item show debug mach-o
19331 @kindex show debug mach-o
19332 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
19333
19334 @item set mach-exceptions on
19335 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
19336 @kindex set mach-exceptions
19337 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
19338 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
19339 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
19340 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
19341
19342 @item show mach-exceptions
19343 @kindex show mach-exceptions
19344 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
19345 @end table
19346
19347
19348 @node Embedded OS
19349 @section Embedded Operating Systems
19350
19351 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
19352 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
19353 architectures.
19354
19355 @menu
19356 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
19357 @end menu
19358
19359 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
19360 various real-time operating systems.
19361
19362 @node VxWorks
19363 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
19364
19365 @cindex VxWorks
19366
19367 @table @code
19368
19369 @kindex target vxworks
19370 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
19371 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
19372 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
19373
19374 @end table
19375
19376 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
19377 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
19378
19379 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
19380 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
19381 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
19382 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
19383 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
19384 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
19385 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
19386
19387 @table @code
19388 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
19389 @kindex vxworks-timeout
19390 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
19391 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
19392 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
19393 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
19394 of a thin network line.
19395 @end table
19396
19397 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
19398 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
19399 procedures.
19400
19401 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
19402 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
19403 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
19404 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
19405 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
19406 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
19407 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
19408 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
19409 manual.
19410 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
19411
19412 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
19413 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
19414 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
19415 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
19416
19417 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
19418
19419 @smallexample
19420 (vxgdb)
19421 @end smallexample
19422
19423 @menu
19424 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
19425 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
19426 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
19427 @end menu
19428
19429 @node VxWorks Connection
19430 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
19431
19432 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
19433 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
19434
19435 @smallexample
19436 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
19437 @end smallexample
19438
19439 @need 750
19440 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
19441
19442 @smallexample
19443 Attaching remote machine across net...
19444 Connected to tt.
19445 @end smallexample
19446
19447 @need 1000
19448 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
19449 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
19450 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
19451 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
19452 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
19453
19454 @smallexample
19455 prog.o: No such file or directory.
19456 @end smallexample
19457
19458 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
19459 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
19460 command again.
19461
19462 @node VxWorks Download
19463 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
19464
19465 @cindex download to VxWorks
19466 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
19467 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
19468 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
19469 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
19470 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
19471 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
19472 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
19473 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
19474 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
19475 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
19476 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
19477 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
19478 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
19479 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
19480 program, type this on VxWorks:
19481
19482 @smallexample
19483 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
19484 @end smallexample
19485
19486 @noindent
19487 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
19488
19489 @smallexample
19490 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
19491 (vxgdb) load prog.o
19492 @end smallexample
19493
19494 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
19495
19496 @smallexample
19497 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
19498 @end smallexample
19499
19500 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
19501 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
19502 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
19503 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
19504 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
19505 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
19506 table.)
19507
19508 @node VxWorks Attach
19509 @subsubsection Running Tasks
19510
19511 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
19512 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
19513 follows:
19514
19515 @smallexample
19516 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
19517 @end smallexample
19518
19519 @noindent
19520 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
19521 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
19522 the time of attachment.
19523
19524 @node Embedded Processors
19525 @section Embedded Processors
19526
19527 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
19528 configurations.
19529
19530 @cindex send command to simulator
19531 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
19532 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
19533
19534 @table @code
19535 @item sim @var{command}
19536 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
19537 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
19538 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
19539 acceptable commands.
19540 @end table
19541
19542
19543 @menu
19544 * ARM:: ARM RDI
19545 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
19546 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
19547 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
19548 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
19549 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
19550 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
19551 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
19552 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
19553 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
19554 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
19555 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
19556 * CRIS:: CRIS
19557 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
19558 @end menu
19559
19560 @node ARM
19561 @subsection ARM
19562 @cindex ARM RDI
19563
19564 @table @code
19565 @kindex target rdi
19566 @item target rdi @var{dev}
19567 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
19568 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
19569 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
19570
19571 @kindex target rdp
19572 @item target rdp @var{dev}
19573 ARM Demon monitor.
19574
19575 @end table
19576
19577 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
19578
19579 @table @code
19580 @item set arm disassembler
19581 @kindex set arm
19582 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
19583 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
19584
19585 @item show arm disassembler
19586 @kindex show arm
19587 Show the current disassembly style.
19588
19589 @item set arm apcs32
19590 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
19591 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
19592
19593 @item show arm apcs32
19594 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
19595
19596 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
19597 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
19598 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
19599
19600 @table @code
19601 @item auto
19602 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
19603 @item softfpa
19604 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
19605 processors.
19606 @item fpa
19607 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
19608 @item softvfp
19609 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
19610 @item vfp
19611 VFP co-processor.
19612 @end table
19613
19614 @item show arm fpu
19615 Show the current type of the FPU.
19616
19617 @item set arm abi
19618 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
19619
19620 @item show arm abi
19621 Show the currently used ABI.
19622
19623 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
19624 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
19625 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
19626 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
19627 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
19628 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
19629 register).
19630
19631 @item show arm fallback-mode
19632 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
19633
19634 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
19635 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
19636 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
19637 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
19638 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
19639
19640 @item show arm force-mode
19641 Show the current forced instruction mode.
19642
19643 @item set debug arm
19644 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
19645 target support subsystem.
19646
19647 @item show debug arm
19648 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
19649 @end table
19650
19651 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
19652 using the RDI interface:
19653
19654 @table @code
19655 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
19656 @kindex rdilogfile
19657 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
19658 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
19659 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
19660 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
19661 @file{rdi.log}.
19662
19663 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
19664 @kindex rdilogenable
19665 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
19666 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
19667 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
19668 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
19669 are logged to a file.
19670
19671 @item set rdiromatzero
19672 @kindex set rdiromatzero
19673 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
19674 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
19675 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
19676 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
19677 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
19678
19679 @item show rdiromatzero
19680 @kindex show rdiromatzero
19681 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
19682
19683 @item set rdiheartbeat
19684 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
19685 @cindex RDI heartbeat
19686 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
19687 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
19688 well as the Angel monitor.
19689
19690 @item show rdiheartbeat
19691 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
19692 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
19693 @end table
19694
19695 @table @code
19696 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19697 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
19698
19699 @table @code
19700 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
19701 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support.
19702 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
19703 The default value is @code{all}.
19704
19705 @table @code
19706 @item none
19707 @item demon
19708 @item angel
19709 @item redboot
19710 @item all
19711 @end table
19712 @end table
19713 @end table
19714
19715 @node M32R/D
19716 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
19717
19718 @table @code
19719 @kindex target m32r
19720 @item target m32r @var{dev}
19721 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
19722
19723 @kindex target m32rsdi
19724 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
19725 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
19726 @end table
19727
19728 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
19729
19730 @table @code
19731 @item set download-path @var{path}
19732 @kindex set download-path
19733 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
19734 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
19735
19736 @item show download-path
19737 @kindex show download-path
19738 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
19739
19740 @item set board-address @var{addr}
19741 @kindex set board-address
19742 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
19743 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
19744
19745 @item show board-address
19746 @kindex show board-address
19747 Show the current IP address of the target board.
19748
19749 @item set server-address @var{addr}
19750 @kindex set server-address
19751 @cindex download server address (M32R)
19752 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
19753 host machine.
19754
19755 @item show server-address
19756 @kindex show server-address
19757 Display the IP address of the download server.
19758
19759 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
19760 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
19761 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
19762 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
19763 executable file is uploaded.
19764
19765 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
19766 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
19767 Test the @code{upload} command.
19768 @end table
19769
19770 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
19771
19772 @table @code
19773 @item sdireset
19774 @kindex sdireset
19775 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
19776 This command resets the SDI connection.
19777
19778 @item sdistatus
19779 @kindex sdistatus
19780 This command shows the SDI connection status.
19781
19782 @item debug_chaos
19783 @kindex debug_chaos
19784 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
19785 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
19786
19787 @item use_debug_dma
19788 @kindex use_debug_dma
19789 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
19790
19791 @item use_mon_code
19792 @kindex use_mon_code
19793 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
19794
19795 @item use_ib_break
19796 @kindex use_ib_break
19797 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
19798
19799 @item use_dbt_break
19800 @kindex use_dbt_break
19801 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
19802 @end table
19803
19804 @node M68K
19805 @subsection M68k
19806
19807 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
19808 target command for the following ROM monitor.
19809
19810 @table @code
19811
19812 @kindex target dbug
19813 @item target dbug @var{dev}
19814 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
19815
19816 @end table
19817
19818 @node MicroBlaze
19819 @subsection MicroBlaze
19820 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
19821 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
19822
19823 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
19824 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
19825 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
19826 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
19827 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
19828 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
19829 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
19830 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
19831 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
19832 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
19833 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
19834
19835 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
19836
19837 @table @code
19838 @item target remote :1234
19839 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
19840 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
19841
19842 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
19843 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
19844 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
19845
19846 @item load
19847 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
19848
19849 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
19850 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
19851
19852 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
19853 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
19854 @end table
19855
19856 @node MIPS Embedded
19857 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
19858
19859 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
19860 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
19861 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
19862 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
19863
19864 @need 1000
19865 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
19866
19867 @table @code
19868 @item target mips @var{port}
19869 @kindex target mips @var{port}
19870 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
19871 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
19872 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
19873 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
19874 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
19875 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
19876
19877 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
19878 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
19879 debugger:
19880
19881 @smallexample
19882 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
19883 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
19884 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
19885 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
19886 (@value{GDBP}) run
19887 @end smallexample
19888
19889 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
19890 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
19891 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
19892 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
19893 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
19894
19895 @item target pmon @var{port}
19896 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
19897 PMON ROM monitor.
19898
19899 @item target ddb @var{port}
19900 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
19901 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
19902
19903 @item target lsi @var{port}
19904 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
19905 LSI variant of PMON.
19906
19907 @kindex target r3900
19908 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
19909 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
19910
19911 @kindex target array
19912 @item target array @var{dev}
19913 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
19914
19915 @end table
19916
19917
19918 @noindent
19919 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
19920
19921 @table @code
19922 @item set mipsfpu double
19923 @itemx set mipsfpu single
19924 @itemx set mipsfpu none
19925 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
19926 @itemx show mipsfpu
19927 @kindex set mipsfpu
19928 @kindex show mipsfpu
19929 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
19930 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
19931 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
19932 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
19933 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
19934 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
19935 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
19936 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
19937 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
19938 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
19939 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
19940 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
19941 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
19942
19943 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
19944 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
19945 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
19946
19947 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
19948 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
19949
19950 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
19951 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
19952 @itemx show timeout
19953 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
19954 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
19955 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
19956 @kindex set timeout
19957 @kindex show timeout
19958 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
19959 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
19960 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
19961 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
19962 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
19963 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
19964 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
19965 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
19966 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
19967 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
19968
19969 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
19970 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
19971 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
19972 to run before stopping.
19973
19974 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
19975 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
19976 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
19977 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
19978 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
19979 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
19980
19981 @item show syn-garbage-limit
19982 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
19983 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
19984 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
19985
19986 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
19987 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
19988 @cindex remote monitor prompt
19989 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
19990 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
19991 @table @asis
19992 @item pmon target
19993 @samp{PMON}
19994 @item ddb target
19995 @samp{NEC010}
19996 @item lsi target
19997 @samp{PMON>}
19998 @end table
19999
20000 @item show monitor-prompt
20001 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20002 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
20003 remote monitor.
20004
20005 @item set monitor-warnings
20006 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20007 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
20008 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
20009 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
20010 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
20011
20012 @item show monitor-warnings
20013 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20014 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
20015
20016 @item pmon @var{command}
20017 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20018 @cindex send PMON command
20019 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
20020 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
20021 @end table
20022
20023 @node OpenRISC 1000
20024 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
20025 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
20026
20027 @cindex or1k boards
20028 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
20029 about platform and commands.
20030
20031 @table @code
20032
20033 @kindex target jtag
20034 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
20035
20036 Connects to remote JTAG server.
20037 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
20038 connected via parallel port to the board.
20039
20040 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
20041
20042 @kindex or1ksim
20043 @item or1ksim @var{command}
20044 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
20045 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
20046
20047 @kindex info or1k spr
20048 @item info or1k spr
20049 Displays spr groups.
20050
20051 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
20052 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
20053 Displays register names in selected group.
20054
20055 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
20056 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
20057 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
20058 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
20059 Shows information about specified spr register.
20060
20061 @kindex spr
20062 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
20063 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
20064 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
20065 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
20066 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
20067 @end table
20068
20069 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
20070 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
20071 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
20072 triggers can be set using:
20073 @table @code
20074 @item $LEA/$LDATA
20075 Load effective address/data
20076 @item $SEA/$SDATA
20077 Store effective address/data
20078 @item $AEA/$ADATA
20079 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
20080 @item $FETCH
20081 Fetch data
20082 @end table
20083
20084 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
20085 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
20086
20087 @code{htrace} commands:
20088 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
20089 @table @code
20090 @kindex hwatch
20091 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
20092 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
20093 or Data. For example:
20094
20095 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
20096
20097 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
20098
20099 @kindex htrace
20100 @item htrace info
20101 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
20102
20103 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
20104 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
20105
20106 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
20107 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
20108
20109 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
20110 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
20111
20112 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
20113 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
20114 triggered.
20115
20116 @item htrace enable
20117 @itemx htrace disable
20118 Enables/disables the HW trace.
20119
20120 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
20121 Clears currently recorded trace data.
20122
20123 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
20124 will be written there.
20125
20126 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
20127 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
20128
20129 @item htrace mode continuous
20130 Set continuous trace mode.
20131
20132 @item htrace mode suspend
20133 Set suspend trace mode.
20134
20135 @end table
20136
20137 @node PowerPC Embedded
20138 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
20139
20140 @cindex DVC register
20141 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
20142 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
20143
20144 @smallexample
20145 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
20146 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
20147 @end smallexample
20148
20149 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
20150 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
20151 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
20152 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
20153 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
20154 or newer.
20155
20156 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
20157 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
20158 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
20159 watching variables of scalar types.
20160
20161 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
20162 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
20163
20164 @smallexample
20165 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
20166 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
20167 @end smallexample
20168
20169 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
20170 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
20171
20172 @cindex ranged breakpoint
20173 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
20174 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
20175 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
20176 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
20177 use the @code{break-range} command.
20178
20179 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
20180
20181 @table @code
20182 @kindex break-range
20183 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
20184 Set a breakpoint for an address range.
20185 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location} can specify a function name,
20186 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
20187 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
20188 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
20189 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
20190 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
20191 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
20192
20193 @kindex set powerpc
20194 @item set powerpc soft-float
20195 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
20196 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
20197 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
20198 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
20199
20200 @item set powerpc vector-abi
20201 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
20202 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
20203 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
20204 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
20205 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
20206 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
20207 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
20208
20209 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
20210 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
20211 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
20212 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
20213 address of its first byte.
20214
20215 @kindex target dink32
20216 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
20217 DINK32 ROM monitor.
20218
20219 @kindex target ppcbug
20220 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
20221 @kindex target ppcbug1
20222 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
20223 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
20224
20225 @kindex target sds
20226 @item target sds @var{dev}
20227 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
20228 @end table
20229
20230 @cindex SDS protocol
20231 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
20232 by @value{GDBN}:
20233
20234 @table @code
20235 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
20236 @kindex set sdstimeout
20237 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
20238 default is 2 seconds.
20239
20240 @item show sdstimeout
20241 @kindex show sdstimeout
20242 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
20243
20244 @item sds @var{command}
20245 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
20246 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
20247 @end table
20248
20249
20250 @node PA
20251 @subsection HP PA Embedded
20252
20253 @table @code
20254
20255 @kindex target op50n
20256 @item target op50n @var{dev}
20257 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
20258
20259 @kindex target w89k
20260 @item target w89k @var{dev}
20261 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
20262
20263 @end table
20264
20265 @node Sparclet
20266 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
20267
20268 @cindex Sparclet
20269
20270 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
20271 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
20272 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
20273 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
20274 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
20275
20276 @table @code
20277 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
20278 @kindex remotetimeout
20279 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
20280 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
20281 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
20282 @end table
20283
20284 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
20285 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
20286 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
20287 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
20288 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
20289
20290 @smallexample
20291 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
20292 @end smallexample
20293
20294 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
20295
20296 @smallexample
20297 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
20298 @end smallexample
20299
20300 @cindex running, on Sparclet
20301 Once you have set
20302 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
20303 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
20304 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
20305
20306 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
20307
20308 @smallexample
20309 (gdbslet)
20310 @end smallexample
20311
20312 @menu
20313 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
20314 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
20315 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
20316 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
20317 @end menu
20318
20319 @node Sparclet File
20320 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
20321
20322 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
20323
20324 @smallexample
20325 (gdbslet) file prog
20326 @end smallexample
20327
20328 @need 1000
20329 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
20330 @value{GDBN} locates
20331 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
20332 path.
20333 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
20334 files will be searched as well.
20335 @value{GDBN} locates
20336 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
20337 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
20338 If it fails
20339 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
20340
20341 @smallexample
20342 prog: No such file or directory.
20343 @end smallexample
20344
20345 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
20346 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
20347 @code{target} command again.
20348
20349 @node Sparclet Connection
20350 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
20351
20352 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
20353 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
20354
20355 @smallexample
20356 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
20357 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
20358 main () at ../prog.c:3
20359 @end smallexample
20360
20361 @need 750
20362 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
20363
20364 @smallexample
20365 Connected to ttya.
20366 @end smallexample
20367
20368 @node Sparclet Download
20369 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
20370
20371 @cindex download to Sparclet
20372 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
20373 you can use the @value{GDBN}
20374 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
20375 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
20376 command.
20377 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
20378 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
20379 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
20380 of each of the file's sections.
20381 For instance, if the program
20382 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
20383 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
20384
20385 @smallexample
20386 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
20387 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
20388 @end smallexample
20389
20390 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
20391 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
20392 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
20393
20394 @node Sparclet Execution
20395 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
20396
20397 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
20398 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
20399 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
20400 manual for the list of commands.
20401
20402 @smallexample
20403 (gdbslet) b main
20404 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
20405 (gdbslet) run
20406 Starting program: prog
20407 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
20408 3 char *symarg = 0;
20409 (gdbslet) step
20410 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
20411 (gdbslet)
20412 @end smallexample
20413
20414 @node Sparclite
20415 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
20416
20417 @table @code
20418
20419 @kindex target sparclite
20420 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
20421 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
20422 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
20423 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
20424 remote protocol.
20425
20426 @end table
20427
20428 @node Z8000
20429 @subsection Zilog Z8000
20430
20431 @cindex Z8000
20432 @cindex simulator, Z8000
20433 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
20434
20435 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
20436 a Z8000 simulator.
20437
20438 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
20439 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
20440 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
20441 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
20442
20443 @table @code
20444 @item target sim @var{args}
20445 @kindex sim
20446 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
20447 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
20448 options, specify them via @var{args}.
20449 @end table
20450
20451 @noindent
20452 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
20453 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
20454 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
20455 to run your program, and so on.
20456
20457 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
20458 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
20459 additional items of information as specially named registers:
20460
20461 @table @code
20462
20463 @item cycles
20464 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
20465
20466 @item insts
20467 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
20468
20469 @item time
20470 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
20471
20472 @end table
20473
20474 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
20475 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
20476 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
20477 simulated clock ticks.
20478
20479 @node AVR
20480 @subsection Atmel AVR
20481 @cindex AVR
20482
20483 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
20484 following AVR-specific commands:
20485
20486 @table @code
20487 @item info io_registers
20488 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
20489 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
20490 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
20491 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
20492 @end table
20493
20494 @node CRIS
20495 @subsection CRIS
20496 @cindex CRIS
20497
20498 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
20499 following CRIS-specific commands:
20500
20501 @table @code
20502 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
20503 @cindex CRIS version
20504 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
20505 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
20506 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
20507
20508 @item show cris-version
20509 Show the current CRIS version.
20510
20511 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
20512 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
20513 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
20514 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
20515 @code{R59}.
20516
20517 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
20518 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
20519
20520 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
20521 @cindex CRIS mode
20522 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
20523 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
20524 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
20525
20526 @item show cris-mode
20527 Show the current CRIS mode.
20528 @end table
20529
20530 @node Super-H
20531 @subsection Renesas Super-H
20532 @cindex Super-H
20533
20534 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
20535 commands:
20536
20537 @table @code
20538 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
20539 @kindex set sh calling-convention
20540 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
20541 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
20542 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
20543 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
20544 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
20545 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
20546 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
20547 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
20548 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
20549 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
20550
20551 @item show sh calling-convention
20552 @kindex show sh calling-convention
20553 Show the current calling convention setting.
20554
20555 @end table
20556
20557
20558 @node Architectures
20559 @section Architectures
20560
20561 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
20562 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
20563
20564 @menu
20565 * i386::
20566 * Alpha::
20567 * MIPS::
20568 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
20569 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
20570 * PowerPC::
20571 @end menu
20572
20573 @node i386
20574 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
20575
20576 @table @code
20577 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
20578 @kindex set struct-convention
20579 @cindex struct return convention
20580 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
20581 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
20582 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
20583 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
20584 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
20585 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
20586 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
20587 be returned in a register.
20588
20589 @item show struct-convention
20590 @kindex show struct-convention
20591 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
20592 from functions.
20593 @end table
20594
20595 @node Alpha
20596 @subsection Alpha
20597
20598 See the following section.
20599
20600 @node MIPS
20601 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
20602
20603 @cindex stack on Alpha
20604 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
20605 @cindex Alpha stack
20606 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
20607 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
20608 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
20609 find the beginning of a function.
20610
20611 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
20612 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
20613 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
20614 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
20615 commands:
20616
20617 @table @code
20618 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
20619 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
20620 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
20621 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
20622 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
20623 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
20624 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
20625 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
20626
20627 @item show heuristic-fence-post
20628 Display the current limit.
20629 @end table
20630
20631 @noindent
20632 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
20633 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
20634
20635 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
20636 programs:
20637
20638 @table @code
20639 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
20640 @kindex set mips abi
20641 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
20642 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
20643 values of @var{arg} are:
20644
20645 @table @samp
20646 @item auto
20647 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
20648 default).
20649 @item o32
20650 @item o64
20651 @item n32
20652 @item n64
20653 @item eabi32
20654 @item eabi64
20655 @end table
20656
20657 @item show mips abi
20658 @kindex show mips abi
20659 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
20660
20661 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
20662 @kindex set mips compression
20663 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
20664 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
20665 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
20666 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
20667 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
20668 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
20669 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
20670 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
20671 provided by the executable.
20672
20673 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
20674 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
20675 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
20676 identified as such.
20677
20678 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
20679 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
20680 implicitly from an executable.
20681
20682 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
20683 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
20684 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
20685 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
20686 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
20687
20688 @item show mips compression
20689 @kindex show mips compression
20690 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
20691 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
20692
20693 @item set mipsfpu
20694 @itemx show mipsfpu
20695 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
20696
20697 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
20698 @kindex set mips mask-address
20699 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
20700 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
20701 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
20702 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
20703 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
20704
20705 @item show mips mask-address
20706 @kindex show mips mask-address
20707 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
20708 not.
20709
20710 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
20711 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
20712 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
20713 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
20714 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
20715 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
20716
20717 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
20718 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
20719 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
20720
20721 @item set debug mips
20722 @kindex set debug mips
20723 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
20724 target code in @value{GDBN}.
20725
20726 @item show debug mips
20727 @kindex show debug mips
20728 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
20729 @end table
20730
20731
20732 @node HPPA
20733 @subsection HPPA
20734 @cindex HPPA support
20735
20736 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
20737 following special commands:
20738
20739 @table @code
20740 @item set debug hppa
20741 @kindex set debug hppa
20742 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
20743 messages are to be displayed.
20744
20745 @item show debug hppa
20746 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
20747
20748 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
20749 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
20750 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
20751 given @var{address}.
20752
20753 @end table
20754
20755
20756 @node SPU
20757 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
20758 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
20759 @cindex SPU
20760
20761 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
20762 it provides the following special commands:
20763
20764 @table @code
20765 @item info spu event
20766 @kindex info spu
20767 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
20768 and pending event status.
20769
20770 @item info spu signal
20771 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
20772 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
20773 notification channels.
20774
20775 @item info spu mailbox
20776 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
20777 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
20778 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
20779
20780 @item info spu dma
20781 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
20782 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
20783 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
20784
20785 @item info spu proxydma
20786 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
20787 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
20788 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
20789
20790 @end table
20791
20792 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
20793 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
20794 special commands:
20795
20796 @table @code
20797 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
20798 @kindex set spu
20799 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
20800 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
20801 function. The default is @code{off}.
20802
20803 @item show spu stop-on-load
20804 @kindex show spu
20805 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
20806
20807 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
20808 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
20809 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
20810 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
20811 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
20812 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
20813
20814 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
20815 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
20816
20817 @end table
20818
20819 @node PowerPC
20820 @subsection PowerPC
20821 @cindex PowerPC architecture
20822
20823 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
20824 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
20825 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
20826 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
20827 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
20828
20829 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
20830 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
20831 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
20832
20833 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
20834 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
20835
20836
20837 @node Controlling GDB
20838 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
20839
20840 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
20841 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
20842 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
20843 described here.
20844
20845 @menu
20846 * Prompt:: Prompt
20847 * Editing:: Command editing
20848 * Command History:: Command history
20849 * Screen Size:: Screen size
20850 * Numbers:: Numbers
20851 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
20852 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
20853 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
20854 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
20855 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
20856 @end menu
20857
20858 @node Prompt
20859 @section Prompt
20860
20861 @cindex prompt
20862
20863 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
20864 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
20865 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
20866 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
20867 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
20868 which one you are talking to.
20869
20870 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
20871 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
20872 or a prompt that does not.
20873
20874 @table @code
20875 @kindex set prompt
20876 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
20877 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
20878
20879 @kindex show prompt
20880 @item show prompt
20881 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
20882 @end table
20883
20884 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
20885 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
20886 are:
20887
20888 @table @code
20889 @kindex set extended-prompt
20890 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
20891 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
20892 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
20893 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
20894 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
20895 is displayed.
20896
20897 For example:
20898
20899 @smallexample
20900 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
20901 @end smallexample
20902
20903 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
20904 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
20905
20906 @kindex show extended-prompt
20907 @item show extended-prompt
20908 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
20909 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
20910 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
20911 @end table
20912
20913 @node Editing
20914 @section Command Editing
20915 @cindex readline
20916 @cindex command line editing
20917
20918 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
20919 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
20920 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
20921 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
20922 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
20923 debugging sessions.
20924
20925 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
20926 command @code{set}.
20927
20928 @table @code
20929 @kindex set editing
20930 @cindex editing
20931 @item set editing
20932 @itemx set editing on
20933 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
20934
20935 @item set editing off
20936 Disable command line editing.
20937
20938 @kindex show editing
20939 @item show editing
20940 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
20941 @end table
20942
20943 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
20944 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
20945 @end ifset
20946 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
20947 @xref{Command Line Editing},
20948 @end ifclear
20949 for more details about the Readline
20950 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
20951 encouraged to read that chapter.
20952
20953 @node Command History
20954 @section Command History
20955 @cindex command history
20956
20957 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
20958 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
20959 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
20960 history facility.
20961
20962 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
20963 package, to provide the history facility.
20964 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
20965 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
20966 @end ifset
20967 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
20968 @xref{Using History Interactively},
20969 @end ifclear
20970 for the detailed description of the History library.
20971
20972 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
20973 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
20974 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
20975 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
20976 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
20977 pressed on a line by itself.
20978
20979 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
20980 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
20981 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
20982 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
20983
20984 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
20985 history.
20986
20987 @table @code
20988 @cindex history substitution
20989 @cindex history file
20990 @kindex set history filename
20991 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
20992 @item set history filename @var{fname}
20993 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
20994 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
20995 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
20996 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
20997 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
20998 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
20999 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
21000 is not set.
21001
21002 @cindex save command history
21003 @kindex set history save
21004 @item set history save
21005 @itemx set history save on
21006 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
21007 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
21008
21009 @item set history save off
21010 Stop recording command history in a file.
21011
21012 @cindex history size
21013 @kindex set history size
21014 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
21015 @item set history size @var{size}
21016 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
21017 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
21018 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
21019 @end table
21020
21021 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
21022 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21023 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
21024 @end ifset
21025 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21026 @xref{Event Designators},
21027 @end ifclear
21028 for more details.
21029
21030 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
21031 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
21032 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
21033 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
21034 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
21035 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
21036 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
21037 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
21038
21039 The commands to control history expansion are:
21040
21041 @table @code
21042 @item set history expansion on
21043 @itemx set history expansion
21044 @kindex set history expansion
21045 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
21046
21047 @item set history expansion off
21048 Disable history expansion.
21049
21050 @c @group
21051 @kindex show history
21052 @item show history
21053 @itemx show history filename
21054 @itemx show history save
21055 @itemx show history size
21056 @itemx show history expansion
21057 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
21058 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
21059 @c @end group
21060 @end table
21061
21062 @table @code
21063 @kindex show commands
21064 @cindex show last commands
21065 @cindex display command history
21066 @item show commands
21067 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
21068
21069 @item show commands @var{n}
21070 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
21071
21072 @item show commands +
21073 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
21074 @end table
21075
21076 @node Screen Size
21077 @section Screen Size
21078 @cindex size of screen
21079 @cindex pauses in output
21080
21081 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
21082 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
21083 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
21084 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
21085 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
21086 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
21087 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
21088 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
21089
21090 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
21091 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
21092 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
21093 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
21094 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
21095 width} commands:
21096
21097 @table @code
21098 @kindex set height
21099 @kindex set width
21100 @kindex show width
21101 @kindex show height
21102 @item set height @var{lpp}
21103 @itemx show height
21104 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
21105 @itemx show width
21106 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
21107 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
21108 commands display the current settings.
21109
21110 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
21111 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
21112 file or to an editor buffer.
21113
21114 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
21115 from wrapping its output.
21116
21117 @item set pagination on
21118 @itemx set pagination off
21119 @kindex set pagination
21120 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
21121 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}. Note that
21122 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
21123 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
21124
21125 @item show pagination
21126 @kindex show pagination
21127 Show the current pagination mode.
21128 @end table
21129
21130 @node Numbers
21131 @section Numbers
21132 @cindex number representation
21133 @cindex entering numbers
21134
21135 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
21136 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
21137 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
21138 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
21139 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
21140 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
21141 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
21142 both input and output with the commands described below.
21143
21144 @table @code
21145 @kindex set input-radix
21146 @item set input-radix @var{base}
21147 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
21148 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
21149 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
21150 example, any of
21151
21152 @smallexample
21153 set input-radix 012
21154 set input-radix 10.
21155 set input-radix 0xa
21156 @end smallexample
21157
21158 @noindent
21159 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
21160 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
21161 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
21162 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
21163 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
21164 change the radix.
21165
21166 @kindex set output-radix
21167 @item set output-radix @var{base}
21168 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
21169 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
21170 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
21171
21172 @kindex show input-radix
21173 @item show input-radix
21174 Display the current default base for numeric input.
21175
21176 @kindex show output-radix
21177 @item show output-radix
21178 Display the current default base for numeric display.
21179
21180 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
21181 @itemx show radix
21182 @kindex set radix
21183 @kindex show radix
21184 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
21185 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
21186 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
21187 default value of 10.
21188
21189 @end table
21190
21191 @node ABI
21192 @section Configuring the Current ABI
21193
21194 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
21195 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
21196 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
21197 current ABI.
21198
21199 @cindex OS ABI
21200 @kindex set osabi
21201 @kindex show osabi
21202
21203 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
21204 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
21205 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
21206 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
21207 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
21208 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
21209 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
21210 platform provides.
21211
21212 @table @code
21213 @item show osabi
21214 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
21215
21216 @item set osabi
21217 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
21218
21219 @item set osabi @var{abi}
21220 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
21221 @end table
21222
21223 @cindex float promotion
21224
21225 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
21226 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
21227 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
21228 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
21229 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
21230 @code{double} and then passed.
21231
21232 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
21233 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
21234 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
21235
21236 @table @code
21237 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
21238 @item set coerce-float-to-double
21239 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
21240 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
21241 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
21242
21243 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
21244 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
21245 functions.
21246
21247 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
21248 @item show coerce-float-to-double
21249 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
21250 @end table
21251
21252 @kindex set cp-abi
21253 @kindex show cp-abi
21254 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
21255 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
21256 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
21257 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
21258 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
21259 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
21260 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
21261 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
21262 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
21263 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
21264 ``auto''.
21265
21266 @table @code
21267 @item show cp-abi
21268 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
21269
21270 @item set cp-abi
21271 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
21272
21273 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
21274 @itemx set cp-abi auto
21275 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
21276 @end table
21277
21278 @node Auto-loading
21279 @section Automatically loading associated files
21280 @cindex auto-loading
21281
21282 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
21283 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
21284 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
21285 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
21286 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
21287 sources).
21288
21289 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
21290 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
21291 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
21292
21293 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
21294 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
21295
21296 @table @code
21297 @anchor{set auto-load off}
21298 @kindex set auto-load off
21299 @item set auto-load off
21300 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
21301 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
21302 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
21303 @smallexample
21304 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
21305 @end smallexample
21306
21307 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
21308 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
21309 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
21310 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
21311 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
21312 @code{set auto-load no}.
21313
21314 @anchor{show auto-load}
21315 @kindex show auto-load
21316 @item show auto-load
21317 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
21318 or disabled.
21319
21320 @smallexample
21321 (gdb) show auto-load
21322 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
21323 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
21324 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
21325 is on.
21326 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
21327 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
21328 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
21329 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
21330 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
21331 @end smallexample
21332
21333 @anchor{info auto-load}
21334 @kindex info auto-load
21335 @item info auto-load
21336 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
21337 not.
21338
21339 @smallexample
21340 (gdb) info auto-load
21341 gdb-scripts:
21342 Loaded Script
21343 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
21344 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
21345 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
21346 loaded.
21347 python-scripts:
21348 Loaded Script
21349 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
21350 @end smallexample
21351 @end table
21352
21353 These are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load:
21354
21355 @itemize @bullet
21356 @item
21357 @xref{objfile-gdb.py file}, controlled by @ref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
21358 @item
21359 @xref{objfile-gdb.gdb file}, controlled by @ref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
21360 @item
21361 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section},
21362 controlled by @ref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
21363 @item
21364 @xref{Init File in the Current Directory},
21365 controlled by @ref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
21366 @item
21367 @xref{libthread_db.so.1 file}, controlled by @ref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
21368 @end itemize
21369
21370 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
21371
21372 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
21373 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
21374 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
21375 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
21376 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
21377 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
21378 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
21379 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
21380 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
21381 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
21382 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
21383 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
21384 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
21385 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
21386 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
21387 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
21388 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
21389 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
21390 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
21391 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
21392 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
21393 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
21394 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
21395 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
21396 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
21397 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
21398 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
21399 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
21400 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
21401 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
21402 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
21403 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
21404 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
21405 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
21406 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
21407 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
21408 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
21409 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
21410 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
21411 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
21412 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
21413 @end multitable
21414
21415 @menu
21416 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
21417 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
21418 * objfile-gdb.gdb file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load gdb-script}
21419 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
21420 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
21421 @xref{Python Auto-loading}.
21422 @end menu
21423
21424 @node Init File in the Current Directory
21425 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
21426 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
21427
21428 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
21429 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
21430 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
21431
21432 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
21433 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
21434
21435 @table @code
21436 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
21437 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
21438 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
21439 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
21440 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
21441
21442 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
21443 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
21444 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
21445 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
21446 current directory is enabled or disabled.
21447
21448 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
21449 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
21450 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
21451 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
21452 current directory have been auto-loaded.
21453 @end table
21454
21455 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
21456 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
21457 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
21458
21459 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
21460
21461 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
21462 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
21463
21464 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
21465 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
21466 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
21467 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
21468 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
21469 library.
21470
21471 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
21472 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
21473
21474 @table @code
21475 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
21476 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
21477 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
21478 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
21479
21480 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
21481 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
21482 @item show auto-load libthread-db
21483 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
21484 enabled or disabled.
21485
21486 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
21487 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
21488 @item info auto-load libthread-db
21489 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
21490 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
21491 @end table
21492
21493 @node objfile-gdb.gdb file
21494 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb} file
21495 @cindex auto-loading @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
21496
21497 @value{GDBN} tries to load an @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb} file containing
21498 canned sequences of commands (@pxref{Sequences}), as long as @samp{set
21499 auto-load gdb-scripts} is set to @samp{on}.
21500
21501 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
21502 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
21503
21504 For more background refer to the similar Python scripts auto-loading
21505 description (@pxref{objfile-gdb.py file}).
21506
21507 @table @code
21508 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
21509 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
21510 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
21511 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
21512
21513 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
21514 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
21515 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
21516 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
21517 disabled.
21518
21519 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
21520 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
21521 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
21522 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
21523 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
21524 auto-loaded.
21525 @end table
21526
21527 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
21528 matching names are printed.
21529
21530 @node Auto-loading safe path
21531 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
21532 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
21533
21534 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
21535 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
21536 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
21537 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
21538 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
21539
21540 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
21541 get loaded:
21542
21543 @smallexample
21544 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
21545 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
21546 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
21547 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
21548 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
21549 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
21550 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
21551 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
21552 @end smallexample
21553
21554 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
21555
21556 @table @code
21557 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
21558 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
21559 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
21560 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
21561 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
21562 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
21563 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
21564 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
21565 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
21566 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
21567
21568 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
21569 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
21570 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
21571
21572 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
21573 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
21574 @item show auto-load safe-path
21575 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
21576 scripts.
21577
21578 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
21579 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
21580 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
21581 Add an entry (or list of entries) the list of directories trusted for automatic
21582 loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited by the
21583 host platform path separator in use.
21584 @end table
21585
21586 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
21587 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
21588 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
21589 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
21590 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
21591
21592 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
21593 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
21594 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
21595 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
21596 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
21597 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
21598 init file in the current directory
21599 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
21600
21601 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
21602 example, you could use one of the following ways:
21603
21604 @table @asis
21605 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
21606 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
21607 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
21608 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
21609
21610 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
21611 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
21612 @value{GDBN} session.
21613
21614 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
21615 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
21616 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
21617 from trusted sources.
21618
21619 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
21620 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
21621 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
21622 trusted sources.
21623 @end table
21624
21625 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
21626 also suppresses any such warning messages:
21627
21628 @table @asis
21629 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
21630 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
21631
21632 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
21633 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
21634 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
21635 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
21636 @end table
21637
21638 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
21639 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
21640 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
21641 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
21642 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
21643 recommended to be entered.
21644
21645 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
21646 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
21647 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
21648
21649 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
21650 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
21651 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
21652 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
21653 be printed.
21654
21655 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
21656 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
21657 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
21658
21659 @smallexample
21660 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
21661 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
21662 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
21663 for objfile "/tmp/true".
21664 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
21665 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
21666 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
21667 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
21668 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
21669 @end smallexample
21670
21671 @table @code
21672 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
21673 @kindex set debug auto-load
21674 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
21675 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
21676
21677 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
21678 @kindex show debug auto-load
21679 @item show debug auto-load
21680 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
21681 on or off.
21682 @end table
21683
21684 @node Messages/Warnings
21685 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
21686
21687 @cindex verbose operation
21688 @cindex optional warnings
21689 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
21690 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
21691 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
21692 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
21693
21694 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
21695 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
21696 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
21697
21698 @table @code
21699 @kindex set verbose
21700 @item set verbose on
21701 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
21702
21703 @item set verbose off
21704 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
21705
21706 @kindex show verbose
21707 @item show verbose
21708 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
21709 @end table
21710
21711 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
21712 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
21713 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
21714 Symbol Files}).
21715
21716 @table @code
21717
21718 @kindex set complaints
21719 @item set complaints @var{limit}
21720 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
21721 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
21722 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
21723 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
21724
21725 @kindex show complaints
21726 @item show complaints
21727 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
21728
21729 @end table
21730
21731 @anchor{confirmation requests}
21732 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
21733 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
21734 you try to run a program which is already running:
21735
21736 @smallexample
21737 (@value{GDBP}) run
21738 The program being debugged has been started already.
21739 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
21740 @end smallexample
21741
21742 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
21743 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
21744
21745 @table @code
21746
21747 @kindex set confirm
21748 @cindex flinching
21749 @cindex confirmation
21750 @cindex stupid questions
21751 @item set confirm off
21752 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
21753 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
21754 automatically disables confirmation requests.
21755
21756 @item set confirm on
21757 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
21758
21759 @kindex show confirm
21760 @item show confirm
21761 Displays state of confirmation requests.
21762
21763 @end table
21764
21765 @cindex command tracing
21766 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
21767 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
21768 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
21769 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
21770
21771 @table @code
21772 @kindex set trace-commands
21773 @cindex command scripts, debugging
21774 @item set trace-commands on
21775 Enable command tracing.
21776 @item set trace-commands off
21777 Disable command tracing.
21778 @item show trace-commands
21779 Display the current state of command tracing.
21780 @end table
21781
21782 @node Debugging Output
21783 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
21784 @cindex optional debugging messages
21785
21786 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
21787 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
21788 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
21789 section documents those commands.
21790
21791 @table @code
21792 @kindex set exec-done-display
21793 @item set exec-done-display
21794 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
21795 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
21796 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
21797 @kindex show exec-done-display
21798 @item show exec-done-display
21799 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
21800 notification.
21801 @kindex set debug
21802 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
21803 @cindex architecture debugging info
21804 @item set debug arch
21805 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
21806 @kindex show debug
21807 @item show debug arch
21808 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
21809 @item set debug aix-thread
21810 @cindex AIX threads
21811 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
21812 module.
21813 @item show debug aix-thread
21814 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
21815 @item set debug check-physname
21816 @cindex physname
21817 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
21818 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
21819 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
21820 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
21821 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
21822 both ways and display any discrepancies.
21823 @item show debug check-physname
21824 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
21825 @item set debug dwarf2-die
21826 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
21827 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
21828 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
21829 A value of zero turns off the display.
21830 @item show debug dwarf2-die
21831 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
21832 @item set debug dwarf2-read
21833 @cindex DWARF2 Reading
21834 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
21835 DWARF debug info. The default is off.
21836 @item show debug dwarf2-read
21837 Show the current state of DWARF2 reader debugging.
21838 @item set debug displaced
21839 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
21840 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
21841 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
21842 @item show debug displaced
21843 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
21844 related to displaced stepping.
21845 @item set debug event
21846 @cindex event debugging info
21847 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
21848 default is off.
21849 @item show debug event
21850 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
21851 info.
21852 @item set debug expression
21853 @cindex expression debugging info
21854 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
21855 expression parsing. The default is off.
21856 @item show debug expression
21857 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
21858 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
21859 @item set debug frame
21860 @cindex frame debugging info
21861 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
21862 default is off.
21863 @item show debug frame
21864 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
21865 info.
21866 @item set debug gnu-nat
21867 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
21868 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
21869 @item show debug gnu-nat
21870 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
21871 @item set debug infrun
21872 @cindex inferior debugging info
21873 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
21874 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
21875 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
21876 @item show debug infrun
21877 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
21878 @item set debug jit
21879 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
21880 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
21881 @item show debug jit
21882 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
21883 @item set debug lin-lwp
21884 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
21885 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
21886 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
21887 @item show debug lin-lwp
21888 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
21889 @item set debug observer
21890 @cindex observer debugging info
21891 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
21892 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
21893 @item show debug observer
21894 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
21895 @item set debug overload
21896 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
21897 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
21898 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
21899 is off.
21900 @item show debug overload
21901 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
21902 debugging info.
21903 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
21904 @cindex debug expression parser
21905 @item set debug parser
21906 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
21907 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
21908 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
21909 details. The default is off.
21910 @item show debug parser
21911 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
21912 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
21913 @cindex serial connections, debugging
21914 @cindex debug remote protocol
21915 @cindex remote protocol debugging
21916 @cindex display remote packets
21917 @item set debug remote
21918 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
21919 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
21920 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
21921 @item show debug remote
21922 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
21923 @item set debug serial
21924 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
21925 default is off.
21926 @item show debug serial
21927 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
21928 info.
21929 @item set debug solib-frv
21930 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
21931 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
21932 @item show debug solib-frv
21933 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
21934 messages.
21935 @item set debug symtab-create
21936 @cindex symbol table creation
21937 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
21938 The default is off.
21939 @item show debug symtab-create
21940 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
21941 @item set debug target
21942 @cindex target debugging info
21943 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
21944 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
21945 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
21946 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
21947 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
21948 @item show debug target
21949 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
21950 info.
21951 @item set debug timestamp
21952 @cindex timestampping debugging info
21953 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
21954 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
21955 message.
21956 @item show debug timestamp
21957 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
21958 debugging info.
21959 @item set debugvarobj
21960 @cindex variable object debugging info
21961 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
21962 info. The default is off.
21963 @item show debugvarobj
21964 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
21965 debugging info.
21966 @item set debug xml
21967 @cindex XML parser debugging
21968 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
21969 @item show debug xml
21970 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
21971 @end table
21972
21973 @node Other Misc Settings
21974 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
21975 @cindex miscellaneous settings
21976
21977 @table @code
21978 @kindex set interactive-mode
21979 @item set interactive-mode
21980 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
21981 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
21982 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
21983 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
21984 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
21985 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
21986 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
21987 is, non-interactively otherwise.
21988
21989 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
21990 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
21991 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
21992 inside a cygwin window.
21993
21994 @kindex show interactive-mode
21995 @item show interactive-mode
21996 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
21997 @end table
21998
21999 @node Extending GDB
22000 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
22001 @cindex extending GDB
22002
22003 @value{GDBN} provides three mechanisms for extension. The first is based
22004 on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, the second is based on the
22005 Python scripting language, and the third is for defining new aliases of
22006 existing commands.
22007
22008 To facilitate the use of the first two extensions, @value{GDBN} is capable
22009 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
22010 can recognize which scripting language is being used by looking at
22011 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
22012 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
22013 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
22014
22015 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
22016 setting:
22017
22018 @table @code
22019 @kindex set script-extension
22020 @kindex show script-extension
22021 @item set script-extension off
22022 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
22023
22024 @item set script-extension soft
22025 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
22026 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
22027 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
22028 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
22029
22030 @item set script-extension strict
22031 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
22032 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
22033 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
22034
22035 @item show script-extension
22036 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
22037
22038 @end table
22039
22040 @menu
22041 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands
22042 * Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
22043 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
22044 @end menu
22045
22046 @node Sequences
22047 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
22048
22049 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
22050 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
22051 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
22052 files.
22053
22054 @menu
22055 * Define:: How to define your own commands
22056 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
22057 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
22058 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
22059 @end menu
22060
22061 @node Define
22062 @subsection User-defined Commands
22063
22064 @cindex user-defined command
22065 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
22066 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
22067 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
22068 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
22069 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
22070 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
22071
22072 @smallexample
22073 define adder
22074 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
22075 end
22076 @end smallexample
22077
22078 @noindent
22079 To execute the command use:
22080
22081 @smallexample
22082 adder 1 2 3
22083 @end smallexample
22084
22085 @noindent
22086 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
22087 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
22088 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
22089 functions calls.
22090
22091 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
22092 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
22093 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
22094 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
22095
22096 @smallexample
22097 define adder
22098 if $argc == 2
22099 print $arg0 + $arg1
22100 end
22101 if $argc == 3
22102 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
22103 end
22104 end
22105 @end smallexample
22106
22107 @table @code
22108
22109 @kindex define
22110 @item define @var{commandname}
22111 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
22112 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
22113 @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
22114 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
22115 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
22116 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
22117
22118 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
22119 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
22120 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
22121
22122 @kindex document
22123 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
22124 @item document @var{commandname}
22125 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
22126 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
22127 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
22128 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
22129 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
22130 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
22131
22132 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
22133 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
22134 does not change the documentation.
22135
22136 @kindex dont-repeat
22137 @cindex don't repeat command
22138 @item dont-repeat
22139 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
22140 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
22141 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
22142
22143 @kindex help user-defined
22144 @item help user-defined
22145 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
22146 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
22147 included (if any).
22148
22149 @kindex show user
22150 @item show user
22151 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
22152 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
22153 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
22154 definitions for all user-defined commands.
22155 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
22156
22157 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
22158 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
22159 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
22160 @item show max-user-call-depth
22161 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
22162 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
22163 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
22164 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
22165 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
22166 @end table
22167
22168 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
22169 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
22170
22171 When user-defined commands are executed, the
22172 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
22173 stops execution of the user-defined command.
22174
22175 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
22176 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
22177 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
22178 messages when used in a user-defined command.
22179
22180 @node Hooks
22181 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
22182 @cindex command hooks
22183 @cindex hooks, for commands
22184 @cindex hooks, pre-command
22185
22186 @kindex hook
22187 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
22188 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
22189 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
22190 before that command.
22191
22192 @cindex hooks, post-command
22193 @kindex hookpost
22194 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
22195 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
22196 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
22197 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
22198 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
22199
22200 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
22201 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
22202
22203 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
22204 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
22205
22206 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
22207 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
22208 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
22209 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
22210 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
22211
22212 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
22213 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
22214 you could define:
22215
22216 @smallexample
22217 define hook-stop
22218 handle SIGALRM nopass
22219 end
22220
22221 define hook-run
22222 handle SIGALRM pass
22223 end
22224
22225 define hook-continue
22226 handle SIGALRM pass
22227 end
22228 @end smallexample
22229
22230 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
22231 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
22232 you could define:
22233
22234 @smallexample
22235 define hook-echo
22236 echo <<<---
22237 end
22238
22239 define hookpost-echo
22240 echo --->>>\n
22241 end
22242
22243 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
22244 <<<---Hello World--->>>
22245 (@value{GDBP})
22246
22247 @end smallexample
22248
22249 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
22250 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
22251 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
22252 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
22253 @c or not?
22254 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
22255 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
22256 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
22257
22258 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
22259 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
22260 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
22261
22262 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
22263 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
22264
22265 @node Command Files
22266 @subsection Command Files
22267
22268 @cindex command files
22269 @cindex scripting commands
22270 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
22271 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
22272 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
22273 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
22274 terminal.
22275
22276 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
22277 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
22278 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
22279 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
22280 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
22281
22282 @table @code
22283 @kindex source
22284 @cindex execute commands from a file
22285 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
22286 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
22287 @end table
22288
22289 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
22290 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
22291 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
22292 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
22293 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
22294
22295 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
22296 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
22297 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
22298 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
22299 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
22300 is not relevant to scripts.
22301
22302 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
22303 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
22304 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
22305 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
22306 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
22307 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
22308 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
22309 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
22310 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
22311 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
22312 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
22313 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
22314 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
22315 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
22316
22317 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
22318 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
22319 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
22320
22321 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
22322 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
22323 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
22324 when called from command files.
22325
22326 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
22327 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
22328 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
22329 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
22330 the next command.
22331
22332 @smallexample
22333 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
22334 @end smallexample
22335
22336 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
22337 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
22338 would be directed to @file{log}.
22339
22340 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
22341 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
22342 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
22343 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
22344 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
22345 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
22346 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
22347 conditionally, etc.
22348
22349 @table @code
22350 @kindex if
22351 @kindex else
22352 @item if
22353 @itemx else
22354 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
22355 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
22356 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
22357 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
22358 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
22359 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
22360 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
22361
22362 @kindex while
22363 @item while
22364 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
22365 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
22366 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
22367 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
22368 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
22369 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
22370
22371 @kindex loop_break
22372 @item loop_break
22373 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
22374 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
22375 line.
22376
22377 @kindex loop_continue
22378 @item loop_continue
22379 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
22380 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
22381 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
22382 the controlling expression.
22383
22384 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
22385 @item end
22386 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
22387 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
22388 @end table
22389
22390
22391 @node Output
22392 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
22393
22394 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
22395 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
22396 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
22397 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
22398 want.
22399
22400 @table @code
22401 @kindex echo
22402 @item echo @var{text}
22403 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
22404 @c because it is not in ANSI.
22405 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
22406 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
22407 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
22408 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
22409 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
22410 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
22411 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
22412 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
22413 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
22414
22415 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
22416 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
22417
22418 @smallexample
22419 echo This is some text\n\
22420 which is continued\n\
22421 onto several lines.\n
22422 @end smallexample
22423
22424 produces the same output as
22425
22426 @smallexample
22427 echo This is some text\n
22428 echo which is continued\n
22429 echo onto several lines.\n
22430 @end smallexample
22431
22432 @kindex output
22433 @item output @var{expression}
22434 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
22435 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
22436 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
22437 on expressions.
22438
22439 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
22440 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
22441 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
22442 Formats}, for more information.
22443
22444 @kindex printf
22445 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
22446 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
22447 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
22448 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
22449 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
22450 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
22451 executing the code below:
22452
22453 @smallexample
22454 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
22455 @end smallexample
22456
22457 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
22458 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
22459 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
22460 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
22461 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
22462 printed.
22463
22464 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
22465
22466 @smallexample
22467 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
22468 @end smallexample
22469
22470 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
22471 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
22472 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
22473
22474 @itemize @bullet
22475 @item
22476 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
22477
22478 @item
22479 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
22480 width.
22481
22482 @item
22483 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
22484 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
22485
22486 @item
22487 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
22488 supported.
22489
22490 @item
22491 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
22492
22493 @item
22494 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
22495 @end itemize
22496
22497 @noindent
22498 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
22499 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
22500 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
22501 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
22502
22503 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
22504 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
22505 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
22506 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
22507 supported.
22508
22509 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
22510 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
22511 together with a floating point specifier.
22512 letters:
22513
22514 @itemize @bullet
22515 @item
22516 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
22517
22518 @item
22519 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
22520
22521 @item
22522 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
22523 @end itemize
22524
22525 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
22526 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
22527 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
22528
22529 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
22530 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
22531
22532 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
22533 @smallexample
22534 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
22535 @end smallexample
22536
22537 @kindex eval
22538 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
22539 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
22540 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
22541
22542 @end table
22543
22544 @node Python
22545 @section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
22546 @cindex python scripting
22547 @cindex scripting with python
22548
22549 You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
22550 Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
22551 @value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
22552
22553 @cindex python directory
22554 Python scripts used by @value{GDBN} should be installed in
22555 @file{@var{data-directory}/python}, where @var{data-directory} is
22556 the data directory as determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}).
22557 This directory, known as the @dfn{python directory},
22558 is automatically added to the Python Search Path in order to allow
22559 the Python interpreter to locate all scripts installed at this location.
22560
22561 Additionally, @value{GDBN} commands and convenience functions which
22562 are written in Python and are located in the
22563 @file{@var{data-directory}/python/gdb/command} or
22564 @file{@var{data-directory}/python/gdb/function} directories are
22565 automatically imported when @value{GDBN} starts.
22566
22567 @menu
22568 * Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
22569 * Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
22570 * Python Auto-loading:: Automatically loading Python code.
22571 * Python modules:: Python modules provided by @value{GDBN}.
22572 @end menu
22573
22574 @node Python Commands
22575 @subsection Python Commands
22576 @cindex python commands
22577 @cindex commands to access python
22578
22579 @value{GDBN} provides two commands for accessing the Python interpreter,
22580 and one related setting:
22581
22582 @table @code
22583 @kindex python-interactive
22584 @kindex pi
22585 @item python-interactive @r{[}@var{command}@r{]}
22586 @itemx pi @r{[}@var{command}@r{]}
22587 Without an argument, the @code{python-interactive} command can be used
22588 to start an interactive Python prompt. To return to @value{GDBN},
22589 type the @code{EOF} character (e.g., @kbd{Ctrl-D} on an empty prompt).
22590
22591 Alternatively, a single-line Python command can be given as an
22592 argument and evaluated. If the command is an expression, the result
22593 will be printed; otherwise, nothing will be printed. For example:
22594
22595 @smallexample
22596 (@value{GDBP}) python-interactive 2 + 3
22597 5
22598 @end smallexample
22599
22600 @kindex python
22601 @kindex py
22602 @item python @r{[}@var{command}@r{]}
22603 @itemx py @r{[}@var{command}@r{]}
22604 The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
22605
22606 If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
22607 argument as a Python command. For example:
22608
22609 @smallexample
22610 (@value{GDBP}) python print 23
22611 23
22612 @end smallexample
22613
22614 If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
22615 multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
22616 script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
22617 @code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
22618 containing @code{end}. For example:
22619
22620 @smallexample
22621 (@value{GDBP}) python
22622 Type python script
22623 End with a line saying just "end".
22624 >print 23
22625 >end
22626 23
22627 @end smallexample
22628
22629 @kindex set python print-stack
22630 @item set python print-stack
22631 By default, @value{GDBN} will print only the message component of a
22632 Python exception when an error occurs in a Python script. This can be
22633 controlled using @code{set python print-stack}: if @code{full}, then
22634 full Python stack printing is enabled; if @code{none}, then Python stack
22635 and message printing is disabled; if @code{message}, the default, only
22636 the message component of the error is printed.
22637 @end table
22638
22639 It is also possible to execute a Python script from the @value{GDBN}
22640 interpreter:
22641
22642 @table @code
22643 @item source @file{script-name}
22644 The script name must end with @samp{.py} and @value{GDBN} must be configured
22645 to recognize the script language based on filename extension using
22646 the @code{script-extension} setting. @xref{Extending GDB, ,Extending GDB}.
22647
22648 @item python execfile ("script-name")
22649 This method is based on the @code{execfile} Python built-in function,
22650 and thus is always available.
22651 @end table
22652
22653 @node Python API
22654 @subsection Python API
22655 @cindex python api
22656 @cindex programming in python
22657
22658 @cindex python stdout
22659 @cindex python pagination
22660 At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
22661 @code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
22662 A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
22663 output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
22664 situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
22665
22666 @menu
22667 * Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
22668 * Exception Handling:: How Python exceptions are translated.
22669 * Values From Inferior:: Python representation of values.
22670 * Types In Python:: Python representation of types.
22671 * Pretty Printing API:: Pretty-printing values.
22672 * Selecting Pretty-Printers:: How GDB chooses a pretty-printer.
22673 * Writing a Pretty-Printer:: Writing a Pretty-Printer.
22674 * Inferiors In Python:: Python representation of inferiors (processes)
22675 * Events In Python:: Listening for events from @value{GDBN}.
22676 * Threads In Python:: Accessing inferior threads from Python.
22677 * Commands In Python:: Implementing new commands in Python.
22678 * Parameters In Python:: Adding new @value{GDBN} parameters.
22679 * Functions In Python:: Writing new convenience functions.
22680 * Progspaces In Python:: Program spaces.
22681 * Objfiles In Python:: Object files.
22682 * Frames In Python:: Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
22683 * Blocks In Python:: Accessing frame blocks from Python.
22684 * Symbols In Python:: Python representation of symbols.
22685 * Symbol Tables In Python:: Python representation of symbol tables.
22686 * Breakpoints In Python:: Manipulating breakpoints using Python.
22687 * Finish Breakpoints in Python:: Setting Breakpoints on function return
22688 using Python.
22689 * Lazy Strings In Python:: Python representation of lazy strings.
22690 @end menu
22691
22692 @node Basic Python
22693 @subsubsection Basic Python
22694
22695 @cindex python functions
22696 @cindex python module
22697 @cindex gdb module
22698 @value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
22699 methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
22700 @value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
22701 use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
22702
22703 @findex gdb.PYTHONDIR
22704 @defvar gdb.PYTHONDIR
22705 A string containing the python directory (@pxref{Python}).
22706 @end defvar
22707
22708 @findex gdb.execute
22709 @defun gdb.execute (command @r{[}, from_tty @r{[}, to_string@r{]]})
22710 Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
22711 If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
22712 translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
22713
22714 @var{from_tty} specifies whether @value{GDBN} ought to consider this
22715 command as having originated from the user invoking it interactively.
22716 It must be a boolean value. If omitted, it defaults to @code{False}.
22717
22718 By default, any output produced by @var{command} is sent to
22719 @value{GDBN}'s standard output. If the @var{to_string} parameter is
22720 @code{True}, then output will be collected by @code{gdb.execute} and
22721 returned as a string. The default is @code{False}, in which case the
22722 return value is @code{None}. If @var{to_string} is @code{True}, the
22723 @value{GDBN} virtual terminal will be temporarily set to unlimited width
22724 and height, and its pagination will be disabled; @pxref{Screen Size}.
22725 @end defun
22726
22727 @findex gdb.breakpoints
22728 @defun gdb.breakpoints ()
22729 Return a sequence holding all of @value{GDBN}'s breakpoints.
22730 @xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for more information.
22731 @end defun
22732
22733 @findex gdb.parameter
22734 @defun gdb.parameter (parameter)
22735 Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
22736 string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
22737 spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
22738 @samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
22739
22740 If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
22741 @code{gdb.error} (@pxref{Exception Handling}). Otherwise, the
22742 parameter's value is converted to a Python value of the appropriate
22743 type, and returned.
22744 @end defun
22745
22746 @findex gdb.history
22747 @defun gdb.history (number)
22748 Return a value from @value{GDBN}'s value history (@pxref{Value
22749 History}). @var{number} indicates which history element to return.
22750 If @var{number} is negative, then @value{GDBN} will take its absolute value
22751 and count backward from the last element (i.e., the most recent element) to
22752 find the value to return. If @var{number} is zero, then @value{GDBN} will
22753 return the most recent element. If the element specified by @var{number}
22754 doesn't exist in the value history, a @code{gdb.error} exception will be
22755 raised.
22756
22757 If no exception is raised, the return value is always an instance of
22758 @code{gdb.Value} (@pxref{Values From Inferior}).
22759 @end defun
22760
22761 @findex gdb.parse_and_eval
22762 @defun gdb.parse_and_eval (expression)
22763 Parse @var{expression} as an expression in the current language,
22764 evaluate it, and return the result as a @code{gdb.Value}.
22765 @var{expression} must be a string.
22766
22767 This function can be useful when implementing a new command
22768 (@pxref{Commands In Python}), as it provides a way to parse the
22769 command's argument as an expression. It is also useful simply to
22770 compute values, for example, it is the only way to get the value of a
22771 convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) as a @code{gdb.Value}.
22772 @end defun
22773
22774 @findex gdb.find_pc_line
22775 @defun gdb.find_pc_line (pc)
22776 Return the @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object corresponding to the
22777 @var{pc} value. @xref{Symbol Tables In Python}. If an invalid
22778 value of @var{pc} is passed as an argument, then the @code{symtab} and
22779 @code{line} attributes of the returned @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object
22780 will be @code{None} and 0 respectively.
22781 @end defun
22782
22783 @findex gdb.post_event
22784 @defun gdb.post_event (event)
22785 Put @var{event}, a callable object taking no arguments, into
22786 @value{GDBN}'s internal event queue. This callable will be invoked at
22787 some later point, during @value{GDBN}'s event processing. Events
22788 posted using @code{post_event} will be run in the order in which they
22789 were posted; however, there is no way to know when they will be
22790 processed relative to other events inside @value{GDBN}.
22791
22792 @value{GDBN} is not thread-safe. If your Python program uses multiple
22793 threads, you must be careful to only call @value{GDBN}-specific
22794 functions in the main @value{GDBN} thread. @code{post_event} ensures
22795 this. For example:
22796
22797 @smallexample
22798 (@value{GDBP}) python
22799 >import threading
22800 >
22801 >class Writer():
22802 > def __init__(self, message):
22803 > self.message = message;
22804 > def __call__(self):
22805 > gdb.write(self.message)
22806 >
22807 >class MyThread1 (threading.Thread):
22808 > def run (self):
22809 > gdb.post_event(Writer("Hello "))
22810 >
22811 >class MyThread2 (threading.Thread):
22812 > def run (self):
22813 > gdb.post_event(Writer("World\n"))
22814 >
22815 >MyThread1().start()
22816 >MyThread2().start()
22817 >end
22818 (@value{GDBP}) Hello World
22819 @end smallexample
22820 @end defun
22821
22822 @findex gdb.write
22823 @defun gdb.write (string @r{[}, stream{]})
22824 Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated output stream. The
22825 optional @var{stream} determines the stream to print to. The default
22826 stream is @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream. Possible stream
22827 values are:
22828
22829 @table @code
22830 @findex STDOUT
22831 @findex gdb.STDOUT
22832 @item gdb.STDOUT
22833 @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream.
22834
22835 @findex STDERR
22836 @findex gdb.STDERR
22837 @item gdb.STDERR
22838 @value{GDBN}'s standard error stream.
22839
22840 @findex STDLOG
22841 @findex gdb.STDLOG
22842 @item gdb.STDLOG
22843 @value{GDBN}'s log stream (@pxref{Logging Output}).
22844 @end table
22845
22846 Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
22847 call this function and will automatically direct the output to the
22848 relevant stream.
22849 @end defun
22850
22851 @findex gdb.flush
22852 @defun gdb.flush ()
22853 Flush the buffer of a @value{GDBN} paginated stream so that the
22854 contents are displayed immediately. @value{GDBN} will flush the
22855 contents of a stream automatically when it encounters a newline in the
22856 buffer. The optional @var{stream} determines the stream to flush. The
22857 default stream is @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream. Possible
22858 stream values are:
22859
22860 @table @code
22861 @findex STDOUT
22862 @findex gdb.STDOUT
22863 @item gdb.STDOUT
22864 @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream.
22865
22866 @findex STDERR
22867 @findex gdb.STDERR
22868 @item gdb.STDERR
22869 @value{GDBN}'s standard error stream.
22870
22871 @findex STDLOG
22872 @findex gdb.STDLOG
22873 @item gdb.STDLOG
22874 @value{GDBN}'s log stream (@pxref{Logging Output}).
22875
22876 @end table
22877
22878 Flushing @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
22879 call this function for the relevant stream.
22880 @end defun
22881
22882 @findex gdb.target_charset
22883 @defun gdb.target_charset ()
22884 Return the name of the current target character set (@pxref{Character
22885 Sets}). This differs from @code{gdb.parameter('target-charset')} in
22886 that @samp{auto} is never returned.
22887 @end defun
22888
22889 @findex gdb.target_wide_charset
22890 @defun gdb.target_wide_charset ()
22891 Return the name of the current target wide character set
22892 (@pxref{Character Sets}). This differs from
22893 @code{gdb.parameter('target-wide-charset')} in that @samp{auto} is
22894 never returned.
22895 @end defun
22896
22897 @findex gdb.solib_name
22898 @defun gdb.solib_name (address)
22899 Return the name of the shared library holding the given @var{address}
22900 as a string, or @code{None}.
22901 @end defun
22902
22903 @findex gdb.decode_line
22904 @defun gdb.decode_line @r{[}expression@r{]}
22905 Return locations of the line specified by @var{expression}, or of the
22906 current line if no argument was given. This function returns a Python
22907 tuple containing two elements. The first element contains a string
22908 holding any unparsed section of @var{expression} (or @code{None} if
22909 the expression has been fully parsed). The second element contains
22910 either @code{None} or another tuple that contains all the locations
22911 that match the expression represented as @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line}
22912 objects (@pxref{Symbol Tables In Python}). If @var{expression} is
22913 provided, it is decoded the way that @value{GDBN}'s inbuilt
22914 @code{break} or @code{edit} commands do (@pxref{Specify Location}).
22915 @end defun
22916
22917 @defun gdb.prompt_hook (current_prompt)
22918 @anchor{prompt_hook}
22919
22920 If @var{prompt_hook} is callable, @value{GDBN} will call the method
22921 assigned to this operation before a prompt is displayed by
22922 @value{GDBN}.
22923
22924 The parameter @code{current_prompt} contains the current @value{GDBN}
22925 prompt. This method must return a Python string, or @code{None}. If
22926 a string is returned, the @value{GDBN} prompt will be set to that
22927 string. If @code{None} is returned, @value{GDBN} will continue to use
22928 the current prompt.
22929
22930 Some prompts cannot be substituted in @value{GDBN}. Secondary prompts
22931 such as those used by readline for command input, and annotation
22932 related prompts are prohibited from being changed.
22933 @end defun
22934
22935 @node Exception Handling
22936 @subsubsection Exception Handling
22937 @cindex python exceptions
22938 @cindex exceptions, python
22939
22940 When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
22941 uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
22942 @value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
22943 @code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
22944 terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
22945 exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
22946 backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
22947
22948 @smallexample
22949 (@value{GDBP}) python print foo
22950 Traceback (most recent call last):
22951 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
22952 NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
22953 @end smallexample
22954
22955 @value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by
22956 Python code are converted to Python exceptions. The type of the
22957 Python exception depends on the error.
22958
22959 @ftable @code
22960 @item gdb.error
22961 This is the base class for most exceptions generated by @value{GDBN}.
22962 It is derived from @code{RuntimeError}, for compatibility with earlier
22963 versions of @value{GDBN}.
22964
22965 If an error occurring in @value{GDBN} does not fit into some more
22966 specific category, then the generated exception will have this type.
22967
22968 @item gdb.MemoryError
22969 This is a subclass of @code{gdb.error} which is thrown when an
22970 operation tried to access invalid memory in the inferior.
22971
22972 @item KeyboardInterrupt
22973 User interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
22974 prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception.
22975 @end ftable
22976
22977 In all cases, your exception handler will see the @value{GDBN} error
22978 message as its value and the Python call stack backtrace at the Python
22979 statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
22980 traceback.
22981
22982 @findex gdb.GdbError
22983 When implementing @value{GDBN} commands in Python via @code{gdb.Command},
22984 it is useful to be able to throw an exception that doesn't cause a
22985 traceback to be printed. For example, the user may have invoked the
22986 command incorrectly. Use the @code{gdb.GdbError} exception
22987 to handle this case. Example:
22988
22989 @smallexample
22990 (gdb) python
22991 >class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
22992 > """Greet the whole world."""
22993 > def __init__ (self):
22994 > super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_USER)
22995 > def invoke (self, args, from_tty):
22996 > argv = gdb.string_to_argv (args)
22997 > if len (argv) != 0:
22998 > raise gdb.GdbError ("hello-world takes no arguments")
22999 > print "Hello, World!"
23000 >HelloWorld ()
23001 >end
23002 (gdb) hello-world 42
23003 hello-world takes no arguments
23004 @end smallexample
23005
23006 @node Values From Inferior
23007 @subsubsection Values From Inferior
23008 @cindex values from inferior, with Python
23009 @cindex python, working with values from inferior
23010
23011 @cindex @code{gdb.Value}
23012 @value{GDBN} provides values it obtains from the inferior program in
23013 an object of type @code{gdb.Value}. @value{GDBN} uses this object
23014 for its internal bookkeeping of the inferior's values, and for
23015 fetching values when necessary.
23016
23017 Inferior values that are simple scalars can be used directly in
23018 Python expressions that are valid for the value's data type. Here's
23019 an example for an integer or floating-point value @code{some_val}:
23020
23021 @smallexample
23022 bar = some_val + 2
23023 @end smallexample
23024
23025 @noindent
23026 As result of this, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object
23027 whose values are of the same type as those of @code{some_val}.
23028
23029 Inferior values that are structures or instances of some class can
23030 be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}. For example, if
23031 @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance holding a structure, you
23032 can access its @code{foo} element with:
23033
23034 @smallexample
23035 bar = some_val['foo']
23036 @end smallexample
23037
23038 Again, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object.
23039
23040 A @code{gdb.Value} that represents a function can be executed via
23041 inferior function call. Any arguments provided to the call must match
23042 the function's prototype, and must be provided in the order specified
23043 by that prototype.
23044
23045 For example, @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance
23046 representing a function that takes two integers as arguments. To
23047 execute this function, call it like so:
23048
23049 @smallexample
23050 result = some_val (10,20)
23051 @end smallexample
23052
23053 Any values returned from a function call will be stored as a
23054 @code{gdb.Value}.
23055
23056 The following attributes are provided:
23057
23058 @table @code
23059 @defvar Value.address
23060 If this object is addressable, this read-only attribute holds a
23061 @code{gdb.Value} object representing the address. Otherwise,
23062 this attribute holds @code{None}.
23063 @end defvar
23064
23065 @cindex optimized out value in Python
23066 @defvar Value.is_optimized_out
23067 This read-only boolean attribute is true if the compiler optimized out
23068 this value, thus it is not available for fetching from the inferior.
23069 @end defvar
23070
23071 @defvar Value.type
23072 The type of this @code{gdb.Value}. The value of this attribute is a
23073 @code{gdb.Type} object (@pxref{Types In Python}).
23074 @end defvar
23075
23076 @defvar Value.dynamic_type
23077 The dynamic type of this @code{gdb.Value}. This uses C@t{++} run-time
23078 type information (@acronym{RTTI}) to determine the dynamic type of the
23079 value. If this value is of class type, it will return the class in
23080 which the value is embedded, if any. If this value is of pointer or
23081 reference to a class type, it will compute the dynamic type of the
23082 referenced object, and return a pointer or reference to that type,
23083 respectively. In all other cases, it will return the value's static
23084 type.
23085
23086 Note that this feature will only work when debugging a C@t{++} program
23087 that includes @acronym{RTTI} for the object in question. Otherwise,
23088 it will just return the static type of the value as in @kbd{ptype foo}
23089 (@pxref{Symbols, ptype}).
23090 @end defvar
23091
23092 @defvar Value.is_lazy
23093 The value of this read-only boolean attribute is @code{True} if this
23094 @code{gdb.Value} has not yet been fetched from the inferior.
23095 @value{GDBN} does not fetch values until necessary, for efficiency.
23096 For example:
23097
23098 @smallexample
23099 myval = gdb.parse_and_eval ('somevar')
23100 @end smallexample
23101
23102 The value of @code{somevar} is not fetched at this time. It will be
23103 fetched when the value is needed, or when the @code{fetch_lazy}
23104 method is invoked.
23105 @end defvar
23106 @end table
23107
23108 The following methods are provided:
23109
23110 @table @code
23111 @defun Value.__init__ (@var{val})
23112 Many Python values can be converted directly to a @code{gdb.Value} via
23113 this object initializer. Specifically:
23114
23115 @table @asis
23116 @item Python boolean
23117 A Python boolean is converted to the boolean type from the current
23118 language.
23119
23120 @item Python integer
23121 A Python integer is converted to the C @code{long} type for the
23122 current architecture.
23123
23124 @item Python long
23125 A Python long is converted to the C @code{long long} type for the
23126 current architecture.
23127
23128 @item Python float
23129 A Python float is converted to the C @code{double} type for the
23130 current architecture.
23131
23132 @item Python string
23133 A Python string is converted to a target string, using the current
23134 target encoding.
23135
23136 @item @code{gdb.Value}
23137 If @code{val} is a @code{gdb.Value}, then a copy of the value is made.
23138
23139 @item @code{gdb.LazyString}
23140 If @code{val} is a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings In
23141 Python}), then the lazy string's @code{value} method is called, and
23142 its result is used.
23143 @end table
23144 @end defun
23145
23146 @defun Value.cast (type)
23147 Return a new instance of @code{gdb.Value} that is the result of
23148 casting this instance to the type described by @var{type}, which must
23149 be a @code{gdb.Type} object. If the cast cannot be performed for some
23150 reason, this method throws an exception.
23151 @end defun
23152
23153 @defun Value.dereference ()
23154 For pointer data types, this method returns a new @code{gdb.Value} object
23155 whose contents is the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if
23156 @code{foo} is a C pointer to an @code{int}, declared in your C program as
23157
23158 @smallexample
23159 int *foo;
23160 @end smallexample
23161
23162 @noindent
23163 then you can use the corresponding @code{gdb.Value} to access what
23164 @code{foo} points to like this:
23165
23166 @smallexample
23167 bar = foo.dereference ()
23168 @end smallexample
23169
23170 The result @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Value} object holding the
23171 value pointed to by @code{foo}.
23172
23173 A similar function @code{Value.referenced_value} exists which also
23174 returns @code{gdb.Value} objects corresonding to the values pointed to
23175 by pointer values (and additionally, values referenced by reference
23176 values). However, the behavior of @code{Value.dereference}
23177 differs from @code{Value.referenced_value} by the fact that the
23178 behavior of @code{Value.dereference} is identical to applying the C
23179 unary operator @code{*} on a given value. For example, consider a
23180 reference to a pointer @code{ptrref}, declared in your C@t{++} program
23181 as
23182
23183 @smallexample
23184 typedef int *intptr;
23185 ...
23186 int val = 10;
23187 intptr ptr = &val;
23188 intptr &ptrref = ptr;
23189 @end smallexample
23190
23191 Though @code{ptrref} is a reference value, one can apply the method
23192 @code{Value.dereference} to the @code{gdb.Value} object corresponding
23193 to it and obtain a @code{gdb.Value} which is identical to that
23194 corresponding to @code{val}. However, if you apply the method
23195 @code{Value.referenced_value}, the result would be a @code{gdb.Value}
23196 object identical to that corresponding to @code{ptr}.
23197
23198 @smallexample
23199 py_ptrref = gdb.parse_and_eval ("ptrref")
23200 py_val = py_ptrref.dereference ()
23201 py_ptr = py_ptrref.referenced_value ()
23202 @end smallexample
23203
23204 The @code{gdb.Value} object @code{py_val} is identical to that
23205 corresponding to @code{val}, and @code{py_ptr} is identical to that
23206 corresponding to @code{ptr}. In general, @code{Value.dereference} can
23207 be applied whenever the C unary operator @code{*} can be applied
23208 to the corresponding C value. For those cases where applying both
23209 @code{Value.dereference} and @code{Value.referenced_value} is allowed,
23210 the results obtained need not be identical (as we have seen in the above
23211 example). The results are however identical when applied on
23212 @code{gdb.Value} objects corresponding to pointers (@code{gdb.Value}
23213 objects with type code @code{TYPE_CODE_PTR}) in a C/C@t{++} program.
23214 @end defun
23215
23216 @defun Value.referenced_value ()
23217 For pointer or reference data types, this method returns a new
23218 @code{gdb.Value} object corresponding to the value referenced by the
23219 pointer/reference value. For pointer data types,
23220 @code{Value.dereference} and @code{Value.referenced_value} produce
23221 identical results. The difference between these methods is that
23222 @code{Value.dereference} cannot get the values referenced by reference
23223 values. For example, consider a reference to an @code{int}, declared
23224 in your C@t{++} program as
23225
23226 @smallexample
23227 int val = 10;
23228 int &ref = val;
23229 @end smallexample
23230
23231 @noindent
23232 then applying @code{Value.dereference} to the @code{gdb.Value} object
23233 corresponding to @code{ref} will result in an error, while applying
23234 @code{Value.referenced_value} will result in a @code{gdb.Value} object
23235 identical to that corresponding to @code{val}.
23236
23237 @smallexample
23238 py_ref = gdb.parse_and_eval ("ref")
23239 er_ref = py_ref.dereference () # Results in error
23240 py_val = py_ref.referenced_value () # Returns the referenced value
23241 @end smallexample
23242
23243 The @code{gdb.Value} object @code{py_val} is identical to that
23244 corresponding to @code{val}.
23245 @end defun
23246
23247 @defun Value.dynamic_cast (type)
23248 Like @code{Value.cast}, but works as if the C@t{++} @code{dynamic_cast}
23249 operator were used. Consult a C@t{++} reference for details.
23250 @end defun
23251
23252 @defun Value.reinterpret_cast (type)
23253 Like @code{Value.cast}, but works as if the C@t{++} @code{reinterpret_cast}
23254 operator were used. Consult a C@t{++} reference for details.
23255 @end defun
23256
23257 @defun Value.string (@r{[}encoding@r{[}, errors@r{[}, length@r{]]]})
23258 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
23259 converts the contents to a Python string. Otherwise, this method will
23260 throw an exception.
23261
23262 Strings are recognized in a language-specific way; whether a given
23263 @code{gdb.Value} represents a string is determined by the current
23264 language.
23265
23266 For C-like languages, a value is a string if it is a pointer to or an
23267 array of characters or ints. The string is assumed to be terminated
23268 by a zero of the appropriate width. However if the optional length
23269 argument is given, the string will be converted to that given length,
23270 ignoring any embedded zeros that the string may contain.
23271
23272 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
23273 naming the encoding of the string in the @code{gdb.Value}, such as
23274 @code{"ascii"}, @code{"iso-8859-6"} or @code{"utf-8"}. It accepts
23275 the same encodings as the corresponding argument to Python's
23276 @code{string.decode} method, and the Python codec machinery will be used
23277 to convert the string. If @var{encoding} is not given, or if
23278 @var{encoding} is the empty string, then either the @code{target-charset}
23279 (@pxref{Character Sets}) will be used, or a language-specific encoding
23280 will be used, if the current language is able to supply one.
23281
23282 The optional @var{errors} argument is the same as the corresponding
23283 argument to Python's @code{string.decode} method.
23284
23285 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
23286 fetched and converted to the given length.
23287 @end defun
23288
23289 @defun Value.lazy_string (@r{[}encoding @r{[}, length@r{]]})
23290 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
23291 converts the contents to a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings
23292 In Python}). Otherwise, this method will throw an exception.
23293
23294 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
23295 naming the encoding of the @code{gdb.LazyString}. Some examples are:
23296 @samp{ascii}, @samp{iso-8859-6} or @samp{utf-8}. If the
23297 @var{encoding} argument is an encoding that @value{GDBN} does
23298 recognize, @value{GDBN} will raise an error.
23299
23300 When a lazy string is printed, the @value{GDBN} encoding machinery is
23301 used to convert the string during printing. If the optional
23302 @var{encoding} argument is not provided, or is an empty string,
23303 @value{GDBN} will automatically select the encoding most suitable for
23304 the string type. For further information on encoding in @value{GDBN}
23305 please see @ref{Character Sets}.
23306
23307 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
23308 fetched and encoded to the length of characters specified. If
23309 the @var{length} argument is not provided, the string will be fetched
23310 and encoded until a null of appropriate width is found.
23311 @end defun
23312
23313 @defun Value.fetch_lazy ()
23314 If the @code{gdb.Value} object is currently a lazy value
23315 (@code{gdb.Value.is_lazy} is @code{True}), then the value is
23316 fetched from the inferior. Any errors that occur in the process
23317 will produce a Python exception.
23318
23319 If the @code{gdb.Value} object is not a lazy value, this method
23320 has no effect.
23321
23322 This method does not return a value.
23323 @end defun
23324
23325 @end table
23326
23327 @node Types In Python
23328 @subsubsection Types In Python
23329 @cindex types in Python
23330 @cindex Python, working with types
23331
23332 @tindex gdb.Type
23333 @value{GDBN} represents types from the inferior using the class
23334 @code{gdb.Type}.
23335
23336 The following type-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
23337 module:
23338
23339 @findex gdb.lookup_type
23340 @defun gdb.lookup_type (name @r{[}, block@r{]})
23341 This function looks up a type by name. @var{name} is the name of the
23342 type to look up. It must be a string.
23343
23344 If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
23345 Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
23346
23347 Ordinarily, this function will return an instance of @code{gdb.Type}.
23348 If the named type cannot be found, it will throw an exception.
23349 @end defun
23350
23351 If the type is a structure or class type, or an enum type, the fields
23352 of that type can be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}.
23353 For example, if @code{some_type} is a @code{gdb.Type} instance holding
23354 a structure type, you can access its @code{foo} field with:
23355
23356 @smallexample
23357 bar = some_type['foo']
23358 @end smallexample
23359
23360 @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Field} object; see below under the
23361 description of the @code{Type.fields} method for a description of the
23362 @code{gdb.Field} class.
23363
23364 An instance of @code{Type} has the following attributes:
23365
23366 @table @code
23367 @defvar Type.code
23368 The type code for this type. The type code will be one of the
23369 @code{TYPE_CODE_} constants defined below.
23370 @end defvar
23371
23372 @defvar Type.sizeof
23373 The size of this type, in target @code{char} units. Usually, a
23374 target's @code{char} type will be an 8-bit byte. However, on some
23375 unusual platforms, this type may have a different size.
23376 @end defvar
23377
23378 @defvar Type.tag
23379 The tag name for this type. The tag name is the name after
23380 @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} in C and C@t{++}; not all
23381 languages have this concept. If this type has no tag name, then
23382 @code{None} is returned.
23383 @end defvar
23384 @end table
23385
23386 The following methods are provided:
23387
23388 @table @code
23389 @defun Type.fields ()
23390 For structure and union types, this method returns the fields. Range
23391 types have two fields, the minimum and maximum values. Enum types
23392 have one field per enum constant. Function and method types have one
23393 field per parameter. The base types of C@t{++} classes are also
23394 represented as fields. If the type has no fields, or does not fit
23395 into one of these categories, an empty sequence will be returned.
23396
23397 Each field is a @code{gdb.Field} object, with some pre-defined attributes:
23398 @table @code
23399 @item bitpos
23400 This attribute is not available for @code{static} fields (as in
23401 C@t{++} or Java). For non-@code{static} fields, the value is the bit
23402 position of the field. For @code{enum} fields, the value is the
23403 enumeration member's integer representation.
23404
23405 @item name
23406 The name of the field, or @code{None} for anonymous fields.
23407
23408 @item artificial
23409 This is @code{True} if the field is artificial, usually meaning that
23410 it was provided by the compiler and not the user. This attribute is
23411 always provided, and is @code{False} if the field is not artificial.
23412
23413 @item is_base_class
23414 This is @code{True} if the field represents a base class of a C@t{++}
23415 structure. This attribute is always provided, and is @code{False}
23416 if the field is not a base class of the type that is the argument of
23417 @code{fields}, or if that type was not a C@t{++} class.
23418
23419 @item bitsize
23420 If the field is packed, or is a bitfield, then this will have a
23421 non-zero value, which is the size of the field in bits. Otherwise,
23422 this will be zero; in this case the field's size is given by its type.
23423
23424 @item type
23425 The type of the field. This is usually an instance of @code{Type},
23426 but it can be @code{None} in some situations.
23427 @end table
23428 @end defun
23429
23430 @defun Type.array (@var{n1} @r{[}, @var{n2}@r{]})
23431 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an array of this
23432 type. If one argument is given, it is the inclusive upper bound of
23433 the array; in this case the lower bound is zero. If two arguments are
23434 given, the first argument is the lower bound of the array, and the
23435 second argument is the upper bound of the array. An array's length
23436 must not be negative, but the bounds can be.
23437 @end defun
23438
23439 @defun Type.vector (@var{n1} @r{[}, @var{n2}@r{]})
23440 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a vector of this
23441 type. If one argument is given, it is the inclusive upper bound of
23442 the vector; in this case the lower bound is zero. If two arguments are
23443 given, the first argument is the lower bound of the vector, and the
23444 second argument is the upper bound of the vector. A vector's length
23445 must not be negative, but the bounds can be.
23446
23447 The difference between an @code{array} and a @code{vector} is that
23448 arrays behave like in C: when used in expressions they decay to a pointer
23449 to the first element whereas vectors are treated as first class values.
23450 @end defun
23451
23452 @defun Type.const ()
23453 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
23454 @code{const}-qualified variant of this type.
23455 @end defun
23456
23457 @defun Type.volatile ()
23458 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
23459 @code{volatile}-qualified variant of this type.
23460 @end defun
23461
23462 @defun Type.unqualified ()
23463 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an unqualified
23464 variant of this type. That is, the result is neither @code{const} nor
23465 @code{volatile}.
23466 @end defun
23467
23468 @defun Type.range ()
23469 Return a Python @code{Tuple} object that contains two elements: the
23470 low bound of the argument type and the high bound of that type. If
23471 the type does not have a range, @value{GDBN} will raise a
23472 @code{gdb.error} exception (@pxref{Exception Handling}).
23473 @end defun
23474
23475 @defun Type.reference ()
23476 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a reference to this
23477 type.
23478 @end defun
23479
23480 @defun Type.pointer ()
23481 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a pointer to this
23482 type.
23483 @end defun
23484
23485 @defun Type.strip_typedefs ()
23486 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} that represents the real type,
23487 after removing all layers of typedefs.
23488 @end defun
23489
23490 @defun Type.target ()
23491 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents the target type
23492 of this type.
23493
23494 For a pointer type, the target type is the type of the pointed-to
23495 object. For an array type (meaning C-like arrays), the target type is
23496 the type of the elements of the array. For a function or method type,
23497 the target type is the type of the return value. For a complex type,
23498 the target type is the type of the elements. For a typedef, the
23499 target type is the aliased type.
23500
23501 If the type does not have a target, this method will throw an
23502 exception.
23503 @end defun
23504
23505 @defun Type.template_argument (n @r{[}, block@r{]})
23506 If this @code{gdb.Type} is an instantiation of a template, this will
23507 return a new @code{gdb.Type} which represents the type of the
23508 @var{n}th template argument.
23509
23510 If this @code{gdb.Type} is not a template type, this will throw an
23511 exception. Ordinarily, only C@t{++} code will have template types.
23512
23513 If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
23514 Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
23515 @end defun
23516 @end table
23517
23518
23519 Each type has a code, which indicates what category this type falls
23520 into. The available type categories are represented by constants
23521 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
23522
23523 @table @code
23524 @findex TYPE_CODE_PTR
23525 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_PTR
23526 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_PTR
23527 The type is a pointer.
23528
23529 @findex TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
23530 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
23531 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
23532 The type is an array.
23533
23534 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
23535 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
23536 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
23537 The type is a structure.
23538
23539 @findex TYPE_CODE_UNION
23540 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_UNION
23541 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_UNION
23542 The type is a union.
23543
23544 @findex TYPE_CODE_ENUM
23545 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ENUM
23546 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_ENUM
23547 The type is an enum.
23548
23549 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
23550 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
23551 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
23552 A bit flags type, used for things such as status registers.
23553
23554 @findex TYPE_CODE_FUNC
23555 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FUNC
23556 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_FUNC
23557 The type is a function.
23558
23559 @findex TYPE_CODE_INT
23560 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INT
23561 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_INT
23562 The type is an integer type.
23563
23564 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLT
23565 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLT
23566 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLT
23567 A floating point type.
23568
23569 @findex TYPE_CODE_VOID
23570 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_VOID
23571 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_VOID
23572 The special type @code{void}.
23573
23574 @findex TYPE_CODE_SET
23575 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_SET
23576 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_SET
23577 A Pascal set type.
23578
23579 @findex TYPE_CODE_RANGE
23580 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_RANGE
23581 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_RANGE
23582 A range type, that is, an integer type with bounds.
23583
23584 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRING
23585 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRING
23586 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRING
23587 A string type. Note that this is only used for certain languages with
23588 language-defined string types; C strings are not represented this way.
23589
23590 @findex TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
23591 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
23592 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
23593 A string of bits. It is deprecated.
23594
23595 @findex TYPE_CODE_ERROR
23596 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ERROR
23597 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_ERROR
23598 An unknown or erroneous type.
23599
23600 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHOD
23601 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHOD
23602 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHOD
23603 A method type, as found in C@t{++} or Java.
23604
23605 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
23606 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
23607 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
23608 A pointer-to-member-function.
23609
23610 @findex TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
23611 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
23612 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
23613 A pointer-to-member.
23614
23615 @findex TYPE_CODE_REF
23616 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_REF
23617 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_REF
23618 A reference type.
23619
23620 @findex TYPE_CODE_CHAR
23621 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_CHAR
23622 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_CHAR
23623 A character type.
23624
23625 @findex TYPE_CODE_BOOL
23626 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BOOL
23627 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_BOOL
23628 A boolean type.
23629
23630 @findex TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
23631 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
23632 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
23633 A complex float type.
23634
23635 @findex TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
23636 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
23637 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
23638 A typedef to some other type.
23639
23640 @findex TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
23641 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
23642 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
23643 A C@t{++} namespace.
23644
23645 @findex TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
23646 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
23647 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
23648 A decimal floating point type.
23649
23650 @findex TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
23651 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
23652 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
23653 A function internal to @value{GDBN}. This is the type used to represent
23654 convenience functions.
23655 @end table
23656
23657 Further support for types is provided in the @code{gdb.types}
23658 Python module (@pxref{gdb.types}).
23659
23660 @node Pretty Printing API
23661 @subsubsection Pretty Printing API
23662
23663 An example output is provided (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
23664
23665 A pretty-printer is just an object that holds a value and implements a
23666 specific interface, defined here.
23667
23668 @defun pretty_printer.children (self)
23669 @value{GDBN} will call this method on a pretty-printer to compute the
23670 children of the pretty-printer's value.
23671
23672 This method must return an object conforming to the Python iterator
23673 protocol. Each item returned by the iterator must be a tuple holding
23674 two elements. The first element is the ``name'' of the child; the
23675 second element is the child's value. The value can be any Python
23676 object which is convertible to a @value{GDBN} value.
23677
23678 This method is optional. If it does not exist, @value{GDBN} will act
23679 as though the value has no children.
23680 @end defun
23681
23682 @defun pretty_printer.display_hint (self)
23683 The CLI may call this method and use its result to change the
23684 formatting of a value. The result will also be supplied to an MI
23685 consumer as a @samp{displayhint} attribute of the variable being
23686 printed.
23687
23688 This method is optional. If it does exist, this method must return a
23689 string.
23690
23691 Some display hints are predefined by @value{GDBN}:
23692
23693 @table @samp
23694 @item array
23695 Indicate that the object being printed is ``array-like''. The CLI
23696 uses this to respect parameters such as @code{set print elements} and
23697 @code{set print array}.
23698
23699 @item map
23700 Indicate that the object being printed is ``map-like'', and that the
23701 children of this value can be assumed to alternate between keys and
23702 values.
23703
23704 @item string
23705 Indicate that the object being printed is ``string-like''. If the
23706 printer's @code{to_string} method returns a Python string of some
23707 kind, then @value{GDBN} will call its internal language-specific
23708 string-printing function to format the string. For the CLI this means
23709 adding quotation marks, possibly escaping some characters, respecting
23710 @code{set print elements}, and the like.
23711 @end table
23712 @end defun
23713
23714 @defun pretty_printer.to_string (self)
23715 @value{GDBN} will call this method to display the string
23716 representation of the value passed to the object's constructor.
23717
23718 When printing from the CLI, if the @code{to_string} method exists,
23719 then @value{GDBN} will prepend its result to the values returned by
23720 @code{children}. Exactly how this formatting is done is dependent on
23721 the display hint, and may change as more hints are added. Also,
23722 depending on the print settings (@pxref{Print Settings}), the CLI may
23723 print just the result of @code{to_string} in a stack trace, omitting
23724 the result of @code{children}.
23725
23726 If this method returns a string, it is printed verbatim.
23727
23728 Otherwise, if this method returns an instance of @code{gdb.Value},
23729 then @value{GDBN} prints this value. This may result in a call to
23730 another pretty-printer.
23731
23732 If instead the method returns a Python value which is convertible to a
23733 @code{gdb.Value}, then @value{GDBN} performs the conversion and prints
23734 the resulting value. Again, this may result in a call to another
23735 pretty-printer. Python scalars (integers, floats, and booleans) and
23736 strings are convertible to @code{gdb.Value}; other types are not.
23737
23738 Finally, if this method returns @code{None} then no further operations
23739 are peformed in this method and nothing is printed.
23740
23741 If the result is not one of these types, an exception is raised.
23742 @end defun
23743
23744 @value{GDBN} provides a function which can be used to look up the
23745 default pretty-printer for a @code{gdb.Value}:
23746
23747 @findex gdb.default_visualizer
23748 @defun gdb.default_visualizer (value)
23749 This function takes a @code{gdb.Value} object as an argument. If a
23750 pretty-printer for this value exists, then it is returned. If no such
23751 printer exists, then this returns @code{None}.
23752 @end defun
23753
23754 @node Selecting Pretty-Printers
23755 @subsubsection Selecting Pretty-Printers
23756
23757 The Python list @code{gdb.pretty_printers} contains an array of
23758 functions or callable objects that have been registered via addition
23759 as a pretty-printer. Printers in this list are called @code{global}
23760 printers, they're available when debugging all inferiors.
23761 Each @code{gdb.Progspace} contains a @code{pretty_printers} attribute.
23762 Each @code{gdb.Objfile} also contains a @code{pretty_printers}
23763 attribute.
23764
23765 Each function on these lists is passed a single @code{gdb.Value}
23766 argument and should return a pretty-printer object conforming to the
23767 interface definition above (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}). If a function
23768 cannot create a pretty-printer for the value, it should return
23769 @code{None}.
23770
23771 @value{GDBN} first checks the @code{pretty_printers} attribute of each
23772 @code{gdb.Objfile} in the current program space and iteratively calls
23773 each enabled lookup routine in the list for that @code{gdb.Objfile}
23774 until it receives a pretty-printer object.
23775 If no pretty-printer is found in the objfile lists, @value{GDBN} then
23776 searches the pretty-printer list of the current program space,
23777 calling each enabled function until an object is returned.
23778 After these lists have been exhausted, it tries the global
23779 @code{gdb.pretty_printers} list, again calling each enabled function until an
23780 object is returned.
23781
23782 The order in which the objfiles are searched is not specified. For a
23783 given list, functions are always invoked from the head of the list,
23784 and iterated over sequentially until the end of the list, or a printer
23785 object is returned.
23786
23787 For various reasons a pretty-printer may not work.
23788 For example, the underlying data structure may have changed and
23789 the pretty-printer is out of date.
23790
23791 The consequences of a broken pretty-printer are severe enough that
23792 @value{GDBN} provides support for enabling and disabling individual
23793 printers. For example, if @code{print frame-arguments} is on,
23794 a backtrace can become highly illegible if any argument is printed
23795 with a broken printer.
23796
23797 Pretty-printers are enabled and disabled by attaching an @code{enabled}
23798 attribute to the registered function or callable object. If this attribute
23799 is present and its value is @code{False}, the printer is disabled, otherwise
23800 the printer is enabled.
23801
23802 @node Writing a Pretty-Printer
23803 @subsubsection Writing a Pretty-Printer
23804 @cindex writing a pretty-printer
23805
23806 A pretty-printer consists of two parts: a lookup function to detect
23807 if the type is supported, and the printer itself.
23808
23809 Here is an example showing how a @code{std::string} printer might be
23810 written. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for details on the API this class
23811 must provide.
23812
23813 @smallexample
23814 class StdStringPrinter(object):
23815 "Print a std::string"
23816
23817 def __init__(self, val):
23818 self.val = val
23819
23820 def to_string(self):
23821 return self.val['_M_dataplus']['_M_p']
23822
23823 def display_hint(self):
23824 return 'string'
23825 @end smallexample
23826
23827 And here is an example showing how a lookup function for the printer
23828 example above might be written.
23829
23830 @smallexample
23831 def str_lookup_function(val):
23832 lookup_tag = val.type.tag
23833 if lookup_tag == None:
23834 return None
23835 regex = re.compile("^std::basic_string<char,.*>$")
23836 if regex.match(lookup_tag):
23837 return StdStringPrinter(val)
23838 return None
23839 @end smallexample
23840
23841 The example lookup function extracts the value's type, and attempts to
23842 match it to a type that it can pretty-print. If it is a type the
23843 printer can pretty-print, it will return a printer object. If not, it
23844 returns @code{None}.
23845
23846 We recommend that you put your core pretty-printers into a Python
23847 package. If your pretty-printers are for use with a library, we
23848 further recommend embedding a version number into the package name.
23849 This practice will enable @value{GDBN} to load multiple versions of
23850 your pretty-printers at the same time, because they will have
23851 different names.
23852
23853 You should write auto-loaded code (@pxref{Python Auto-loading}) such that it
23854 can be evaluated multiple times without changing its meaning. An
23855 ideal auto-load file will consist solely of @code{import}s of your
23856 printer modules, followed by a call to a register pretty-printers with
23857 the current objfile.
23858
23859 Taken as a whole, this approach will scale nicely to multiple
23860 inferiors, each potentially using a different library version.
23861 Embedding a version number in the Python package name will ensure that
23862 @value{GDBN} is able to load both sets of printers simultaneously.
23863 Then, because the search for pretty-printers is done by objfile, and
23864 because your auto-loaded code took care to register your library's
23865 printers with a specific objfile, @value{GDBN} will find the correct
23866 printers for the specific version of the library used by each
23867 inferior.
23868
23869 To continue the @code{std::string} example (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}),
23870 this code might appear in @code{gdb.libstdcxx.v6}:
23871
23872 @smallexample
23873 def register_printers(objfile):
23874 objfile.pretty_printers.append(str_lookup_function)
23875 @end smallexample
23876
23877 @noindent
23878 And then the corresponding contents of the auto-load file would be:
23879
23880 @smallexample
23881 import gdb.libstdcxx.v6
23882 gdb.libstdcxx.v6.register_printers(gdb.current_objfile())
23883 @end smallexample
23884
23885 The previous example illustrates a basic pretty-printer.
23886 There are a few things that can be improved on.
23887 The printer doesn't have a name, making it hard to identify in a
23888 list of installed printers. The lookup function has a name, but
23889 lookup functions can have arbitrary, even identical, names.
23890
23891 Second, the printer only handles one type, whereas a library typically has
23892 several types. One could install a lookup function for each desired type
23893 in the library, but one could also have a single lookup function recognize
23894 several types. The latter is the conventional way this is handled.
23895 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
23896 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
23897
23898 The @code{gdb.printing} module provides a formal way of solving these
23899 problems (@pxref{gdb.printing}).
23900 Here is another example that handles multiple types.
23901
23902 These are the types we are going to pretty-print:
23903
23904 @smallexample
23905 struct foo @{ int a, b; @};
23906 struct bar @{ struct foo x, y; @};
23907 @end smallexample
23908
23909 Here are the printers:
23910
23911 @smallexample
23912 class fooPrinter:
23913 """Print a foo object."""
23914
23915 def __init__(self, val):
23916 self.val = val
23917
23918 def to_string(self):
23919 return ("a=<" + str(self.val["a"]) +
23920 "> b=<" + str(self.val["b"]) + ">")
23921
23922 class barPrinter:
23923 """Print a bar object."""
23924
23925 def __init__(self, val):
23926 self.val = val
23927
23928 def to_string(self):
23929 return ("x=<" + str(self.val["x"]) +
23930 "> y=<" + str(self.val["y"]) + ">")
23931 @end smallexample
23932
23933 This example doesn't need a lookup function, that is handled by the
23934 @code{gdb.printing} module. Instead a function is provided to build up
23935 the object that handles the lookup.
23936
23937 @smallexample
23938 import gdb.printing
23939
23940 def build_pretty_printer():
23941 pp = gdb.printing.RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter(
23942 "my_library")
23943 pp.add_printer('foo', '^foo$', fooPrinter)
23944 pp.add_printer('bar', '^bar$', barPrinter)
23945 return pp
23946 @end smallexample
23947
23948 And here is the autoload support:
23949
23950 @smallexample
23951 import gdb.printing
23952 import my_library
23953 gdb.printing.register_pretty_printer(
23954 gdb.current_objfile(),
23955 my_library.build_pretty_printer())
23956 @end smallexample
23957
23958 Finally, when this printer is loaded into @value{GDBN}, here is the
23959 corresponding output of @samp{info pretty-printer}:
23960
23961 @smallexample
23962 (gdb) info pretty-printer
23963 my_library.so:
23964 my_library
23965 foo
23966 bar
23967 @end smallexample
23968
23969 @node Inferiors In Python
23970 @subsubsection Inferiors In Python
23971 @cindex inferiors in Python
23972
23973 @findex gdb.Inferior
23974 Programs which are being run under @value{GDBN} are called inferiors
23975 (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). Python scripts can access
23976 information about and manipulate inferiors controlled by @value{GDBN}
23977 via objects of the @code{gdb.Inferior} class.
23978
23979 The following inferior-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
23980 module:
23981
23982 @defun gdb.inferiors ()
23983 Return a tuple containing all inferior objects.
23984 @end defun
23985
23986 @defun gdb.selected_inferior ()
23987 Return an object representing the current inferior.
23988 @end defun
23989
23990 A @code{gdb.Inferior} object has the following attributes:
23991
23992 @table @code
23993 @defvar Inferior.num
23994 ID of inferior, as assigned by GDB.
23995 @end defvar
23996
23997 @defvar Inferior.pid
23998 Process ID of the inferior, as assigned by the underlying operating
23999 system.
24000 @end defvar
24001
24002 @defvar Inferior.was_attached
24003 Boolean signaling whether the inferior was created using `attach', or
24004 started by @value{GDBN} itself.
24005 @end defvar
24006 @end table
24007
24008 A @code{gdb.Inferior} object has the following methods:
24009
24010 @table @code
24011 @defun Inferior.is_valid ()
24012 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Inferior} object is valid,
24013 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Inferior} object will become invalid
24014 if the inferior no longer exists within @value{GDBN}. All other
24015 @code{gdb.Inferior} methods will throw an exception if it is invalid
24016 at the time the method is called.
24017 @end defun
24018
24019 @defun Inferior.threads ()
24020 This method returns a tuple holding all the threads which are valid
24021 when it is called. If there are no valid threads, the method will
24022 return an empty tuple.
24023 @end defun
24024
24025 @findex Inferior.read_memory
24026 @defun Inferior.read_memory (address, length)
24027 Read @var{length} bytes of memory from the inferior, starting at
24028 @var{address}. Returns a buffer object, which behaves much like an array
24029 or a string. It can be modified and given to the
24030 @code{Inferior.write_memory} function.
24031 @end defun
24032
24033 @findex Inferior.write_memory
24034 @defun Inferior.write_memory (address, buffer @r{[}, length@r{]})
24035 Write the contents of @var{buffer} to the inferior, starting at
24036 @var{address}. The @var{buffer} parameter must be a Python object
24037 which supports the buffer protocol, i.e., a string, an array or the
24038 object returned from @code{Inferior.read_memory}. If given, @var{length}
24039 determines the number of bytes from @var{buffer} to be written.
24040 @end defun
24041
24042 @findex gdb.search_memory
24043 @defun Inferior.search_memory (address, length, pattern)
24044 Search a region of the inferior memory starting at @var{address} with
24045 the given @var{length} using the search pattern supplied in
24046 @var{pattern}. The @var{pattern} parameter must be a Python object
24047 which supports the buffer protocol, i.e., a string, an array or the
24048 object returned from @code{gdb.read_memory}. Returns a Python @code{Long}
24049 containing the address where the pattern was found, or @code{None} if
24050 the pattern could not be found.
24051 @end defun
24052 @end table
24053
24054 @node Events In Python
24055 @subsubsection Events In Python
24056 @cindex inferior events in Python
24057
24058 @value{GDBN} provides a general event facility so that Python code can be
24059 notified of various state changes, particularly changes that occur in
24060 the inferior.
24061
24062 An @dfn{event} is just an object that describes some state change. The
24063 type of the object and its attributes will vary depending on the details
24064 of the change. All the existing events are described below.
24065
24066 In order to be notified of an event, you must register an event handler
24067 with an @dfn{event registry}. An event registry is an object in the
24068 @code{gdb.events} module which dispatches particular events. A registry
24069 provides methods to register and unregister event handlers:
24070
24071 @table @code
24072 @defun EventRegistry.connect (object)
24073 Add the given callable @var{object} to the registry. This object will be
24074 called when an event corresponding to this registry occurs.
24075 @end defun
24076
24077 @defun EventRegistry.disconnect (object)
24078 Remove the given @var{object} from the registry. Once removed, the object
24079 will no longer receive notifications of events.
24080 @end defun
24081 @end table
24082
24083 Here is an example:
24084
24085 @smallexample
24086 def exit_handler (event):
24087 print "event type: exit"
24088 print "exit code: %d" % (event.exit_code)
24089
24090 gdb.events.exited.connect (exit_handler)
24091 @end smallexample
24092
24093 In the above example we connect our handler @code{exit_handler} to the
24094 registry @code{events.exited}. Once connected, @code{exit_handler} gets
24095 called when the inferior exits. The argument @dfn{event} in this example is
24096 of type @code{gdb.ExitedEvent}. As you can see in the example the
24097 @code{ExitedEvent} object has an attribute which indicates the exit code of
24098 the inferior.
24099
24100 The following is a listing of the event registries that are available and
24101 details of the events they emit:
24102
24103 @table @code
24104
24105 @item events.cont
24106 Emits @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}.
24107
24108 Some events can be thread specific when @value{GDBN} is running in non-stop
24109 mode. When represented in Python, these events all extend
24110 @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}. Note, this event is not emitted directly; instead,
24111 events which are emitted by this or other modules might extend this event.
24112 Examples of these events are @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} and
24113 @code{gdb.ContinueEvent}.
24114
24115 @table @code
24116 @defvar ThreadEvent.inferior_thread
24117 In non-stop mode this attribute will be set to the specific thread which was
24118 involved in the emitted event. Otherwise, it will be set to @code{None}.
24119 @end defvar
24120 @end table
24121
24122 Emits @code{gdb.ContinueEvent} which extends @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}.
24123
24124 This event indicates that the inferior has been continued after a stop. For
24125 inherited attribute refer to @code{gdb.ThreadEvent} above.
24126
24127 @item events.exited
24128 Emits @code{events.ExitedEvent} which indicates that the inferior has exited.
24129 @code{events.ExitedEvent} has two attributes:
24130 @table @code
24131 @defvar ExitedEvent.exit_code
24132 An integer representing the exit code, if available, which the inferior
24133 has returned. (The exit code could be unavailable if, for example,
24134 @value{GDBN} detaches from the inferior.) If the exit code is unavailable,
24135 the attribute does not exist.
24136 @end defvar
24137 @defvar ExitedEvent inferior
24138 A reference to the inferior which triggered the @code{exited} event.
24139 @end defvar
24140 @end table
24141
24142 @item events.stop
24143 Emits @code{gdb.StopEvent} which extends @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}.
24144
24145 Indicates that the inferior has stopped. All events emitted by this registry
24146 extend StopEvent. As a child of @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}, @code{gdb.StopEvent}
24147 will indicate the stopped thread when @value{GDBN} is running in non-stop
24148 mode. Refer to @code{gdb.ThreadEvent} above for more details.
24149
24150 Emits @code{gdb.SignalEvent} which extends @code{gdb.StopEvent}.
24151
24152 This event indicates that the inferior or one of its threads has received as
24153 signal. @code{gdb.SignalEvent} has the following attributes:
24154
24155 @table @code
24156 @defvar SignalEvent.stop_signal
24157 A string representing the signal received by the inferior. A list of possible
24158 signal values can be obtained by running the command @code{info signals} in
24159 the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
24160 @end defvar
24161 @end table
24162
24163 Also emits @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} which extends @code{gdb.StopEvent}.
24164
24165 @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} event indicates that one or more breakpoints have
24166 been hit, and has the following attributes:
24167
24168 @table @code
24169 @defvar BreakpointEvent.breakpoints
24170 A sequence containing references to all the breakpoints (type
24171 @code{gdb.Breakpoint}) that were hit.
24172 @xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for details of the @code{gdb.Breakpoint} object.
24173 @end defvar
24174 @defvar BreakpointEvent.breakpoint
24175 A reference to the first breakpoint that was hit.
24176 This function is maintained for backward compatibility and is now deprecated
24177 in favor of the @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent.breakpoints} attribute.
24178 @end defvar
24179 @end table
24180
24181 @item events.new_objfile
24182 Emits @code{gdb.NewObjFileEvent} which indicates that a new object file has
24183 been loaded by @value{GDBN}. @code{gdb.NewObjFileEvent} has one attribute:
24184
24185 @table @code
24186 @defvar NewObjFileEvent.new_objfile
24187 A reference to the object file (@code{gdb.Objfile}) which has been loaded.
24188 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for details of the @code{gdb.Objfile} object.
24189 @end defvar
24190 @end table
24191
24192 @end table
24193
24194 @node Threads In Python
24195 @subsubsection Threads In Python
24196 @cindex threads in python
24197
24198 @findex gdb.InferiorThread
24199 Python scripts can access information about, and manipulate inferior threads
24200 controlled by @value{GDBN}, via objects of the @code{gdb.InferiorThread} class.
24201
24202 The following thread-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
24203 module:
24204
24205 @findex gdb.selected_thread
24206 @defun gdb.selected_thread ()
24207 This function returns the thread object for the selected thread. If there
24208 is no selected thread, this will return @code{None}.
24209 @end defun
24210
24211 A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object has the following attributes:
24212
24213 @table @code
24214 @defvar InferiorThread.name
24215 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using
24216 @code{thread name}, then this returns that name. Otherwise, if an
24217 OS-supplied name is available, then it is returned. Otherwise, this
24218 returns @code{None}.
24219
24220 This attribute can be assigned to. The new value must be a string
24221 object, which sets the new name, or @code{None}, which removes any
24222 user-specified thread name.
24223 @end defvar
24224
24225 @defvar InferiorThread.num
24226 ID of the thread, as assigned by GDB.
24227 @end defvar
24228
24229 @defvar InferiorThread.ptid
24230 ID of the thread, as assigned by the operating system. This attribute is a
24231 tuple containing three integers. The first is the Process ID (PID); the second
24232 is the Lightweight Process ID (LWPID), and the third is the Thread ID (TID).
24233 Either the LWPID or TID may be 0, which indicates that the operating system
24234 does not use that identifier.
24235 @end defvar
24236 @end table
24237
24238 A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object has the following methods:
24239
24240 @table @code
24241 @defun InferiorThread.is_valid ()
24242 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object is valid,
24243 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object will become
24244 invalid if the thread exits, or the inferior that the thread belongs
24245 is deleted. All other @code{gdb.InferiorThread} methods will throw an
24246 exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
24247 @end defun
24248
24249 @defun InferiorThread.switch ()
24250 This changes @value{GDBN}'s currently selected thread to the one represented
24251 by this object.
24252 @end defun
24253
24254 @defun InferiorThread.is_stopped ()
24255 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is stopped.
24256 @end defun
24257
24258 @defun InferiorThread.is_running ()
24259 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is running.
24260 @end defun
24261
24262 @defun InferiorThread.is_exited ()
24263 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is exited.
24264 @end defun
24265 @end table
24266
24267 @node Commands In Python
24268 @subsubsection Commands In Python
24269
24270 @cindex commands in python
24271 @cindex python commands
24272 You can implement new @value{GDBN} CLI commands in Python. A CLI
24273 command is implemented using an instance of the @code{gdb.Command}
24274 class, most commonly using a subclass.
24275
24276 @defun Command.__init__ (name, @var{command_class} @r{[}, @var{completer_class} @r{[}, @var{prefix}@r{]]})
24277 The object initializer for @code{Command} registers the new command
24278 with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked from the
24279 subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
24280
24281 @var{name} is the name of the command. If @var{name} consists of
24282 multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
24283 commands. In this case, if one of the prefix commands does not exist,
24284 an exception is raised.
24285
24286 There is no support for multi-line commands.
24287
24288 @var{command_class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
24289 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to categorize the
24290 new command in the help system.
24291
24292 @var{completer_class} is an optional argument. If given, it should be
24293 one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined below. This argument
24294 tells @value{GDBN} how to perform completion for this command. If not
24295 given, @value{GDBN} will attempt to complete using the object's
24296 @code{complete} method (see below); if no such method is found, an
24297 error will occur when completion is attempted.
24298
24299 @var{prefix} is an optional argument. If @code{True}, then the new
24300 command is a prefix command; sub-commands of this command may be
24301 registered.
24302
24303 The help text for the new command is taken from the Python
24304 documentation string for the command's class, if there is one. If no
24305 documentation string is provided, the default value ``This command is
24306 not documented.'' is used.
24307 @end defun
24308
24309 @cindex don't repeat Python command
24310 @defun Command.dont_repeat ()
24311 By default, a @value{GDBN} command is repeated when the user enters a
24312 blank line at the command prompt. A command can suppress this
24313 behavior by invoking the @code{dont_repeat} method. This is similar
24314 to the user command @code{dont-repeat}, see @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
24315 @end defun
24316
24317 @defun Command.invoke (argument, from_tty)
24318 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when this command is invoked.
24319
24320 @var{argument} is a string. It is the argument to the command, after
24321 leading and trailing whitespace has been stripped.
24322
24323 @var{from_tty} is a boolean argument. When true, this means that the
24324 command was entered by the user at the terminal; when false it means
24325 that the command came from elsewhere.
24326
24327 If this method throws an exception, it is turned into a @value{GDBN}
24328 @code{error} call. Otherwise, the return value is ignored.
24329
24330 @findex gdb.string_to_argv
24331 To break @var{argument} up into an argv-like string use
24332 @code{gdb.string_to_argv}. This function behaves identically to
24333 @value{GDBN}'s internal argument lexer @code{buildargv}.
24334 It is recommended to use this for consistency.
24335 Arguments are separated by spaces and may be quoted.
24336 Example:
24337
24338 @smallexample
24339 print gdb.string_to_argv ("1 2\ \\\"3 '4 \"5' \"6 '7\"")
24340 ['1', '2 "3', '4 "5', "6 '7"]
24341 @end smallexample
24342
24343 @end defun
24344
24345 @cindex completion of Python commands
24346 @defun Command.complete (text, word)
24347 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when the user attempts
24348 completion on this command. All forms of completion are handled by
24349 this method, that is, the @key{TAB} and @key{M-?} key bindings
24350 (@pxref{Completion}), and the @code{complete} command (@pxref{Help,
24351 complete}).
24352
24353 The arguments @var{text} and @var{word} are both strings. @var{text}
24354 holds the complete command line up to the cursor's location.
24355 @var{word} holds the last word of the command line; this is computed
24356 using a word-breaking heuristic.
24357
24358 The @code{complete} method can return several values:
24359 @itemize @bullet
24360 @item
24361 If the return value is a sequence, the contents of the sequence are
24362 used as the completions. It is up to @code{complete} to ensure that the
24363 contents actually do complete the word. A zero-length sequence is
24364 allowed, it means that there were no completions available. Only
24365 string elements of the sequence are used; other elements in the
24366 sequence are ignored.
24367
24368 @item
24369 If the return value is one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined
24370 below, then the corresponding @value{GDBN}-internal completion
24371 function is invoked, and its result is used.
24372
24373 @item
24374 All other results are treated as though there were no available
24375 completions.
24376 @end itemize
24377 @end defun
24378
24379 When a new command is registered, it must be declared as a member of
24380 some general class of commands. This is used to classify top-level
24381 commands in the on-line help system; note that prefix commands are not
24382 listed under their own category but rather that of their top-level
24383 command. The available classifications are represented by constants
24384 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
24385
24386 @table @code
24387 @findex COMMAND_NONE
24388 @findex gdb.COMMAND_NONE
24389 @item gdb.COMMAND_NONE
24390 The command does not belong to any particular class. A command in
24391 this category will not be displayed in any of the help categories.
24392
24393 @findex COMMAND_RUNNING
24394 @findex gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
24395 @item gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
24396 The command is related to running the inferior. For example,
24397 @code{start}, @code{step}, and @code{continue} are in this category.
24398 Type @kbd{help running} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
24399 commands in this category.
24400
24401 @findex COMMAND_DATA
24402 @findex gdb.COMMAND_DATA
24403 @item gdb.COMMAND_DATA
24404 The command is related to data or variables. For example,
24405 @code{call}, @code{find}, and @code{print} are in this category. Type
24406 @kbd{help data} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands
24407 in this category.
24408
24409 @findex COMMAND_STACK
24410 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STACK
24411 @item gdb.COMMAND_STACK
24412 The command has to do with manipulation of the stack. For example,
24413 @code{backtrace}, @code{frame}, and @code{return} are in this
24414 category. Type @kbd{help stack} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a
24415 list of commands in this category.
24416
24417 @findex COMMAND_FILES
24418 @findex gdb.COMMAND_FILES
24419 @item gdb.COMMAND_FILES
24420 This class is used for file-related commands. For example,
24421 @code{file}, @code{list} and @code{section} are in this category.
24422 Type @kbd{help files} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
24423 commands in this category.
24424
24425 @findex COMMAND_SUPPORT
24426 @findex gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
24427 @item gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
24428 This should be used for ``support facilities'', generally meaning
24429 things that are useful to the user when interacting with @value{GDBN},
24430 but not related to the state of the inferior. For example,
24431 @code{help}, @code{make}, and @code{shell} are in this category. Type
24432 @kbd{help support} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
24433 commands in this category.
24434
24435 @findex COMMAND_STATUS
24436 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
24437 @item gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
24438 The command is an @samp{info}-related command, that is, related to the
24439 state of @value{GDBN} itself. For example, @code{info}, @code{macro},
24440 and @code{show} are in this category. Type @kbd{help status} at the
24441 @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
24442
24443 @findex COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
24444 @findex gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
24445 @item gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
24446 The command has to do with breakpoints. For example, @code{break},
24447 @code{clear}, and @code{delete} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
24448 breakpoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in
24449 this category.
24450
24451 @findex COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
24452 @findex gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
24453 @item gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
24454 The command has to do with tracepoints. For example, @code{trace},
24455 @code{actions}, and @code{tfind} are in this category. Type
24456 @kbd{help tracepoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
24457 commands in this category.
24458
24459 @findex COMMAND_USER
24460 @findex gdb.COMMAND_USER
24461 @item gdb.COMMAND_USER
24462 The command is a general purpose command for the user, and typically
24463 does not fit in one of the other categories.
24464 Type @kbd{help user-defined} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see
24465 a list of commands in this category, as well as the list of gdb macros
24466 (@pxref{Sequences}).
24467
24468 @findex COMMAND_OBSCURE
24469 @findex gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
24470 @item gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
24471 The command is only used in unusual circumstances, or is not of
24472 general interest to users. For example, @code{checkpoint},
24473 @code{fork}, and @code{stop} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
24474 obscure} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this
24475 category.
24476
24477 @findex COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
24478 @findex gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
24479 @item gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
24480 The command is only useful to @value{GDBN} maintainers. The
24481 @code{maintenance} and @code{flushregs} commands are in this category.
24482 Type @kbd{help internals} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
24483 commands in this category.
24484 @end table
24485
24486 A new command can use a predefined completion function, either by
24487 specifying it via an argument at initialization, or by returning it
24488 from the @code{complete} method. These predefined completion
24489 constants are all defined in the @code{gdb} module:
24490
24491 @table @code
24492 @findex COMPLETE_NONE
24493 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
24494 @item gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
24495 This constant means that no completion should be done.
24496
24497 @findex COMPLETE_FILENAME
24498 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
24499 @item gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
24500 This constant means that filename completion should be performed.
24501
24502 @findex COMPLETE_LOCATION
24503 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
24504 @item gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
24505 This constant means that location completion should be done.
24506 @xref{Specify Location}.
24507
24508 @findex COMPLETE_COMMAND
24509 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
24510 @item gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
24511 This constant means that completion should examine @value{GDBN}
24512 command names.
24513
24514 @findex COMPLETE_SYMBOL
24515 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
24516 @item gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
24517 This constant means that completion should be done using symbol names
24518 as the source.
24519 @end table
24520
24521 The following code snippet shows how a trivial CLI command can be
24522 implemented in Python:
24523
24524 @smallexample
24525 class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
24526 """Greet the whole world."""
24527
24528 def __init__ (self):
24529 super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_USER)
24530
24531 def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):
24532 print "Hello, World!"
24533
24534 HelloWorld ()
24535 @end smallexample
24536
24537 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
24538 registration of the command with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
24539 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
24540 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
24541
24542 @node Parameters In Python
24543 @subsubsection Parameters In Python
24544
24545 @cindex parameters in python
24546 @cindex python parameters
24547 @tindex gdb.Parameter
24548 @tindex Parameter
24549 You can implement new @value{GDBN} parameters using Python. A new
24550 parameter is implemented as an instance of the @code{gdb.Parameter}
24551 class.
24552
24553 Parameters are exposed to the user via the @code{set} and
24554 @code{show} commands. @xref{Help}.
24555
24556 There are many parameters that already exist and can be set in
24557 @value{GDBN}. Two examples are: @code{set follow fork} and
24558 @code{set charset}. Setting these parameters influences certain
24559 behavior in @value{GDBN}. Similarly, you can define parameters that
24560 can be used to influence behavior in custom Python scripts and commands.
24561
24562 @defun Parameter.__init__ (name, @var{command-class}, @var{parameter-class} @r{[}, @var{enum-sequence}@r{]})
24563 The object initializer for @code{Parameter} registers the new
24564 parameter with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked
24565 from the subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
24566
24567 @var{name} is the name of the new parameter. If @var{name} consists
24568 of multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
24569 parameters. An example of this can be illustrated with the
24570 @code{set print} set of parameters. If @var{name} is
24571 @code{print foo}, then @code{print} will be searched as the prefix
24572 parameter. In this case the parameter can subsequently be accessed in
24573 @value{GDBN} as @code{set print foo}.
24574
24575 If @var{name} consists of multiple words, and no prefix parameter group
24576 can be found, an exception is raised.
24577
24578 @var{command-class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
24579 (@pxref{Commands In Python}). This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to
24580 categorize the new parameter in the help system.
24581
24582 @var{parameter-class} should be one of the @samp{PARAM_} constants
24583 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} the type of the new
24584 parameter; this information is used for input validation and
24585 completion.
24586
24587 If @var{parameter-class} is @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then
24588 @var{enum-sequence} must be a sequence of strings. These strings
24589 represent the possible values for the parameter.
24590
24591 If @var{parameter-class} is not @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then the presence
24592 of a fourth argument will cause an exception to be thrown.
24593
24594 The help text for the new parameter is taken from the Python
24595 documentation string for the parameter's class, if there is one. If
24596 there is no documentation string, a default value is used.
24597 @end defun
24598
24599 @defvar Parameter.set_doc
24600 If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
24601 the help text for this parameter's @code{set} command. The value is
24602 examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
24603 have no effect.
24604 @end defvar
24605
24606 @defvar Parameter.show_doc
24607 If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
24608 the help text for this parameter's @code{show} command. The value is
24609 examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
24610 have no effect.
24611 @end defvar
24612
24613 @defvar Parameter.value
24614 The @code{value} attribute holds the underlying value of the
24615 parameter. It can be read and assigned to just as any other
24616 attribute. @value{GDBN} does validation when assignments are made.
24617 @end defvar
24618
24619 There are two methods that should be implemented in any
24620 @code{Parameter} class. These are:
24621
24622 @defun Parameter.get_set_string (self)
24623 @value{GDBN} will call this method when a @var{parameter}'s value has
24624 been changed via the @code{set} API (for example, @kbd{set foo off}).
24625 The @code{value} attribute has already been populated with the new
24626 value and may be used in output. This method must return a string.
24627 @end defun
24628
24629 @defun Parameter.get_show_string (self, svalue)
24630 @value{GDBN} will call this method when a @var{parameter}'s
24631 @code{show} API has been invoked (for example, @kbd{show foo}). The
24632 argument @code{svalue} receives the string representation of the
24633 current value. This method must return a string.
24634 @end defun
24635
24636 When a new parameter is defined, its type must be specified. The
24637 available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
24638 module:
24639
24640 @table @code
24641 @findex PARAM_BOOLEAN
24642 @findex gdb.PARAM_BOOLEAN
24643 @item gdb.PARAM_BOOLEAN
24644 The value is a plain boolean. The Python boolean values, @code{True}
24645 and @code{False} are the only valid values.
24646
24647 @findex PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
24648 @findex gdb.PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
24649 @item gdb.PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
24650 The value has three possible states: true, false, and @samp{auto}. In
24651 Python, true and false are represented using boolean constants, and
24652 @samp{auto} is represented using @code{None}.
24653
24654 @findex PARAM_UINTEGER
24655 @findex gdb.PARAM_UINTEGER
24656 @item gdb.PARAM_UINTEGER
24657 The value is an unsigned integer. The value of 0 should be
24658 interpreted to mean ``unlimited''.
24659
24660 @findex PARAM_INTEGER
24661 @findex gdb.PARAM_INTEGER
24662 @item gdb.PARAM_INTEGER
24663 The value is a signed integer. The value of 0 should be interpreted
24664 to mean ``unlimited''.
24665
24666 @findex PARAM_STRING
24667 @findex gdb.PARAM_STRING
24668 @item gdb.PARAM_STRING
24669 The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, any escape
24670 sequences, such as @samp{\t}, @samp{\f}, and octal escapes, are
24671 translated into corresponding characters and encoded into the current
24672 host charset.
24673
24674 @findex PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
24675 @findex gdb.PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
24676 @item gdb.PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
24677 The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, escapes are
24678 passed through untranslated.
24679
24680 @findex PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
24681 @findex gdb.PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
24682 @item gdb.PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
24683 The value is a either a filename (a string), or @code{None}.
24684
24685 @findex PARAM_FILENAME
24686 @findex gdb.PARAM_FILENAME
24687 @item gdb.PARAM_FILENAME
24688 The value is a filename. This is just like
24689 @code{PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE}, but uses file names for completion.
24690
24691 @findex PARAM_ZINTEGER
24692 @findex gdb.PARAM_ZINTEGER
24693 @item gdb.PARAM_ZINTEGER
24694 The value is an integer. This is like @code{PARAM_INTEGER}, except 0
24695 is interpreted as itself.
24696
24697 @findex PARAM_ENUM
24698 @findex gdb.PARAM_ENUM
24699 @item gdb.PARAM_ENUM
24700 The value is a string, which must be one of a collection string
24701 constants provided when the parameter is created.
24702 @end table
24703
24704 @node Functions In Python
24705 @subsubsection Writing new convenience functions
24706
24707 @cindex writing convenience functions
24708 @cindex convenience functions in python
24709 @cindex python convenience functions
24710 @tindex gdb.Function
24711 @tindex Function
24712 You can implement new convenience functions (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
24713 in Python. A convenience function is an instance of a subclass of the
24714 class @code{gdb.Function}.
24715
24716 @defun Function.__init__ (name)
24717 The initializer for @code{Function} registers the new function with
24718 @value{GDBN}. The argument @var{name} is the name of the function,
24719 a string. The function will be visible to the user as a convenience
24720 variable of type @code{internal function}, whose name is the same as
24721 the given @var{name}.
24722
24723 The documentation for the new function is taken from the documentation
24724 string for the new class.
24725 @end defun
24726
24727 @defun Function.invoke (@var{*args})
24728 When a convenience function is evaluated, its arguments are converted
24729 to instances of @code{gdb.Value}, and then the function's
24730 @code{invoke} method is called. Note that @value{GDBN} does not
24731 predetermine the arity of convenience functions. Instead, all
24732 available arguments are passed to @code{invoke}, following the
24733 standard Python calling convention. In particular, a convenience
24734 function can have default values for parameters without ill effect.
24735
24736 The return value of this method is used as its value in the enclosing
24737 expression. If an ordinary Python value is returned, it is converted
24738 to a @code{gdb.Value} following the usual rules.
24739 @end defun
24740
24741 The following code snippet shows how a trivial convenience function can
24742 be implemented in Python:
24743
24744 @smallexample
24745 class Greet (gdb.Function):
24746 """Return string to greet someone.
24747 Takes a name as argument."""
24748
24749 def __init__ (self):
24750 super (Greet, self).__init__ ("greet")
24751
24752 def invoke (self, name):
24753 return "Hello, %s!" % name.string ()
24754
24755 Greet ()
24756 @end smallexample
24757
24758 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
24759 registration of the function with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
24760 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
24761 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
24762
24763 Now you can use the function in an expression:
24764
24765 @smallexample
24766 (gdb) print $greet("Bob")
24767 $1 = "Hello, Bob!"
24768 @end smallexample
24769
24770 @node Progspaces In Python
24771 @subsubsection Program Spaces In Python
24772
24773 @cindex progspaces in python
24774 @tindex gdb.Progspace
24775 @tindex Progspace
24776 A program space, or @dfn{progspace}, represents a symbolic view
24777 of an address space.
24778 It consists of all of the objfiles of the program.
24779 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
24780 @xref{Inferiors and Programs, program spaces}, for more details
24781 about program spaces.
24782
24783 The following progspace-related functions are available in the
24784 @code{gdb} module:
24785
24786 @findex gdb.current_progspace
24787 @defun gdb.current_progspace ()
24788 This function returns the program space of the currently selected inferior.
24789 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}.
24790 @end defun
24791
24792 @findex gdb.progspaces
24793 @defun gdb.progspaces ()
24794 Return a sequence of all the progspaces currently known to @value{GDBN}.
24795 @end defun
24796
24797 Each progspace is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Progspace}
24798 class.
24799
24800 @defvar Progspace.filename
24801 The file name of the progspace as a string.
24802 @end defvar
24803
24804 @defvar Progspace.pretty_printers
24805 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
24806 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
24807 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
24808 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
24809 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
24810 information.
24811 @end defvar
24812
24813 @node Objfiles In Python
24814 @subsubsection Objfiles In Python
24815
24816 @cindex objfiles in python
24817 @tindex gdb.Objfile
24818 @tindex Objfile
24819 @value{GDBN} loads symbols for an inferior from various
24820 symbol-containing files (@pxref{Files}). These include the primary
24821 executable file, any shared libraries used by the inferior, and any
24822 separate debug info files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}).
24823 @value{GDBN} calls these symbol-containing files @dfn{objfiles}.
24824
24825 The following objfile-related functions are available in the
24826 @code{gdb} module:
24827
24828 @findex gdb.current_objfile
24829 @defun gdb.current_objfile ()
24830 When auto-loading a Python script (@pxref{Python Auto-loading}), @value{GDBN}
24831 sets the ``current objfile'' to the corresponding objfile. This
24832 function returns the current objfile. If there is no current objfile,
24833 this function returns @code{None}.
24834 @end defun
24835
24836 @findex gdb.objfiles
24837 @defun gdb.objfiles ()
24838 Return a sequence of all the objfiles current known to @value{GDBN}.
24839 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
24840 @end defun
24841
24842 Each objfile is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Objfile}
24843 class.
24844
24845 @defvar Objfile.filename
24846 The file name of the objfile as a string.
24847 @end defvar
24848
24849 @defvar Objfile.pretty_printers
24850 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
24851 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
24852 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
24853 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
24854 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
24855 information.
24856 @end defvar
24857
24858 A @code{gdb.Objfile} object has the following methods:
24859
24860 @defun Objfile.is_valid ()
24861 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Objfile} object is valid,
24862 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Objfile} object can become invalid
24863 if the object file it refers to is not loaded in @value{GDBN} any
24864 longer. All other @code{gdb.Objfile} methods will throw an exception
24865 if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
24866 @end defun
24867
24868 @node Frames In Python
24869 @subsubsection Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
24870
24871 @cindex frames in python
24872 When the debugged program stops, @value{GDBN} is able to analyze its call
24873 stack (@pxref{Frames,,Stack frames}). The @code{gdb.Frame} class
24874 represents a frame in the stack. A @code{gdb.Frame} object is only valid
24875 while its corresponding frame exists in the inferior's stack. If you try
24876 to use an invalid frame object, @value{GDBN} will throw a @code{gdb.error}
24877 exception (@pxref{Exception Handling}).
24878
24879 Two @code{gdb.Frame} objects can be compared for equality with the @code{==}
24880 operator, like:
24881
24882 @smallexample
24883 (@value{GDBP}) python print gdb.newest_frame() == gdb.selected_frame ()
24884 True
24885 @end smallexample
24886
24887 The following frame-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} module:
24888
24889 @findex gdb.selected_frame
24890 @defun gdb.selected_frame ()
24891 Return the selected frame object. (@pxref{Selection,,Selecting a Frame}).
24892 @end defun
24893
24894 @findex gdb.newest_frame
24895 @defun gdb.newest_frame ()
24896 Return the newest frame object for the selected thread.
24897 @end defun
24898
24899 @defun gdb.frame_stop_reason_string (reason)
24900 Return a string explaining the reason why @value{GDBN} stopped unwinding
24901 frames, as expressed by the given @var{reason} code (an integer, see the
24902 @code{unwind_stop_reason} method further down in this section).
24903 @end defun
24904
24905 A @code{gdb.Frame} object has the following methods:
24906
24907 @table @code
24908 @defun Frame.is_valid ()
24909 Returns true if the @code{gdb.Frame} object is valid, false if not.
24910 A frame object can become invalid if the frame it refers to doesn't
24911 exist anymore in the inferior. All @code{gdb.Frame} methods will throw
24912 an exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
24913 @end defun
24914
24915 @defun Frame.name ()
24916 Returns the function name of the frame, or @code{None} if it can't be
24917 obtained.
24918 @end defun
24919
24920 @defun Frame.type ()
24921 Returns the type of the frame. The value can be one of:
24922 @table @code
24923 @item gdb.NORMAL_FRAME
24924 An ordinary stack frame.
24925
24926 @item gdb.DUMMY_FRAME
24927 A fake stack frame that was created by @value{GDBN} when performing an
24928 inferior function call.
24929
24930 @item gdb.INLINE_FRAME
24931 A frame representing an inlined function. The function was inlined
24932 into a @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME} that is older than this one.
24933
24934 @item gdb.TAILCALL_FRAME
24935 A frame representing a tail call. @xref{Tail Call Frames}.
24936
24937 @item gdb.SIGTRAMP_FRAME
24938 A signal trampoline frame. This is the frame created by the OS when
24939 it calls into a signal handler.
24940
24941 @item gdb.ARCH_FRAME
24942 A fake stack frame representing a cross-architecture call.
24943
24944 @item gdb.SENTINEL_FRAME
24945 This is like @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME}, but it is only used for the
24946 newest frame.
24947 @end table
24948 @end defun
24949
24950 @defun Frame.unwind_stop_reason ()
24951 Return an integer representing the reason why it's not possible to find
24952 more frames toward the outermost frame. Use
24953 @code{gdb.frame_stop_reason_string} to convert the value returned by this
24954 function to a string. The value can be one of:
24955
24956 @table @code
24957 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_NO_REASON
24958 No particular reason (older frames should be available).
24959
24960 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_NULL_ID
24961 The previous frame's analyzer returns an invalid result.
24962
24963 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_OUTERMOST
24964 This frame is the outermost.
24965
24966 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_UNAVAILABLE
24967 Cannot unwind further, because that would require knowing the
24968 values of registers or memory that have not been collected.
24969
24970 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_INNER_ID
24971 This frame ID looks like it ought to belong to a NEXT frame,
24972 but we got it for a PREV frame. Normally, this is a sign of
24973 unwinder failure. It could also indicate stack corruption.
24974
24975 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_SAME_ID
24976 This frame has the same ID as the previous one. That means
24977 that unwinding further would almost certainly give us another
24978 frame with exactly the same ID, so break the chain. Normally,
24979 this is a sign of unwinder failure. It could also indicate
24980 stack corruption.
24981
24982 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_NO_SAVED_PC
24983 The frame unwinder did not find any saved PC, but we needed
24984 one to unwind further.
24985
24986 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_FIRST_ERROR
24987 Any stop reason greater or equal to this value indicates some kind
24988 of error. This special value facilitates writing code that tests
24989 for errors in unwinding in a way that will work correctly even if
24990 the list of the other values is modified in future @value{GDBN}
24991 versions. Using it, you could write:
24992 @smallexample
24993 reason = gdb.selected_frame().unwind_stop_reason ()
24994 reason_str = gdb.frame_stop_reason_string (reason)
24995 if reason >= gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_FIRST_ERROR:
24996 print "An error occured: %s" % reason_str
24997 @end smallexample
24998 @end table
24999
25000 @end defun
25001
25002 @defun Frame.pc ()
25003 Returns the frame's resume address.
25004 @end defun
25005
25006 @defun Frame.block ()
25007 Return the frame's code block. @xref{Blocks In Python}.
25008 @end defun
25009
25010 @defun Frame.function ()
25011 Return the symbol for the function corresponding to this frame.
25012 @xref{Symbols In Python}.
25013 @end defun
25014
25015 @defun Frame.older ()
25016 Return the frame that called this frame.
25017 @end defun
25018
25019 @defun Frame.newer ()
25020 Return the frame called by this frame.
25021 @end defun
25022
25023 @defun Frame.find_sal ()
25024 Return the frame's symtab and line object.
25025 @xref{Symbol Tables In Python}.
25026 @end defun
25027
25028 @defun Frame.read_var (variable @r{[}, block@r{]})
25029 Return the value of @var{variable} in this frame. If the optional
25030 argument @var{block} is provided, search for the variable from that
25031 block; otherwise start at the frame's current block (which is
25032 determined by the frame's current program counter). @var{variable}
25033 must be a string or a @code{gdb.Symbol} object. @var{block} must be a
25034 @code{gdb.Block} object.
25035 @end defun
25036
25037 @defun Frame.select ()
25038 Set this frame to be the selected frame. @xref{Stack, ,Examining the
25039 Stack}.
25040 @end defun
25041 @end table
25042
25043 @node Blocks In Python
25044 @subsubsection Accessing frame blocks from Python.
25045
25046 @cindex blocks in python
25047 @tindex gdb.Block
25048
25049 Within each frame, @value{GDBN} maintains information on each block
25050 stored in that frame. These blocks are organized hierarchically, and
25051 are represented individually in Python as a @code{gdb.Block}.
25052 Please see @ref{Frames In Python}, for a more in-depth discussion on
25053 frames. Furthermore, see @ref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}, for more
25054 detailed technical information on @value{GDBN}'s book-keeping of the
25055 stack.
25056
25057 A @code{gdb.Block} is iterable. The iterator returns the symbols
25058 (@pxref{Symbols In Python}) local to the block. Python programs
25059 should not assume that a specific block object will always contain a
25060 given symbol, since changes in @value{GDBN} features and
25061 infrastructure may cause symbols move across blocks in a symbol
25062 table.
25063
25064 The following block-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
25065 module:
25066
25067 @findex gdb.block_for_pc
25068 @defun gdb.block_for_pc (pc)
25069 Return the @code{gdb.Block} containing the given @var{pc} value. If the
25070 block cannot be found for the @var{pc} value specified, the function
25071 will return @code{None}.
25072 @end defun
25073
25074 A @code{gdb.Block} object has the following methods:
25075
25076 @table @code
25077 @defun Block.is_valid ()
25078 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Block} object is valid,
25079 @code{False} if not. A block object can become invalid if the block it
25080 refers to doesn't exist anymore in the inferior. All other
25081 @code{gdb.Block} methods will throw an exception if it is invalid at
25082 the time the method is called. The block's validity is also checked
25083 during iteration over symbols of the block.
25084 @end defun
25085 @end table
25086
25087 A @code{gdb.Block} object has the following attributes:
25088
25089 @table @code
25090 @defvar Block.start
25091 The start address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
25092 @end defvar
25093
25094 @defvar Block.end
25095 The end address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
25096 @end defvar
25097
25098 @defvar Block.function
25099 The name of the block represented as a @code{gdb.Symbol}. If the
25100 block is not named, then this attribute holds @code{None}. This
25101 attribute is not writable.
25102 @end defvar
25103
25104 @defvar Block.superblock
25105 The block containing this block. If this parent block does not exist,
25106 this attribute holds @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
25107 @end defvar
25108
25109 @defvar Block.global_block
25110 The global block associated with this block. This attribute is not
25111 writable.
25112 @end defvar
25113
25114 @defvar Block.static_block
25115 The static block associated with this block. This attribute is not
25116 writable.
25117 @end defvar
25118
25119 @defvar Block.is_global
25120 @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Block} object is a global block,
25121 @code{False} if not. This attribute is not
25122 writable.
25123 @end defvar
25124
25125 @defvar Block.is_static
25126 @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Block} object is a static block,
25127 @code{False} if not. This attribute is not writable.
25128 @end defvar
25129 @end table
25130
25131 @node Symbols In Python
25132 @subsubsection Python representation of Symbols.
25133
25134 @cindex symbols in python
25135 @tindex gdb.Symbol
25136
25137 @value{GDBN} represents every variable, function and type as an
25138 entry in a symbol table. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
25139 Similarly, Python represents these symbols in @value{GDBN} with the
25140 @code{gdb.Symbol} object.
25141
25142 The following symbol-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
25143 module:
25144
25145 @findex gdb.lookup_symbol
25146 @defun gdb.lookup_symbol (name @r{[}, block @r{[}, domain@r{]]})
25147 This function searches for a symbol by name. The search scope can be
25148 restricted to the parameters defined in the optional domain and block
25149 arguments.
25150
25151 @var{name} is the name of the symbol. It must be a string. The
25152 optional @var{block} argument restricts the search to symbols visible
25153 in that @var{block}. The @var{block} argument must be a
25154 @code{gdb.Block} object. If omitted, the block for the current frame
25155 is used. The optional @var{domain} argument restricts
25156 the search to the domain type. The @var{domain} argument must be a
25157 domain constant defined in the @code{gdb} module and described later
25158 in this chapter.
25159
25160 The result is a tuple of two elements.
25161 The first element is a @code{gdb.Symbol} object or @code{None} if the symbol
25162 is not found.
25163 If the symbol is found, the second element is @code{True} if the symbol
25164 is a field of a method's object (e.g., @code{this} in C@t{++}),
25165 otherwise it is @code{False}.
25166 If the symbol is not found, the second element is @code{False}.
25167 @end defun
25168
25169 @findex gdb.lookup_global_symbol
25170 @defun gdb.lookup_global_symbol (name @r{[}, domain@r{]})
25171 This function searches for a global symbol by name.
25172 The search scope can be restricted to by the domain argument.
25173
25174 @var{name} is the name of the symbol. It must be a string.
25175 The optional @var{domain} argument restricts the search to the domain type.
25176 The @var{domain} argument must be a domain constant defined in the @code{gdb}
25177 module and described later in this chapter.
25178
25179 The result is a @code{gdb.Symbol} object or @code{None} if the symbol
25180 is not found.
25181 @end defun
25182
25183 A @code{gdb.Symbol} object has the following attributes:
25184
25185 @table @code
25186 @defvar Symbol.type
25187 The type of the symbol or @code{None} if no type is recorded.
25188 This attribute is represented as a @code{gdb.Type} object.
25189 @xref{Types In Python}. This attribute is not writable.
25190 @end defvar
25191
25192 @defvar Symbol.symtab
25193 The symbol table in which the symbol appears. This attribute is
25194 represented as a @code{gdb.Symtab} object. @xref{Symbol Tables In
25195 Python}. This attribute is not writable.
25196 @end defvar
25197
25198 @defvar Symbol.line
25199 The line number in the source code at which the symbol was defined.
25200 This is an integer.
25201 @end defvar
25202
25203 @defvar Symbol.name
25204 The name of the symbol as a string. This attribute is not writable.
25205 @end defvar
25206
25207 @defvar Symbol.linkage_name
25208 The name of the symbol, as used by the linker (i.e., may be mangled).
25209 This attribute is not writable.
25210 @end defvar
25211
25212 @defvar Symbol.print_name
25213 The name of the symbol in a form suitable for output. This is either
25214 @code{name} or @code{linkage_name}, depending on whether the user
25215 asked @value{GDBN} to display demangled or mangled names.
25216 @end defvar
25217
25218 @defvar Symbol.addr_class
25219 The address class of the symbol. This classifies how to find the value
25220 of a symbol. Each address class is a constant defined in the
25221 @code{gdb} module and described later in this chapter.
25222 @end defvar
25223
25224 @defvar Symbol.needs_frame
25225 This is @code{True} if evaluating this symbol's value requires a frame
25226 (@pxref{Frames In Python}) and @code{False} otherwise. Typically,
25227 local variables will require a frame, but other symbols will not.
25228 @end defvar
25229
25230 @defvar Symbol.is_argument
25231 @code{True} if the symbol is an argument of a function.
25232 @end defvar
25233
25234 @defvar Symbol.is_constant
25235 @code{True} if the symbol is a constant.
25236 @end defvar
25237
25238 @defvar Symbol.is_function
25239 @code{True} if the symbol is a function or a method.
25240 @end defvar
25241
25242 @defvar Symbol.is_variable
25243 @code{True} if the symbol is a variable.
25244 @end defvar
25245 @end table
25246
25247 A @code{gdb.Symbol} object has the following methods:
25248
25249 @table @code
25250 @defun Symbol.is_valid ()
25251 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Symbol} object is valid,
25252 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Symbol} object can become invalid if
25253 the symbol it refers to does not exist in @value{GDBN} any longer.
25254 All other @code{gdb.Symbol} methods will throw an exception if it is
25255 invalid at the time the method is called.
25256 @end defun
25257
25258 @defun Symbol.value (@r{[}frame@r{]})
25259 Compute the value of the symbol, as a @code{gdb.Value}. For
25260 functions, this computes the address of the function, cast to the
25261 appropriate type. If the symbol requires a frame in order to compute
25262 its value, then @var{frame} must be given. If @var{frame} is not
25263 given, or if @var{frame} is invalid, then this method will throw an
25264 exception.
25265 @end defun
25266 @end table
25267
25268 The available domain categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
25269 as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
25270
25271 @table @code
25272 @findex SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
25273 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
25274 @item gdb.SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
25275 This is used when a domain has not been discovered or none of the
25276 following domains apply. This usually indicates an error either
25277 in the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
25278 @findex SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
25279 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
25280 @item gdb.SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
25281 This domain contains variables, function names, typedef names and enum
25282 type values.
25283 @findex SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
25284 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
25285 @item gdb.SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
25286 This domain holds struct, union and enum type names.
25287 @findex SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
25288 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
25289 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
25290 This domain contains names of labels (for gotos).
25291 @findex SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
25292 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
25293 @item gdb.SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
25294 This domain holds a subset of the @code{SYMBOLS_VAR_DOMAIN}; it
25295 contains everything minus functions and types.
25296 @findex SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
25297 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
25298 @item gdb.SYMBOL_FUNCTION_DOMAIN
25299 This domain contains all functions.
25300 @findex SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
25301 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
25302 @item gdb.SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
25303 This domain contains all types.
25304 @end table
25305
25306 The available address class categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
25307 as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
25308
25309 @table @code
25310 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
25311 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
25312 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
25313 If this is returned by address class, it indicates an error either in
25314 the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
25315 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
25316 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
25317 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
25318 Value is constant int.
25319 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
25320 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
25321 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
25322 Value is at a fixed address.
25323 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
25324 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
25325 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
25326 Value is in a register.
25327 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
25328 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
25329 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
25330 Value is an argument. This value is at the offset stored within the
25331 symbol inside the frame's argument list.
25332 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
25333 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
25334 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
25335 Value address is stored in the frame's argument list. Just like
25336 @code{LOC_ARG} except that the value's address is stored at the
25337 offset, not the value itself.
25338 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
25339 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
25340 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
25341 Value is a specified register. Just like @code{LOC_REGISTER} except
25342 the register holds the address of the argument instead of the argument
25343 itself.
25344 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
25345 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
25346 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
25347 Value is a local variable.
25348 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
25349 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
25350 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
25351 Value not used. Symbols in the domain @code{SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN} all
25352 have this class.
25353 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
25354 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
25355 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
25356 Value is a block.
25357 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
25358 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
25359 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
25360 Value is a byte-sequence.
25361 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
25362 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
25363 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
25364 Value is at a fixed address, but the address of the variable has to be
25365 determined from the minimal symbol table whenever the variable is
25366 referenced.
25367 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
25368 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
25369 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
25370 The value does not actually exist in the program.
25371 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
25372 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
25373 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
25374 The value's address is a computed location.
25375 @end table
25376
25377 @node Symbol Tables In Python
25378 @subsubsection Symbol table representation in Python.
25379
25380 @cindex symbol tables in python
25381 @tindex gdb.Symtab
25382 @tindex gdb.Symtab_and_line
25383
25384 Access to symbol table data maintained by @value{GDBN} on the inferior
25385 is exposed to Python via two objects: @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} and
25386 @code{gdb.Symtab}. Symbol table and line data for a frame is returned
25387 from the @code{find_sal} method in @code{gdb.Frame} object.
25388 @xref{Frames In Python}.
25389
25390 For more information on @value{GDBN}'s symbol table management, see
25391 @ref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, for more information.
25392
25393 A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object has the following attributes:
25394
25395 @table @code
25396 @defvar Symtab_and_line.symtab
25397 The symbol table object (@code{gdb.Symtab}) for this frame.
25398 This attribute is not writable.
25399 @end defvar
25400
25401 @defvar Symtab_and_line.pc
25402 Indicates the start of the address range occupied by code for the
25403 current source line. This attribute is not writable.
25404 @end defvar
25405
25406 @defvar Symtab_and_line.last
25407 Indicates the end of the address range occupied by code for the current
25408 source line. This attribute is not writable.
25409 @end defvar
25410
25411 @defvar Symtab_and_line.line
25412 Indicates the current line number for this object. This
25413 attribute is not writable.
25414 @end defvar
25415 @end table
25416
25417 A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object has the following methods:
25418
25419 @table @code
25420 @defun Symtab_and_line.is_valid ()
25421 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object is valid,
25422 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object can become
25423 invalid if the Symbol table and line object it refers to does not
25424 exist in @value{GDBN} any longer. All other
25425 @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} methods will throw an exception if it is
25426 invalid at the time the method is called.
25427 @end defun
25428 @end table
25429
25430 A @code{gdb.Symtab} object has the following attributes:
25431
25432 @table @code
25433 @defvar Symtab.filename
25434 The symbol table's source filename. This attribute is not writable.
25435 @end defvar
25436
25437 @defvar Symtab.objfile
25438 The symbol table's backing object file. @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
25439 This attribute is not writable.
25440 @end defvar
25441 @end table
25442
25443 A @code{gdb.Symtab} object has the following methods:
25444
25445 @table @code
25446 @defun Symtab.is_valid ()
25447 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Symtab} object is valid,
25448 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Symtab} object can become invalid if
25449 the symbol table it refers to does not exist in @value{GDBN} any
25450 longer. All other @code{gdb.Symtab} methods will throw an exception
25451 if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
25452 @end defun
25453
25454 @defun Symtab.fullname ()
25455 Return the symbol table's source absolute file name.
25456 @end defun
25457
25458 @defun Symtab.global_block ()
25459 Return the global block of the underlying symbol table.
25460 @xref{Blocks In Python}.
25461 @end defun
25462
25463 @defun Symtab.static_block ()
25464 Return the static block of the underlying symbol table.
25465 @xref{Blocks In Python}.
25466 @end defun
25467 @end table
25468
25469 @node Breakpoints In Python
25470 @subsubsection Manipulating breakpoints using Python
25471
25472 @cindex breakpoints in python
25473 @tindex gdb.Breakpoint
25474
25475 Python code can manipulate breakpoints via the @code{gdb.Breakpoint}
25476 class.
25477
25478 @defun Breakpoint.__init__ (spec @r{[}, type @r{[}, wp_class @r{[},internal@r{]]]})
25479 Create a new breakpoint. @var{spec} is a string naming the
25480 location of the breakpoint, or an expression that defines a
25481 watchpoint. The contents can be any location recognized by the
25482 @code{break} command, or in the case of a watchpoint, by the @code{watch}
25483 command. The optional @var{type} denotes the breakpoint to create
25484 from the types defined later in this chapter. This argument can be
25485 either: @code{gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT} or @code{gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT}. @var{type}
25486 defaults to @code{gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT}. The optional @var{internal} argument
25487 allows the breakpoint to become invisible to the user. The breakpoint
25488 will neither be reported when created, nor will it be listed in the
25489 output from @code{info breakpoints} (but will be listed with the
25490 @code{maint info breakpoints} command). The optional @var{wp_class}
25491 argument defines the class of watchpoint to create, if @var{type} is
25492 @code{gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT}. If a watchpoint class is not provided, it is
25493 assumed to be a @code{gdb.WP_WRITE} class.
25494 @end defun
25495
25496 @defun Breakpoint.stop (self)
25497 The @code{gdb.Breakpoint} class can be sub-classed and, in
25498 particular, you may choose to implement the @code{stop} method.
25499 If this method is defined as a sub-class of @code{gdb.Breakpoint},
25500 it will be called when the inferior reaches any location of a
25501 breakpoint which instantiates that sub-class. If the method returns
25502 @code{True}, the inferior will be stopped at the location of the
25503 breakpoint, otherwise the inferior will continue.
25504
25505 If there are multiple breakpoints at the same location with a
25506 @code{stop} method, each one will be called regardless of the
25507 return status of the previous. This ensures that all @code{stop}
25508 methods have a chance to execute at that location. In this scenario
25509 if one of the methods returns @code{True} but the others return
25510 @code{False}, the inferior will still be stopped.
25511
25512 You should not alter the execution state of the inferior (i.e.@:, step,
25513 next, etc.), alter the current frame context (i.e.@:, change the current
25514 active frame), or alter, add or delete any breakpoint. As a general
25515 rule, you should not alter any data within @value{GDBN} or the inferior
25516 at this time.
25517
25518 Example @code{stop} implementation:
25519
25520 @smallexample
25521 class MyBreakpoint (gdb.Breakpoint):
25522 def stop (self):
25523 inf_val = gdb.parse_and_eval("foo")
25524 if inf_val == 3:
25525 return True
25526 return False
25527 @end smallexample
25528 @end defun
25529
25530 The available watchpoint types represented by constants are defined in the
25531 @code{gdb} module:
25532
25533 @table @code
25534 @findex WP_READ
25535 @findex gdb.WP_READ
25536 @item gdb.WP_READ
25537 Read only watchpoint.
25538
25539 @findex WP_WRITE
25540 @findex gdb.WP_WRITE
25541 @item gdb.WP_WRITE
25542 Write only watchpoint.
25543
25544 @findex WP_ACCESS
25545 @findex gdb.WP_ACCESS
25546 @item gdb.WP_ACCESS
25547 Read/Write watchpoint.
25548 @end table
25549
25550 @defun Breakpoint.is_valid ()
25551 Return @code{True} if this @code{Breakpoint} object is valid,
25552 @code{False} otherwise. A @code{Breakpoint} object can become invalid
25553 if the user deletes the breakpoint. In this case, the object still
25554 exists, but the underlying breakpoint does not. In the cases of
25555 watchpoint scope, the watchpoint remains valid even if execution of the
25556 inferior leaves the scope of that watchpoint.
25557 @end defun
25558
25559 @defun Breakpoint.delete
25560 Permanently deletes the @value{GDBN} breakpoint. This also
25561 invalidates the Python @code{Breakpoint} object. Any further access
25562 to this object's attributes or methods will raise an error.
25563 @end defun
25564
25565 @defvar Breakpoint.enabled
25566 This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is enabled, and
25567 @code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
25568 @end defvar
25569
25570 @defvar Breakpoint.silent
25571 This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is silent, and
25572 @code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
25573
25574 Note that a breakpoint can also be silent if it has commands and the
25575 first command is @code{silent}. This is not reported by the
25576 @code{silent} attribute.
25577 @end defvar
25578
25579 @defvar Breakpoint.thread
25580 If the breakpoint is thread-specific, this attribute holds the thread
25581 id. If the breakpoint is not thread-specific, this attribute is
25582 @code{None}. This attribute is writable.
25583 @end defvar
25584
25585 @defvar Breakpoint.task
25586 If the breakpoint is Ada task-specific, this attribute holds the Ada task
25587 id. If the breakpoint is not task-specific (or the underlying
25588 language is not Ada), this attribute is @code{None}. This attribute
25589 is writable.
25590 @end defvar
25591
25592 @defvar Breakpoint.ignore_count
25593 This attribute holds the ignore count for the breakpoint, an integer.
25594 This attribute is writable.
25595 @end defvar
25596
25597 @defvar Breakpoint.number
25598 This attribute holds the breakpoint's number --- the identifier used by
25599 the user to manipulate the breakpoint. This attribute is not writable.
25600 @end defvar
25601
25602 @defvar Breakpoint.type
25603 This attribute holds the breakpoint's type --- the identifier used to
25604 determine the actual breakpoint type or use-case. This attribute is not
25605 writable.
25606 @end defvar
25607
25608 @defvar Breakpoint.visible
25609 This attribute tells whether the breakpoint is visible to the user
25610 when set, or when the @samp{info breakpoints} command is run. This
25611 attribute is not writable.
25612 @end defvar
25613
25614 The available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
25615 module:
25616
25617 @table @code
25618 @findex BP_BREAKPOINT
25619 @findex gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT
25620 @item gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT
25621 Normal code breakpoint.
25622
25623 @findex BP_WATCHPOINT
25624 @findex gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT
25625 @item gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT
25626 Watchpoint breakpoint.
25627
25628 @findex BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
25629 @findex gdb.BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
25630 @item gdb.BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
25631 Hardware assisted watchpoint.
25632
25633 @findex BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
25634 @findex gdb.BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
25635 @item gdb.BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
25636 Hardware assisted read watchpoint.
25637
25638 @findex BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
25639 @findex gdb.BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
25640 @item gdb.BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
25641 Hardware assisted access watchpoint.
25642 @end table
25643
25644 @defvar Breakpoint.hit_count
25645 This attribute holds the hit count for the breakpoint, an integer.
25646 This attribute is writable, but currently it can only be set to zero.
25647 @end defvar
25648
25649 @defvar Breakpoint.location
25650 This attribute holds the location of the breakpoint, as specified by
25651 the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have a location
25652 (that is, it is a watchpoint) the attribute's value is @code{None}. This
25653 attribute is not writable.
25654 @end defvar
25655
25656 @defvar Breakpoint.expression
25657 This attribute holds a breakpoint expression, as specified by
25658 the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have an
25659 expression (the breakpoint is not a watchpoint) the attribute's value
25660 is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
25661 @end defvar
25662
25663 @defvar Breakpoint.condition
25664 This attribute holds the condition of the breakpoint, as specified by
25665 the user. It is a string. If there is no condition, this attribute's
25666 value is @code{None}. This attribute is writable.
25667 @end defvar
25668
25669 @defvar Breakpoint.commands
25670 This attribute holds the commands attached to the breakpoint. If
25671 there are commands, this attribute's value is a string holding all the
25672 commands, separated by newlines. If there are no commands, this
25673 attribute is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
25674 @end defvar
25675
25676 @node Finish Breakpoints in Python
25677 @subsubsection Finish Breakpoints
25678
25679 @cindex python finish breakpoints
25680 @tindex gdb.FinishBreakpoint
25681
25682 A finish breakpoint is a temporary breakpoint set at the return address of
25683 a frame, based on the @code{finish} command. @code{gdb.FinishBreakpoint}
25684 extends @code{gdb.Breakpoint}. The underlying breakpoint will be disabled
25685 and deleted when the execution will run out of the breakpoint scope (i.e.@:
25686 @code{Breakpoint.stop} or @code{FinishBreakpoint.out_of_scope} triggered).
25687 Finish breakpoints are thread specific and must be create with the right
25688 thread selected.
25689
25690 @defun FinishBreakpoint.__init__ (@r{[}frame@r{]} @r{[}, internal@r{]})
25691 Create a finish breakpoint at the return address of the @code{gdb.Frame}
25692 object @var{frame}. If @var{frame} is not provided, this defaults to the
25693 newest frame. The optional @var{internal} argument allows the breakpoint to
25694 become invisible to the user. @xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for further
25695 details about this argument.
25696 @end defun
25697
25698 @defun FinishBreakpoint.out_of_scope (self)
25699 In some circumstances (e.g.@: @code{longjmp}, C@t{++} exceptions, @value{GDBN}
25700 @code{return} command, @dots{}), a function may not properly terminate, and
25701 thus never hit the finish breakpoint. When @value{GDBN} notices such a
25702 situation, the @code{out_of_scope} callback will be triggered.
25703
25704 You may want to sub-class @code{gdb.FinishBreakpoint} and override this
25705 method:
25706
25707 @smallexample
25708 class MyFinishBreakpoint (gdb.FinishBreakpoint)
25709 def stop (self):
25710 print "normal finish"
25711 return True
25712
25713 def out_of_scope ():
25714 print "abnormal finish"
25715 @end smallexample
25716 @end defun
25717
25718 @defvar FinishBreakpoint.return_value
25719 When @value{GDBN} is stopped at a finish breakpoint and the frame
25720 used to build the @code{gdb.FinishBreakpoint} object had debug symbols, this
25721 attribute will contain a @code{gdb.Value} object corresponding to the return
25722 value of the function. The value will be @code{None} if the function return
25723 type is @code{void} or if the return value was not computable. This attribute
25724 is not writable.
25725 @end defvar
25726
25727 @node Lazy Strings In Python
25728 @subsubsection Python representation of lazy strings.
25729
25730 @cindex lazy strings in python
25731 @tindex gdb.LazyString
25732
25733 A @dfn{lazy string} is a string whose contents is not retrieved or
25734 encoded until it is needed.
25735
25736 A @code{gdb.LazyString} is represented in @value{GDBN} as an
25737 @code{address} that points to a region of memory, an @code{encoding}
25738 that will be used to encode that region of memory, and a @code{length}
25739 to delimit the region of memory that represents the string. The
25740 difference between a @code{gdb.LazyString} and a string wrapped within
25741 a @code{gdb.Value} is that a @code{gdb.LazyString} will be treated
25742 differently by @value{GDBN} when printing. A @code{gdb.LazyString} is
25743 retrieved and encoded during printing, while a @code{gdb.Value}
25744 wrapping a string is immediately retrieved and encoded on creation.
25745
25746 A @code{gdb.LazyString} object has the following functions:
25747
25748 @defun LazyString.value ()
25749 Convert the @code{gdb.LazyString} to a @code{gdb.Value}. This value
25750 will point to the string in memory, but will lose all the delayed
25751 retrieval, encoding and handling that @value{GDBN} applies to a
25752 @code{gdb.LazyString}.
25753 @end defun
25754
25755 @defvar LazyString.address
25756 This attribute holds the address of the string. This attribute is not
25757 writable.
25758 @end defvar
25759
25760 @defvar LazyString.length
25761 This attribute holds the length of the string in characters. If the
25762 length is -1, then the string will be fetched and encoded up to the
25763 first null of appropriate width. This attribute is not writable.
25764 @end defvar
25765
25766 @defvar LazyString.encoding
25767 This attribute holds the encoding that will be applied to the string
25768 when the string is printed by @value{GDBN}. If the encoding is not
25769 set, or contains an empty string, then @value{GDBN} will select the
25770 most appropriate encoding when the string is printed. This attribute
25771 is not writable.
25772 @end defvar
25773
25774 @defvar LazyString.type
25775 This attribute holds the type that is represented by the lazy string's
25776 type. For a lazy string this will always be a pointer type. To
25777 resolve this to the lazy string's character type, use the type's
25778 @code{target} method. @xref{Types In Python}. This attribute is not
25779 writable.
25780 @end defvar
25781
25782 @node Python Auto-loading
25783 @subsection Python Auto-loading
25784 @cindex Python auto-loading
25785
25786 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25787 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
25788 @value{GDBN} will look for Python support scripts in several ways:
25789 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} (@pxref{objfile-gdb.py file})
25790 and @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25791 (@pxref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}).
25792
25793 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
25794 debugging commands and scripts.
25795
25796 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25797 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25798
25799 @table @code
25800 @anchor{set auto-load python-scripts}
25801 @kindex set auto-load python-scripts
25802 @item set auto-load python-scripts [on|off]
25803 Enable or disable the auto-loading of Python scripts.
25804
25805 @anchor{show auto-load python-scripts}
25806 @kindex show auto-load python-scripts
25807 @item show auto-load python-scripts
25808 Show whether auto-loading of Python scripts is enabled or disabled.
25809
25810 @anchor{info auto-load python-scripts}
25811 @kindex info auto-load python-scripts
25812 @cindex print list of auto-loaded Python scripts
25813 @item info auto-load python-scripts [@var{regexp}]
25814 Print the list of all Python scripts that @value{GDBN} auto-loaded.
25815
25816 Also printed is the list of Python scripts that were mentioned in
25817 the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section and were not found
25818 (@pxref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}).
25819 This is useful because their names are not printed when @value{GDBN}
25820 tries to load them and fails. There may be many of them, and printing
25821 an error message for each one is problematic.
25822
25823 If @var{regexp} is supplied only Python scripts with matching names are printed.
25824
25825 Example:
25826
25827 @smallexample
25828 (gdb) info auto-load python-scripts
25829 Loaded Script
25830 Yes py-section-script.py
25831 full name: /tmp/py-section-script.py
25832 No my-foo-pretty-printers.py
25833 @end smallexample
25834 @end table
25835
25836 When reading an auto-loaded file, @value{GDBN} sets the
25837 @dfn{current objfile}. This is available via the @code{gdb.current_objfile}
25838 function (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}). This can be useful for
25839 registering objfile-specific pretty-printers.
25840
25841 @menu
25842 * objfile-gdb.py file:: The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file
25843 * dotdebug_gdb_scripts section:: The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25844 * Which flavor to choose?::
25845 @end menu
25846
25847 @node objfile-gdb.py file
25848 @subsubsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file
25849 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25850
25851 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for
25852 a file named @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
25853 where @var{objfile} is the object file's real name, formed by ensuring
25854 that the file name is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving
25855 @code{.} and @code{..} components. If this file exists and is
25856 readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a Python script.
25857
25858 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
25859 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
25860
25861 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25862 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25863
25864 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
25865 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
25866 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
25867 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
25868 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
25869 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
25870
25871 @table @code
25872 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
25873 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
25874 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
25875 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
25876 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
25877 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
25878
25879 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
25880 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
25881
25882 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
25883 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
25884 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
25885 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
25886
25887 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
25888 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
25889 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
25890 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
25891 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
25892 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
25893 platform.
25894
25895 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
25896 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
25897 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
25898
25899 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
25900 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
25901 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
25902 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
25903 @end table
25904
25905 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
25906 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
25907 @var{objfile} is opened.
25908 So your @file{-gdb.py} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
25909 is evaluated more than once.
25910
25911 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
25912 @subsubsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25913 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25914
25915 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
25916 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
25917 it will look for a special section named @samp{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25918 If this section exists, its contents is a list of names of scripts to load.
25919
25920 @value{GDBN} will look for each specified script file first in the
25921 current directory and then along the source search path
25922 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
25923 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
25924 directory is not relevant to scripts.
25925
25926 Entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
25927 for example, this GCC macro:
25928
25929 @example
25930 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
25931 #define DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT(script_name) \
25932 asm("\
25933 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
25934 .byte 1\n\
25935 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
25936 .popsection \n\
25937 ");
25938 @end example
25939
25940 @noindent
25941 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
25942
25943 @example
25944 DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
25945 @end example
25946
25947 The script name may include directories if desired.
25948
25949 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25950 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25951
25952 If the macro is put in a header, any application or library
25953 using this header will get a reference to the specified script.
25954
25955 @node Which flavor to choose?
25956 @subsubsection Which flavor to choose?
25957
25958 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading Python scripts, it might not always
25959 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
25960
25961 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.py} way:
25962
25963 @itemize @bullet
25964 @item
25965 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
25966
25967 @item
25968 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
25969
25970 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
25971 in the source search path.
25972 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
25973 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
25974
25975 @item
25976 Doesn't require source code additions.
25977 @end itemize
25978
25979 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
25980
25981 @itemize @bullet
25982 @item
25983 Works with static linking.
25984
25985 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.py} way require an objfile to
25986 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
25987 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
25988 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's @file{-gdb.py} script.
25989
25990 @item
25991 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
25992
25993 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
25994 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.py} script to.
25995
25996 @item
25997 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
25998
25999 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
26000 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
26001 @file{-gdb.py} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
26002 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
26003 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
26004 top of the source tree to the source search path.
26005 @end itemize
26006
26007 @node Python modules
26008 @subsection Python modules
26009 @cindex python modules
26010
26011 @value{GDBN} comes with several modules to assist writing Python code.
26012
26013 @menu
26014 * gdb.printing:: Building and registering pretty-printers.
26015 * gdb.types:: Utilities for working with types.
26016 * gdb.prompt:: Utilities for prompt value substitution.
26017 @end menu
26018
26019 @node gdb.printing
26020 @subsubsection gdb.printing
26021 @cindex gdb.printing
26022
26023 This module provides a collection of utilities for working with
26024 pretty-printers.
26025
26026 @table @code
26027 @item PrettyPrinter (@var{name}, @var{subprinters}=None)
26028 This class specifies the API that makes @samp{info pretty-printer},
26029 @samp{enable pretty-printer} and @samp{disable pretty-printer} work.
26030 Pretty-printers should generally inherit from this class.
26031
26032 @item SubPrettyPrinter (@var{name})
26033 For printers that handle multiple types, this class specifies the
26034 corresponding API for the subprinters.
26035
26036 @item RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter (@var{name})
26037 Utility class for handling multiple printers, all recognized via
26038 regular expressions.
26039 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for an example.
26040
26041 @item FlagEnumerationPrinter (@var{name})
26042 A pretty-printer which handles printing of @code{enum} values. Unlike
26043 @value{GDBN}'s built-in @code{enum} printing, this printer attempts to
26044 work properly when there is some overlap between the enumeration
26045 constants. @var{name} is the name of the printer and also the name of
26046 the @code{enum} type to look up.
26047
26048 @item register_pretty_printer (@var{obj}, @var{printer}, @var{replace}=False)
26049 Register @var{printer} with the pretty-printer list of @var{obj}.
26050 If @var{replace} is @code{True} then any existing copy of the printer
26051 is replaced. Otherwise a @code{RuntimeError} exception is raised
26052 if a printer with the same name already exists.
26053 @end table
26054
26055 @node gdb.types
26056 @subsubsection gdb.types
26057 @cindex gdb.types
26058
26059 This module provides a collection of utilities for working with
26060 @code{gdb.Types} objects.
26061
26062 @table @code
26063 @item get_basic_type (@var{type})
26064 Return @var{type} with const and volatile qualifiers stripped,
26065 and with typedefs and C@t{++} references converted to the underlying type.
26066
26067 C@t{++} example:
26068
26069 @smallexample
26070 typedef const int const_int;
26071 const_int foo (3);
26072 const_int& foo_ref (foo);
26073 int main () @{ return 0; @}
26074 @end smallexample
26075
26076 Then in gdb:
26077
26078 @smallexample
26079 (gdb) start
26080 (gdb) python import gdb.types
26081 (gdb) python foo_ref = gdb.parse_and_eval("foo_ref")
26082 (gdb) python print gdb.types.get_basic_type(foo_ref.type)
26083 int
26084 @end smallexample
26085
26086 @item has_field (@var{type}, @var{field})
26087 Return @code{True} if @var{type}, assumed to be a type with fields
26088 (e.g., a structure or union), has field @var{field}.
26089
26090 @item make_enum_dict (@var{enum_type})
26091 Return a Python @code{dictionary} type produced from @var{enum_type}.
26092
26093 @item deep_items (@var{type})
26094 Returns a Python iterator similar to the standard
26095 @code{gdb.Type.iteritems} method, except that the iterator returned
26096 by @code{deep_items} will recursively traverse anonymous struct or
26097 union fields. For example:
26098
26099 @smallexample
26100 struct A
26101 @{
26102 int a;
26103 union @{
26104 int b0;
26105 int b1;
26106 @};
26107 @};
26108 @end smallexample
26109
26110 @noindent
26111 Then in @value{GDBN}:
26112 @smallexample
26113 (@value{GDBP}) python import gdb.types
26114 (@value{GDBP}) python struct_a = gdb.lookup_type("struct A")
26115 (@value{GDBP}) python print struct_a.keys ()
26116 @{['a', '']@}
26117 (@value{GDBP}) python print [k for k,v in gdb.types.deep_items(struct_a)]
26118 @{['a', 'b0', 'b1']@}
26119 @end smallexample
26120
26121 @end table
26122
26123 @node gdb.prompt
26124 @subsubsection gdb.prompt
26125 @cindex gdb.prompt
26126
26127 This module provides a method for prompt value-substitution.
26128
26129 @table @code
26130 @item substitute_prompt (@var{string})
26131 Return @var{string} with escape sequences substituted by values. Some
26132 escape sequences take arguments. You can specify arguments inside
26133 ``@{@}'' immediately following the escape sequence.
26134
26135 The escape sequences you can pass to this function are:
26136
26137 @table @code
26138 @item \\
26139 Substitute a backslash.
26140 @item \e
26141 Substitute an ESC character.
26142 @item \f
26143 Substitute the selected frame; an argument names a frame parameter.
26144 @item \n
26145 Substitute a newline.
26146 @item \p
26147 Substitute a parameter's value; the argument names the parameter.
26148 @item \r
26149 Substitute a carriage return.
26150 @item \t
26151 Substitute the selected thread; an argument names a thread parameter.
26152 @item \v
26153 Substitute the version of GDB.
26154 @item \w
26155 Substitute the current working directory.
26156 @item \[
26157 Begin a sequence of non-printing characters. These sequences are
26158 typically used with the ESC character, and are not counted in the string
26159 length. Example: ``\[\e[0;34m\](gdb)\[\e[0m\]'' will return a
26160 blue-colored ``(gdb)'' prompt where the length is five.
26161 @item \]
26162 End a sequence of non-printing characters.
26163 @end table
26164
26165 For example:
26166
26167 @smallexample
26168 substitute_prompt (``frame: \f,
26169 print arguments: \p@{print frame-arguments@}'')
26170 @end smallexample
26171
26172 @exdent will return the string:
26173
26174 @smallexample
26175 "frame: main, print arguments: scalars"
26176 @end smallexample
26177 @end table
26178
26179 @node Aliases
26180 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
26181 @cindex aliases for commands
26182
26183 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
26184 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
26185 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
26186 that involves less typing.
26187
26188 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
26189 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
26190 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
26191
26192 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
26193 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
26194 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
26195
26196 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
26197
26198 @table @code
26199
26200 @kindex alias
26201 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
26202
26203 @end table
26204
26205 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
26206 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
26207 underscores.
26208
26209 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
26210 that is being aliased.
26211
26212 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
26213 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
26214 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
26215
26216 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
26217 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
26218
26219 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
26220 of a command so that there is less to type.
26221 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
26222 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
26223 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
26224 The following will accomplish this.
26225
26226 @smallexample
26227 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
26228 @end smallexample
26229
26230 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
26231 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
26232 for it with the @samp{document} command.
26233 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
26234
26235 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
26236 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
26237 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
26238 of a command.
26239
26240 @smallexample
26241 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
26242 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
26243 (gdb) set p elms 20
26244 (gdb) show p elms
26245 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
26246 @end smallexample
26247
26248 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
26249 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
26250 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
26251
26252 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
26253 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
26254
26255 @smallexample
26256 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
26257 @end smallexample
26258
26259 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
26260 alias for a more complex command.
26261 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
26262
26263 @smallexample
26264 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
26265 (gdb) spe 20
26266 @end smallexample
26267
26268 @node Interpreters
26269 @chapter Command Interpreters
26270 @cindex command interpreters
26271
26272 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
26273 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
26274 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
26275
26276 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
26277 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
26278 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
26279 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
26280
26281 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
26282 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
26283 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
26284 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
26285
26286 @table @code
26287 @item console
26288 @cindex console interpreter
26289 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
26290 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
26291 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
26292
26293 @item mi
26294 @cindex mi interpreter
26295 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
26296 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
26297 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
26298 Interface}.
26299
26300 @item mi2
26301 @cindex mi2 interpreter
26302 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
26303
26304 @item mi1
26305 @cindex mi1 interpreter
26306 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
26307
26308 @end table
26309
26310 @cindex invoke another interpreter
26311 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
26312 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
26313 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
26314 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
26315 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
26316 the IDE inoperable!
26317
26318 @kindex interpreter-exec
26319 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
26320 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
26321 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
26322 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
26323
26324 @smallexample
26325 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
26326 @end smallexample
26327
26328 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
26329 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
26330
26331 @node TUI
26332 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
26333 @cindex TUI
26334 @cindex Text User Interface
26335
26336 @menu
26337 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
26338 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
26339 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
26340 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
26341 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
26342 @end menu
26343
26344 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
26345 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
26346 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
26347 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
26348 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
26349 is available.
26350
26351 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
26352 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
26353 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
26354 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
26355 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
26356
26357 @node TUI Overview
26358 @section TUI Overview
26359
26360 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
26361
26362 @table @emph
26363 @item command
26364 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
26365 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
26366 managed using readline.
26367
26368 @item source
26369 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
26370 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
26371
26372 @item assembly
26373 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
26374
26375 @item register
26376 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
26377 when their values change.
26378 @end table
26379
26380 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
26381 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
26382 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
26383 indicates the breakpoint type:
26384
26385 @table @code
26386 @item B
26387 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26388
26389 @item b
26390 Breakpoint which was never hit.
26391
26392 @item H
26393 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26394
26395 @item h
26396 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
26397 @end table
26398
26399 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
26400
26401 @table @code
26402 @item +
26403 Breakpoint is enabled.
26404
26405 @item -
26406 Breakpoint is disabled.
26407 @end table
26408
26409 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
26410 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
26411 changes.
26412
26413 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
26414 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
26415 layouts:
26416
26417 @itemize @bullet
26418 @item
26419 source only,
26420
26421 @item
26422 assembly only,
26423
26424 @item
26425 source and assembly,
26426
26427 @item
26428 source and registers, or
26429
26430 @item
26431 assembly and registers.
26432 @end itemize
26433
26434 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
26435
26436 @table @emph
26437 @item target
26438 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
26439 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
26440
26441 @item process
26442 Gives the current process or thread number.
26443 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
26444
26445 @item function
26446 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
26447 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
26448 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
26449 the string @code{??} is displayed.
26450
26451 @item line
26452 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
26453 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
26454
26455 @item pc
26456 Indicates the current program counter address.
26457 @end table
26458
26459 @node TUI Keys
26460 @section TUI Key Bindings
26461 @cindex TUI key bindings
26462
26463 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
26464 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
26465 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
26466 @end ifset
26467 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
26468 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
26469 @end ifclear
26470 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
26471 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
26472
26473 @table @kbd
26474 @kindex C-x C-a
26475 @item C-x C-a
26476 @kindex C-x a
26477 @itemx C-x a
26478 @kindex C-x A
26479 @itemx C-x A
26480 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
26481 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
26482 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
26483 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
26484 The screen is then refreshed.
26485
26486 @kindex C-x 1
26487 @item C-x 1
26488 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
26489 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
26490 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
26491
26492 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
26493
26494 @kindex C-x 2
26495 @item C-x 2
26496 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
26497 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
26498 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
26499 previous layout and the new one.
26500
26501 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
26502
26503 @kindex C-x o
26504 @item C-x o
26505 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
26506 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
26507 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
26508
26509 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
26510
26511 @kindex C-x s
26512 @item C-x s
26513 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
26514 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
26515 @end table
26516
26517 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
26518
26519 @table @asis
26520 @kindex PgUp
26521 @item @key{PgUp}
26522 Scroll the active window one page up.
26523
26524 @kindex PgDn
26525 @item @key{PgDn}
26526 Scroll the active window one page down.
26527
26528 @kindex Up
26529 @item @key{Up}
26530 Scroll the active window one line up.
26531
26532 @kindex Down
26533 @item @key{Down}
26534 Scroll the active window one line down.
26535
26536 @kindex Left
26537 @item @key{Left}
26538 Scroll the active window one column left.
26539
26540 @kindex Right
26541 @item @key{Right}
26542 Scroll the active window one column right.
26543
26544 @kindex C-L
26545 @item @kbd{C-L}
26546 Refresh the screen.
26547 @end table
26548
26549 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
26550 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
26551 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
26552 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
26553 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
26554
26555 @node TUI Single Key Mode
26556 @section TUI Single Key Mode
26557 @cindex TUI single key mode
26558
26559 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
26560 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
26561 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
26562
26563 @table @kbd
26564 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26565 @item c
26566 continue
26567
26568 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26569 @item d
26570 down
26571
26572 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26573 @item f
26574 finish
26575
26576 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26577 @item n
26578 next
26579
26580 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26581 @item q
26582 exit the SingleKey mode.
26583
26584 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26585 @item r
26586 run
26587
26588 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26589 @item s
26590 step
26591
26592 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26593 @item u
26594 up
26595
26596 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26597 @item v
26598 info locals
26599
26600 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26601 @item w
26602 where
26603 @end table
26604
26605 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
26606 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
26607 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
26608 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
26609 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
26610 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
26611
26612
26613 @node TUI Commands
26614 @section TUI-specific Commands
26615 @cindex TUI commands
26616
26617 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
26618 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
26619 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
26620 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
26621
26622 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
26623 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
26624 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
26625 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
26626 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
26627
26628 @table @code
26629 @item info win
26630 @kindex info win
26631 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
26632
26633 @item layout next
26634 @kindex layout
26635 Display the next layout.
26636
26637 @item layout prev
26638 Display the previous layout.
26639
26640 @item layout src
26641 Display the source window only.
26642
26643 @item layout asm
26644 Display the assembly window only.
26645
26646 @item layout split
26647 Display the source and assembly window.
26648
26649 @item layout regs
26650 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
26651
26652 @item focus next
26653 @kindex focus
26654 Make the next window active for scrolling.
26655
26656 @item focus prev
26657 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
26658
26659 @item focus src
26660 Make the source window active for scrolling.
26661
26662 @item focus asm
26663 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
26664
26665 @item focus regs
26666 Make the register window active for scrolling.
26667
26668 @item focus cmd
26669 Make the command window active for scrolling.
26670
26671 @item refresh
26672 @kindex refresh
26673 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
26674
26675 @item tui reg float
26676 @kindex tui reg
26677 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
26678
26679 @item tui reg general
26680 Show the general registers in the register window.
26681
26682 @item tui reg next
26683 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
26684 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
26685 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
26686 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
26687
26688 @item tui reg system
26689 Show the system registers in the register window.
26690
26691 @item update
26692 @kindex update
26693 Update the source window and the current execution point.
26694
26695 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
26696 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
26697 @kindex winheight
26698 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
26699 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
26700 decrease it.
26701
26702 @item tabset @var{nchars}
26703 @kindex tabset
26704 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
26705 @end table
26706
26707 @node TUI Configuration
26708 @section TUI Configuration Variables
26709 @cindex TUI configuration variables
26710
26711 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
26712
26713 @table @code
26714 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
26715 @kindex set tui border-kind
26716 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
26717 The possible values are the following:
26718 @table @code
26719 @item space
26720 Use a space character to draw the border.
26721
26722 @item ascii
26723 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
26724
26725 @item acs
26726 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
26727 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
26728 @end table
26729
26730 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
26731 @kindex set tui border-mode
26732 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
26733 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
26734 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
26735 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
26736 @table @code
26737 @item normal
26738 Use normal attributes to display the border.
26739
26740 @item standout
26741 Use standout mode.
26742
26743 @item reverse
26744 Use reverse video mode.
26745
26746 @item half
26747 Use half bright mode.
26748
26749 @item half-standout
26750 Use half bright and standout mode.
26751
26752 @item bold
26753 Use extra bright or bold mode.
26754
26755 @item bold-standout
26756 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
26757 @end table
26758 @end table
26759
26760 @node Emacs
26761 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
26762
26763 @cindex Emacs
26764 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
26765 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
26766 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
26767 @value{GDBN}.
26768
26769 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
26770 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
26771 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
26772 created Emacs buffer.
26773 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
26774
26775 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
26776 things:
26777
26778 @itemize @bullet
26779 @item
26780 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
26781 the GUD buffer.
26782
26783 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
26784 and output done by the program you are debugging.
26785
26786 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
26787 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
26788 in this way.
26789
26790 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
26791 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
26792 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
26793 stop.
26794
26795 @item
26796 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
26797
26798 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
26799 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
26800 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
26801 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
26802 and the source.
26803
26804 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
26805 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
26806 @end itemize
26807
26808 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
26809 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
26810 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
26811 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
26812
26813 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
26814 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
26815 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
26816 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
26817 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
26818 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
26819 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
26820 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
26821 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
26822
26823 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
26824 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
26825 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
26826 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
26827
26828 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
26829 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
26830 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
26831 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
26832 one you want.
26833
26834 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
26835 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
26836
26837 @table @kbd
26838 @item C-h m
26839 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
26840
26841 @item C-c C-s
26842 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
26843 update the display window to show the current file and location.
26844
26845 @item C-c C-n
26846 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
26847 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
26848 to show the current file and location.
26849
26850 @item C-c C-i
26851 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
26852 display window accordingly.
26853
26854 @item C-c C-f
26855 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
26856 @code{finish} command.
26857
26858 @item C-c C-r
26859 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
26860 command.
26861
26862 @item C-c <
26863 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
26864 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
26865 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
26866
26867 @item C-c >
26868 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
26869 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
26870 @end table
26871
26872 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
26873 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
26874
26875 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
26876 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
26877 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
26878 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
26879 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
26880 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
26881 speedbar displays watch expressions.
26882
26883 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
26884 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
26885 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
26886 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
26887 frame.
26888
26889 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
26890 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
26891 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
26892 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
26893 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
26894 to correspond properly with the code.
26895
26896 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
26897 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
26898 Emacs Manual}).
26899
26900 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
26901 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
26902 @ignore
26903 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
26904 @kindex Epoch
26905 @kindex inspect
26906
26907 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
26908 called the @code{epoch}
26909 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
26910 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
26911 each value is printed in its own window.
26912 @end ignore
26913
26914
26915 @node GDB/MI
26916 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
26917
26918 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
26919
26920 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
26921 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
26922 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
26923 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
26924 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
26925 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
26926
26927 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
26928 in the form of a reference manual.
26929
26930 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
26931 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
26932 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
26933
26934 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
26935
26936 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
26937 This chapter uses the following notation:
26938
26939 @itemize @bullet
26940 @item
26941 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
26942
26943 @item
26944 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
26945 it may or may not be given.
26946
26947 @item
26948 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26949 may repeat zero or more times.
26950
26951 @item
26952 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26953 may repeat one or more times.
26954
26955 @item
26956 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
26957 @end itemize
26958
26959 @ignore
26960 @heading Dependencies
26961 @end ignore
26962
26963 @menu
26964 * GDB/MI General Design::
26965 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
26966 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
26967 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
26968 * GDB/MI Output Records::
26969 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
26970 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
26971 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
26972 * GDB/MI Program Context::
26973 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
26974 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
26975 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
26976 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
26977 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
26978 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
26979 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
26980 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
26981 * GDB/MI File Commands::
26982 @ignore
26983 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
26984 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
26985 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
26986 @end ignore
26987 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
26988 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
26989 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
26990 @end menu
26991
26992 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26993 @node GDB/MI General Design
26994 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
26995 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
26996
26997 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
26998 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
26999 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
27000 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
27001 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
27002 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
27003 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
27004 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
27005 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
27006 a command and reported as part of that command response.
27007
27008 The important examples of notifications are:
27009 @itemize @bullet
27010
27011 @item
27012 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
27013 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
27014 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
27015 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
27016 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
27017 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
27018 command itself was successfully executed.
27019
27020 @item
27021 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
27022 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
27023 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
27024 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
27025 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
27026 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
27027
27028 @item
27029 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
27030 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
27031 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
27032 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
27033 orthogonal frontend design.
27034
27035 @end itemize
27036
27037 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
27038 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
27039 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
27040 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
27041 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
27042 the user interface.
27043
27044
27045 @menu
27046 * Context management::
27047 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
27048 * Thread groups::
27049 @end menu
27050
27051 @node Context management
27052 @subsection Context management
27053
27054 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
27055 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
27056 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
27057 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
27058 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
27059 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
27060 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
27061 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
27062 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
27063
27064 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
27065 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
27066 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
27067 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
27068 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
27069 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
27070 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
27071 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
27072 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
27073 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
27074 for thread and frame to operate on.
27075
27076 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
27077 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
27078 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
27079 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
27080 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
27081 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
27082 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
27083 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
27084 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
27085 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
27086
27087 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
27088 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
27089 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
27090 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
27091 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
27092 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
27093 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
27094 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
27095 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
27096 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
27097 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
27098 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
27099 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
27100 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
27101 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
27102 @samp{--frame} options.
27103
27104 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
27105 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
27106
27107 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
27108 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
27109 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
27110 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
27111 @code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
27112 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
27113 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
27114 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
27115 @code{-list-target-features} command.
27116
27117 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
27118 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
27119 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
27120 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
27121 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
27122 are running.
27123
27124 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
27125 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
27126 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
27127 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
27128 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
27129 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
27130 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
27131 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
27132 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
27133 @samp{--thread} option).
27134
27135 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
27136 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
27137 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
27138 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
27139
27140 @node Thread groups
27141 @subsection Thread groups
27142 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
27143 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
27144 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
27145 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
27146 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
27147
27148 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
27149 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
27150 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
27151 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
27152 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
27153 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
27154 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
27155 into processes.
27156
27157 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
27158 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
27159 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
27160 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
27161 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
27162 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
27163 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
27164 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
27165 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
27166 the members of specific thread group.
27167
27168 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
27169 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
27170 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
27171 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
27172 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
27173 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
27174 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
27175 after attaching to that thread group.
27176
27177 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
27178 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
27179 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
27180 such thread groups.
27181
27182 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27183 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
27184 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
27185
27186 @menu
27187 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
27188 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
27189 @end menu
27190
27191 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
27192 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
27193
27194 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
27195 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
27196 @table @code
27197 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
27198 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
27199
27200 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
27201 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
27202 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
27203
27204 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
27205 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
27206 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
27207
27208 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27209 "any sequence of digits"
27210
27211 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
27212 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
27213
27214 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
27215 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
27216
27217 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
27218 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
27219
27220 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
27221 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
27222 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
27223
27224 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
27225 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
27226
27227 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27228 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27229 @end table
27230
27231 @noindent
27232 Notes:
27233
27234 @itemize @bullet
27235 @item
27236 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
27237 output is described below.
27238
27239 @item
27240 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
27241 finishes.
27242
27243 @item
27244 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
27245 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
27246 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
27247 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
27248 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
27249 @end itemize
27250
27251 Pragmatics:
27252
27253 @itemize @bullet
27254 @item
27255 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
27256
27257 @item
27258 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
27259 @end itemize
27260
27261 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
27262 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
27263
27264 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
27265 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
27266 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
27267 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
27268 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
27269 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
27270
27271 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
27272 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
27273 @var{token}.
27274
27275 @table @code
27276 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
27277 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
27278
27279 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
27280 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
27281
27282 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
27283 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
27284
27285 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
27286 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
27287
27288 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
27289 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
27290
27291 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
27292 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
27293
27294 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
27295 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
27296
27297 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
27298 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
27299
27300 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
27301 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
27302
27303 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
27304 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
27305 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
27306
27307 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
27308 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
27309
27310 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
27311 @code{ @var{string} }
27312
27313 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
27314 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
27315
27316 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
27317 @code{@var{c-string}}
27318
27319 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
27320 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
27321
27322 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
27323 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
27324 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
27325
27326 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
27327 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
27328
27329 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
27330 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
27331
27332 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
27333 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
27334
27335 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
27336 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
27337
27338 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27339 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27340
27341 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27342 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
27343 @end table
27344
27345 @noindent
27346 Notes:
27347
27348 @itemize @bullet
27349 @item
27350 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
27351
27352 @item
27353 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
27354 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
27355 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
27356 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
27357 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
27358 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
27359 prior command.
27360
27361 @item
27362 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27363 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
27364 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
27365 prefixed by @samp{+}.
27366
27367 @item
27368 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27369 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
27370 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
27371 @samp{*}.
27372
27373 @item
27374 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27375 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
27376 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
27377 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
27378
27379 @item
27380 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27381 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
27382 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
27383 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
27384
27385 @item
27386 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27387 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
27388 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
27389
27390 @item
27391 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27392 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
27393 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
27394 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
27395
27396 @item
27397 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27398 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
27399 @var{values}.
27400
27401
27402 @end itemize
27403
27404 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
27405 details about the various output records.
27406
27407 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27408 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
27409 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
27410
27411 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
27412 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
27413
27414 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
27415 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
27416 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
27417 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
27418 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
27419 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
27420
27421 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
27422 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
27423 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
27424
27425 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27426 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
27427 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
27428 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
27429
27430 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
27431 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
27432
27433 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
27434 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
27435 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
27436 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
27437 might change.
27438
27439 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
27440 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
27441 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
27442 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
27443
27444 @itemize @bullet
27445 @item
27446 New MI commands may be added.
27447
27448 @item
27449 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
27450
27451 @item
27452 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
27453 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
27454
27455 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
27456 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
27457
27458 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
27459 @c resolve inconsistencies.
27460 @end itemize
27461
27462 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
27463 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
27464 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
27465 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
27466 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
27467
27468 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
27469 @c version?
27470
27471 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
27472 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
27473 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
27474 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
27475 @cindex mailing lists
27476
27477 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27478 @node GDB/MI Output Records
27479 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
27480
27481 @menu
27482 * GDB/MI Result Records::
27483 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
27484 * GDB/MI Async Records::
27485 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
27486 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
27487 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
27488 @end menu
27489
27490 @node GDB/MI Result Records
27491 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
27492
27493 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27494 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
27495 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
27496 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
27497
27498 @table @code
27499 @findex ^done
27500 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
27501 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
27502 values.
27503
27504 @item "^running"
27505 @findex ^running
27506 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
27507 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
27508 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
27509 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
27510 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
27511 which threads are resumed.
27512
27513 @item "^connected"
27514 @findex ^connected
27515 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
27516
27517 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
27518 @findex ^error
27519 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
27520 error message.
27521
27522 @item "^exit"
27523 @findex ^exit
27524 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
27525
27526 @end table
27527
27528 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
27529 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
27530
27531 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
27532 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27533 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
27534 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
27535 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
27536
27537 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
27538 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
27539 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
27540 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
27541 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
27542
27543 @table @code
27544 @item "~" @var{string-output}
27545 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
27546 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
27547
27548 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
27549 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
27550 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
27551 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
27552
27553 @item "&" @var{string-output}
27554 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
27555 internals.
27556 @end table
27557
27558 @node GDB/MI Async Records
27559 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
27560
27561 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27562 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
27563 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
27564 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
27565 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
27566 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
27567
27568 The following is the list of possible async records:
27569
27570 @table @code
27571
27572 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
27573 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
27574 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
27575 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
27576 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
27577 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
27578 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
27579 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
27580 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
27581 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
27582
27583 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
27584 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
27585 following values:
27586
27587 @table @code
27588 @item breakpoint-hit
27589 A breakpoint was reached.
27590 @item watchpoint-trigger
27591 A watchpoint was triggered.
27592 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
27593 A read watchpoint was triggered.
27594 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
27595 An access watchpoint was triggered.
27596 @item function-finished
27597 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27598 @item location-reached
27599 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27600 @item watchpoint-scope
27601 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
27602 @item end-stepping-range
27603 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
27604 similar CLI command was accomplished.
27605 @item exited-signalled
27606 The inferior exited because of a signal.
27607 @item exited
27608 The inferior exited.
27609 @item exited-normally
27610 The inferior exited normally.
27611 @item signal-received
27612 A signal was received by the inferior.
27613 @item solib-event
27614 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
27615 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
27616 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
27617 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
27618 @item fork
27619 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
27620 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27621 @item vfork
27622 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
27623 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27624 @item syscall-entry
27625 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
27626 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27627 @item syscall-entry
27628 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
27629 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27630 @item exec
27631 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
27632 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27633 @end table
27634
27635 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
27636 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
27637 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
27638 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
27639 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
27640 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
27641 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
27642 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
27643 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
27644 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
27645 if such information is not available.
27646
27647 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
27648 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
27649 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
27650 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
27651 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
27652 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
27653 cannot be used in any way.
27654
27655 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
27656 A thread group became associated with a running program,
27657 either because the program was just started or the thread group
27658 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
27659 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
27660 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
27661
27662 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
27663 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
27664 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
27665 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
27666 thread group. @var{code} is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
27667 only when the inferior exited with some code.
27668
27669 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27670 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27671 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
27672 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
27673 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
27674
27675 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
27676 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
27677 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
27678 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
27679 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
27680 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
27681 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
27682
27683 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
27684 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
27685 that thread.
27686
27687 @item =library-loaded,...
27688 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
27689 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
27690 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
27691 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
27692 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
27693 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
27694 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
27695 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
27696 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
27697 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
27698 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
27699 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
27700 thread groups.
27701
27702 @item =library-unloaded,...
27703 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
27704 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
27705 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
27706 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
27707 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
27708 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
27709 thread groups.
27710
27711 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
27712 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
27713 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
27714 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
27715 frame is @var{tpnum}.
27716
27717 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},value=@var{value}
27718 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
27719 value @var{value}.
27720
27721 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
27722 @itemx =tsv-deleted
27723 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
27724 trace state variables are deleted.
27725
27726 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
27727 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
27728 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
27729 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
27730 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
27731 user.
27732
27733 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
27734 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
27735 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
27736
27737 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
27738 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
27739
27740 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
27741 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
27742 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
27743 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
27744 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
27745
27746 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
27747 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
27748 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
27749 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
27750 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
27751 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
27752
27753 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
27754 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
27755 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
27756 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
27757 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
27758 executable code.
27759 @end table
27760
27761 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
27762 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
27763
27764 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
27765 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
27766 fields:
27767
27768 @table @code
27769 @item level
27770 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
27771 zero. This field is always present.
27772
27773 @item func
27774 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
27775 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
27776
27777 @item addr
27778 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
27779
27780 @item file
27781 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
27782 address. This field may be absent.
27783
27784 @item line
27785 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
27786 may be absent.
27787
27788 @item from
27789 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
27790 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
27791
27792 @end table
27793
27794 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
27795 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
27796
27797 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
27798 uses a tuple with the following fields:
27799
27800 @table @code
27801 @item id
27802 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
27803 always present.
27804
27805 @item target-id
27806 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
27807
27808 @item details
27809 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
27810 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
27811 frontend. This field is optional.
27812
27813 @item state
27814 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
27815 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
27816
27817 @item core
27818 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
27819 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
27820 @end table
27821
27822 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
27823 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
27824
27825 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
27826 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
27827 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
27828 the @code{exception-name} field.
27829
27830 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27831 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
27832 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
27833 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
27834
27835 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
27836 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
27837 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
27838 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
27839
27840 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
27841 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
27842
27843 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
27844
27845 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
27846 information of the breakpoint.
27847
27848 @smallexample
27849 -> -break-insert main
27850 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27851 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27852 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
27853 <- (gdb)
27854 @end smallexample
27855
27856 @subheading Program Execution
27857
27858 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
27859 reason that execution stopped.
27860
27861 @smallexample
27862 -> -exec-run
27863 <- ^running
27864 <- (gdb)
27865 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
27866 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
27867 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
27868 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
27869 <- (gdb)
27870 -> -exec-continue
27871 <- ^running
27872 <- (gdb)
27873 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27874 <- (gdb)
27875 @end smallexample
27876
27877 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
27878
27879 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
27880
27881 @smallexample
27882 -> (gdb)
27883 <- -gdb-exit
27884 <- ^exit
27885 @end smallexample
27886
27887 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
27888 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
27889 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
27890 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
27891 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
27892 fails to exit in reasonable time.
27893
27894 @subheading A Bad Command
27895
27896 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
27897
27898 @smallexample
27899 -> -rubbish
27900 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
27901 <- (gdb)
27902 @end smallexample
27903
27904
27905 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27906 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
27907 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
27908
27909 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
27910 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
27911
27912 @subheading Motivation
27913
27914 The motivation for this collection of commands.
27915
27916 @subheading Introduction
27917
27918 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
27919
27920 @subheading Commands
27921
27922 For each command in the block, the following is described:
27923
27924 @subsubheading Synopsis
27925
27926 @smallexample
27927 -command @var{args}@dots{}
27928 @end smallexample
27929
27930 @subsubheading Result
27931
27932 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27933
27934 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
27935
27936 @subsubheading Example
27937
27938 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
27939 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
27940
27941
27942 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27943 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
27944 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
27945
27946 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
27947 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
27948 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27949 breakpoints.
27950
27951 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
27952 @findex -break-after
27953
27954 @subsubheading Synopsis
27955
27956 @smallexample
27957 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
27958 @end smallexample
27959
27960 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
27961 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
27962 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
27963 @samp{-break-list} command below.
27964
27965 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27966
27967 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
27968
27969 @subsubheading Example
27970
27971 @smallexample
27972 (gdb)
27973 -break-insert main
27974 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27975 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27976 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
27977 (gdb)
27978 -break-after 1 3
27979 ~
27980 ^done
27981 (gdb)
27982 -break-list
27983 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27984 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27985 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27986 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27987 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27988 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27989 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27990 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27991 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27992 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27993 (gdb)
27994 @end smallexample
27995
27996 @ignore
27997 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
27998 @findex -break-catch
27999 @end ignore
28000
28001 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
28002 @findex -break-commands
28003
28004 @subsubheading Synopsis
28005
28006 @smallexample
28007 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
28008 @end smallexample
28009
28010 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
28011 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
28012 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
28013 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
28014 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
28015 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
28016
28017 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28018
28019 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
28020
28021 @subsubheading Example
28022
28023 @smallexample
28024 (gdb)
28025 -break-insert main
28026 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28027 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28028 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
28029 (gdb)
28030 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
28031 ^done
28032 (gdb)
28033 @end smallexample
28034
28035 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
28036 @findex -break-condition
28037
28038 @subsubheading Synopsis
28039
28040 @smallexample
28041 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
28042 @end smallexample
28043
28044 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
28045 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
28046 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
28047 command below).
28048
28049 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28050
28051 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
28052
28053 @subsubheading Example
28054
28055 @smallexample
28056 (gdb)
28057 -break-condition 1 1
28058 ^done
28059 (gdb)
28060 -break-list
28061 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28062 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28063 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28064 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28065 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28066 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28067 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28068 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28069 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28070 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28071 (gdb)
28072 @end smallexample
28073
28074 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
28075 @findex -break-delete
28076
28077 @subsubheading Synopsis
28078
28079 @smallexample
28080 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28081 @end smallexample
28082
28083 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
28084 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
28085
28086 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28087
28088 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
28089
28090 @subsubheading Example
28091
28092 @smallexample
28093 (gdb)
28094 -break-delete 1
28095 ^done
28096 (gdb)
28097 -break-list
28098 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28099 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28100 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28101 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28102 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28103 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28104 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28105 body=[]@}
28106 (gdb)
28107 @end smallexample
28108
28109 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
28110 @findex -break-disable
28111
28112 @subsubheading Synopsis
28113
28114 @smallexample
28115 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28116 @end smallexample
28117
28118 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
28119 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
28120
28121 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28122
28123 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
28124
28125 @subsubheading Example
28126
28127 @smallexample
28128 (gdb)
28129 -break-disable 2
28130 ^done
28131 (gdb)
28132 -break-list
28133 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28134 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28135 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28136 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28137 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28138 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28139 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28140 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28141 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28142 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
28143 (gdb)
28144 @end smallexample
28145
28146 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
28147 @findex -break-enable
28148
28149 @subsubheading Synopsis
28150
28151 @smallexample
28152 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28153 @end smallexample
28154
28155 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
28156
28157 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28158
28159 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
28160
28161 @subsubheading Example
28162
28163 @smallexample
28164 (gdb)
28165 -break-enable 2
28166 ^done
28167 (gdb)
28168 -break-list
28169 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28170 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28171 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28172 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28173 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28174 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28175 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28176 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28177 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28178 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
28179 (gdb)
28180 @end smallexample
28181
28182 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
28183 @findex -break-info
28184
28185 @subsubheading Synopsis
28186
28187 @smallexample
28188 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
28189 @end smallexample
28190
28191 @c REDUNDANT???
28192 Get information about a single breakpoint.
28193
28194 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28195
28196 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
28197
28198 @subsubheading Example
28199 N.A.
28200
28201 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
28202 @findex -break-insert
28203
28204 @subsubheading Synopsis
28205
28206 @smallexample
28207 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
28208 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28209 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
28210 @end smallexample
28211
28212 @noindent
28213 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
28214
28215 @itemize @bullet
28216 @item function
28217 @c @item +offset
28218 @c @item -offset
28219 @c @item linenum
28220 @item filename:linenum
28221 @item filename:function
28222 @item *address
28223 @end itemize
28224
28225 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28226
28227 @table @samp
28228 @item -t
28229 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28230 @item -h
28231 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
28232 @item -f
28233 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
28234 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28235 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28236 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28237 cannot be parsed.
28238 @item -d
28239 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28240 @item -a
28241 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
28242 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
28243 @item -c @var{condition}
28244 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28245 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28246 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
28247 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28248 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
28249 @end table
28250
28251 @subsubheading Result
28252
28253 The result is in the form:
28254
28255 @smallexample
28256 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
28257 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
28258 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
28259 times="@var{times}"@}
28260 @end smallexample
28261
28262 @noindent
28263 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
28264 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
28265 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
28266 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
28267 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
28268 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
28269 which use the same output).
28270
28271 Note: this format is open to change.
28272 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28273
28274 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28275
28276 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
28277 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
28278
28279 @subsubheading Example
28280
28281 @smallexample
28282 (gdb)
28283 -break-insert main
28284 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
28285 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
28286 (gdb)
28287 -break-insert -t foo
28288 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
28289 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
28290 (gdb)
28291 -break-list
28292 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28293 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28294 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28295 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28296 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28297 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28298 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28299 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28300 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
28301 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
28302 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28303 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
28304 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
28305 (gdb)
28306 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
28307 @c ~int foo(int, int);
28308 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
28309 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
28310 @c (gdb)
28311 @end smallexample
28312
28313 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
28314 @findex -break-list
28315
28316 @subsubheading Synopsis
28317
28318 @smallexample
28319 -break-list
28320 @end smallexample
28321
28322 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
28323
28324 @table @samp
28325 @item Number
28326 number of the breakpoint
28327 @item Type
28328 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
28329 @item Disposition
28330 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
28331 or @samp{nokeep}
28332 @item Enabled
28333 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
28334 @item Address
28335 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
28336 @item What
28337 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
28338 name, line number
28339 @item Times
28340 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
28341 @end table
28342
28343 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
28344 @code{body} field is an empty list.
28345
28346 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28347
28348 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
28349
28350 @subsubheading Example
28351
28352 @smallexample
28353 (gdb)
28354 -break-list
28355 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28356 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28357 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28358 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28359 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28360 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28361 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28362 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28363 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
28364 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28365 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28366 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
28367 (gdb)
28368 @end smallexample
28369
28370 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
28371
28372 @smallexample
28373 (gdb)
28374 -break-list
28375 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28376 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28377 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28378 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28379 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28380 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28381 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28382 body=[]@}
28383 (gdb)
28384 @end smallexample
28385
28386 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
28387 @findex -break-passcount
28388
28389 @subsubheading Synopsis
28390
28391 @smallexample
28392 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
28393 @end smallexample
28394
28395 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
28396 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
28397 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
28398 command @samp{passcount}.
28399
28400 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
28401 @findex -break-watch
28402
28403 @subsubheading Synopsis
28404
28405 @smallexample
28406 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
28407 @end smallexample
28408
28409 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
28410 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
28411 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
28412 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
28413 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
28414 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
28415 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
28416 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
28417
28418 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
28419 breakpoints inserted.
28420
28421 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28422
28423 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
28424 @samp{rwatch}.
28425
28426 @subsubheading Example
28427
28428 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
28429
28430 @smallexample
28431 (gdb)
28432 -break-watch x
28433 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
28434 (gdb)
28435 -exec-continue
28436 ^running
28437 (gdb)
28438 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
28439 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
28440 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28441 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
28442 (gdb)
28443 @end smallexample
28444
28445 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
28446 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
28447 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
28448
28449 @smallexample
28450 (gdb)
28451 -break-watch C
28452 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
28453 (gdb)
28454 -exec-continue
28455 ^running
28456 (gdb)
28457 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
28458 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28459 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28460 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28461 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
28462 (gdb)
28463 -exec-continue
28464 ^running
28465 (gdb)
28466 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
28467 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28468 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28469 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28470 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28471 (gdb)
28472 @end smallexample
28473
28474 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
28475 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
28476 deleted.
28477
28478 @smallexample
28479 (gdb)
28480 -break-watch C
28481 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
28482 (gdb)
28483 -break-list
28484 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28485 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28486 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28487 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28488 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28489 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28490 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28491 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28492 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28493 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28494 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
28495 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28496 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
28497 (gdb)
28498 -exec-continue
28499 ^running
28500 (gdb)
28501 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
28502 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28503 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28504 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28505 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
28506 (gdb)
28507 -break-list
28508 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28509 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28510 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28511 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28512 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28513 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28514 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28515 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28516 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28517 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28518 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
28519 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28520 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
28521 (gdb)
28522 -exec-continue
28523 ^running
28524 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
28525 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28526 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28527 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28528 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28529 (gdb)
28530 -break-list
28531 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28532 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28533 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28534 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28535 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28536 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28537 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28538 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28539 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28540 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28541 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
28542 times="1"@}]@}
28543 (gdb)
28544 @end smallexample
28545
28546 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28547 @node GDB/MI Program Context
28548 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
28549
28550 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
28551 @findex -exec-arguments
28552
28553
28554 @subsubheading Synopsis
28555
28556 @smallexample
28557 -exec-arguments @var{args}
28558 @end smallexample
28559
28560 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
28561 @samp{-exec-run}.
28562
28563 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28564
28565 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
28566
28567 @subsubheading Example
28568
28569 @smallexample
28570 (gdb)
28571 -exec-arguments -v word
28572 ^done
28573 (gdb)
28574 @end smallexample
28575
28576
28577 @ignore
28578 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
28579 @findex -exec-show-arguments
28580
28581 @subsubheading Synopsis
28582
28583 @smallexample
28584 -exec-show-arguments
28585 @end smallexample
28586
28587 Print the arguments of the program.
28588
28589 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28590
28591 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
28592
28593 @subsubheading Example
28594 N.A.
28595 @end ignore
28596
28597
28598 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
28599 @findex -environment-cd
28600
28601 @subsubheading Synopsis
28602
28603 @smallexample
28604 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
28605 @end smallexample
28606
28607 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
28608
28609 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28610
28611 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
28612
28613 @subsubheading Example
28614
28615 @smallexample
28616 (gdb)
28617 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
28618 ^done
28619 (gdb)
28620 @end smallexample
28621
28622
28623 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
28624 @findex -environment-directory
28625
28626 @subsubheading Synopsis
28627
28628 @smallexample
28629 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
28630 @end smallexample
28631
28632 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
28633 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
28634 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
28635 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28636 occurs as normal.
28637 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
28638 multiple directories in a single command
28639 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28640 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28641 If blanks are needed as
28642 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28643 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
28644 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
28645 character must not be used
28646 in any directory name.
28647 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
28648
28649 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28650
28651 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
28652
28653 @subsubheading Example
28654
28655 @smallexample
28656 (gdb)
28657 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
28658 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
28659 (gdb)
28660 -environment-directory ""
28661 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
28662 (gdb)
28663 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
28664 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
28665 (gdb)
28666 -environment-directory -r
28667 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
28668 (gdb)
28669 @end smallexample
28670
28671
28672 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
28673 @findex -environment-path
28674
28675 @subsubheading Synopsis
28676
28677 @smallexample
28678 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
28679 @end smallexample
28680
28681 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
28682 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
28683 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
28684 supplied in addition to the
28685 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28686 occurs as normal.
28687 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
28688 multiple directories in a single command
28689 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28690 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28691 If blanks are needed as
28692 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28693 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
28694 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
28695 character must not be used
28696 in any directory name.
28697 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
28698
28699
28700 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28701
28702 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
28703
28704 @subsubheading Example
28705
28706 @smallexample
28707 (gdb)
28708 -environment-path
28709 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
28710 (gdb)
28711 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
28712 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
28713 (gdb)
28714 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
28715 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
28716 (gdb)
28717 @end smallexample
28718
28719
28720 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
28721 @findex -environment-pwd
28722
28723 @subsubheading Synopsis
28724
28725 @smallexample
28726 -environment-pwd
28727 @end smallexample
28728
28729 Show the current working directory.
28730
28731 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28732
28733 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
28734
28735 @subsubheading Example
28736
28737 @smallexample
28738 (gdb)
28739 -environment-pwd
28740 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
28741 (gdb)
28742 @end smallexample
28743
28744 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28745 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
28746 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
28747
28748
28749 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
28750 @findex -thread-info
28751
28752 @subsubheading Synopsis
28753
28754 @smallexample
28755 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
28756 @end smallexample
28757
28758 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
28759 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
28760 threads. When printing information about all threads,
28761 also reports the current thread.
28762
28763 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28764
28765 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
28766 about all threads.
28767
28768 @subsubheading Result
28769
28770 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
28771 defined for a given thread:
28772
28773 @table @samp
28774 @item current
28775 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
28776
28777 @item id
28778 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
28779
28780 @item target-id
28781 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
28782
28783 @item details
28784 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
28785 field is optional.
28786
28787 @item name
28788 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
28789 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
28790 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
28791 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
28792 field is omitted.
28793
28794 @item frame
28795 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
28796
28797 @item state
28798 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
28799 values:
28800
28801 @table @code
28802 @item stopped
28803 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
28804 threads.
28805
28806 @item running
28807 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
28808 threads.
28809
28810 @end table
28811
28812 @item core
28813 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
28814 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
28815
28816 @end table
28817
28818 @subsubheading Example
28819
28820 @smallexample
28821 -thread-info
28822 ^done,threads=[
28823 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
28824 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
28825 args=[]@},state="running"@},
28826 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
28827 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
28828 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
28829 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
28830 state="running"@}],
28831 current-thread-id="1"
28832 (gdb)
28833 @end smallexample
28834
28835 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
28836 @findex -thread-list-ids
28837
28838 @subsubheading Synopsis
28839
28840 @smallexample
28841 -thread-list-ids
28842 @end smallexample
28843
28844 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
28845 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
28846
28847 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
28848 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
28849
28850 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28851
28852 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
28853
28854 @subsubheading Example
28855
28856 @smallexample
28857 (gdb)
28858 -thread-list-ids
28859 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28860 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
28861 (gdb)
28862 @end smallexample
28863
28864
28865 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
28866 @findex -thread-select
28867
28868 @subsubheading Synopsis
28869
28870 @smallexample
28871 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
28872 @end smallexample
28873
28874 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
28875 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
28876
28877 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
28878 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
28879
28880 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28881
28882 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
28883
28884 @subsubheading Example
28885
28886 @smallexample
28887 (gdb)
28888 -exec-next
28889 ^running
28890 (gdb)
28891 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
28892 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
28893 (gdb)
28894 -thread-list-ids
28895 ^done,
28896 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28897 number-of-threads="3"
28898 (gdb)
28899 -thread-select 3
28900 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
28901 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
28902 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
28903 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
28904 (gdb)
28905 @end smallexample
28906
28907 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28908 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
28909 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
28910
28911 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
28912 @findex -ada-task-info
28913
28914 @subsubheading Synopsis
28915
28916 @smallexample
28917 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
28918 @end smallexample
28919
28920 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
28921 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
28922
28923 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28924
28925 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
28926 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
28927
28928 @subsubheading Result
28929
28930 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
28931 defined for each Ada task:
28932
28933 @table @samp
28934 @item current
28935 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
28936
28937 @item id
28938 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
28939
28940 @item task-id
28941 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
28942
28943 @item thread-id
28944 The identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
28945
28946 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
28947 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
28948 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
28949
28950 @item parent-id
28951 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
28952 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
28953
28954 @item priority
28955 The base priority of the task.
28956
28957 @item state
28958 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
28959 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
28960
28961 @item name
28962 The name of the task.
28963
28964 @end table
28965
28966 @subsubheading Example
28967
28968 @smallexample
28969 -ada-task-info
28970 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
28971 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
28972 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
28973 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
28974 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
28975 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
28976 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
28977 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
28978 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
28979 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
28980 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
28981 (gdb)
28982 @end smallexample
28983
28984 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28985 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
28986 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
28987
28988 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
28989 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
28990 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
28991 other cases.
28992
28993 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
28994 @findex -exec-continue
28995
28996 @subsubheading Synopsis
28997
28998 @smallexample
28999 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
29000 @end smallexample
29001
29002 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
29003 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
29004 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
29005 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
29006 @itemize @bullet
29007 @item
29008 breakpoints or watchpoints
29009 @item
29010 signals or exceptions
29011 @item
29012 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
29013 @item
29014 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
29015 @end itemize
29016 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
29017 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
29018 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
29019 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
29020 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
29021 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
29022
29023 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29024
29025 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
29026
29027 @subsubheading Example
29028
29029 @smallexample
29030 -exec-continue
29031 ^running
29032 (gdb)
29033 @@Hello world
29034 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
29035 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
29036 line="13"@}
29037 (gdb)
29038 @end smallexample
29039
29040
29041 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
29042 @findex -exec-finish
29043
29044 @subsubheading Synopsis
29045
29046 @smallexample
29047 -exec-finish [--reverse]
29048 @end smallexample
29049
29050 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
29051 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
29052 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
29053 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
29054 function was called.
29055
29056 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29057
29058 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
29059
29060 @subsubheading Example
29061
29062 Function returning @code{void}.
29063
29064 @smallexample
29065 -exec-finish
29066 ^running
29067 (gdb)
29068 @@hello from foo
29069 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29070 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
29071 (gdb)
29072 @end smallexample
29073
29074 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
29075 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
29076 value itself.
29077
29078 @smallexample
29079 -exec-finish
29080 ^running
29081 (gdb)
29082 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
29083 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
29084 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29085 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
29086 (gdb)
29087 @end smallexample
29088
29089
29090 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
29091 @findex -exec-interrupt
29092
29093 @subsubheading Synopsis
29094
29095 @smallexample
29096 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
29097 @end smallexample
29098
29099 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
29100 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
29101 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
29102 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
29103 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
29104
29105 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
29106 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
29107 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
29108 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
29109
29110 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
29111 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
29112 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
29113 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
29114
29115 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29116
29117 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
29118
29119 @subsubheading Example
29120
29121 @smallexample
29122 (gdb)
29123 111-exec-continue
29124 111^running
29125
29126 (gdb)
29127 222-exec-interrupt
29128 222^done
29129 (gdb)
29130 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
29131 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29132 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
29133 (gdb)
29134
29135 (gdb)
29136 -exec-interrupt
29137 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
29138 (gdb)
29139 @end smallexample
29140
29141 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
29142 @findex -exec-jump
29143
29144 @subsubheading Synopsis
29145
29146 @smallexample
29147 -exec-jump @var{location}
29148 @end smallexample
29149
29150 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
29151 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
29152 different forms of @var{location}.
29153
29154 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29155
29156 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
29157
29158 @subsubheading Example
29159
29160 @smallexample
29161 -exec-jump foo.c:10
29162 *running,thread-id="all"
29163 ^running
29164 @end smallexample
29165
29166
29167 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
29168 @findex -exec-next
29169
29170 @subsubheading Synopsis
29171
29172 @smallexample
29173 -exec-next [--reverse]
29174 @end smallexample
29175
29176 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29177 of the next source line is reached.
29178
29179 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29180 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
29181 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
29182 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
29183 source line where the function was called.
29184
29185
29186 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29187
29188 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
29189
29190 @subsubheading Example
29191
29192 @smallexample
29193 -exec-next
29194 ^running
29195 (gdb)
29196 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
29197 (gdb)
29198 @end smallexample
29199
29200
29201 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
29202 @findex -exec-next-instruction
29203
29204 @subsubheading Synopsis
29205
29206 @smallexample
29207 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
29208 @end smallexample
29209
29210 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
29211 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
29212 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
29213 printed as well.
29214
29215 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29216 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
29217 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
29218 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
29219 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
29220
29221 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29222
29223 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
29224
29225 @subsubheading Example
29226
29227 @smallexample
29228 (gdb)
29229 -exec-next-instruction
29230 ^running
29231
29232 (gdb)
29233 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29234 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
29235 (gdb)
29236 @end smallexample
29237
29238
29239 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
29240 @findex -exec-return
29241
29242 @subsubheading Synopsis
29243
29244 @smallexample
29245 -exec-return
29246 @end smallexample
29247
29248 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
29249 Displays the new current frame.
29250
29251 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29252
29253 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
29254
29255 @subsubheading Example
29256
29257 @smallexample
29258 (gdb)
29259 200-break-insert callee4
29260 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
29261 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
29262 (gdb)
29263 000-exec-run
29264 000^running
29265 (gdb)
29266 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
29267 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29268 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29269 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
29270 (gdb)
29271 205-break-delete
29272 205^done
29273 (gdb)
29274 111-exec-return
29275 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
29276 args=[@{name="strarg",
29277 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29278 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29279 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
29280 (gdb)
29281 @end smallexample
29282
29283
29284 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
29285 @findex -exec-run
29286
29287 @subsubheading Synopsis
29288
29289 @smallexample
29290 -exec-run [--all | --thread-group N]
29291 @end smallexample
29292
29293 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
29294 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
29295 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
29296 the program has exited exceptionally.
29297
29298 When no option is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
29299 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
29300 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
29301 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
29302
29303 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29304
29305 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
29306
29307 @subsubheading Examples
29308
29309 @smallexample
29310 (gdb)
29311 -break-insert main
29312 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
29313 (gdb)
29314 -exec-run
29315 ^running
29316 (gdb)
29317 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
29318 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
29319 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
29320 (gdb)
29321 @end smallexample
29322
29323 @noindent
29324 Program exited normally:
29325
29326 @smallexample
29327 (gdb)
29328 -exec-run
29329 ^running
29330 (gdb)
29331 x = 55
29332 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
29333 (gdb)
29334 @end smallexample
29335
29336 @noindent
29337 Program exited exceptionally:
29338
29339 @smallexample
29340 (gdb)
29341 -exec-run
29342 ^running
29343 (gdb)
29344 x = 55
29345 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
29346 (gdb)
29347 @end smallexample
29348
29349 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
29350 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
29351
29352 @smallexample
29353 (gdb)
29354 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
29355 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
29356 @end smallexample
29357
29358
29359 @c @subheading -exec-signal
29360
29361
29362 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
29363 @findex -exec-step
29364
29365 @subsubheading Synopsis
29366
29367 @smallexample
29368 -exec-step [--reverse]
29369 @end smallexample
29370
29371 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29372 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
29373 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
29374 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
29375 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
29376 previously executed source line.
29377
29378 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29379
29380 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
29381
29382 @subsubheading Example
29383
29384 Stepping into a function:
29385
29386 @smallexample
29387 -exec-step
29388 ^running
29389 (gdb)
29390 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29391 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
29392 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
29393 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
29394 (gdb)
29395 @end smallexample
29396
29397 Regular stepping:
29398
29399 @smallexample
29400 -exec-step
29401 ^running
29402 (gdb)
29403 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
29404 (gdb)
29405 @end smallexample
29406
29407
29408 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
29409 @findex -exec-step-instruction
29410
29411 @subsubheading Synopsis
29412
29413 @smallexample
29414 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
29415 @end smallexample
29416
29417 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
29418 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
29419 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
29420 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
29421 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
29422 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
29423 as well.
29424
29425 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29426
29427 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
29428
29429 @subsubheading Example
29430
29431 @smallexample
29432 (gdb)
29433 -exec-step-instruction
29434 ^running
29435
29436 (gdb)
29437 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29438 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29439 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
29440 (gdb)
29441 -exec-step-instruction
29442 ^running
29443
29444 (gdb)
29445 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29446 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29447 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
29448 (gdb)
29449 @end smallexample
29450
29451
29452 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
29453 @findex -exec-until
29454
29455 @subsubheading Synopsis
29456
29457 @smallexample
29458 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
29459 @end smallexample
29460
29461 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
29462 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
29463 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
29464 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
29465
29466 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29467
29468 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
29469
29470 @subsubheading Example
29471
29472 @smallexample
29473 (gdb)
29474 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
29475 ^running
29476 (gdb)
29477 x = 55
29478 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29479 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
29480 (gdb)
29481 @end smallexample
29482
29483 @ignore
29484 @subheading -file-clear
29485 Is this going away????
29486 @end ignore
29487
29488 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29489 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
29490 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
29491
29492
29493 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
29494 @findex -stack-info-frame
29495
29496 @subsubheading Synopsis
29497
29498 @smallexample
29499 -stack-info-frame
29500 @end smallexample
29501
29502 Get info on the selected frame.
29503
29504 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29505
29506 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
29507 (without arguments).
29508
29509 @subsubheading Example
29510
29511 @smallexample
29512 (gdb)
29513 -stack-info-frame
29514 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29515 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29516 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
29517 (gdb)
29518 @end smallexample
29519
29520 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
29521 @findex -stack-info-depth
29522
29523 @subsubheading Synopsis
29524
29525 @smallexample
29526 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
29527 @end smallexample
29528
29529 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
29530 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
29531
29532 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29533
29534 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
29535
29536 @subsubheading Example
29537
29538 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
29539
29540 @smallexample
29541 (gdb)
29542 -stack-info-depth
29543 ^done,depth="12"
29544 (gdb)
29545 -stack-info-depth 4
29546 ^done,depth="4"
29547 (gdb)
29548 -stack-info-depth 12
29549 ^done,depth="12"
29550 (gdb)
29551 -stack-info-depth 11
29552 ^done,depth="11"
29553 (gdb)
29554 -stack-info-depth 13
29555 ^done,depth="12"
29556 (gdb)
29557 @end smallexample
29558
29559 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
29560 @findex -stack-list-arguments
29561
29562 @subsubheading Synopsis
29563
29564 @smallexample
29565 -stack-list-arguments @var{print-values}
29566 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29567 @end smallexample
29568
29569 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
29570 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
29571 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
29572 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
29573 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
29574 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
29575 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
29576 which case only existing frames will be returned.
29577
29578 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29579 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29580 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29581 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29582 structures and unions.
29583
29584 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
29585 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29586
29587 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29588
29589 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
29590 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
29591 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
29592
29593 @subsubheading Example
29594
29595 @smallexample
29596 (gdb)
29597 -stack-list-frames
29598 ^done,
29599 stack=[
29600 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29601 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29602 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
29603 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29604 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29605 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
29606 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
29607 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29608 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
29609 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
29610 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29611 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
29612 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
29613 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29614 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
29615 (gdb)
29616 -stack-list-arguments 0
29617 ^done,
29618 stack-args=[
29619 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
29620 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
29621 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
29622 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
29623 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
29624 (gdb)
29625 -stack-list-arguments 1
29626 ^done,
29627 stack-args=[
29628 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
29629 frame=@{level="1",
29630 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
29631 frame=@{level="2",args=[
29632 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29633 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
29634 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
29635 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29636 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
29637 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
29638 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
29639 (gdb)
29640 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
29641 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
29642 (gdb)
29643 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
29644 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
29645 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29646 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
29647 (gdb)
29648 @end smallexample
29649
29650 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
29651
29652
29653 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
29654 @findex -stack-list-frames
29655
29656 @subsubheading Synopsis
29657
29658 @smallexample
29659 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29660 @end smallexample
29661
29662 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
29663 following info:
29664
29665 @table @samp
29666 @item @var{level}
29667 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
29668 @item @var{addr}
29669 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
29670 @item @var{func}
29671 Function name.
29672 @item @var{file}
29673 File name of the source file where the function lives.
29674 @item @var{fullname}
29675 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
29676 @item @var{line}
29677 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
29678 @item @var{from}
29679 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
29680 if the frame's function is not known.
29681 @end table
29682
29683 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
29684 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
29685 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
29686 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
29687 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
29688 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
29689 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
29690
29691 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29692
29693 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
29694
29695 @subsubheading Example
29696
29697 Full stack backtrace:
29698
29699 @smallexample
29700 (gdb)
29701 -stack-list-frames
29702 ^done,stack=
29703 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
29704 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
29705 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29706 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29707 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29708 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29709 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29710 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29711 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29712 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29713 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29714 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29715 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29716 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29717 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29718 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29719 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29720 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29721 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29722 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29723 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29724 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29725 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
29726 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
29727 (gdb)
29728 @end smallexample
29729
29730 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
29731
29732 @smallexample
29733 (gdb)
29734 -stack-list-frames 3 5
29735 ^done,stack=
29736 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29737 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29738 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29739 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29740 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29741 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29742 (gdb)
29743 @end smallexample
29744
29745 Show a single frame:
29746
29747 @smallexample
29748 (gdb)
29749 -stack-list-frames 3 3
29750 ^done,stack=
29751 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29752 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29753 (gdb)
29754 @end smallexample
29755
29756
29757 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
29758 @findex -stack-list-locals
29759
29760 @subsubheading Synopsis
29761
29762 @smallexample
29763 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
29764 @end smallexample
29765
29766 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
29767 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29768 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29769 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29770 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29771 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
29772 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
29773 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
29774 more detail.
29775
29776 This command is deprecated in favor of the
29777 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29778
29779 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29780
29781 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
29782
29783 @subsubheading Example
29784
29785 @smallexample
29786 (gdb)
29787 -stack-list-locals 0
29788 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
29789 (gdb)
29790 -stack-list-locals --all-values
29791 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
29792 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
29793 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
29794 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
29795 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
29796 (gdb)
29797 @end smallexample
29798
29799 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
29800 @findex -stack-list-variables
29801
29802 @subsubheading Synopsis
29803
29804 @smallexample
29805 -stack-list-variables @var{print-values}
29806 @end smallexample
29807
29808 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
29809 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29810 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29811 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29812 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29813 structures and unions.
29814
29815 @subsubheading Example
29816
29817 @smallexample
29818 (gdb)
29819 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
29820 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
29821 (gdb)
29822 @end smallexample
29823
29824
29825 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
29826 @findex -stack-select-frame
29827
29828 @subsubheading Synopsis
29829
29830 @smallexample
29831 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
29832 @end smallexample
29833
29834 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
29835 the stack.
29836
29837 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
29838 option to every command.
29839
29840 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29841
29842 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
29843 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
29844
29845 @subsubheading Example
29846
29847 @smallexample
29848 (gdb)
29849 -stack-select-frame 2
29850 ^done
29851 (gdb)
29852 @end smallexample
29853
29854 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29855 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
29856 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
29857
29858 @ignore
29859
29860 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29861
29862 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
29863 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
29864 used by @code{Insight}.
29865
29866 The two main reasons for that are:
29867
29868 @enumerate 1
29869 @item
29870 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
29871
29872 @item
29873 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
29874 now).
29875 @end enumerate
29876
29877 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
29878 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
29879 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
29880 hints about their use.
29881
29882 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
29883 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
29884 least, the following operations:
29885
29886 @itemize @bullet
29887 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
29888 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
29889 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
29890 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
29891 @end itemize
29892
29893 @end ignore
29894
29895 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
29896
29897 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29898
29899 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
29900 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
29901 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
29902 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
29903 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
29904 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
29905 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
29906 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
29907 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
29908 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
29909 object, or to change display format.
29910
29911 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
29912 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
29913 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
29914 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
29915 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
29916 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
29917 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
29918 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
29919 child will be created.
29920
29921 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
29922 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
29923 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
29924 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
29925 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
29926
29927 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
29928 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
29929 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
29930 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
29931 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
29932 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
29933 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
29934 variables that frontend has created.
29935
29936 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
29937 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
29938 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
29939 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
29940 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
29941 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
29942 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
29943 implicitly updated.
29944
29945 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
29946 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
29947 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
29948 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
29949 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
29950 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
29951 frame. Consider this example:
29952
29953 @smallexample
29954 void do_work(...)
29955 @{
29956 struct work_state state;
29957
29958 if (...)
29959 do_work(...);
29960 @}
29961 @end smallexample
29962
29963 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
29964 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
29965 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
29966 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
29967 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
29968
29969 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
29970 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
29971 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
29972 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
29973 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
29974 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
29975
29976 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
29977 access this functionality:
29978
29979 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
29980 @item @strong{Operation}
29981 @tab @strong{Description}
29982
29983 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
29984 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
29985 @item @code{-var-create}
29986 @tab create a variable object
29987 @item @code{-var-delete}
29988 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
29989 @item @code{-var-set-format}
29990 @tab set the display format of this variable
29991 @item @code{-var-show-format}
29992 @tab show the display format of this variable
29993 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
29994 @tab tells how many children this object has
29995 @item @code{-var-list-children}
29996 @tab return a list of the object's children
29997 @item @code{-var-info-type}
29998 @tab show the type of this variable object
29999 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
30000 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
30001 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
30002 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
30003 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
30004 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
30005 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
30006 @tab get the value of this variable
30007 @item @code{-var-assign}
30008 @tab set the value of this variable
30009 @item @code{-var-update}
30010 @tab update the variable and its children
30011 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
30012 @tab set frozeness attribute
30013 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
30014 @tab set range of children to display on update
30015 @end multitable
30016
30017 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
30018 how it can be used.
30019
30020 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
30021
30022 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
30023 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
30024
30025 @smallexample
30026 -enable-pretty-printing
30027 @end smallexample
30028
30029 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
30030 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
30031 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30032 request that this functionality be enabled.
30033
30034 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
30035
30036 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
30037 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30038
30039 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
30040 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
30041
30042 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
30043 @findex -var-create
30044
30045 @subsubheading Synopsis
30046
30047 @smallexample
30048 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
30049 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
30050 @end smallexample
30051
30052 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
30053 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
30054 register.
30055
30056 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
30057 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
30058 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
30059 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
30060 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
30061
30062 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
30063 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
30064 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
30065 object must be created.
30066
30067 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
30068 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
30069
30070 @itemize @bullet
30071 @item
30072 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
30073
30074 @item
30075 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
30076
30077 @item
30078 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
30079 @end itemize
30080
30081 @cindex dynamic varobj
30082 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
30083 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
30084 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
30085 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
30086 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
30087 compatibility for existing clients.
30088
30089 @subsubheading Result
30090
30091 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
30092 are:
30093
30094 @table @samp
30095 @item name
30096 The name of the varobj.
30097
30098 @item numchild
30099 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
30100 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
30101 @samp{has_more} attribute.
30102
30103 @item value
30104 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
30105 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
30106 will not be interesting.
30107
30108 @item type
30109 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
30110 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
30111 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30112 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30113 @emph{declared} one.
30114
30115 @item thread-id
30116 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
30117 thread's identifier.
30118
30119 @item has_more
30120 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
30121 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
30122
30123 @item dynamic
30124 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30125 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30126 then this attribute will not be present.
30127
30128 @item displayhint
30129 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30130 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30131 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30132 @end table
30133
30134 Typical output will look like this:
30135
30136 @smallexample
30137 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
30138 has_more="@var{has_more}"
30139 @end smallexample
30140
30141
30142 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
30143 @findex -var-delete
30144
30145 @subsubheading Synopsis
30146
30147 @smallexample
30148 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
30149 @end smallexample
30150
30151 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
30152 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
30153
30154 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
30155
30156
30157 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
30158 @findex -var-set-format
30159
30160 @subsubheading Synopsis
30161
30162 @smallexample
30163 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
30164 @end smallexample
30165
30166 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
30167 @var{format-spec}.
30168
30169 @anchor{-var-set-format}
30170 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
30171
30172 @smallexample
30173 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
30174 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
30175 @end smallexample
30176
30177 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
30178 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
30179 for pointers, etc.).
30180
30181 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
30182 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
30183
30184 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
30185 @findex -var-show-format
30186
30187 @subsubheading Synopsis
30188
30189 @smallexample
30190 -var-show-format @var{name}
30191 @end smallexample
30192
30193 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
30194
30195 @smallexample
30196 @var{format} @expansion{}
30197 @var{format-spec}
30198 @end smallexample
30199
30200
30201 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
30202 @findex -var-info-num-children
30203
30204 @subsubheading Synopsis
30205
30206 @smallexample
30207 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
30208 @end smallexample
30209
30210 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
30211
30212 @smallexample
30213 numchild=@var{n}
30214 @end smallexample
30215
30216 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
30217 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
30218 be available.
30219
30220
30221 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
30222 @findex -var-list-children
30223
30224 @subsubheading Synopsis
30225
30226 @smallexample
30227 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
30228 @end smallexample
30229 @anchor{-var-list-children}
30230
30231 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
30232 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
30233 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
30234 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
30235 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
30236 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
30237 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
30238 and unions.
30239
30240 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
30241 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
30242 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
30243 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
30244 reported.
30245
30246 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
30247 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
30248 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
30249 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
30250 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
30251 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
30252 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
30253 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
30254 the visible items.
30255
30256 For each child the following results are returned:
30257
30258 @table @var
30259
30260 @item name
30261 Name of the variable object created for this child.
30262
30263 @item exp
30264 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
30265 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
30266
30267 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
30268 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
30269
30270 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
30271 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
30272 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
30273 type and value are not present.
30274
30275 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
30276 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
30277 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
30278
30279 @item numchild
30280 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
30281 0.
30282
30283 @item type
30284 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
30285 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30286 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30287 @emph{declared} one.
30288
30289 @item value
30290 If values were requested, this is the value.
30291
30292 @item thread-id
30293 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
30294 Otherwise this result is not present.
30295
30296 @item frozen
30297 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
30298 @end table
30299
30300 The result may have its own attributes:
30301
30302 @table @samp
30303 @item displayhint
30304 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30305 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30306 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30307
30308 @item has_more
30309 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
30310 remaining after the end of the selected range.
30311 @end table
30312
30313 @subsubheading Example
30314
30315 @smallexample
30316 (gdb)
30317 -var-list-children n
30318 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
30319 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
30320 (gdb)
30321 -var-list-children --all-values n
30322 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
30323 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
30324 @end smallexample
30325
30326
30327 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
30328 @findex -var-info-type
30329
30330 @subsubheading Synopsis
30331
30332 @smallexample
30333 -var-info-type @var{name}
30334 @end smallexample
30335
30336 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
30337 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
30338 @value{GDBN} CLI:
30339
30340 @smallexample
30341 type=@var{typename}
30342 @end smallexample
30343
30344
30345 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
30346 @findex -var-info-expression
30347
30348 @subsubheading Synopsis
30349
30350 @smallexample
30351 -var-info-expression @var{name}
30352 @end smallexample
30353
30354 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
30355 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
30356 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
30357
30358 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
30359 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
30360
30361 @smallexample
30362 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
30363 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
30364 @end smallexample
30365
30366 @noindent
30367 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
30368
30369 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
30370 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
30371 is of limited use.
30372
30373 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
30374 @findex -var-info-path-expression
30375
30376 @subsubheading Synopsis
30377
30378 @smallexample
30379 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
30380 @end smallexample
30381
30382 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
30383 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
30384 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
30385 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
30386 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
30387 watchpoint from a variable object.
30388
30389 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
30390 and will give an error when invoked on one.
30391
30392 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
30393 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
30394 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
30395 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
30396 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
30397 @smallexample
30398 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
30399 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
30400 @end smallexample
30401
30402 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
30403 @findex -var-show-attributes
30404
30405 @subsubheading Synopsis
30406
30407 @smallexample
30408 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
30409 @end smallexample
30410
30411 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
30412
30413 @smallexample
30414 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
30415 @end smallexample
30416
30417 @noindent
30418 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
30419
30420 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
30421 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
30422
30423 @subsubheading Synopsis
30424
30425 @smallexample
30426 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
30427 @end smallexample
30428
30429 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
30430 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
30431 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
30432 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
30433 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
30434 the current display format will be used. The current display format
30435 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
30436
30437 @smallexample
30438 value=@var{value}
30439 @end smallexample
30440
30441 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
30442 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
30443
30444 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
30445 @findex -var-assign
30446
30447 @subsubheading Synopsis
30448
30449 @smallexample
30450 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
30451 @end smallexample
30452
30453 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
30454 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
30455 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
30456 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
30457
30458 @subsubheading Example
30459
30460 @smallexample
30461 (gdb)
30462 -var-assign var1 3
30463 ^done,value="3"
30464 (gdb)
30465 -var-update *
30466 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
30467 (gdb)
30468 @end smallexample
30469
30470 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
30471 @findex -var-update
30472
30473 @subsubheading Synopsis
30474
30475 @smallexample
30476 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
30477 @end smallexample
30478
30479 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
30480 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
30481 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
30482 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
30483 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
30484 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
30485 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
30486 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
30487 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
30488 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
30489 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
30490 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
30491 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
30492
30493 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
30494 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
30495 diagnostic.
30496
30497 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
30498 only the selected range of children will be reported.
30499
30500 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
30501 @samp{changelist}.
30502
30503 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
30504
30505 @table @samp
30506 @item name
30507 The name of the varobj.
30508
30509 @item value
30510 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
30511 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
30512
30513 @item in_scope
30514 @anchor{-var-update}
30515 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
30516
30517 @table @code
30518 @item "true"
30519 The variable object's current value is valid.
30520
30521 @item "false"
30522 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
30523 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
30524 scope.
30525
30526 @item "invalid"
30527 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
30528 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
30529 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
30530 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
30531 objects.
30532 @end table
30533
30534 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
30535 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
30536
30537 @item type_changed
30538 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
30539 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
30540 be @samp{false}.
30541
30542 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
30543 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
30544 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
30545 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
30546 unset.
30547
30548 @item new_type
30549 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
30550 hold the new type.
30551
30552 @item new_num_children
30553 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
30554 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
30555
30556 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
30557 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
30558 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
30559 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
30560 children which may be available.
30561
30562 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
30563 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
30564 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
30565 only happen at the end of the update range).
30566
30567 @item displayhint
30568 The display hint, if any.
30569
30570 @item has_more
30571 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
30572 available outside the varobj's update range.
30573
30574 @item dynamic
30575 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30576 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30577 then this attribute will not be present.
30578
30579 @item new_children
30580 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
30581 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
30582 be listed in this attribute.
30583 @end table
30584
30585 @subsubheading Example
30586
30587 @smallexample
30588 (gdb)
30589 -var-assign var1 3
30590 ^done,value="3"
30591 (gdb)
30592 -var-update --all-values var1
30593 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
30594 type_changed="false"@}]
30595 (gdb)
30596 @end smallexample
30597
30598 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
30599 @findex -var-set-frozen
30600 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
30601
30602 @subsubheading Synopsis
30603
30604 @smallexample
30605 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
30606 @end smallexample
30607
30608 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
30609 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
30610 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
30611 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
30612 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
30613 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
30614 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
30615 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
30616 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
30617 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
30618 @code{-var-update} does.
30619
30620 @subsubheading Example
30621
30622 @smallexample
30623 (gdb)
30624 -var-set-frozen V 1
30625 ^done
30626 (gdb)
30627 @end smallexample
30628
30629 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
30630 @findex -var-set-update-range
30631 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
30632
30633 @subsubheading Synopsis
30634
30635 @smallexample
30636 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
30637 @end smallexample
30638
30639 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
30640 @code{-var-update}.
30641
30642 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
30643 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
30644 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
30645 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
30646
30647 @subsubheading Example
30648
30649 @smallexample
30650 (gdb)
30651 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
30652 ^done
30653 @end smallexample
30654
30655 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
30656 @findex -var-set-visualizer
30657 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
30658
30659 @subsubheading Synopsis
30660
30661 @smallexample
30662 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
30663 @end smallexample
30664
30665 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
30666
30667 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
30668 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
30669
30670 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
30671 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
30672 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
30673 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
30674 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
30675 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
30676 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
30677
30678 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
30679 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
30680 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
30681 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
30682
30683 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
30684 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands})
30685 can be used to check this.
30686
30687 @subsubheading Example
30688
30689 Resetting the visualizer:
30690
30691 @smallexample
30692 (gdb)
30693 -var-set-visualizer V None
30694 ^done
30695 @end smallexample
30696
30697 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
30698
30699 @smallexample
30700 (gdb)
30701 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
30702 ^done
30703 @end smallexample
30704
30705 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
30706 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
30707
30708 @smallexample
30709 (gdb)
30710 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
30711 ^done
30712 @end smallexample
30713
30714 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30715 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
30716 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
30717
30718 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
30719 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
30720 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
30721 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
30722
30723 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
30724 @c @subheading -data-assign
30725 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
30726 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
30727 @c set variable
30728 @c @subsubheading Example
30729 @c N.A.
30730
30731 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
30732 @findex -data-disassemble
30733
30734 @subsubheading Synopsis
30735
30736 @smallexample
30737 -data-disassemble
30738 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
30739 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
30740 -- @var{mode}
30741 @end smallexample
30742
30743 @noindent
30744 Where:
30745
30746 @table @samp
30747 @item @var{start-addr}
30748 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
30749 @item @var{end-addr}
30750 is the end address
30751 @item @var{filename}
30752 is the name of the file to disassemble
30753 @item @var{linenum}
30754 is the line number to disassemble around
30755 @item @var{lines}
30756 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
30757 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
30758 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
30759 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
30760 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
30761 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
30762 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
30763 are displayed.
30764 @item @var{mode}
30765 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly), 1 (meaning mixed source and
30766 disassembly), 2 (meaning disassembly with raw opcodes), or 3 (meaning
30767 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes).
30768 @end table
30769
30770 @subsubheading Result
30771
30772 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
30773 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
30774 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
30775
30776 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
30777 following fields:
30778
30779 @table @code
30780 @item address
30781 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
30782
30783 @item func-name
30784 The name of the function this instruction is within.
30785
30786 @item offset
30787 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
30788
30789 @item inst
30790 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
30791
30792 @item opcodes
30793 This field is only present for mode 2. This contains the raw opcode
30794 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
30795
30796 @end table
30797
30798 For modes 1 and 3 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
30799 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
30800
30801 @table @code
30802 @item line
30803 The line number within @samp{file}.
30804
30805 @item file
30806 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
30807 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
30808 used.
30809
30810 @item fullname
30811 This field is optional. If it is present it will contain an absolute
30812 file name of @samp{file}. If this field is not present then
30813 @value{GDBN} was unable to determine the absolute file name.
30814
30815 @item line_asm_insn
30816 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
30817 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
30818 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
30819 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
30820 @samp{opcodes}.
30821
30822 @end table
30823
30824 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
30825 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
30826 adjust its format.
30827
30828 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30829
30830 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
30831
30832 @subsubheading Example
30833
30834 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
30835
30836 @smallexample
30837 (gdb)
30838 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
30839 ^done,
30840 asm_insns=[
30841 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30842 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30843 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30844 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30845 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
30846 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
30847 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
30848 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30849 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
30850 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
30851 (gdb)
30852 @end smallexample
30853
30854 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
30855 @code{main}.
30856
30857 @smallexample
30858 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
30859 ^done,asm_insns=[
30860 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30861 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30862 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30863 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30864 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30865 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30866 [@dots{}]
30867 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
30868 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
30869 (gdb)
30870 @end smallexample
30871
30872 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
30873
30874 @smallexample
30875 (gdb)
30876 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
30877 ^done,asm_insns=[
30878 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30879 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30880 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30881 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30882 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30883 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
30884 (gdb)
30885 @end smallexample
30886
30887 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
30888
30889 @smallexample
30890 (gdb)
30891 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
30892 ^done,asm_insns=[
30893 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
30894 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30895 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30896 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
30897 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
30898 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
30899 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30900 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30901 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
30902 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30903 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30904 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
30905 (gdb)
30906 @end smallexample
30907
30908
30909 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
30910 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
30911
30912 @subsubheading Synopsis
30913
30914 @smallexample
30915 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
30916 @end smallexample
30917
30918 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
30919 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
30920 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
30921
30922 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30923
30924 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
30925 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
30926 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
30927
30928 @subsubheading Example
30929
30930 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
30931 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
30932 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
30933 output.
30934
30935 @smallexample
30936 211-data-evaluate-expression A
30937 211^done,value="1"
30938 (gdb)
30939 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
30940 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
30941 (gdb)
30942 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
30943 411^done,value="4"
30944 (gdb)
30945 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
30946 511^done,value="4"
30947 (gdb)
30948 @end smallexample
30949
30950
30951 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
30952 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
30953
30954 @subsubheading Synopsis
30955
30956 @smallexample
30957 -data-list-changed-registers
30958 @end smallexample
30959
30960 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
30961
30962 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30963
30964 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
30965 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
30966
30967 @subsubheading Example
30968
30969 On a PPC MBX board:
30970
30971 @smallexample
30972 (gdb)
30973 -exec-continue
30974 ^running
30975
30976 (gdb)
30977 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
30978 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
30979 line="5"@}
30980 (gdb)
30981 -data-list-changed-registers
30982 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
30983 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
30984 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
30985 (gdb)
30986 @end smallexample
30987
30988
30989 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
30990 @findex -data-list-register-names
30991
30992 @subsubheading Synopsis
30993
30994 @smallexample
30995 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
30996 @end smallexample
30997
30998 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
30999 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
31000 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
31001 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
31002 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
31003 include empty register names.
31004
31005 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31006
31007 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
31008 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
31009 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
31010
31011 @subsubheading Example
31012
31013 For the PPC MBX board:
31014 @smallexample
31015 (gdb)
31016 -data-list-register-names
31017 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
31018 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
31019 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
31020 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
31021 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
31022 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
31023 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
31024 (gdb)
31025 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
31026 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
31027 (gdb)
31028 @end smallexample
31029
31030 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
31031 @findex -data-list-register-values
31032
31033 @subsubheading Synopsis
31034
31035 @smallexample
31036 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
31037 @end smallexample
31038
31039 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
31040 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
31041 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
31042 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
31043
31044 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
31045
31046 @table @code
31047 @item x
31048 Hexadecimal
31049 @item o
31050 Octal
31051 @item t
31052 Binary
31053 @item d
31054 Decimal
31055 @item r
31056 Raw
31057 @item N
31058 Natural
31059 @end table
31060
31061 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31062
31063 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
31064 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
31065
31066 @subsubheading Example
31067
31068 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
31069 don't appear in the actual output):
31070
31071 @smallexample
31072 (gdb)
31073 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
31074 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31075 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
31076 (gdb)
31077 -data-list-register-values x
31078 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
31079 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31080 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
31081 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
31082 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
31083 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
31084 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
31085 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
31086 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
31087 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31088 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
31089 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
31090 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
31091 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
31092 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
31093 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
31094 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
31095 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
31096 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
31097 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
31098 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
31099 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
31100 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
31101 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
31102 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
31103 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
31104 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
31105 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
31106 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
31107 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
31108 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
31109 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
31110 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31111 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
31112 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
31113 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
31114 (gdb)
31115 @end smallexample
31116
31117
31118 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
31119 @findex -data-read-memory
31120
31121 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
31122
31123 @subsubheading Synopsis
31124
31125 @smallexample
31126 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
31127 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
31128 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
31129 @end smallexample
31130
31131 @noindent
31132 where:
31133
31134 @table @samp
31135 @item @var{address}
31136 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
31137 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31138 quoted using the C convention.
31139
31140 @item @var{word-format}
31141 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
31142 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
31143 ,Output Formats}).
31144
31145 @item @var{word-size}
31146 The size of each memory word in bytes.
31147
31148 @item @var{nr-rows}
31149 The number of rows in the output table.
31150
31151 @item @var{nr-cols}
31152 The number of columns in the output table.
31153
31154 @item @var{aschar}
31155 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
31156 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
31157 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
31158 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
31159
31160 @item @var{byte-offset}
31161 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
31162 @end table
31163
31164 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
31165 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
31166 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
31167 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
31168 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
31169 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
31170 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
31171 @samp{addr}.
31172
31173 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
31174 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
31175 @samp{prev-page}.
31176
31177 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31178
31179 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
31180 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
31181
31182 @subsubheading Example
31183
31184 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
31185 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
31186 word. Display each word in hex.
31187
31188 @smallexample
31189 (gdb)
31190 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
31191 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
31192 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
31193 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
31194 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
31195 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
31196 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
31197 (gdb)
31198 @end smallexample
31199
31200 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
31201 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
31202
31203 @smallexample
31204 (gdb)
31205 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
31206 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
31207 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
31208 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
31209 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
31210 (gdb)
31211 @end smallexample
31212
31213 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
31214 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
31215 used as the non-printable character.
31216
31217 @smallexample
31218 (gdb)
31219 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
31220 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
31221 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
31222 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
31223 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31224 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31225 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31226 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31227 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
31228 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
31229 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
31230 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
31231 (gdb)
31232 @end smallexample
31233
31234 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
31235 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
31236
31237 @subsubheading Synopsis
31238
31239 @smallexample
31240 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
31241 @var{address} @var{count}
31242 @end smallexample
31243
31244 @noindent
31245 where:
31246
31247 @table @samp
31248 @item @var{address}
31249 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
31250 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31251 quoted using the C convention.
31252
31253 @item @var{count}
31254 The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal.
31255
31256 @item @var{byte-offset}
31257 The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start
31258 reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided
31259 so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then
31260 perform address arithmetics itself.
31261
31262 @end table
31263
31264 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
31265 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
31266 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
31267 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
31268 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
31269 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
31270
31271 In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not,
31272 and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at
31273 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
31274 attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end
31275 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
31276 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
31277 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
31278 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
31279
31280 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
31281 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
31282 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
31283 and has the following fields:
31284
31285 @table @code
31286 @item begin
31287 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
31288
31289 @item end
31290 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
31291
31292 @item offset
31293 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
31294 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
31295
31296 @item contents
31297 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
31298
31299 @end table
31300
31301
31302
31303 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31304
31305 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
31306
31307 @subsubheading Example
31308
31309 @smallexample
31310 (gdb)
31311 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
31312 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
31313 end="0xbffff15e",
31314 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
31315 (gdb)
31316 @end smallexample
31317
31318
31319 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
31320 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
31321
31322 @subsubheading Synopsis
31323
31324 @smallexample
31325 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
31326 @end smallexample
31327
31328 @noindent
31329 where:
31330
31331 @table @samp
31332 @item @var{address}
31333 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
31334 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31335 quoted using the C convention.
31336
31337 @item @var{contents}
31338 The hex-encoded bytes to write.
31339
31340 @end table
31341
31342 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31343
31344 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31345
31346 @subsubheading Example
31347
31348 @smallexample
31349 (gdb)
31350 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
31351 ^done
31352 (gdb)
31353 @end smallexample
31354
31355
31356 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31357 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
31358 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
31359
31360 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
31361 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
31362
31363 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
31364 @findex -trace-find
31365
31366 @subsubheading Synopsis
31367
31368 @smallexample
31369 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
31370 @end smallexample
31371
31372 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
31373 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
31374 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
31375
31376 @table @samp
31377
31378 @item none
31379 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
31380
31381 @item frame-number
31382 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
31383 that index.
31384
31385 @item tracepoint-number
31386 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
31387 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
31388
31389 @item pc
31390 An address is required as parameter. Finds
31391 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
31392 address.
31393
31394 @item pc-inside-range
31395 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
31396 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
31397 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31398
31399 @item pc-outside-range
31400 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
31401 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
31402 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31403
31404 @item line
31405 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
31406 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
31407 the specified location.
31408
31409 @end table
31410
31411 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
31412 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
31413
31414 @table @samp
31415 @item found
31416 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
31417 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
31418
31419 @item traceframe
31420 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
31421 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
31422
31423 @item tracepoint
31424 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
31425 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
31426
31427 @item frame
31428 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
31429 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
31430 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
31431
31432 @end table
31433
31434 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31435
31436 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
31437
31438 @subheading -trace-define-variable
31439 @findex -trace-define-variable
31440
31441 @subsubheading Synopsis
31442
31443 @smallexample
31444 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
31445 @end smallexample
31446
31447 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
31448 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
31449 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
31450 with the @samp{$} character.
31451
31452 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31453
31454 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
31455
31456 @subheading -trace-list-variables
31457 @findex -trace-list-variables
31458
31459 @subsubheading Synopsis
31460
31461 @smallexample
31462 -trace-list-variables
31463 @end smallexample
31464
31465 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
31466 table has the following fields:
31467
31468 @table @samp
31469 @item name
31470 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
31471
31472 @item initial
31473 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
31474 field is always present.
31475
31476 @item current
31477 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
31478 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
31479 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
31480 presently running.
31481
31482 @end table
31483
31484 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31485
31486 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
31487
31488 @subsubheading Example
31489
31490 @smallexample
31491 (gdb)
31492 -trace-list-variables
31493 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
31494 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31495 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
31496 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
31497 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
31498 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
31499 (gdb)
31500 @end smallexample
31501
31502 @subheading -trace-save
31503 @findex -trace-save
31504
31505 @subsubheading Synopsis
31506
31507 @smallexample
31508 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
31509 @end smallexample
31510
31511 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
31512 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
31513 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
31514 to perform the save.
31515
31516 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31517
31518 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
31519
31520
31521 @subheading -trace-start
31522 @findex -trace-start
31523
31524 @subsubheading Synopsis
31525
31526 @smallexample
31527 -trace-start
31528 @end smallexample
31529
31530 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
31531 have any fields.
31532
31533 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31534
31535 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
31536
31537 @subheading -trace-status
31538 @findex -trace-status
31539
31540 @subsubheading Synopsis
31541
31542 @smallexample
31543 -trace-status
31544 @end smallexample
31545
31546 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
31547 the following fields:
31548
31549 @table @samp
31550
31551 @item supported
31552 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
31553 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
31554 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
31555 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
31556 started. This field is always present.
31557
31558 @item running
31559 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
31560 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
31561 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31562
31563 @item stop-reason
31564 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
31565 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
31566 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
31567 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
31568 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
31569 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
31570 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
31571 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
31572 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31573
31574 @item stopping-tracepoint
31575 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
31576 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
31577 @samp{passcount}.
31578
31579 @item frames
31580 @itemx frames-created
31581 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
31582 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
31583 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
31584 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
31585
31586 @item buffer-size
31587 @itemx buffer-free
31588 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
31589 remaining space. These fields are optional.
31590
31591 @item circular
31592 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
31593 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
31594 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
31595 and may fill up.
31596
31597 @item disconnected
31598 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
31599 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
31600 that the trace run will stop.
31601
31602 @end table
31603
31604 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31605
31606 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
31607
31608 @subheading -trace-stop
31609 @findex -trace-stop
31610
31611 @subsubheading Synopsis
31612
31613 @smallexample
31614 -trace-stop
31615 @end smallexample
31616
31617 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
31618 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
31619 @samp{running} fields are not output.
31620
31621 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31622
31623 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
31624
31625
31626 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31627 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
31628 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
31629
31630
31631 @ignore
31632 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
31633 @findex -symbol-info-address
31634
31635 @subsubheading Synopsis
31636
31637 @smallexample
31638 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
31639 @end smallexample
31640
31641 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
31642
31643 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31644
31645 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
31646
31647 @subsubheading Example
31648 N.A.
31649
31650
31651 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
31652 @findex -symbol-info-file
31653
31654 @subsubheading Synopsis
31655
31656 @smallexample
31657 -symbol-info-file
31658 @end smallexample
31659
31660 Show the file for the symbol.
31661
31662 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31663
31664 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
31665 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
31666
31667 @subsubheading Example
31668 N.A.
31669
31670
31671 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
31672 @findex -symbol-info-function
31673
31674 @subsubheading Synopsis
31675
31676 @smallexample
31677 -symbol-info-function
31678 @end smallexample
31679
31680 Show which function the symbol lives in.
31681
31682 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31683
31684 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
31685
31686 @subsubheading Example
31687 N.A.
31688
31689
31690 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
31691 @findex -symbol-info-line
31692
31693 @subsubheading Synopsis
31694
31695 @smallexample
31696 -symbol-info-line
31697 @end smallexample
31698
31699 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
31700
31701 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31702
31703 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
31704 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
31705
31706 @subsubheading Example
31707 N.A.
31708
31709
31710 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
31711 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
31712
31713 @subsubheading Synopsis
31714
31715 @smallexample
31716 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
31717 @end smallexample
31718
31719 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
31720
31721 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31722
31723 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
31724
31725 @subsubheading Example
31726 N.A.
31727
31728
31729 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
31730 @findex -symbol-list-functions
31731
31732 @subsubheading Synopsis
31733
31734 @smallexample
31735 -symbol-list-functions
31736 @end smallexample
31737
31738 List the functions in the executable.
31739
31740 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31741
31742 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
31743 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31744
31745 @subsubheading Example
31746 N.A.
31747 @end ignore
31748
31749
31750 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
31751 @findex -symbol-list-lines
31752
31753 @subsubheading Synopsis
31754
31755 @smallexample
31756 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
31757 @end smallexample
31758
31759 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
31760 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
31761 ascending PC order.
31762
31763 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31764
31765 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31766
31767 @subsubheading Example
31768 @smallexample
31769 (gdb)
31770 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
31771 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
31772 (gdb)
31773 @end smallexample
31774
31775
31776 @ignore
31777 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
31778 @findex -symbol-list-types
31779
31780 @subsubheading Synopsis
31781
31782 @smallexample
31783 -symbol-list-types
31784 @end smallexample
31785
31786 List all the type names.
31787
31788 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31789
31790 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
31791 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31792
31793 @subsubheading Example
31794 N.A.
31795
31796
31797 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
31798 @findex -symbol-list-variables
31799
31800 @subsubheading Synopsis
31801
31802 @smallexample
31803 -symbol-list-variables
31804 @end smallexample
31805
31806 List all the global and static variable names.
31807
31808 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31809
31810 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31811
31812 @subsubheading Example
31813 N.A.
31814
31815
31816 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
31817 @findex -symbol-locate
31818
31819 @subsubheading Synopsis
31820
31821 @smallexample
31822 -symbol-locate
31823 @end smallexample
31824
31825 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31826
31827 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
31828
31829 @subsubheading Example
31830 N.A.
31831
31832
31833 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
31834 @findex -symbol-type
31835
31836 @subsubheading Synopsis
31837
31838 @smallexample
31839 -symbol-type @var{variable}
31840 @end smallexample
31841
31842 Show type of @var{variable}.
31843
31844 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31845
31846 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
31847 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
31848
31849 @subsubheading Example
31850 N.A.
31851 @end ignore
31852
31853
31854 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31855 @node GDB/MI File Commands
31856 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
31857
31858 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
31859 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
31860
31861 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
31862 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
31863
31864 @subsubheading Synopsis
31865
31866 @smallexample
31867 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
31868 @end smallexample
31869
31870 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
31871 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
31872 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
31873 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
31874 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
31875 notification.
31876
31877 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31878
31879 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
31880
31881 @subsubheading Example
31882
31883 @smallexample
31884 (gdb)
31885 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31886 ^done
31887 (gdb)
31888 @end smallexample
31889
31890
31891 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
31892 @findex -file-exec-file
31893
31894 @subsubheading Synopsis
31895
31896 @smallexample
31897 -file-exec-file @var{file}
31898 @end smallexample
31899
31900 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
31901 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
31902 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
31903 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
31904 notification.
31905
31906 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31907
31908 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
31909
31910 @subsubheading Example
31911
31912 @smallexample
31913 (gdb)
31914 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31915 ^done
31916 (gdb)
31917 @end smallexample
31918
31919
31920 @ignore
31921 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
31922 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
31923
31924 @subsubheading Synopsis
31925
31926 @smallexample
31927 -file-list-exec-sections
31928 @end smallexample
31929
31930 List the sections of the current executable file.
31931
31932 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31933
31934 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
31935 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
31936 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
31937
31938 @subsubheading Example
31939 N.A.
31940 @end ignore
31941
31942
31943 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31944 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31945
31946 @subsubheading Synopsis
31947
31948 @smallexample
31949 -file-list-exec-source-file
31950 @end smallexample
31951
31952 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31953 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
31954 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31955 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31956
31957 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31958
31959 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31960
31961 @subsubheading Example
31962
31963 @smallexample
31964 (gdb)
31965 123-file-list-exec-source-file
31966 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31967 (gdb)
31968 @end smallexample
31969
31970
31971 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31972 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31973
31974 @subsubheading Synopsis
31975
31976 @smallexample
31977 -file-list-exec-source-files
31978 @end smallexample
31979
31980 List the source files for the current executable.
31981
31982 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
31983 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
31984
31985 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31986
31987 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31988 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31989
31990 @subsubheading Example
31991 @smallexample
31992 (gdb)
31993 -file-list-exec-source-files
31994 ^done,files=[
31995 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31996 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31997 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31998 (gdb)
31999 @end smallexample
32000
32001 @ignore
32002 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
32003 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
32004
32005 @subsubheading Synopsis
32006
32007 @smallexample
32008 -file-list-shared-libraries
32009 @end smallexample
32010
32011 List the shared libraries in the program.
32012
32013 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32014
32015 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
32016
32017 @subsubheading Example
32018 N.A.
32019
32020
32021 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
32022 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
32023
32024 @subsubheading Synopsis
32025
32026 @smallexample
32027 -file-list-symbol-files
32028 @end smallexample
32029
32030 List symbol files.
32031
32032 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32033
32034 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
32035
32036 @subsubheading Example
32037 N.A.
32038 @end ignore
32039
32040
32041 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
32042 @findex -file-symbol-file
32043
32044 @subsubheading Synopsis
32045
32046 @smallexample
32047 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
32048 @end smallexample
32049
32050 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
32051 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
32052 produced, except for a completion notification.
32053
32054 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32055
32056 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
32057
32058 @subsubheading Example
32059
32060 @smallexample
32061 (gdb)
32062 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32063 ^done
32064 (gdb)
32065 @end smallexample
32066
32067 @ignore
32068 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32069 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
32070 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
32071
32072 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
32073
32074 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
32075
32076 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
32077
32078 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
32079
32080 @c @subheading -overlay-map
32081
32082 @c @subheading -overlay-off
32083
32084 @c @subheading -overlay-on
32085
32086 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
32087
32088 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32089 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
32090 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
32091
32092 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
32093
32094 @c @subheading -signal-handle
32095
32096 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
32097
32098 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
32099 @end ignore
32100
32101
32102 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32103 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
32104 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
32105
32106
32107 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
32108 @findex -target-attach
32109
32110 @subsubheading Synopsis
32111
32112 @smallexample
32113 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
32114 @end smallexample
32115
32116 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
32117 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
32118 group, the id previously returned by
32119 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
32120
32121 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32122
32123 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
32124
32125 @subsubheading Example
32126 @smallexample
32127 (gdb)
32128 -target-attach 34
32129 =thread-created,id="1"
32130 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
32131 ^done
32132 (gdb)
32133 @end smallexample
32134
32135 @ignore
32136 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
32137 @findex -target-compare-sections
32138
32139 @subsubheading Synopsis
32140
32141 @smallexample
32142 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
32143 @end smallexample
32144
32145 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
32146 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
32147
32148 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32149
32150 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
32151
32152 @subsubheading Example
32153 N.A.
32154 @end ignore
32155
32156
32157 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
32158 @findex -target-detach
32159
32160 @subsubheading Synopsis
32161
32162 @smallexample
32163 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
32164 @end smallexample
32165
32166 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
32167 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
32168 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
32169
32170 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32171
32172 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
32173
32174 @subsubheading Example
32175
32176 @smallexample
32177 (gdb)
32178 -target-detach
32179 ^done
32180 (gdb)
32181 @end smallexample
32182
32183
32184 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
32185 @findex -target-disconnect
32186
32187 @subsubheading Synopsis
32188
32189 @smallexample
32190 -target-disconnect
32191 @end smallexample
32192
32193 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
32194 generally not resumed.
32195
32196 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32197
32198 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
32199
32200 @subsubheading Example
32201
32202 @smallexample
32203 (gdb)
32204 -target-disconnect
32205 ^done
32206 (gdb)
32207 @end smallexample
32208
32209
32210 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
32211 @findex -target-download
32212
32213 @subsubheading Synopsis
32214
32215 @smallexample
32216 -target-download
32217 @end smallexample
32218
32219 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
32220 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
32221
32222 @table @samp
32223 @item section
32224 The name of the section.
32225 @item section-sent
32226 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
32227 @item section-size
32228 The size of the section.
32229 @item total-sent
32230 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
32231 @item total-size
32232 The size of the overall executable to download.
32233 @end table
32234
32235 @noindent
32236 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
32237 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
32238
32239 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
32240 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
32241
32242 @table @samp
32243 @item section
32244 The name of the section.
32245 @item section-size
32246 The size of the section.
32247 @item total-size
32248 The size of the overall executable to download.
32249 @end table
32250
32251 @noindent
32252 At the end, a summary is printed.
32253
32254 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32255
32256 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
32257
32258 @subsubheading Example
32259
32260 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
32261 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
32262
32263 @smallexample
32264 (gdb)
32265 -target-download
32266 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
32267 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
32268 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
32269 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
32270 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
32271 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
32272 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
32273 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
32274 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
32275 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
32276 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
32277 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
32278 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
32279 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
32280 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
32281 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
32282 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
32283 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
32284 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
32285 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
32286 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
32287 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
32288 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
32289 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
32290 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
32291 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
32292 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
32293 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
32294 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
32295 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
32296 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
32297 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
32298 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
32299 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
32300 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
32301 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
32302 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
32303 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
32304 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
32305 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
32306 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
32307 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
32308 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
32309 write-rate="429"
32310 (gdb)
32311 @end smallexample
32312
32313
32314 @ignore
32315 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
32316 @findex -target-exec-status
32317
32318 @subsubheading Synopsis
32319
32320 @smallexample
32321 -target-exec-status
32322 @end smallexample
32323
32324 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
32325 not, for instance).
32326
32327 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32328
32329 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
32330
32331 @subsubheading Example
32332 N.A.
32333
32334
32335 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
32336 @findex -target-list-available-targets
32337
32338 @subsubheading Synopsis
32339
32340 @smallexample
32341 -target-list-available-targets
32342 @end smallexample
32343
32344 List the possible targets to connect to.
32345
32346 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32347
32348 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
32349
32350 @subsubheading Example
32351 N.A.
32352
32353
32354 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
32355 @findex -target-list-current-targets
32356
32357 @subsubheading Synopsis
32358
32359 @smallexample
32360 -target-list-current-targets
32361 @end smallexample
32362
32363 Describe the current target.
32364
32365 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32366
32367 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
32368 other things).
32369
32370 @subsubheading Example
32371 N.A.
32372
32373
32374 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
32375 @findex -target-list-parameters
32376
32377 @subsubheading Synopsis
32378
32379 @smallexample
32380 -target-list-parameters
32381 @end smallexample
32382
32383 @c ????
32384 @end ignore
32385
32386 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32387
32388 No equivalent.
32389
32390 @subsubheading Example
32391 N.A.
32392
32393
32394 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
32395 @findex -target-select
32396
32397 @subsubheading Synopsis
32398
32399 @smallexample
32400 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
32401 @end smallexample
32402
32403 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
32404
32405 @table @samp
32406 @item @var{type}
32407 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
32408 @item @var{parameters}
32409 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
32410 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
32411 @end table
32412
32413 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
32414 which the target program is, in the following form:
32415
32416 @smallexample
32417 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
32418 args=[@var{arg list}]
32419 @end smallexample
32420
32421 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32422
32423 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
32424
32425 @subsubheading Example
32426
32427 @smallexample
32428 (gdb)
32429 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
32430 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
32431 (gdb)
32432 @end smallexample
32433
32434 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32435 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
32436 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
32437
32438
32439 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
32440 @findex -target-file-put
32441
32442 @subsubheading Synopsis
32443
32444 @smallexample
32445 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
32446 @end smallexample
32447
32448 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
32449 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
32450
32451 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32452
32453 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
32454
32455 @subsubheading Example
32456
32457 @smallexample
32458 (gdb)
32459 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
32460 ^done
32461 (gdb)
32462 @end smallexample
32463
32464
32465 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
32466 @findex -target-file-get
32467
32468 @subsubheading Synopsis
32469
32470 @smallexample
32471 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
32472 @end smallexample
32473
32474 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
32475 on the host system.
32476
32477 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32478
32479 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
32480
32481 @subsubheading Example
32482
32483 @smallexample
32484 (gdb)
32485 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
32486 ^done
32487 (gdb)
32488 @end smallexample
32489
32490
32491 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
32492 @findex -target-file-delete
32493
32494 @subsubheading Synopsis
32495
32496 @smallexample
32497 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
32498 @end smallexample
32499
32500 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
32501
32502 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32503
32504 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
32505
32506 @subsubheading Example
32507
32508 @smallexample
32509 (gdb)
32510 -target-file-delete remotefile
32511 ^done
32512 (gdb)
32513 @end smallexample
32514
32515
32516 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32517 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
32518 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32519
32520 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
32521
32522 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
32523 @findex -gdb-exit
32524
32525 @subsubheading Synopsis
32526
32527 @smallexample
32528 -gdb-exit
32529 @end smallexample
32530
32531 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
32532
32533 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32534
32535 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
32536
32537 @subsubheading Example
32538
32539 @smallexample
32540 (gdb)
32541 -gdb-exit
32542 ^exit
32543 @end smallexample
32544
32545
32546 @ignore
32547 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
32548 @findex -exec-abort
32549
32550 @subsubheading Synopsis
32551
32552 @smallexample
32553 -exec-abort
32554 @end smallexample
32555
32556 Kill the inferior running program.
32557
32558 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32559
32560 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
32561
32562 @subsubheading Example
32563 N.A.
32564 @end ignore
32565
32566
32567 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
32568 @findex -gdb-set
32569
32570 @subsubheading Synopsis
32571
32572 @smallexample
32573 -gdb-set
32574 @end smallexample
32575
32576 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
32577 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
32578
32579 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32580
32581 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
32582
32583 @subsubheading Example
32584
32585 @smallexample
32586 (gdb)
32587 -gdb-set $foo=3
32588 ^done
32589 (gdb)
32590 @end smallexample
32591
32592
32593 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
32594 @findex -gdb-show
32595
32596 @subsubheading Synopsis
32597
32598 @smallexample
32599 -gdb-show
32600 @end smallexample
32601
32602 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
32603
32604 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32605
32606 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
32607
32608 @subsubheading Example
32609
32610 @smallexample
32611 (gdb)
32612 -gdb-show annotate
32613 ^done,value="0"
32614 (gdb)
32615 @end smallexample
32616
32617 @c @subheading -gdb-source
32618
32619
32620 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
32621 @findex -gdb-version
32622
32623 @subsubheading Synopsis
32624
32625 @smallexample
32626 -gdb-version
32627 @end smallexample
32628
32629 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
32630
32631 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32632
32633 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
32634 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
32635
32636 @subsubheading Example
32637
32638 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
32639 @c box in TeX.
32640 @smallexample
32641 (gdb)
32642 -gdb-version
32643 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
32644 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32645 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
32646 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
32647 ~ certain conditions.
32648 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32649 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
32650 ~ details.
32651 ~This GDB was configured as
32652 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
32653 ^done
32654 (gdb)
32655 @end smallexample
32656
32657 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
32658 @findex -list-features
32659
32660 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
32661 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
32662 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
32663 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
32664 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
32665 startup.
32666
32667 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
32668 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
32669 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
32670 is given below.
32671
32672 Example output:
32673
32674 @smallexample
32675 (gdb) -list-features
32676 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
32677 @end smallexample
32678
32679 The current list of features is:
32680
32681 @table @samp
32682 @item frozen-varobjs
32683 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
32684 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
32685 of @code{-varobj-create}.
32686 @item pending-breakpoints
32687 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
32688 command.
32689 @item python
32690 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
32691 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
32692 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
32693 @item thread-info
32694 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
32695 @item data-read-memory-bytes
32696 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
32697 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
32698 @item breakpoint-notifications
32699 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
32700 CLI will be announced via async records.
32701 @item ada-task-info
32702 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
32703 @end table
32704
32705 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
32706 @findex -list-target-features
32707
32708 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
32709 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
32710 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
32711 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
32712 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
32713 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
32714 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
32715 Example output:
32716
32717 @smallexample
32718 (gdb) -list-features
32719 ^done,result=["async"]
32720 @end smallexample
32721
32722 The current list of features is:
32723
32724 @table @samp
32725 @item async
32726 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
32727 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
32728 while the target is running.
32729
32730 @item reverse
32731 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
32732 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
32733
32734 @end table
32735
32736 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
32737 @findex -list-thread-groups
32738
32739 @subheading Synopsis
32740
32741 @smallexample
32742 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
32743 @end smallexample
32744
32745 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
32746 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
32747 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
32748 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
32749 top-level thread groups.
32750
32751 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
32752 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
32753 available on the target.
32754
32755 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
32756 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
32757 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
32758 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
32759 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
32760 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
32761 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
32762 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
32763
32764 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
32765 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
32766 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
32767 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
32768 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
32769 @samp{threads} field.
32770
32771 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
32772 the following caveats:
32773
32774 @itemize @bullet
32775 @item
32776 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
32777 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
32778 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
32779
32780 @item
32781 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
32782 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
32783 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
32784 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
32785 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
32786 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
32787
32788 @end itemize
32789
32790 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
32791 have the following fields:
32792
32793 @table @code
32794 @item id
32795 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
32796 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
32797 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
32798
32799 @item type
32800 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
32801 valid type.
32802
32803 @item pid
32804 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
32805 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
32806
32807 @item num_children
32808 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
32809 absent for an available thread group.
32810
32811 @item threads
32812 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32813 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32814 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32815
32816 @item cores
32817 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32818 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
32819 such information is not available.
32820
32821 @item executable
32822 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32823 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32824 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32825
32826 @end table
32827
32828 @subheading Example
32829
32830 @smallexample
32831 @value{GDBP}
32832 -list-thread-groups
32833 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32834 -list-thread-groups 17
32835 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32836 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32837 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32838 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32839 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32840 -list-thread-groups --available
32841 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32842 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32843 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32844 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32845 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32846 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32847 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32848 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32849 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32850 @end smallexample
32851
32852 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32853 @findex -info-os
32854
32855 @subsubheading Synopsis
32856
32857 @smallexample
32858 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
32859 @end smallexample
32860
32861 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32862 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
32863 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32864 of data of that type.
32865
32866 The types of information available depend on the target operating
32867 system.
32868
32869 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32870
32871 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32872
32873 @subsubheading Example
32874
32875 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32876 like this:
32877
32878 @smallexample
32879 @value{GDBP}
32880 -info-os
32881 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="9",nr_cols="3",
32882 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32883 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32884 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32885 body=[item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32886 col2="Processes"@},
32887 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32888 col2="Process groups"@},
32889 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32890 col2="Threads"@},
32891 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32892 col2="File descriptors"@},
32893 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32894 col2="Sockets"@},
32895 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32896 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32897 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32898 col2="Semaphores"@},
32899 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32900 col2="Message queues"@},
32901 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32902 col2="Kernel modules"@}]@}
32903 @value{GDBP}
32904 -info-os processes
32905 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32906 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32907 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32908 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32909 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32910 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32911 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32912 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32913 ...
32914 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32915 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32916 (gdb)
32917 @end smallexample
32918
32919 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32920 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32921 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32922 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32923 @code{info os} omits it.)
32924
32925 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32926 @findex -add-inferior
32927
32928 @subheading Synopsis
32929
32930 @smallexample
32931 -add-inferior
32932 @end smallexample
32933
32934 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
32935 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
32936 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32937 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
32938 field, @samp{thread-group}, whose value is the identifier of the
32939 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32940
32941 @subheading Example
32942
32943 @smallexample
32944 @value{GDBP}
32945 -add-inferior
32946 ^done,thread-group="i3"
32947 @end smallexample
32948
32949 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32950 @findex -interpreter-exec
32951
32952 @subheading Synopsis
32953
32954 @smallexample
32955 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32956 @end smallexample
32957 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32958
32959 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32960
32961 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32962
32963 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32964
32965 @subheading Example
32966
32967 @smallexample
32968 (gdb)
32969 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
32970 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32971 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32972 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32973 ^done
32974 (gdb)
32975 @end smallexample
32976
32977 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32978 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32979
32980 @subheading Synopsis
32981
32982 @smallexample
32983 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32984 @end smallexample
32985
32986 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32987
32988 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32989
32990 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32991
32992 @subheading Example
32993
32994 @smallexample
32995 (gdb)
32996 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32997 ^done
32998 (gdb)
32999 @end smallexample
33000
33001 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
33002 @findex -inferior-tty-show
33003
33004 @subheading Synopsis
33005
33006 @smallexample
33007 -inferior-tty-show
33008 @end smallexample
33009
33010 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
33011
33012 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33013
33014 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
33015
33016 @subheading Example
33017
33018 @smallexample
33019 (gdb)
33020 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33021 ^done
33022 (gdb)
33023 -inferior-tty-show
33024 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
33025 (gdb)
33026 @end smallexample
33027
33028 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
33029 @findex -enable-timings
33030
33031 @subheading Synopsis
33032
33033 @smallexample
33034 -enable-timings [yes | no]
33035 @end smallexample
33036
33037 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
33038 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
33039 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
33040 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
33041
33042 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33043
33044 No equivalent.
33045
33046 @subheading Example
33047
33048 @smallexample
33049 (gdb)
33050 -enable-timings
33051 ^done
33052 (gdb)
33053 -break-insert main
33054 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
33055 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
33056 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
33057 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
33058 (gdb)
33059 -enable-timings no
33060 ^done
33061 (gdb)
33062 -exec-run
33063 ^running
33064 (gdb)
33065 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
33066 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
33067 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
33068 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
33069 (gdb)
33070 @end smallexample
33071
33072 @node Annotations
33073 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
33074
33075 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
33076 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
33077 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
33078 relatively high level.
33079
33080 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
33081 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
33082
33083 @ignore
33084 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
33085 @end ignore
33086
33087 @menu
33088 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
33089 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
33090 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
33091 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
33092 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
33093 * Annotations for Running::
33094 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
33095 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
33096 @end menu
33097
33098 @node Annotations Overview
33099 @section What is an Annotation?
33100 @cindex annotations
33101
33102 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
33103 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
33104 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
33105 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
33106 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
33107 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
33108 cannot contain newline characters.
33109
33110 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
33111 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
33112 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
33113 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
33114 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
33115 means those three characters as output.
33116
33117 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
33118 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
33119 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
33120 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
33121 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
33122 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
33123 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
33124 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
33125 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
33126
33127 @table @code
33128 @kindex set annotate
33129 @item set annotate @var{level}
33130 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
33131 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
33132
33133 @item show annotate
33134 @kindex show annotate
33135 Show the current annotation level.
33136 @end table
33137
33138 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
33139
33140 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
33141
33142 @smallexample
33143 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
33144 GNU gdb 6.0
33145 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
33146 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
33147 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
33148 under certain conditions.
33149 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
33150 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
33151 for details.
33152 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
33153
33154 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
33155 (@value{GDBP})
33156 ^Z^Zprompt
33157 @kbd{quit}
33158
33159 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
33160 $
33161 @end smallexample
33162
33163 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
33164 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
33165 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
33166 output from @value{GDBN}.
33167
33168 @node Server Prefix
33169 @section The Server Prefix
33170 @cindex server prefix
33171
33172 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
33173 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
33174 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
33175 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
33176 a transparent manner.
33177
33178 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
33179 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
33180 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
33181 @code{print} command.
33182
33183 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
33184 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
33185
33186 @node Prompting
33187 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
33188
33189 @cindex annotations for prompts
33190 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
33191 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
33192 over, etc.
33193
33194 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
33195 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
33196 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
33197 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
33198 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
33199 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
33200 features the following annotations:
33201
33202 @smallexample
33203 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
33204 ^Z^Zprompt
33205 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
33206 @end smallexample
33207
33208 The input types are
33209
33210 @table @code
33211 @findex pre-prompt annotation
33212 @findex prompt annotation
33213 @findex post-prompt annotation
33214 @item prompt
33215 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
33216
33217 @findex pre-commands annotation
33218 @findex commands annotation
33219 @findex post-commands annotation
33220 @item commands
33221 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
33222 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
33223
33224 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
33225 @findex overload-choice annotation
33226 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
33227 @item overload-choice
33228 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
33229
33230 @findex pre-query annotation
33231 @findex query annotation
33232 @findex post-query annotation
33233 @item query
33234 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
33235
33236 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
33237 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
33238 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
33239 @item prompt-for-continue
33240 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
33241 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
33242 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
33243 presence of annotations.
33244 @end table
33245
33246 @node Errors
33247 @section Errors
33248 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
33249
33250 @findex quit annotation
33251 @smallexample
33252 ^Z^Zquit
33253 @end smallexample
33254
33255 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
33256
33257 @findex error annotation
33258 @smallexample
33259 ^Z^Zerror
33260 @end smallexample
33261
33262 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
33263
33264 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
33265 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
33266 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
33267 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
33268 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
33269 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
33270 to the top level.
33271
33272 @findex error-begin annotation
33273 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
33274
33275 @smallexample
33276 ^Z^Zerror-begin
33277 @end smallexample
33278
33279 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
33280 message.
33281
33282 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
33283 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
33284 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
33285
33286 @node Invalidation
33287 @section Invalidation Notices
33288
33289 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
33290 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
33291 changed.
33292
33293 @table @code
33294 @findex frames-invalid annotation
33295 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
33296
33297 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
33298 have changed.
33299
33300 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
33301 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
33302
33303 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
33304 deleted a breakpoint.
33305 @end table
33306
33307 @node Annotations for Running
33308 @section Running the Program
33309 @cindex annotations for running programs
33310
33311 @findex starting annotation
33312 @findex stopping annotation
33313 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
33314 @code{step} or @code{continue},
33315
33316 @smallexample
33317 ^Z^Zstarting
33318 @end smallexample
33319
33320 is output. When the program stops,
33321
33322 @smallexample
33323 ^Z^Zstopped
33324 @end smallexample
33325
33326 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
33327 annotations describe how the program stopped.
33328
33329 @table @code
33330 @findex exited annotation
33331 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
33332 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
33333 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
33334
33335 @findex signalled annotation
33336 @findex signal-name annotation
33337 @findex signal-name-end annotation
33338 @findex signal-string annotation
33339 @findex signal-string-end annotation
33340 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
33341 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
33342 annotation continues:
33343
33344 @smallexample
33345 @var{intro-text}
33346 ^Z^Zsignal-name
33347 @var{name}
33348 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
33349 @var{middle-text}
33350 ^Z^Zsignal-string
33351 @var{string}
33352 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
33353 @var{end-text}
33354 @end smallexample
33355
33356 @noindent
33357 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
33358 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
33359 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
33360 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
33361 user's benefit and have no particular format.
33362
33363 @findex signal annotation
33364 @item ^Z^Zsignal
33365 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
33366 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
33367 terminated with it.
33368
33369 @findex breakpoint annotation
33370 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
33371 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
33372
33373 @findex watchpoint annotation
33374 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
33375 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
33376 @end table
33377
33378 @node Source Annotations
33379 @section Displaying Source
33380 @cindex annotations for source display
33381
33382 @findex source annotation
33383 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
33384
33385 @smallexample
33386 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
33387 @end smallexample
33388
33389 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
33390 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
33391 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
33392 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
33393 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
33394 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
33395 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
33396 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
33397 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
33398 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
33399 depend on the language).
33400
33401 @node JIT Interface
33402 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
33403 @cindex just-in-time compilation
33404 @cindex JIT compilation interface
33405
33406 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
33407 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
33408 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
33409 performance while maintaining platform independence.
33410
33411 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
33412 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
33413 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
33414 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
33415 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
33416 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
33417
33418 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
33419 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
33420 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
33421 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
33422 LLVM JIT.
33423
33424 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
33425 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
33426 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
33427 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
33428 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
33429 out about additional code.
33430
33431 @menu
33432 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
33433 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
33434 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
33435 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
33436 @end menu
33437
33438 @node Declarations
33439 @section JIT Declarations
33440
33441 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
33442 implement the interface:
33443
33444 @smallexample
33445 typedef enum
33446 @{
33447 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
33448 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
33449 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
33450 @} jit_actions_t;
33451
33452 struct jit_code_entry
33453 @{
33454 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
33455 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
33456 const char *symfile_addr;
33457 uint64_t symfile_size;
33458 @};
33459
33460 struct jit_descriptor
33461 @{
33462 uint32_t version;
33463 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
33464 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
33465 uint32_t action_flag;
33466 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
33467 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
33468 @};
33469
33470 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
33471 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
33472
33473 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
33474 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
33475 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
33476 @end smallexample
33477
33478 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
33479 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
33480 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
33481
33482 @node Registering Code
33483 @section Registering Code
33484
33485 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
33486
33487 @itemize @bullet
33488 @item
33489 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
33490 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
33491
33492 @item
33493 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
33494 file.
33495
33496 @item
33497 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
33498
33499 @item
33500 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
33501
33502 @item
33503 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
33504 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33505 @end itemize
33506
33507 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
33508 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
33509 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
33510 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
33511
33512 @node Unregistering Code
33513 @section Unregistering Code
33514
33515 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
33516
33517 @itemize @bullet
33518 @item
33519 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
33520
33521 @item
33522 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
33523
33524 @item
33525 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
33526 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33527 @end itemize
33528
33529 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
33530 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
33531
33532 @node Custom Debug Info
33533 @section Custom Debug Info
33534 @cindex custom JIT debug info
33535 @cindex JIT debug info reader
33536
33537 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
33538 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
33539 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
33540 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
33541 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
33542 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
33543 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
33544 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
33545 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
33546
33547 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
33548 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
33549 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
33550 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
33551 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
33552 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
33553 compiler.
33554
33555 @menu
33556 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
33557 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
33558 @end menu
33559
33560 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33561 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33562 @kindex jit-reader-load
33563 @kindex jit-reader-unload
33564
33565 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
33566 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
33567
33568 @table @code
33569 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader-name}
33570 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader-name}. On a UNIX system, this
33571 will usually load @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/@var{reader-name}}, where
33572 @var{libdir} is the system library directory, usually
33573 @file{/usr/local/lib}. Only one reader can be active at a time;
33574 trying to load a second reader when one is already loaded will result
33575 in @value{GDBN} reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by
33576 first unloading the current one using @code{jit-reader-load} and then
33577 invoking @code{jit-reader-load}.
33578
33579 @item jit-reader-unload
33580 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
33581
33582 @end table
33583
33584 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33585 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33586 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
33587
33588 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
33589 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
33590
33591 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
33592 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
33593 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
33594 the system include directory.
33595
33596 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
33597 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
33598 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
33599
33600 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
33601 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
33602
33603 @findex gdb_init_reader
33604 @smallexample
33605 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
33606 @end smallexample
33607
33608 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
33609
33610 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
33611 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
33612 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
33613 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
33614 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
33615 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
33616
33617 @smallexample
33618 struct gdb_reader_funcs
33619 @{
33620 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
33621 int reader_version;
33622
33623 /* For use by the reader. */
33624 void *priv_data;
33625
33626 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
33627 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
33628 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
33629 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
33630 @};
33631 @end smallexample
33632
33633 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
33634 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
33635
33636 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
33637 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
33638 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
33639 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
33640 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
33641 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
33642 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
33643 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
33644 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
33645 target's address space.
33646
33647 @node In-Process Agent
33648 @chapter In-Process Agent
33649 @cindex debugging agent
33650 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
33651 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
33652 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
33653 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
33654 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
33655 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
33656 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
33657 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
33658 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
33659 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
33660 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
33661 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
33662 behavior without interrupting it.
33663
33664 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
33665 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
33666 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
33667 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
33668 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
33669 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
33670 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
33671 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
33672 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
33673
33674 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
33675 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
33676 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
33677 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
33678
33679 @anchor{Control Agent}
33680 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
33681 debugging with the following commands:
33682
33683 @table @code
33684 @kindex set agent on
33685 @item set agent on
33686 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
33687 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
33688 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
33689 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
33690 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
33691 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
33692
33693 @kindex set agent off
33694 @item set agent off
33695 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
33696 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
33697
33698 @kindex show agent
33699 @item show agent
33700 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
33701 the in-process agent.
33702 @end table
33703
33704 @menu
33705 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
33706 @end menu
33707
33708 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
33709 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
33710 @cindex in-process agent protocol
33711
33712 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
33713 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
33714 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
33715 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
33716 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
33717 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
33718 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
33719 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
33720 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
33721
33722 @menu
33723 * IPA Protocol Objects::
33724 * IPA Protocol Commands::
33725 @end menu
33726
33727 @node IPA Protocol Objects
33728 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
33729 @cindex ipa protocol objects
33730
33731 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
33732 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
33733
33734 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
33735 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
33736 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
33737 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
33738
33739 @enumerate
33740 @item
33741 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
33742 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
33743 @item
33744 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
33745 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
33746 the other one.
33747 @end enumerate
33748
33749 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
33750
33751 @enumerate
33752 @item
33753 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
33754 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
33755 @anchor{agent expression object}
33756 @item
33757 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
33758 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
33759 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
33760 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
33761 @item
33762 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33763 @anchor{tracepoint object}
33764
33765 @end enumerate
33766
33767 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
33768 object:
33769
33770 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
33771 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
33772 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
33773 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
33774 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
33775 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
33776 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33777 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
33778 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
33779 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
33780 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
33781 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
33782 memory address for collecting.
33783 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
33784 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33785 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
33786 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33787 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
33788 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33789 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
33790 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
33791 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
33792 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
33793 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
33794 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
33795 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
33796 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
33797 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
33798 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
33799 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33800 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33801 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33802 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33803 @ref{agent expression object}
33804 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33805 @ref{agent expression object}
33806 @item actions @tab variable
33807 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33808 @end multitable
33809
33810 @node IPA Protocol Commands
33811 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33812 @cindex ipa protocol commands
33813
33814 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33815 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
33816
33817 @table @samp
33818
33819 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33820 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33821 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33822 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33823 in IPA finally.
33824
33825 Replies:
33826 @table @samp
33827 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33828 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33829 @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
33830 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33831 @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33832 @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33833 @item E @var{NN}
33834 for an error
33835
33836 @end table
33837
33838 @item close
33839 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33840 is about to kill inferiors.
33841
33842 @item qTfSTM
33843 @xref{qTfSTM}.
33844 @item qTsSTM
33845 @xref{qTsSTM}.
33846 @item qTSTMat
33847 @xref{qTSTMat}.
33848 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33849 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33850
33851 Replies:
33852 @table @samp
33853 @item E @var{NN}
33854 for an error
33855 @end table
33856 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33857 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33858 @end table
33859
33860 @node GDB Bugs
33861 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33862 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33863 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33864
33865 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33866
33867 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33868 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33869 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
33870 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33871
33872 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33873 information that enables us to fix the bug.
33874
33875 @menu
33876 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
33877 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
33878 @end menu
33879
33880 @node Bug Criteria
33881 @section Have You Found a Bug?
33882 @cindex bug criteria
33883
33884 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33885
33886 @itemize @bullet
33887 @cindex fatal signal
33888 @cindex debugger crash
33889 @cindex crash of debugger
33890 @item
33891 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33892 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
33893
33894 @cindex error on valid input
33895 @item
33896 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33897 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33898 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33899
33900 @cindex invalid input
33901 @item
33902 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33903 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
33904 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33905 for traditional practice''.
33906
33907 @item
33908 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33909 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33910 @end itemize
33911
33912 @node Bug Reporting
33913 @section How to Report Bugs
33914 @cindex bug reports
33915 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33916
33917 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33918 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33919 contact that organization first.
33920
33921 You can find contact information for many support companies and
33922 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33923 distribution.
33924 @c should add a web page ref...
33925
33926 @ifset BUGURL
33927 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33928 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33929 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33930 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33931 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33932 be used.
33933
33934 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33935 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33936 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
33937 @samp{bug-gdb}.
33938
33939 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33940 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33941 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33942 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
33943 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33944 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33945 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
33946 bug reports to the mailing list.
33947 @end ifset
33948 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33949 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33950 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33951 @end ifclear
33952 @end ifset
33953
33954 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33955 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
33956 fact or leave it out, state it!
33957
33958 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33959 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
33960 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33961 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
33962 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33963 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33964 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33965 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33966 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33967
33968 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33969 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33970 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33971 self-contained.
33972
33973 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33974 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33975 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33976 bugs properly.
33977
33978 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33979
33980 @itemize @bullet
33981 @item
33982 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33983 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33984 version}.
33985
33986 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33987 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33988
33989 @item
33990 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33991 version number.
33992
33993 @item
33994 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33995 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33996
33997 @item
33998 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33999 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
34000 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
34001 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
34002 those compilers.
34003
34004 @item
34005 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
34006 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
34007 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
34008 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
34009
34010 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
34011 and then we might not encounter the bug.
34012
34013 @item
34014 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
34015 reproduce the bug.
34016
34017 @item
34018 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
34019 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
34020
34021 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
34022 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
34023 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
34024 a chance to make a mistake.
34025
34026 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
34027 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
34028 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
34029 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
34030 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
34031 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
34032 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
34033 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
34034
34035 @pindex script
34036 @cindex recording a session script
34037 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
34038 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
34039 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
34040 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
34041
34042 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
34043 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
34044
34045 @item
34046 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
34047 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
34048 it by context, not by line number.
34049
34050 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
34051 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
34052
34053 @end itemize
34054
34055 Here are some things that are not necessary:
34056
34057 @itemize @bullet
34058 @item
34059 A description of the envelope of the bug.
34060
34061 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
34062 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
34063 changes will not affect it.
34064
34065 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
34066 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
34067 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
34068 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
34069
34070 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
34071 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
34072 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
34073 less time, and so on.
34074
34075 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
34076 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
34077
34078 @item
34079 A patch for the bug.
34080
34081 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
34082 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
34083 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
34084 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
34085
34086 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
34087 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
34088 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
34089 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
34090
34091 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
34092 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
34093 help us to understand.
34094
34095 @item
34096 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
34097
34098 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
34099 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
34100 @end itemize
34101
34102 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
34103 @c and consists of the two following files:
34104 @c rluser.texi
34105 @c hsuser.texi
34106 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
34107 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
34108 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
34109 @include rluser.texi
34110 @include hsuser.texi
34111 @end ifclear
34112
34113 @node In Memoriam
34114 @appendix In Memoriam
34115
34116 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
34117 contributors:
34118
34119 @table @code
34120 @item Fred Fish
34121 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
34122 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
34123 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
34124
34125 @item Michael Snyder
34126 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
34127 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
34128 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
34129 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
34130 @end table
34131
34132 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
34133 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
34134
34135 @node Formatting Documentation
34136 @appendix Formatting Documentation
34137
34138 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
34139 @cindex reference card
34140 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
34141 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
34142 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
34143 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
34144 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
34145 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
34146
34147 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
34148 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
34149
34150 @smallexample
34151 make refcard.dvi
34152 @end smallexample
34153
34154 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
34155 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
34156 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
34157 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
34158 your @sc{dvi} output program.
34159
34160 @cindex documentation
34161
34162 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
34163 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
34164 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
34165 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
34166 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
34167 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
34168
34169 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
34170 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
34171 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
34172 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
34173 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
34174 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
34175 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
34176 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
34177
34178 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
34179 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
34180 @code{makeinfo}.
34181
34182 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
34183 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
34184 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
34185
34186 @smallexample
34187 cd gdb
34188 make gdb.info
34189 @end smallexample
34190
34191 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
34192 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
34193 Texinfo definitions file.
34194
34195 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
34196 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
34197 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
34198 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
34199 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
34200 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
34201 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
34202
34203 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
34204 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
34205 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
34206 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
34207 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
34208 directory.
34209
34210 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
34211 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
34212 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
34213 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
34214
34215 @smallexample
34216 make gdb.dvi
34217 @end smallexample
34218
34219 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
34220
34221 @node Installing GDB
34222 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
34223 @cindex installation
34224
34225 @menu
34226 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
34227 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
34228 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
34229 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
34230 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
34231 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
34232 @end menu
34233
34234 @node Requirements
34235 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
34236 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
34237
34238 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
34239 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
34240
34241 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
34242 @table @asis
34243 @item ISO C90 compiler
34244 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
34245 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
34246
34247 @end table
34248
34249 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
34250 @table @asis
34251 @item Expat
34252 @anchor{Expat}
34253 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
34254 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
34255 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
34256 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
34257 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
34258 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
34259
34260 Expat is used for:
34261
34262 @itemize @bullet
34263 @item
34264 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
34265 @item
34266 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
34267 @item
34268 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
34269 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
34270 @item
34271 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
34272 @item
34273 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
34274 @end itemize
34275
34276 @item zlib
34277 @cindex compressed debug sections
34278 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
34279 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
34280 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
34281 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
34282 information in such binaries.
34283
34284 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
34285 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
34286 @url{http://zlib.net}.
34287
34288 @item iconv
34289 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
34290 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
34291 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
34292 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
34293
34294 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
34295 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
34296 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
34297 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
34298
34299 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
34300 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
34301 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
34302
34303 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
34304 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
34305 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
34306 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
34307 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
34308 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
34309 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
34310 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
34311 @end table
34312
34313 @node Running Configure
34314 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
34315 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
34316 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
34317 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
34318 build the @code{gdb} program.
34319 @iftex
34320 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
34321 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
34322 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
34323 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
34324 @end iftex
34325
34326 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
34327 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
34328 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
34329
34330 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
34331 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
34332
34333 @table @code
34334 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
34335 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
34336
34337 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
34338 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
34339
34340 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
34341 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
34342
34343 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
34344 @sc{gnu} include files
34345
34346 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
34347 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
34348
34349 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
34350 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
34351
34352 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
34353 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
34354
34355 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
34356 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
34357
34358 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
34359 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
34360 @end table
34361
34362 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
34363 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
34364 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
34365
34366 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
34367 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
34368 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
34369 argument.
34370
34371 For example:
34372
34373 @smallexample
34374 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34375 ./configure @var{host}
34376 make
34377 @end smallexample
34378
34379 @noindent
34380 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
34381 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
34382 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
34383 correct value by examining your system.)
34384
34385 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
34386 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
34387 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
34388 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
34389
34390 @need 750
34391 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
34392 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
34393 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
34394
34395 @smallexample
34396 sh configure @var{host}
34397 @end smallexample
34398
34399 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
34400 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
34401 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
34402 @file{configure}
34403 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
34404 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
34405
34406 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
34407 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
34408 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
34409 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
34410 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
34411 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
34412 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
34413 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
34414 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34415
34416 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
34417 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
34418 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
34419 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
34420 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
34421
34422 @node Separate Objdir
34423 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
34424
34425 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
34426 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
34427 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
34428 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
34429 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
34430 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
34431 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
34432 program specified there.
34433
34434 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
34435 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
34436 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
34437 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
34438 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
34439 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
34440
34441 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
34442 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
34443
34444 @smallexample
34445 @group
34446 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34447 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
34448 cd ../gdb-sun4
34449 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
34450 make
34451 @end group
34452 @end smallexample
34453
34454 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
34455 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
34456 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
34457 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
34458 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
34459 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
34460
34461 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
34462 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
34463 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
34464 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
34465 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34466
34467 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
34468 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
34469 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
34470 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
34471 You specify a cross-debugging target by
34472 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
34473
34474 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
34475 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
34476 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
34477
34478 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
34479 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
34480 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
34481 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
34482 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
34483
34484 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
34485 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
34486 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
34487 with each other.
34488
34489 @node Config Names
34490 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
34491
34492 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
34493 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
34494 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
34495 of information in the following pattern:
34496
34497 @smallexample
34498 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
34499 @end smallexample
34500
34501 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
34502 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
34503 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
34504
34505 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
34506 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
34507 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
34508 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
34509 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
34510 abbreviations---for example:
34511
34512 @smallexample
34513 % sh config.sub i386-linux
34514 i386-pc-linux-gnu
34515 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
34516 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
34517 % sh config.sub hp9k700
34518 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
34519 % sh config.sub sun4
34520 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
34521 % sh config.sub sun3
34522 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
34523 % sh config.sub i986v
34524 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
34525 @end smallexample
34526
34527 @noindent
34528 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
34529 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
34530
34531 @node Configure Options
34532 @section @file{configure} Options
34533
34534 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
34535 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
34536 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
34537 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
34538
34539 @smallexample
34540 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
34541 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34542 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34543 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
34544 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
34545 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
34546 @var{host}
34547 @end smallexample
34548
34549 @noindent
34550 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
34551 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
34552 @samp{--}.
34553
34554 @table @code
34555 @item --help
34556 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
34557
34558 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
34559 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
34560 @file{@var{dir}}.
34561
34562 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
34563 Configure the source to install programs under directory
34564 @file{@var{dir}}.
34565
34566 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
34567 @need 2000
34568 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
34569 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
34570 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
34571 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
34572 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
34573 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
34574 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
34575 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
34576 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
34577 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
34578 @var{dirname}.
34579
34580 @item --norecursion
34581 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
34582 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
34583
34584 @item --target=@var{target}
34585 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
34586 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
34587 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
34588
34589 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
34590
34591 @item @var{host} @dots{}
34592 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
34593
34594 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
34595 @end table
34596
34597 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
34598 needed for special purposes only.
34599
34600 @node System-wide configuration
34601 @section System-wide configuration and settings
34602 @cindex system-wide init file
34603
34604 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
34605 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
34606 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
34607
34608 Here is the corresponding configure option:
34609
34610 @table @code
34611 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
34612 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
34613 @var{file}.
34614 @end table
34615
34616 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
34617 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
34618
34619 @itemize @bullet
34620 @item
34621 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
34622 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
34623 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
34624 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
34625 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
34626 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
34627
34628 @item
34629 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
34630 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
34631 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34632 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34633 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
34634 @end itemize
34635
34636 @node Maintenance Commands
34637 @appendix Maintenance Commands
34638 @cindex maintenance commands
34639 @cindex internal commands
34640
34641 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
34642 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
34643 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
34644 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
34645 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
34646
34647 @table @code
34648 @kindex maint agent
34649 @kindex maint agent-eval
34650 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34651 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34652 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
34653 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
34654 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
34655 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
34656 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
34657 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
34658 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
34659 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
34660 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
34661 addition and return the sum.
34662 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
34663 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
34664
34665 @kindex maint agent-printf
34666 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
34667 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
34668 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
34669 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
34670 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}.
34671
34672 @kindex maint info breakpoints
34673 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
34674 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
34675 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
34676 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
34677 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
34678 is shown:
34679
34680 @table @code
34681 @item breakpoint
34682 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
34683
34684 @item watchpoint
34685 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
34686
34687 @item longjmp
34688 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
34689 @code{longjmp} calls.
34690
34691 @item longjmp resume
34692 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
34693
34694 @item until
34695 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
34696
34697 @item finish
34698 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
34699
34700 @item shlib events
34701 Shared library events.
34702
34703 @end table
34704
34705 @kindex maint info bfds
34706 @item maint info bfds
34707 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
34708 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Top, , BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}.
34709
34710 @kindex set displaced-stepping
34711 @kindex show displaced-stepping
34712 @cindex displaced stepping support
34713 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34714 @item set displaced-stepping
34715 @itemx show displaced-stepping
34716 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34717 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34718 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34719 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34720 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34721
34722 @table @code
34723 @item set displaced-stepping on
34724 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34725 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34726
34727 @item set displaced-stepping off
34728 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34729 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34730
34731 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34732 @item set displaced-stepping auto
34733 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34734 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34735 architecture supports displaced stepping.
34736 @end table
34737
34738 @kindex maint check-symtabs
34739 @item maint check-symtabs
34740 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
34741
34742 @kindex maint cplus first_component
34743 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
34744 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
34745
34746 @kindex maint cplus namespace
34747 @item maint cplus namespace
34748 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
34749
34750 @kindex maint demangle
34751 @item maint demangle @var{name}
34752 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
34753
34754 @kindex maint deprecate
34755 @kindex maint undeprecate
34756 @cindex deprecated commands
34757 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
34758 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
34759 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
34760 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
34761 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
34762 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
34763 the replacement as part of the warning.
34764
34765 @kindex maint dump-me
34766 @item maint dump-me
34767 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
34768 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
34769 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
34770 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34771
34772 @kindex maint internal-error
34773 @kindex maint internal-warning
34774 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34775 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34776 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
34777 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
34778 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
34779 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
34780 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
34781 @value{GDBN} session.
34782
34783 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34784 used as the text of the error or warning message.
34785
34786 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34787
34788 @smallexample
34789 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34790 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34791 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
34792 debugging may prove unreliable.
34793 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34794 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34795 (@value{GDBP})
34796 @end smallexample
34797
34798 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34799 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34800
34801 @kindex maint set internal-error
34802 @kindex maint show internal-error
34803 @kindex maint set internal-warning
34804 @kindex maint show internal-warning
34805 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34806 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34807 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34808 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34809 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34810 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34811 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
34812 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34813 described in the table below.
34814
34815 @table @samp
34816 @item quit
34817 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34818 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
34819
34820 @item corefile
34821 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34822 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do.
34823 @end table
34824
34825 @kindex maint packet
34826 @item maint packet @var{text}
34827 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34828 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34829 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34830 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34831 checksum.
34832
34833 @kindex maint print architecture
34834 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34835 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
34836 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
34837
34838 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
34839 @item maint print c-tdesc
34840 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
34841 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
34842 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
34843
34844 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
34845 @item maint print dummy-frames
34846 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
34847
34848 @smallexample
34849 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
34850 @dots{}
34851 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
34852 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
34853 58 return (a + b);
34854 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
34855 @dots{}
34856 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
34857 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
34858 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
34859 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
34860 (@value{GDBP})
34861 @end smallexample
34862
34863 Takes an optional file parameter.
34864
34865 @kindex maint print registers
34866 @kindex maint print raw-registers
34867 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
34868 @kindex maint print register-groups
34869 @kindex maint print remote-registers
34870 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34871 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34872 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34873 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34874 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34875 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
34876
34877 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
34878 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
34879 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
34880 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
34881 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
34882 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
34883 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34884 and offsets in the `G' packets. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
34885 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
34886
34887 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34888 write the information.
34889
34890 @kindex maint print reggroups
34891 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34892 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
34893 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34894 information.
34895
34896 The register groups info looks like this:
34897
34898 @smallexample
34899 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34900 Group Type
34901 general user
34902 float user
34903 all user
34904 vector user
34905 system user
34906 save internal
34907 restore internal
34908 @end smallexample
34909
34910 @kindex flushregs
34911 @item flushregs
34912 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
34913
34914 @kindex maint print objfiles
34915 @cindex info for known object files
34916 @item maint print objfiles
34917 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
34918 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
34919 and symtabs.
34920
34921 @kindex maint print section-scripts
34922 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
34923 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
34924 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
34925 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
34926 matching @var{regexp}.
34927 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
34928 and the full path if known.
34929 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
34930
34931 @kindex maint print statistics
34932 @cindex bcache statistics
34933 @item maint print statistics
34934 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
34935 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
34936 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
34937 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
34938 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
34939 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
34940 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
34941 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
34942 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
34943 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
34944 lengths.
34945
34946 @kindex maint print target-stack
34947 @cindex target stack description
34948 @item maint print target-stack
34949 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
34950 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
34951 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
34952 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
34953 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
34954 address.
34955
34956 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
34957 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
34958
34959 @kindex maint print type
34960 @cindex type chain of a data type
34961 @item maint print type @var{expr}
34962 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
34963 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
34964 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
34965 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
34966 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
34967
34968 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
34969 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
34970 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
34971 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
34972 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
34973 information.
34974
34975 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
34976 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
34977 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
34978 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
34979 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
34980 always see the disassembly form.
34981
34982 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
34983
34984 @smallexample
34985 (gdb) info addr argc
34986 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
34987 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
34988 @end smallexample
34989
34990 For more information on these expressions, see
34991 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
34992
34993 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
34994 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
34995 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
34996 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
34997 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
34998
34999 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
35000 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
35001 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
35002 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
35003 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
35004 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
35005 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
35006 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
35007 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
35008
35009 @kindex maint set profile
35010 @kindex maint show profile
35011 @cindex profiling GDB
35012 @item maint set profile
35013 @itemx maint show profile
35014 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
35015
35016 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
35017 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
35018 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
35019 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
35020 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
35021 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
35022 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
35023
35024 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
35025 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
35026
35027 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
35028 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
35029 @cindex hardware debug registers
35030 @item maint set show-debug-regs
35031 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
35032 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
35033 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
35034 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
35035 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
35036 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
35037
35038 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
35039 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
35040 @item maint set show-all-tib
35041 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
35042 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
35043 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
35044 command.
35045
35046 @kindex maint space
35047 @cindex memory used by commands
35048 @item maint space
35049 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
35050 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
35051 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
35052 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
35053 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
35054
35055 @kindex maint time
35056 @cindex time of command execution
35057 @item maint time
35058 Control whether to display the execution time of @value{GDBN} for each command.
35059 If set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
35060 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
35061 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
35062 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
35063 CPU or, e.g., disk/network, latency.
35064 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
35065 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
35066 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
35067 spent by the program been debugged.
35068 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
35069 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
35070
35071 @kindex maint translate-address
35072 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
35073 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
35074 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
35075 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
35076 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
35077 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
35078 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
35079
35080 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
35081 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
35082 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
35083
35084 @end table
35085
35086 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
35087 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
35088
35089 @table @code
35090 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
35091 @kindex set watchdog
35092 @cindex watchdog timer
35093 @cindex timeout for commands
35094 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
35095 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
35096 reports and error and the command is aborted.
35097
35098 @item show watchdog
35099 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
35100 @end table
35101
35102 @node Remote Protocol
35103 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
35104
35105 @menu
35106 * Overview::
35107 * Packets::
35108 * Stop Reply Packets::
35109 * General Query Packets::
35110 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
35111 * Tracepoint Packets::
35112 * Host I/O Packets::
35113 * Interrupts::
35114 * Notification Packets::
35115 * Remote Non-Stop::
35116 * Packet Acknowledgment::
35117 * Examples::
35118 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
35119 * Library List Format::
35120 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
35121 * Memory Map Format::
35122 * Thread List Format::
35123 * Traceframe Info Format::
35124 @end menu
35125
35126 @node Overview
35127 @section Overview
35128
35129 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
35130 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
35131 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
35132 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
35133
35134 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
35135 transmitted and received data, respectively.
35136
35137 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
35138 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
35139 @cindex remote serial protocol
35140 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
35141 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
35142 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
35143 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
35144 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
35145
35146 @smallexample
35147 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35148 @end smallexample
35149 @noindent
35150
35151 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
35152 @noindent
35153 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
35154 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
35155 eight bit unsigned checksum).
35156
35157 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
35158 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
35159
35160 @smallexample
35161 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35162 @end smallexample
35163
35164 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
35165 @noindent
35166 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
35167 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
35168 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
35169
35170 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
35171 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
35172 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
35173 retransmission):
35174
35175 @smallexample
35176 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35177 <- @code{+}
35178 @end smallexample
35179 @noindent
35180
35181 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
35182 once a connection is established.
35183 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
35184
35185 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
35186 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
35187 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
35188 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
35189 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
35190 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
35191 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
35192
35193 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
35194 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
35195 exceptions).
35196
35197 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
35198 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
35199 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
35200 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
35201
35202 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
35203 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
35204 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
35205
35206 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
35207 @anchor{Binary Data}
35208 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
35209 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
35210 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
35211 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
35212 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
35213 binary data.
35214
35215 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
35216 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
35217 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
35218 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
35219 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
35220 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
35221 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
35222 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
35223 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
35224 (described next).
35225
35226 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
35227 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
35228 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
35229 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
35230 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
35231 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
35232 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
35233 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
35234 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
35235 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
35236 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
35237 3}} more times.
35238
35239 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
35240 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
35241 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
35242 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
35243 @samp{0*"00}.
35244
35245 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
35246 error number. That number is not well defined.
35247
35248 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
35249 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
35250 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
35251 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
35252 on that response.
35253
35254 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
35255 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
35256 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
35257 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
35258 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
35259 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
35260
35261 @node Packets
35262 @section Packets
35263
35264 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
35265 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
35266 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
35267 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
35268
35269 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
35270 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
35271 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
35272 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
35273 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
35274 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
35275 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
35276 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
35277 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
35278 @var{baz}.
35279
35280 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
35281 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
35282 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
35283 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
35284 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
35285 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
35286 pick any thread.
35287
35288 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
35289 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
35290 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
35291 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
35292 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
35293 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
35294 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
35295 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
35296 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
35297 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
35298 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
35299 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
35300 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
35301
35302 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
35303 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
35304 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
35305 more information.
35306
35307 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
35308 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
35309
35310 Here are the packet descriptions.
35311
35312 @table @samp
35313
35314 @item !
35315 @cindex @samp{!} packet
35316 @anchor{extended mode}
35317 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
35318 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
35319 debugged.
35320
35321 Reply:
35322 @table @samp
35323 @item OK
35324 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
35325 @end table
35326
35327 @item ?
35328 @cindex @samp{?} packet
35329 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
35330 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
35331 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
35332
35333 Reply:
35334 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35335
35336 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
35337 @cindex @samp{A} packet
35338 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
35339 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
35340 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
35341
35342 Reply:
35343 @table @samp
35344 @item OK
35345 The arguments were set.
35346 @item E @var{NN}
35347 An error occurred.
35348 @end table
35349
35350 @item b @var{baud}
35351 @cindex @samp{b} packet
35352 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
35353 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
35354
35355 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
35356 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
35357 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
35358
35359 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
35360 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
35361 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
35362 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
35363 of view, nothing actually happened.}
35364
35365 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
35366 @cindex @samp{B} packet
35367 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
35368 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
35369
35370 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
35371 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
35372
35373 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
35374 @anchor{bc}
35375 @item bc
35376 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
35377 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35378
35379 Reply:
35380 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35381
35382 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
35383 @anchor{bs}
35384 @item bs
35385 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
35386 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35387
35388 Reply:
35389 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35390
35391 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35392 @cindex @samp{c} packet
35393 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
35394 resume at current address.
35395
35396 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35397 packet}.
35398
35399 Reply:
35400 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35401
35402 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35403 @cindex @samp{C} packet
35404 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
35405 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
35406
35407 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35408 packet}.
35409
35410 Reply:
35411 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35412
35413 @item d
35414 @cindex @samp{d} packet
35415 Toggle debug flag.
35416
35417 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
35418 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
35419
35420 @item D
35421 @itemx D;@var{pid}
35422 @cindex @samp{D} packet
35423 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
35424 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
35425 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
35426
35427 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
35428 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
35429 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
35430 big-endian hex string.
35431
35432 Reply:
35433 @table @samp
35434 @item OK
35435 for success
35436 @item E @var{NN}
35437 for an error
35438 @end table
35439
35440 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
35441 @cindex @samp{F} packet
35442 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
35443 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
35444 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
35445
35446 @item g
35447 @anchor{read registers packet}
35448 @cindex @samp{g} packet
35449 Read general registers.
35450
35451 Reply:
35452 @table @samp
35453 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35454 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
35455 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
35456 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
35457 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
35458 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
35459 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
35460
35461 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
35462 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
35463 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
35464 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
35465 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
35466 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
35467 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
35468 have been collected, and both have zero value:
35469
35470 @smallexample
35471 -> @code{g}
35472 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
35473 @end smallexample
35474
35475 @item E @var{NN}
35476 for an error.
35477 @end table
35478
35479 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
35480 @cindex @samp{G} packet
35481 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
35482 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
35483
35484 Reply:
35485 @table @samp
35486 @item OK
35487 for success
35488 @item E @var{NN}
35489 for an error
35490 @end table
35491
35492 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
35493 @cindex @samp{H} packet
35494 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
35495 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{op} depends on the operation to be performed:
35496 it should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
35497 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
35498 option), @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
35499 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
35500 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35501
35502 Reply:
35503 @table @samp
35504 @item OK
35505 for success
35506 @item E @var{NN}
35507 for an error
35508 @end table
35509
35510 @c FIXME: JTC:
35511 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
35512 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
35513 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
35514 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
35515 @c described. For example:
35516 @c
35517 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35518 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
35519 @c otherwise returns current registers.
35520 @c
35521 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35522 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
35523 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
35524
35525 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
35526 @anchor{cycle step packet}
35527 @cindex @samp{i} packet
35528 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
35529 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
35530 step starting at that address.
35531
35532 @item I
35533 @cindex @samp{I} packet
35534 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
35535 step packet}.
35536
35537 @item k
35538 @cindex @samp{k} packet
35539 Kill request.
35540
35541 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
35542 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
35543 thread?)}.
35544
35545 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
35546 @cindex @samp{m} packet
35547 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
35548 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
35549
35550 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
35551 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
35552 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
35553 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
35554 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
35555 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
35556 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
35557 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
35558
35559 Reply:
35560 @table @samp
35561 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35562 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
35563 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
35564 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35565 @item E @var{NN}
35566 @var{NN} is errno
35567 @end table
35568
35569 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35570 @cindex @samp{M} packet
35571 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
35572 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
35573 hexadecimal number.
35574
35575 Reply:
35576 @table @samp
35577 @item OK
35578 for success
35579 @item E @var{NN}
35580 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35581 written).
35582 @end table
35583
35584 @item p @var{n}
35585 @cindex @samp{p} packet
35586 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35587 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35588 register value is encoded.
35589
35590 Reply:
35591 @table @samp
35592 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35593 the register's value
35594 @item E @var{NN}
35595 for an error
35596 @item
35597 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
35598 @end table
35599
35600 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
35601 @anchor{write register packet}
35602 @cindex @samp{P} packet
35603 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
35604 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
35605 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
35606
35607 Reply:
35608 @table @samp
35609 @item OK
35610 for success
35611 @item E @var{NN}
35612 for an error
35613 @end table
35614
35615 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35616 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35617 @cindex @samp{q} packet
35618 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
35619 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
35620 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
35621
35622 @item r
35623 @cindex @samp{r} packet
35624 Reset the entire system.
35625
35626 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
35627
35628 @item R @var{XX}
35629 @cindex @samp{R} packet
35630 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
35631 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35632
35633 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
35634
35635 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35636 @cindex @samp{s} packet
35637 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
35638 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
35639
35640 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35641 packet}.
35642
35643 Reply:
35644 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35645
35646 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35647 @anchor{step with signal packet}
35648 @cindex @samp{S} packet
35649 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
35650 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
35651
35652 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35653 packet}.
35654
35655 Reply:
35656 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35657
35658 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
35659 @cindex @samp{t} packet
35660 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
35661 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
35662 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
35663
35664 @item T @var{thread-id}
35665 @cindex @samp{T} packet
35666 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35667
35668 Reply:
35669 @table @samp
35670 @item OK
35671 thread is still alive
35672 @item E @var{NN}
35673 thread is dead
35674 @end table
35675
35676 @item v
35677 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
35678 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
35679
35680 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
35681 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
35682 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
35683 The process ID is a
35684 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
35685 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35686 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35687
35688 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35689 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
35690 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35691 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35692 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35693 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35694 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35695 @c stopping or restarting threads.
35696
35697 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35698
35699 Reply:
35700 @table @samp
35701 @item E @var{nn}
35702 for an error
35703 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35704 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35705 @item OK
35706 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35707 @end table
35708
35709 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35710 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35711 @anchor{vCont packet}
35712 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35713 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
35714 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
35715 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
35716 in their current state in non-stop mode.
35717 Specifying multiple
35718 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
35719 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35720
35721 Currently supported actions are:
35722
35723 @table @samp
35724 @item c
35725 Continue.
35726 @item C @var{sig}
35727 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35728 @item s
35729 Step.
35730 @item S @var{sig}
35731 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35732 @item t
35733 Stop.
35734 @end table
35735
35736 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
35737 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
35738 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
35739
35740 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
35741 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
35742 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
35743 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
35744 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
35745 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
35746 as an implementation detail.
35747
35748 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
35749 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
35750 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
35751 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
35752 @var{thread-id}.
35753
35754 Reply:
35755 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35756
35757 @item vCont?
35758 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
35759 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
35760
35761 Reply:
35762 @table @samp
35763 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
35764 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
35765 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
35766 @item
35767 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
35768 @end table
35769
35770 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
35771 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
35772 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
35773 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
35774
35775 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
35776 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
35777 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
35778 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
35779 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
35780 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
35781 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
35782 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
35783 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35784 packet is received.
35785
35786 Reply:
35787 @table @samp
35788 @item OK
35789 for success
35790 @item E @var{NN}
35791 for an error
35792 @end table
35793
35794 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35795 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
35796 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
35797 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
35798 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
35799 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
35800 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
35801 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
35802 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
35803 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
35804 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
35805 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
35806
35807
35808 Reply:
35809 @table @samp
35810 @item OK
35811 for success
35812 @item E.memtype
35813 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
35814 @item E @var{NN}
35815 for an error
35816 @end table
35817
35818 @item vFlashDone
35819 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
35820 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
35821 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
35822 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
35823 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
35824 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35825 request is completed.
35826
35827 @item vKill;@var{pid}
35828 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
35829 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
35830 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
35831 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
35832 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35833
35834 Reply:
35835 @table @samp
35836 @item E @var{nn}
35837 for an error
35838 @item OK
35839 for success
35840 @end table
35841
35842 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
35843 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
35844 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
35845 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
35846 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
35847 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
35848 state.
35849
35850 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
35851
35852 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35853
35854 Reply:
35855 @table @samp
35856 @item E @var{nn}
35857 for an error
35858 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35859 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35860 @end table
35861
35862 @item vStopped
35863 @anchor{vStopped packet}
35864 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
35865
35866 In non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}), acknowledge a previous stop
35867 reply and prompt for the stub to report another one.
35868
35869 Reply:
35870 @table @samp
35871 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35872 if there is another unreported stop event (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35873 @item OK
35874 if there are no unreported stop events
35875 @end table
35876
35877 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35878 @anchor{X packet}
35879 @cindex @samp{X} packet
35880 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
35881 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
35882 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
35883
35884 Reply:
35885 @table @samp
35886 @item OK
35887 for success
35888 @item E @var{NN}
35889 for an error
35890 @end table
35891
35892 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35893 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35894 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
35895 @cindex @samp{z} packet
35896 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
35897 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
35898 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
35899
35900 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
35901 separately.
35902
35903 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
35904 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
35905 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
35906 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
35907 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
35908 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
35909
35910 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35911 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35912 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
35913 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
35914 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
35915 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
35916
35917 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
35918 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
35919 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
35920 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
35921 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
35922 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
35923 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
35924 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
35925 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
35926 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
35927
35928 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
35929 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
35930
35931 @table @samp
35932
35933 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35934 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35935 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35936
35937 @end table
35938
35939 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
35940 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35941 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
35942 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
35943 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
35944 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
35945 separators. Each expression has the following form:
35946
35947 @table @samp
35948
35949 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35950 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35951 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35952
35953 @end table
35954
35955 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
35956
35957 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
35958 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
35959 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
35960 target, is not defined.}
35961
35962 Reply:
35963 @table @samp
35964 @item OK
35965 success
35966 @item
35967 not supported
35968 @item E @var{NN}
35969 for an error
35970 @end table
35971
35972 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35973 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35974 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
35975 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
35976 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
35977 address @var{addr}.
35978
35979 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
35980 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. @var{kind}
35981 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
35982
35983 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
35984 movement.}
35985
35986 Reply:
35987 @table @samp
35988 @item OK
35989 success
35990 @item
35991 not supported
35992 @item E @var{NN}
35993 for an error
35994 @end table
35995
35996 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35997 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35998 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
35999 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
36000 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36001 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
36002
36003 Reply:
36004 @table @samp
36005 @item OK
36006 success
36007 @item
36008 not supported
36009 @item E @var{NN}
36010 for an error
36011 @end table
36012
36013 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36014 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36015 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
36016 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
36017 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36018 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
36019
36020 Reply:
36021 @table @samp
36022 @item OK
36023 success
36024 @item
36025 not supported
36026 @item E @var{NN}
36027 for an error
36028 @end table
36029
36030 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36031 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36032 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
36033 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
36034 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36035 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
36036
36037 Reply:
36038 @table @samp
36039 @item OK
36040 success
36041 @item
36042 not supported
36043 @item E @var{NN}
36044 for an error
36045 @end table
36046
36047 @end table
36048
36049 @node Stop Reply Packets
36050 @section Stop Reply Packets
36051 @cindex stop reply packets
36052
36053 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
36054 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
36055 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
36056 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
36057 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
36058 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
36059 @value{GDBN} source code.
36060
36061 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
36062 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
36063 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
36064 components.
36065
36066 @table @samp
36067
36068 @item S @var{AA}
36069 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36070 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
36071 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
36072
36073 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
36074 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
36075 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36076 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
36077 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
36078 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
36079 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
36080 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
36081
36082 @itemize @bullet
36083 @item
36084 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
36085 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
36086 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
36087 two-digit hex number.
36088
36089 @item
36090 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
36091 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36092
36093 @item
36094 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
36095 the core on which the stop event was detected.
36096
36097 @item
36098 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
36099 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
36100 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
36101 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
36102
36103 @item
36104 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
36105 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
36106 future.
36107 @end itemize
36108
36109 The currently defined stop reasons are:
36110
36111 @table @samp
36112 @item watch
36113 @itemx rwatch
36114 @itemx awatch
36115 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
36116 hex.
36117
36118 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
36119 @item library
36120 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
36121 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
36122 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
36123
36124 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
36125 @item replaylog
36126 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
36127 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
36128 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
36129 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
36130 for more information.
36131 @end table
36132
36133 @item W @var{AA}
36134 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36135 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
36136 applicable to certain targets.
36137
36138 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
36139 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
36140 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
36141 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
36142
36143 @item X @var{AA}
36144 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36145 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
36146
36147 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36148 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36149 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36150 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
36151
36152 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
36153 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
36154 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
36155 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
36156 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
36157
36158 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
36159 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
36160 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
36161 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
36162 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
36163 system calls.
36164
36165 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
36166 this very system call.
36167
36168 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
36169 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
36170 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
36171 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
36172 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
36173 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
36174
36175 @end table
36176
36177 @node General Query Packets
36178 @section General Query Packets
36179 @cindex remote query requests
36180
36181 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
36182 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
36183 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
36184 sending information to and from the stub.
36185
36186 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
36187 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
36188 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
36189 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
36190 conventions:
36191
36192 @itemize @bullet
36193 @item
36194 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
36195 @item
36196 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
36197 letter.
36198 @item
36199 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
36200 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
36201 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
36202 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
36203 @end itemize
36204
36205 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
36206 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
36207 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
36208 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
36209 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
36210 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
36211 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
36212 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
36213 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
36214 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
36215 packet.}.
36216
36217 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
36218 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
36219 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
36220 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
36221 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
36222
36223 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
36224
36225 @table @samp
36226
36227 @item QAgent:1
36228 @itemx QAgent:0
36229 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
36230 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
36231
36232 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
36233 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
36234 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
36235 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
36236 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
36237 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
36238 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
36239 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
36240 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
36241 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
36242 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
36243
36244 @item qC
36245 @cindex current thread, remote request
36246 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
36247 Return the current thread ID.
36248
36249 Reply:
36250 @table @samp
36251 @item QC @var{thread-id}
36252 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
36253 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36254 @item @r{(anything else)}
36255 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
36256 @end table
36257
36258 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
36259 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
36260 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
36261 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
36262 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
36263 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
36264 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
36265
36266 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
36267 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
36268 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
36269 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
36270 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
36271 detect trailing zeros.
36272
36273 Reply:
36274 @table @samp
36275 @item E @var{NN}
36276 An error (such as memory fault)
36277 @item C @var{crc32}
36278 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
36279 @end table
36280
36281 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
36282 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
36283 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
36284 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
36285 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
36286 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
36287 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
36288 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
36289 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
36290 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
36291 randomization.
36292
36293 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36294
36295 Reply:
36296 @table @samp
36297 @item OK
36298 The request succeeded.
36299
36300 @item E @var{nn}
36301 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
36302
36303 @item
36304 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
36305 by the stub.
36306 @end table
36307
36308 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36309 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36310 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
36311 address space randomization.
36312
36313 @item qfThreadInfo
36314 @itemx qsThreadInfo
36315 @cindex list active threads, remote request
36316 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
36317 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
36318 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
36319 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
36320 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
36321 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
36322 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
36323 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
36324
36325 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
36326
36327 Reply:
36328 @table @samp
36329 @item m @var{thread-id}
36330 A single thread ID
36331 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
36332 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
36333 @item l
36334 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36335 @end table
36336
36337 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36338 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
36339 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
36340 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
36341 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
36342 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36343 fields.
36344
36345 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
36346 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
36347 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
36348 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
36349 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
36350
36351 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
36352 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36353
36354 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
36355 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
36356 information associated with the variable.)
36357
36358 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
36359 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
36360 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
36361 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
36362 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
36363 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
36364
36365 Reply:
36366 @table @samp
36367 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36368 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
36369 local storage requested.
36370
36371 @item E @var{nn}
36372 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
36373
36374 @item
36375 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36376 @end table
36377
36378 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
36379 @cindex get thread information block address
36380 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
36381 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
36382
36383 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
36384
36385 Reply:
36386 @table @samp
36387 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36388 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
36389 thread information block.
36390
36391 @item E @var{nn}
36392 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
36393 address could not be retrieved.
36394
36395 @item
36396 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36397 @end table
36398
36399 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
36400 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
36401 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
36402 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
36403 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
36404 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
36405 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
36406
36407 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
36408
36409 Reply:
36410 @table @samp
36411 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
36412 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
36413 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
36414 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
36415 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
36416 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
36417 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
36418 @end table
36419
36420 @item qOffsets
36421 @cindex section offsets, remote request
36422 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
36423 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
36424 image.
36425
36426 Reply:
36427 @table @samp
36428 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
36429 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
36430 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
36431 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
36432 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
36433 segments by the supplied offsets.
36434
36435 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
36436 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
36437 to the @code{Bss} section.}
36438
36439 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
36440 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
36441 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
36442 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
36443 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
36444 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
36445 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
36446 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
36447 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
36448 @end table
36449
36450 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
36451 @cindex thread information, remote request
36452 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
36453 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
36454 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
36455 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
36456
36457 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
36458 (see below).
36459
36460 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
36461
36462 @item QNonStop:1
36463 @itemx QNonStop:0
36464 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
36465 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
36466 @anchor{QNonStop}
36467 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
36468 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
36469
36470 Reply:
36471 @table @samp
36472 @item OK
36473 The request succeeded.
36474
36475 @item E @var{nn}
36476 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
36477
36478 @item
36479 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
36480 the stub.
36481 @end table
36482
36483 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36484 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36485 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
36486 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
36487
36488 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36489 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
36490 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36491 @anchor{QPassSignals}
36492 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
36493 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36494 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36495 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
36496 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
36497 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
36498 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
36499 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
36500 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
36501
36502 Reply:
36503 @table @samp
36504 @item OK
36505 The request succeeded.
36506
36507 @item E @var{nn}
36508 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
36509
36510 @item
36511 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
36512 the stub.
36513 @end table
36514
36515 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
36516 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
36517 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36518 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36519
36520 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36521 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
36522 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
36523 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
36524 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
36525 Others should be silently discarded.
36526
36527 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
36528 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
36529 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
36530 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
36531 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
36532 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
36533 signals.
36534
36535 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
36536 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
36537
36538 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36539 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36540 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
36541 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
36542 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36543
36544 Reply:
36545 @table @samp
36546 @item OK
36547 The request succeeded.
36548
36549 @item E @var{nn}
36550 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
36551
36552 @item
36553 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
36554 by the stub.
36555 @end table
36556
36557 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
36558 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
36559 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36560 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36561
36562 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
36563 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
36564 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
36565 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
36566 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
36567 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
36568 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
36569 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
36570 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
36571
36572 Reply:
36573 @table @samp
36574 @item OK
36575 A command response with no output.
36576 @item @var{OUTPUT}
36577 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
36578 @item E @var{NN}
36579 Indicate a badly formed request.
36580 @item
36581 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
36582 @end table
36583
36584 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
36585 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36586 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36587 packets.)
36588
36589 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
36590 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
36591 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
36592 @anchor{qSearch memory}
36593 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
36594 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
36595 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
36596
36597 Reply:
36598 @table @samp
36599 @item 0
36600 The pattern was not found.
36601 @item 1,address
36602 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
36603 @item E @var{NN}
36604 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
36605 @item
36606 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
36607 @end table
36608
36609 @item QStartNoAckMode
36610 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
36611 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
36612 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
36613 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
36614
36615 Reply:
36616 @table @samp
36617 @item OK
36618 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
36619 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
36620 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
36621 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
36622 @item
36623 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
36624 @end table
36625
36626 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
36627 @cindex supported packets, remote query
36628 @cindex features of the remote protocol
36629 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
36630 @anchor{qSupported}
36631 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
36632 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
36633 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
36634 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
36635 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
36636 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
36637 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
36638 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
36639 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
36640 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
36641 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
36642 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
36643 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
36644 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
36645
36646 Reply:
36647 @table @samp
36648 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
36649 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
36650 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
36651 possible forms).
36652 @item
36653 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
36654 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
36655 @end table
36656
36657 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
36658 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
36659 are:
36660
36661 @table @samp
36662 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
36663 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
36664 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
36665 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
36666 @item @var{name}+
36667 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
36668 need an associated value.
36669 @item @var{name}-
36670 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
36671 @item @var{name}?
36672 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
36673 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
36674 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
36675 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
36676 @end table
36677
36678 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
36679 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
36680 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
36681 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
36682 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
36683
36684 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
36685 are defined:
36686
36687 @table @samp
36688 @item multiprocess
36689 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
36690 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36691 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36692 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36693 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
36694
36695 @item xmlRegisters
36696 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
36697 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
36698 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
36699 description.
36700
36701 @item qRelocInsn
36702 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
36703 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36704 instruction reply packet}).
36705 @end table
36706
36707 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
36708 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
36709 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
36710 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
36711 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
36712 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
36713 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
36714 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
36715 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
36716 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
36717 all the features it supports.
36718
36719 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
36720 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
36721
36722 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
36723 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
36724 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
36725 form response.
36726
36727 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
36728 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
36729 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
36730 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
36731
36732 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
36733 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
36734 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
36735 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
36736 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
36737
36738 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
36739
36740 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
36741 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
36742 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
36743 @item Feature Name
36744 @tab Value Required
36745 @tab Default
36746 @tab Probe Allowed
36747
36748 @item @samp{PacketSize}
36749 @tab Yes
36750 @tab @samp{-}
36751 @tab No
36752
36753 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
36754 @tab No
36755 @tab @samp{-}
36756 @tab Yes
36757
36758 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
36759 @tab No
36760 @tab @samp{-}
36761 @tab Yes
36762
36763 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
36764 @tab No
36765 @tab @samp{-}
36766 @tab Yes
36767
36768 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
36769 @tab No
36770 @tab @samp{-}
36771 @tab Yes
36772
36773 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
36774 @tab No
36775 @tab @samp{-}
36776 @tab Yes
36777
36778 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
36779 @tab No
36780 @tab @samp{-}
36781 @tab Yes
36782
36783 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
36784 @tab No
36785 @tab @samp{-}
36786 @tab Yes
36787
36788 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
36789 @tab No
36790 @tab @samp{-}
36791 @tab Yes
36792
36793 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
36794 @tab No
36795 @tab @samp{-}
36796 @tab Yes
36797
36798 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
36799 @tab No
36800 @tab @samp{-}
36801 @tab Yes
36802
36803 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36804 @tab No
36805 @tab @samp{-}
36806 @tab Yes
36807
36808 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36809 @tab No
36810 @tab @samp{-}
36811 @tab Yes
36812
36813 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36814 @tab No
36815 @tab @samp{-}
36816 @tab Yes
36817
36818 @item @samp{QNonStop}
36819 @tab No
36820 @tab @samp{-}
36821 @tab Yes
36822
36823 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
36824 @tab No
36825 @tab @samp{-}
36826 @tab Yes
36827
36828 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
36829 @tab No
36830 @tab @samp{-}
36831 @tab Yes
36832
36833 @item @samp{multiprocess}
36834 @tab No
36835 @tab @samp{-}
36836 @tab No
36837
36838 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
36839 @tab No
36840 @tab @samp{-}
36841 @tab No
36842
36843 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
36844 @tab No
36845 @tab @samp{-}
36846 @tab No
36847
36848 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
36849 @tab No
36850 @tab @samp{-}
36851 @tab No
36852
36853 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
36854 @tab No
36855 @tab @samp{-}
36856 @tab No
36857
36858 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
36859 @tab No
36860 @tab @samp{-}
36861 @tab No
36862
36863 @item @samp{QAgent}
36864 @tab No
36865 @tab @samp{-}
36866 @tab No
36867
36868 @item @samp{QAllow}
36869 @tab No
36870 @tab @samp{-}
36871 @tab No
36872
36873 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
36874 @tab No
36875 @tab @samp{-}
36876 @tab No
36877
36878 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
36879 @tab No
36880 @tab @samp{-}
36881 @tab No
36882
36883 @item @samp{tracenz}
36884 @tab No
36885 @tab @samp{-}
36886 @tab No
36887
36888 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
36889 @tab No
36890 @tab @samp{-}
36891 @tab No
36892
36893 @end multitable
36894
36895 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
36896
36897 @table @samp
36898 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
36899 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
36900 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
36901 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
36902 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
36903 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
36904 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
36905 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
36906 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
36907 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
36908
36909 @item qXfer:auxv:read
36910 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
36911 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
36912
36913 @item qXfer:features:read
36914 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
36915 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
36916
36917 @item qXfer:libraries:read
36918 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
36919 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
36920
36921 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
36922 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36923 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36924
36925 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
36926 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
36927 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
36928
36929 @item qXfer:sdata:read
36930 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
36931 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
36932
36933 @item qXfer:spu:read
36934 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
36935 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
36936
36937 @item qXfer:spu:write
36938 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
36939 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
36940
36941 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
36942 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
36943 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
36944
36945 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
36946 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
36947 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
36948
36949 @item qXfer:threads:read
36950 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
36951 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
36952
36953 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
36954 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36955 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
36956
36957 @item qXfer:uib:read
36958 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36959 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
36960
36961 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
36962 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36963 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
36964
36965 @item QNonStop
36966 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
36967 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
36968
36969 @item QPassSignals
36970 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36971 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
36972
36973 @item QStartNoAckMode
36974 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
36975 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
36976
36977 @item multiprocess
36978 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
36979 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
36980 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
36981 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
36982 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
36983 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
36984 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
36985 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
36986 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
36987 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
36988 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
36989
36990 @item qXfer:osdata:read
36991 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
36992 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
36993
36994 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
36995 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
36996 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
36997 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
36998
36999 @item ConditionalTracepoints
37000 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
37001 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
37002
37003 @item ReverseContinue
37004 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
37005 (@pxref{bc}).
37006
37007 @item ReverseStep
37008 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
37009 (@pxref{bs}).
37010
37011 @item TracepointSource
37012 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
37013 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
37014
37015 @item QAgent
37016 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
37017
37018 @item QAllow
37019 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
37020
37021 @item QDisableRandomization
37022 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
37023
37024 @item StaticTracepoint
37025 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
37026 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
37027
37028 @item InstallInTrace
37029 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
37030 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
37031
37032 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
37033 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
37034 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
37035 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
37036
37037 @item tracenz
37038 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
37039 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
37040 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
37041
37042 @item BreakpointCommands
37043 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
37044 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
37045 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
37046
37047 @end table
37048
37049 @item qSymbol::
37050 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
37051 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
37052 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
37053 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
37054
37055 Reply:
37056 @table @samp
37057 @item OK
37058 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37059 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37060 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
37061 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
37062 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
37063 below.
37064 @end table
37065
37066 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
37067 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
37068
37069 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
37070 target has previously requested.
37071
37072 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
37073 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
37074 will be empty.
37075
37076 Reply:
37077 @table @samp
37078 @item OK
37079 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37080 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37081 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
37082 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
37083 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
37084 @end table
37085
37086 @item qTBuffer
37087 @itemx QTBuffer
37088 @itemx QTDisconnected
37089 @itemx QTDP
37090 @itemx QTDPsrc
37091 @itemx QTDV
37092 @itemx qTfP
37093 @itemx qTfV
37094 @itemx QTFrame
37095 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
37096
37097 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37098
37099 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
37100 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
37101 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
37102 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
37103 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
37104 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
37105 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
37106 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
37107 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
37108 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
37109 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
37110
37111 Reply:
37112 @table @samp
37113 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37114 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
37115 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
37116 the thread's attributes.
37117 @end table
37118
37119 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
37120 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37121 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37122 packets.)
37123
37124 @item QTNotes
37125 @itemx qTP
37126 @itemx QTSave
37127 @itemx qTsP
37128 @itemx qTsV
37129 @itemx QTStart
37130 @itemx QTStop
37131 @itemx QTEnable
37132 @itemx QTDisable
37133 @itemx QTinit
37134 @itemx QTro
37135 @itemx qTStatus
37136 @itemx qTV
37137 @itemx qTfSTM
37138 @itemx qTsSTM
37139 @itemx qTSTMat
37140 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37141
37142 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37143 @cindex read special object, remote request
37144 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
37145 @anchor{qXfer read}
37146 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
37147 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
37148 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
37149 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
37150 additional details about what data to access.
37151
37152 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
37153 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37154 formats, listed below.
37155
37156 @table @samp
37157 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37158 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
37159 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
37160 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
37161
37162 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37163 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37164
37165 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37166 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
37167 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
37168 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
37169 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
37170
37171 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37172 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37173
37174 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37175 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
37176 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
37177 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37178 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37179
37180 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
37181 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
37182 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
37183
37184 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37185 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37186
37187 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37188 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
37189 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
37190 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
37191 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37192
37193 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
37194 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
37195
37196 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37197 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37198
37199 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37200 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
37201 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
37202 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37203 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37204
37205 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37206 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37207
37208 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37209 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
37210
37211 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
37212 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
37213 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
37214 Action Lists}.
37215
37216 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37217 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37218 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37219
37220 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37221 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
37222 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
37223 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37224 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37225
37226 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37227 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37228 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37229
37230 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37231 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
37232 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37233 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
37234 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37235 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37236 in that context to be accessed.
37237
37238 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37239 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37240 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37241
37242 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37243 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
37244 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
37245 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37246 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37247
37248 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37249 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37250
37251 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37252 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
37253
37254 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
37255 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
37256 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37257
37258 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37259 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37260
37261 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37262 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
37263
37264 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
37265 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
37266
37267 This packet is not probed by default.
37268
37269 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37270 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
37271 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
37272 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
37273 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
37274
37275 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37276 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37277
37278 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37279 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
37280 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
37281 @xref{Operating System Information}.
37282
37283 @end table
37284
37285 Reply:
37286 @table @samp
37287 @item m @var{data}
37288 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
37289 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
37290 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
37291 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
37292 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
37293 request.
37294
37295 @item l @var{data}
37296 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
37297 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
37298 than the @var{length} in the request.
37299
37300 @item l
37301 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
37302 There is no more data to be read.
37303
37304 @item E00
37305 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37306
37307 @item E @var{nn}
37308 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
37309 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37310
37311 @item
37312 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
37313 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
37314 @end table
37315
37316 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37317 @cindex write data into object, remote request
37318 @anchor{qXfer write}
37319 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
37320 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
37321 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
37322 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
37323 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
37324 to access.
37325
37326 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
37327 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37328 formats, listed below.
37329
37330 @table @samp
37331 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37332 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
37333 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
37334 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37335 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
37336
37337 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37338 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37339 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37340
37341 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37342 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
37343 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37344 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
37345 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37346 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37347 in that context to be accessed.
37348
37349 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37350 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37351 @end table
37352
37353 Reply:
37354 @table @samp
37355 @item @var{nn}
37356 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
37357 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
37358
37359 @item E00
37360 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37361
37362 @item E @var{nn}
37363 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
37364 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37365
37366 @item
37367 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
37368 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
37369 @end table
37370
37371 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
37372 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
37373 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
37374 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
37375 must respond with an empty packet.
37376
37377 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
37378 @cindex query attached, remote request
37379 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
37380 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
37381 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
37382 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
37383 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
37384 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
37385 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
37386
37387 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
37388 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
37389 the @code{quit} command.
37390
37391 Reply:
37392 @table @samp
37393 @item 1
37394 The remote server attached to an existing process.
37395 @item 0
37396 The remote server created a new process.
37397 @item E @var{NN}
37398 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37399 @end table
37400
37401 @end table
37402
37403 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37404 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37405
37406 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
37407 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
37408 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
37409
37410 @menu
37411 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
37412 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
37413 @end menu
37414
37415 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
37416 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
37417
37418 @menu
37419 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
37420 @end menu
37421
37422 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
37423 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
37424 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
37425
37426 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37427
37428 @table @r
37429
37430 @item 2
37431 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
37432
37433 @item 3
37434 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
37435
37436 @item 4
37437 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
37438
37439 @end table
37440
37441 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
37442 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
37443
37444 @menu
37445 * MIPS Register packet Format::
37446 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
37447 @end menu
37448
37449 @node MIPS Register packet Format
37450 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
37451 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
37452
37453 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
37454 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
37455 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
37456 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
37457 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
37458 most-significant -- least-significant.
37459
37460 @table @r
37461
37462 @item MIPS32
37463 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
37464 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
37465 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
37466
37467 @item MIPS64
37468 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
37469 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
37470 as @code{MIPS32}.
37471
37472 @end table
37473
37474 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
37475 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
37476 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
37477
37478 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37479
37480 @table @r
37481
37482 @item 2
37483 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
37484
37485 @item 3
37486 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37487
37488 @item 4
37489 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
37490
37491 @item 5
37492 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37493
37494 @end table
37495
37496 @node Tracepoint Packets
37497 @section Tracepoint Packets
37498 @cindex tracepoint packets
37499 @cindex packets, tracepoint
37500
37501 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
37502 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
37503
37504 @table @samp
37505
37506 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
37507 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
37508 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
37509 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
37510 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
37511 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
37512 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
37513 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
37514 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
37515 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
37516 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
37517 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
37518 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
37519 actions.
37520
37521 Replies:
37522 @table @samp
37523 @item OK
37524 The packet was understood and carried out.
37525 @item qRelocInsn
37526 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37527 @item
37528 The packet was not recognized.
37529 @end table
37530
37531 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
37532 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
37533 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
37534 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
37535 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
37536 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
37537 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
37538
37539 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
37540 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
37541 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
37542 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
37543 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
37544 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
37545 tracepoint actions.
37546
37547 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
37548 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
37549 following forms:
37550
37551 @table @samp
37552
37553 @item R @var{mask}
37554 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
37555 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
37556 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
37557 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
37558 not fit in a 32-bit word.
37559
37560 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
37561 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
37562 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
37563 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
37564 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
37565 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
37566 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
37567
37568 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37569 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
37570 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
37571 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
37572 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
37573 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
37574 packet).
37575
37576 @end table
37577
37578 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
37579 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
37580 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
37581 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
37582 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
37583 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
37584 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
37585 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
37586
37587 Replies:
37588 @table @samp
37589 @item OK
37590 The packet was understood and carried out.
37591 @item qRelocInsn
37592 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37593 @item
37594 The packet was not recognized.
37595 @end table
37596
37597 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
37598 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
37599 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
37600 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
37601 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. @var{type}
37602 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
37603 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
37604 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
37605
37606 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
37607 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
37608 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
37609 fit in a single packet.
37610 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
37611 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
37612
37613 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
37614 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
37615 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
37616 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
37617
37618 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
37619 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
37620 query packets.
37621
37622 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
37623 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
37624 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
37625 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
37626 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
37627 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
37628 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
37629 be found.
37630
37631 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}
37632 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
37633 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
37634 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
37635 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
37636 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
37637 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
37638 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
37639 mentioned in expressions.
37640
37641 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
37642 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
37643 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
37644 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
37645 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
37646
37647 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
37648 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
37649 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
37650 one of the following forms:
37651
37652 @table @samp
37653 @item F @var{f}
37654 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
37655 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
37656 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
37657
37658 @item T @var{t}
37659 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
37660 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
37661
37662 @end table
37663
37664 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
37665 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37666 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
37667 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
37668
37669 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
37670 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37671 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
37672 is a hexadecimal number.
37673
37674 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
37675 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37676 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
37677 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
37678 numbers.
37679
37680 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
37681 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
37682 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
37683
37684 @item qTMinFTPILen
37685 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
37686 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
37687 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
37688 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
37689 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
37690 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
37691 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
37692 arrange for that.
37693
37694 Replies:
37695
37696 @table @samp
37697 @item 0
37698 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
37699 @item @var{length}
37700 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length} is greater
37701 or equal to 1. @var{length} is a hexadecimal number. A reply of 1 means
37702 that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction regardless of size.
37703 @item E
37704 An error has occurred.
37705 @item
37706 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
37707 @end table
37708
37709 @item QTStart
37710 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
37711 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
37712 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
37713 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
37714 instruction reply packet}).
37715
37716 @item QTStop
37717 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
37718 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
37719
37720 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37721 @anchor{QTEnable}
37722 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
37723 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37724 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
37725 of data from it will resume.
37726
37727 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37728 @anchor{QTDisable}
37729 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
37730 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37731 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
37732 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
37733
37734 @item QTinit
37735 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
37736 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
37737
37738 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
37739 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
37740 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
37741 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
37742 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
37743
37744 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
37745 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
37746 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
37747 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
37748
37749 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
37750 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
37751 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
37752 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
37753 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
37754 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
37755
37756 @item qTStatus
37757 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
37758 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
37759
37760 The reply has the form:
37761
37762 @table @samp
37763
37764 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
37765 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
37766 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
37767 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
37768
37769 @end table
37770
37771 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
37772 explanations as one of the optional fields:
37773
37774 @table @samp
37775
37776 @item tnotrun:0
37777 No trace has been run yet.
37778
37779 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
37780 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
37781 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
37782 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
37783 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
37784
37785 @item tfull:0
37786 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
37787
37788 @item tdisconnected:0
37789 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
37790
37791 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
37792 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
37793
37794 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
37795 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
37796 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
37797 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression).
37798 @var{text} is hex encoded.
37799
37800 @item tunknown:0
37801 The trace stopped for some other reason.
37802
37803 @end table
37804
37805 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
37806 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
37807 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
37808 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
37809 trace.
37810
37811 @table @samp
37812
37813 @item tframes:@var{n}
37814 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
37815
37816 @item tcreated:@var{n}
37817 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
37818 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
37819
37820 @item tsize:@var{n}
37821 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
37822
37823 @item tfree:@var{n}
37824 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
37825
37826 @item circular:@var{n}
37827 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
37828 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
37829 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
37830 and may fill up.
37831
37832 @item disconn:@var{n}
37833 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
37834 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
37835 that the trace run will stop.
37836
37837 @end table
37838
37839 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
37840 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
37841 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
37842 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
37843 address @var{addr}.
37844
37845 Replies:
37846 @table @samp
37847 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
37848 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
37849 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
37850 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
37851 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
37852
37853 @end table
37854
37855 @item qTV:@var{var}
37856 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
37857 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
37858 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
37859
37860 Replies:
37861 @table @samp
37862 @item V@var{value}
37863 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
37864 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
37865 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
37866 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
37867 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
37868 program is running.
37869
37870 @item U
37871 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
37872 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
37873 was not collected.
37874 @end table
37875
37876 @item qTfP
37877 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
37878 @itemx qTsP
37879 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
37880 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
37881 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
37882 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
37883 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
37884 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
37885
37886 @item qTfV
37887 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
37888 @itemx qTsV
37889 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
37890 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
37891 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
37892 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
37893 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
37894 trace state variables.
37895
37896 @item qTfSTM
37897 @itemx qTsSTM
37898 @anchor{qTfSTM}
37899 @anchor{qTsSTM}
37900 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
37901 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
37902 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
37903 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
37904 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
37905 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
37906
37907 Reply:
37908 @table @samp
37909 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
37910 A single marker
37911 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
37912 a comma-separated list of markers
37913 @item l
37914 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
37915 @item E @var{nn}
37916 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
37917 @item
37918 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
37919 stub.
37920 @end table
37921
37922 @var{address} is encoded in hex.
37923 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
37924
37925 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
37926 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
37927 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
37928 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
37929 @dfn{last}).
37930
37931 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
37932 @anchor{qTSTMat}
37933 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
37934 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
37935 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
37936 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
37937 tracepoint markers.
37938
37939 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
37940 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
37941 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
37942 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. @var{filename} is encoded
37943 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
37944 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
37945
37946 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
37947 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
37948 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
37949 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
37950 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
37951 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
37952 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
37953 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
37954 available.
37955
37956 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
37957 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
37958 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
37959
37960 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
37961 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
37962 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
37963 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
37964 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
37965
37966 @end table
37967
37968 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
37969 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
37970 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
37971 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
37972 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
37973 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
37974 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
37975 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
37976 it had executed in the original location.
37977
37978 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
37979 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
37980 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
37981 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
37982 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
37983 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
37984 format of the request is:
37985
37986 @table @samp
37987 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
37988
37989 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
37990 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
37991 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
37992 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
37993 memory starting at @var{to}.
37994 @end table
37995
37996 Replies:
37997 @table @samp
37998 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
37999 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. @var{adjusted_size} is
38000 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
38001 @item E @var{NN}
38002 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
38003 relocating the instruction.
38004 @end table
38005
38006 @node Host I/O Packets
38007 @section Host I/O Packets
38008 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
38009 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
38010
38011 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
38012 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
38013 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
38014 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
38015 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
38016 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
38017 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
38018 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
38019 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
38020 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
38021
38022 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
38023 its arguments. They have this format:
38024
38025 @table @samp
38026
38027 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
38028 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
38029 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
38030 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
38031 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
38032 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
38033 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
38034 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
38035 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
38036
38037 @end table
38038
38039 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
38040
38041 @table @samp
38042
38043 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
38044 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
38045 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
38046 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
38047 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
38048 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
38049 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
38050 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
38051 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
38052 @var{attachment}.
38053
38054 @item
38055 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
38056
38057 @end table
38058
38059 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
38060
38061 @table @samp
38062 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
38063 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
38064 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
38065 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
38066 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
38067 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
38068 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
38069
38070 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
38071 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
38072 -1 if an error occurs.
38073
38074 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
38075 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
38076 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
38077 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
38078 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
38079 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
38080 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
38081 @var{count} was zero.
38082
38083 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38084 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38085 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38086 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38087 some characters were escaped.
38088
38089 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
38090 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
38091 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
38092 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
38093 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
38094 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
38095 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
38096 error occurred.
38097
38098 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
38099 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
38100 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
38101
38102 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
38103 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
38104 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
38105
38106 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38107 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38108 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38109 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38110 some characters were escaped.
38111
38112 @end table
38113
38114 @node Interrupts
38115 @section Interrupts
38116 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
38117
38118 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
38119 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
38120 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
38121 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
38122
38123 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
38124 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
38125 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
38126 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
38127 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
38128
38129 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
38130 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
38131 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
38132 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
38133 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
38134 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
38135 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
38136 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
38137
38138 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
38139 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
38140 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
38141
38142 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
38143 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
38144 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
38145 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
38146 currently-executing threads and processes.
38147 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
38148 running program, it should send one of the stop
38149 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
38150 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
38151 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
38152 Interrupts received while the
38153 program is stopped are discarded.
38154
38155 @node Notification Packets
38156 @section Notification Packets
38157 @cindex notification packets
38158 @cindex packets, notification
38159
38160 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
38161 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
38162 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
38163 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
38164 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
38165 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
38166 is not a problem.
38167
38168 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
38169 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
38170 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
38171 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
38172 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
38173 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
38174 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
38175
38176 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
38177 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
38178
38179 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
38180 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
38181 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
38182 not they understand it.
38183
38184 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
38185 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
38186 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
38187 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
38188 recipients.
38189
38190 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
38191 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
38192 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
38193 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
38194 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
38195
38196 The following notification packets from the stub to @value{GDBN} are
38197 defined:
38198
38199 @table @samp
38200 @item Stop: @var{reply}
38201 Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
38202 The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
38203 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
38204 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
38205 @value{GDBN}.
38206 @end table
38207
38208 @node Remote Non-Stop
38209 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
38210
38211 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
38212 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
38213 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
38214 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38215
38216 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
38217 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
38218 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
38219 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
38220 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
38221 probe the target state after a mode change.
38222
38223 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
38224 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
38225 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
38226 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
38227 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
38228 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
38229 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
38230 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
38231 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
38232 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
38233 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
38234
38235 Only one stop reply notification at a time may be pending; if
38236 additional stop events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
38237 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
38238 synchronous transmission in response to @samp{vStopped} packets from
38239 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
38240 the stub is permitted to resend a stop reply notification
38241 if it believes @value{GDBN} may not have received it. @value{GDBN}
38242 ignores additional stop reply notifications received before it has
38243 finished processing a previous notification and the stub has completed
38244 sending any queued stop events.
38245
38246 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} must be prepared to receive a stop reply
38247 notification at any time. Specifically, they may appear when
38248 @value{GDBN} is not otherwise reading input from the stub, or when
38249 @value{GDBN} is expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
38250 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
38251 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
38252 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
38253
38254 After receiving a stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall
38255 acknowledge it by sending a @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{vStopped packet})
38256 as a regular, synchronous request to the stub. Such acknowledgment
38257 is not required to happen immediately, as @value{GDBN} is permitted to
38258 send other, unrelated packets to the stub first, which the stub should
38259 process normally.
38260
38261 Upon receiving a @samp{vStopped} packet, if the stub has other queued
38262 stop events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
38263 normal stop reply response. @value{GDBN} shall then send another
38264 @samp{vStopped} packet to solicit further responses; again, it is
38265 permitted to send other, unrelated packets as well which the stub
38266 should process normally.
38267
38268 If the stub receives a @samp{vStopped} packet and there are no
38269 additional stop events to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK}
38270 response. At this point, if further stop events occur, the stub shall
38271 send a new stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the
38272 notification, and the process shall be repeated.
38273
38274 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
38275 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
38276 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
38277 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
38278 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
38279 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
38280 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
38281 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
38282 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
38283 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
38284 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
38285 @samp{OK}.
38286
38287 @node Packet Acknowledgment
38288 @section Packet Acknowledgment
38289
38290 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38291 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38292 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
38293 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
38294 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
38295 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
38296 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
38297
38298 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
38299 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
38300 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
38301 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
38302 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
38303
38304 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
38305 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
38306 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
38307 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
38308
38309 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
38310 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
38311 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
38312 @pxref{qSupported}.
38313 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
38314 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
38315 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
38316 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
38317 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
38318 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
38319 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
38320
38321 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
38322 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
38323 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
38324 connection.
38325 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
38326 new connection is established,
38327 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
38328 for the current connection, once disabled.
38329
38330 @node Examples
38331 @section Examples
38332
38333 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
38334 does not get any direct output:
38335
38336 @smallexample
38337 -> @code{R00}
38338 <- @code{+}
38339 @emph{target restarts}
38340 -> @code{?}
38341 <- @code{+}
38342 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38343 -> @code{+}
38344 @end smallexample
38345
38346 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
38347
38348 @smallexample
38349 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
38350 <- @code{+}
38351 -> @code{s}
38352 <- @code{+}
38353 @emph{time passes}
38354 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38355 -> @code{+}
38356 -> @code{g}
38357 <- @code{+}
38358 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
38359 -> @code{+}
38360 @end smallexample
38361
38362 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38363 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38364 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
38365
38366 @menu
38367 * File-I/O Overview::
38368 * Protocol Basics::
38369 * The F Request Packet::
38370 * The F Reply Packet::
38371 * The Ctrl-C Message::
38372 * Console I/O::
38373 * List of Supported Calls::
38374 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
38375 * Constants::
38376 * File-I/O Examples::
38377 @end menu
38378
38379 @node File-I/O Overview
38380 @subsection File-I/O Overview
38381 @cindex file-i/o overview
38382
38383 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
38384 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
38385 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
38386 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
38387 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
38388 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
38389
38390 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
38391 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
38392 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
38393 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
38394 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
38395
38396 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
38397 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
38398 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
38399 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
38400 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
38401 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
38402 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
38403
38404 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
38405 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
38406 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
38407 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
38408 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
38409
38410 @smallexample
38411 (@value{GDBP}) continue
38412 <- target requests 'system call X'
38413 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
38414 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
38415 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
38416 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
38417 @end smallexample
38418
38419 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
38420 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
38421 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
38422 system are not supported by this protocol.
38423
38424 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
38425
38426 @node Protocol Basics
38427 @subsection Protocol Basics
38428 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
38429
38430 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
38431 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
38432 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
38433 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
38434 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
38435 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
38436 to call the appropriate host system call:
38437
38438 @itemize @bullet
38439 @item
38440 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
38441
38442 @item
38443 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
38444 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
38445 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
38446 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
38447
38448 @end itemize
38449
38450 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
38451
38452 @itemize @bullet
38453 @item
38454 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
38455 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
38456 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
38457 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
38458 packet.
38459
38460 @item
38461 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
38462 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
38463
38464 @item
38465 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
38466
38467 @item
38468 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
38469
38470 @item
38471 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
38472 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
38473 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
38474 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
38475 packet.
38476
38477 @end itemize
38478
38479 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
38480 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
38481
38482 @itemize @bullet
38483 @item
38484 Return value.
38485
38486 @item
38487 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
38488
38489 @item
38490 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
38491
38492 @end itemize
38493
38494 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
38495 the latest continue or step action.
38496
38497 @node The F Request Packet
38498 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
38499 @cindex file-i/o request packet
38500 @cindex @code{F} request packet
38501
38502 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
38503
38504 @table @samp
38505 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
38506
38507 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
38508 This is just the name of the function.
38509
38510 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
38511 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
38512 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
38513 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
38514 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
38515 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
38516 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
38517
38518 @end table
38519
38520
38521
38522 @node The F Reply Packet
38523 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
38524 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
38525 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
38526
38527 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
38528
38529 @table @samp
38530
38531 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
38532
38533 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
38534
38535 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
38536 representation.
38537 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
38538
38539 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
38540 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
38541 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
38542
38543 @smallexample
38544 F0,0,C
38545 @end smallexample
38546
38547 @noindent
38548 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
38549
38550 @smallexample
38551 F-1,4,C
38552 @end smallexample
38553
38554 @noindent
38555 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
38556
38557 @end table
38558
38559
38560 @node The Ctrl-C Message
38561 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
38562 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
38563
38564 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
38565 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
38566 the target should behave as if it had
38567 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
38568 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
38569 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
38570 packet.
38571
38572 It's important for the target to know in which
38573 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
38574
38575 @itemize @bullet
38576 @item
38577 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
38578
38579 @item
38580 The system call on the host has been finished.
38581
38582 @end itemize
38583
38584 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
38585 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
38586 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
38587 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
38588 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
38589 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
38590
38591 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
38592 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
38593 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
38594 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
38595 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
38596 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
38597 or the full action has been completed.
38598
38599 @node Console I/O
38600 @subsection Console I/O
38601 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
38602
38603 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
38604 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
38605 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
38606 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
38607 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
38608 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
38609 conditions is met:
38610
38611 @itemize @bullet
38612 @item
38613 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
38614 @code{read}
38615 system call is treated as finished.
38616
38617 @item
38618 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
38619 newline.
38620
38621 @item
38622 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
38623 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
38624
38625 @end itemize
38626
38627 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
38628 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
38629 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
38630 is stopped at the user's request.
38631
38632
38633 @node List of Supported Calls
38634 @subsection List of Supported Calls
38635 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
38636
38637 @menu
38638 * open::
38639 * close::
38640 * read::
38641 * write::
38642 * lseek::
38643 * rename::
38644 * unlink::
38645 * stat/fstat::
38646 * gettimeofday::
38647 * isatty::
38648 * system::
38649 @end menu
38650
38651 @node open
38652 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
38653 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
38654
38655 @table @asis
38656 @item Synopsis:
38657 @smallexample
38658 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
38659 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
38660 @end smallexample
38661
38662 @item Request:
38663 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
38664
38665 @noindent
38666 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38667
38668 @table @code
38669 @item O_CREAT
38670 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
38671 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
38672 are concerned.
38673
38674 @item O_EXCL
38675 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
38676 an error and open() fails.
38677
38678 @item O_TRUNC
38679 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
38680 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
38681 truncated to zero length.
38682
38683 @item O_APPEND
38684 The file is opened in append mode.
38685
38686 @item O_RDONLY
38687 The file is opened for reading only.
38688
38689 @item O_WRONLY
38690 The file is opened for writing only.
38691
38692 @item O_RDWR
38693 The file is opened for reading and writing.
38694 @end table
38695
38696 @noindent
38697 Other bits are silently ignored.
38698
38699
38700 @noindent
38701 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38702
38703 @table @code
38704 @item S_IRUSR
38705 User has read permission.
38706
38707 @item S_IWUSR
38708 User has write permission.
38709
38710 @item S_IRGRP
38711 Group has read permission.
38712
38713 @item S_IWGRP
38714 Group has write permission.
38715
38716 @item S_IROTH
38717 Others have read permission.
38718
38719 @item S_IWOTH
38720 Others have write permission.
38721 @end table
38722
38723 @noindent
38724 Other bits are silently ignored.
38725
38726
38727 @item Return value:
38728 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
38729 occurred.
38730
38731 @item Errors:
38732
38733 @table @code
38734 @item EEXIST
38735 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
38736
38737 @item EISDIR
38738 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
38739
38740 @item EACCES
38741 The requested access is not allowed.
38742
38743 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38744 @var{pathname} was too long.
38745
38746 @item ENOENT
38747 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
38748
38749 @item ENODEV
38750 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
38751
38752 @item EROFS
38753 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
38754 write access was requested.
38755
38756 @item EFAULT
38757 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
38758
38759 @item ENOSPC
38760 No space on device to create the file.
38761
38762 @item EMFILE
38763 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
38764
38765 @item ENFILE
38766 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
38767 has been reached.
38768
38769 @item EINTR
38770 The call was interrupted by the user.
38771 @end table
38772
38773 @end table
38774
38775 @node close
38776 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
38777 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
38778
38779 @table @asis
38780 @item Synopsis:
38781 @smallexample
38782 int close(int fd);
38783 @end smallexample
38784
38785 @item Request:
38786 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
38787
38788 @item Return value:
38789 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
38790
38791 @item Errors:
38792
38793 @table @code
38794 @item EBADF
38795 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
38796
38797 @item EINTR
38798 The call was interrupted by the user.
38799 @end table
38800
38801 @end table
38802
38803 @node read
38804 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
38805 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
38806
38807 @table @asis
38808 @item Synopsis:
38809 @smallexample
38810 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
38811 @end smallexample
38812
38813 @item Request:
38814 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
38815
38816 @item Return value:
38817 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
38818 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
38819 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
38820
38821 @item Errors:
38822
38823 @table @code
38824 @item EBADF
38825 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
38826 reading.
38827
38828 @item EFAULT
38829 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38830
38831 @item EINTR
38832 The call was interrupted by the user.
38833 @end table
38834
38835 @end table
38836
38837 @node write
38838 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
38839 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
38840
38841 @table @asis
38842 @item Synopsis:
38843 @smallexample
38844 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
38845 @end smallexample
38846
38847 @item Request:
38848 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
38849
38850 @item Return value:
38851 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
38852 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
38853 is returned.
38854
38855 @item Errors:
38856
38857 @table @code
38858 @item EBADF
38859 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
38860 writing.
38861
38862 @item EFAULT
38863 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38864
38865 @item EFBIG
38866 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
38867 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
38868
38869 @item ENOSPC
38870 No space on device to write the data.
38871
38872 @item EINTR
38873 The call was interrupted by the user.
38874 @end table
38875
38876 @end table
38877
38878 @node lseek
38879 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
38880 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
38881
38882 @table @asis
38883 @item Synopsis:
38884 @smallexample
38885 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
38886 @end smallexample
38887
38888 @item Request:
38889 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
38890
38891 @var{flag} is one of:
38892
38893 @table @code
38894 @item SEEK_SET
38895 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
38896
38897 @item SEEK_CUR
38898 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
38899 bytes.
38900
38901 @item SEEK_END
38902 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
38903 bytes.
38904 @end table
38905
38906 @item Return value:
38907 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
38908 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
38909 value of -1 is returned.
38910
38911 @item Errors:
38912
38913 @table @code
38914 @item EBADF
38915 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
38916
38917 @item ESPIPE
38918 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
38919
38920 @item EINVAL
38921 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
38922
38923 @item EINTR
38924 The call was interrupted by the user.
38925 @end table
38926
38927 @end table
38928
38929 @node rename
38930 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
38931 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
38932
38933 @table @asis
38934 @item Synopsis:
38935 @smallexample
38936 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
38937 @end smallexample
38938
38939 @item Request:
38940 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
38941
38942 @item Return value:
38943 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38944
38945 @item Errors:
38946
38947 @table @code
38948 @item EISDIR
38949 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
38950 directory.
38951
38952 @item EEXIST
38953 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
38954
38955 @item EBUSY
38956 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
38957 process.
38958
38959 @item EINVAL
38960 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
38961 of itself.
38962
38963 @item ENOTDIR
38964 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
38965 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
38966 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
38967
38968 @item EFAULT
38969 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
38970
38971 @item EACCES
38972 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38973
38974 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38975
38976 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
38977
38978 @item ENOENT
38979 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
38980
38981 @item EROFS
38982 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
38983
38984 @item ENOSPC
38985 The device containing the file has no room for the new
38986 directory entry.
38987
38988 @item EINTR
38989 The call was interrupted by the user.
38990 @end table
38991
38992 @end table
38993
38994 @node unlink
38995 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
38996 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
38997
38998 @table @asis
38999 @item Synopsis:
39000 @smallexample
39001 int unlink(const char *pathname);
39002 @end smallexample
39003
39004 @item Request:
39005 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
39006
39007 @item Return value:
39008 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39009
39010 @item Errors:
39011
39012 @table @code
39013 @item EACCES
39014 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39015
39016 @item EPERM
39017 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
39018
39019 @item EBUSY
39020 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
39021 being used by another process.
39022
39023 @item EFAULT
39024 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39025
39026 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39027 @var{pathname} was too long.
39028
39029 @item ENOENT
39030 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39031
39032 @item ENOTDIR
39033 A component of the path is not a directory.
39034
39035 @item EROFS
39036 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39037
39038 @item EINTR
39039 The call was interrupted by the user.
39040 @end table
39041
39042 @end table
39043
39044 @node stat/fstat
39045 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
39046 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
39047 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
39048
39049 @table @asis
39050 @item Synopsis:
39051 @smallexample
39052 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
39053 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
39054 @end smallexample
39055
39056 @item Request:
39057 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
39058 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
39059
39060 @item Return value:
39061 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39062
39063 @item Errors:
39064
39065 @table @code
39066 @item EBADF
39067 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
39068
39069 @item ENOENT
39070 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
39071 path is an empty string.
39072
39073 @item ENOTDIR
39074 A component of the path is not a directory.
39075
39076 @item EFAULT
39077 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39078
39079 @item EACCES
39080 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39081
39082 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39083 @var{pathname} was too long.
39084
39085 @item EINTR
39086 The call was interrupted by the user.
39087 @end table
39088
39089 @end table
39090
39091 @node gettimeofday
39092 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
39093 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
39094
39095 @table @asis
39096 @item Synopsis:
39097 @smallexample
39098 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
39099 @end smallexample
39100
39101 @item Request:
39102 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
39103
39104 @item Return value:
39105 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
39106
39107 @item Errors:
39108
39109 @table @code
39110 @item EINVAL
39111 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
39112
39113 @item EFAULT
39114 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39115 @end table
39116
39117 @end table
39118
39119 @node isatty
39120 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
39121 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
39122
39123 @table @asis
39124 @item Synopsis:
39125 @smallexample
39126 int isatty(int fd);
39127 @end smallexample
39128
39129 @item Request:
39130 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
39131
39132 @item Return value:
39133 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
39134
39135 @item Errors:
39136
39137 @table @code
39138 @item EINTR
39139 The call was interrupted by the user.
39140 @end table
39141
39142 @end table
39143
39144 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
39145 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
39146 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
39147 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
39148 needed.
39149
39150
39151 @node system
39152 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
39153 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
39154
39155 @table @asis
39156 @item Synopsis:
39157 @smallexample
39158 int system(const char *command);
39159 @end smallexample
39160
39161 @item Request:
39162 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
39163
39164 @item Return value:
39165 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
39166 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
39167 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
39168 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
39169 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
39170 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
39171 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
39172
39173 @item Errors:
39174
39175 @table @code
39176 @item EINTR
39177 The call was interrupted by the user.
39178 @end table
39179
39180 @end table
39181
39182 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
39183 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
39184 the host is simplified before it's returned
39185 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
39186 is discarded, and the return value consists
39187 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
39188
39189 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
39190 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
39191 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
39192
39193 @table @code
39194 @item set remote system-call-allowed
39195 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
39196 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
39197 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
39198
39199 @item show remote system-call-allowed
39200 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
39201 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
39202 protocol.
39203 @end table
39204
39205 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39206 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39207 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39208
39209 @menu
39210 * Integral Datatypes::
39211 * Pointer Values::
39212 * Memory Transfer::
39213 * struct stat::
39214 * struct timeval::
39215 @end menu
39216
39217 @node Integral Datatypes
39218 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
39219 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39220
39221 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
39222 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
39223 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
39224
39225 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
39226 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
39227
39228 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
39229
39230 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
39231 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
39232
39233 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
39234
39235 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
39236 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
39237 byte order.
39238
39239 @node Pointer Values
39240 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
39241 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
39242
39243 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
39244 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
39245 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
39246 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
39247
39248 @smallexample
39249 @code{1aaf/12}
39250 @end smallexample
39251
39252 @noindent
39253 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
39254 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
39255 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
39256 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
39257
39258 @smallexample
39259 @code{123456/d}
39260 @end smallexample
39261
39262 @node Memory Transfer
39263 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
39264 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
39265
39266 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
39267 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
39268 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
39269 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
39270 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
39271 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
39272 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
39273
39274
39275 @node struct stat
39276 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
39277 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
39278
39279 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
39280 is defined as follows:
39281
39282 @smallexample
39283 struct stat @{
39284 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
39285 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
39286 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
39287 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
39288 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
39289 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
39290 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
39291 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
39292 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
39293 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
39294 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
39295 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
39296 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
39297 @};
39298 @end smallexample
39299
39300 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39301 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39302 structure is of size 64 bytes.
39303
39304 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
39305 range of values.
39306
39307 @table @code
39308
39309 @item st_dev
39310 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
39311
39312 @item st_ino
39313 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39314
39315 @item st_mode
39316 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
39317 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
39318
39319 @item st_uid
39320 @itemx st_gid
39321 @itemx st_rdev
39322 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39323
39324 @item st_atime
39325 @itemx st_mtime
39326 @itemx st_ctime
39327 These values have a host and file system dependent
39328 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
39329 support exact timing values.
39330 @end table
39331
39332 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
39333 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
39334 continuing.
39335
39336 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
39337 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
39338 get truncated on the target.
39339
39340 @node struct timeval
39341 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
39342 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
39343
39344 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
39345 is defined as follows:
39346
39347 @smallexample
39348 struct timeval @{
39349 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
39350 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
39351 @};
39352 @end smallexample
39353
39354 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39355 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39356 structure is of size 8 bytes.
39357
39358 @node Constants
39359 @subsection Constants
39360 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
39361
39362 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
39363 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
39364 values before and after the call as needed.
39365
39366 @menu
39367 * Open Flags::
39368 * mode_t Values::
39369 * Errno Values::
39370 * Lseek Flags::
39371 * Limits::
39372 @end menu
39373
39374 @node Open Flags
39375 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
39376 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
39377
39378 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
39379
39380 @smallexample
39381 O_RDONLY 0x0
39382 O_WRONLY 0x1
39383 O_RDWR 0x2
39384 O_APPEND 0x8
39385 O_CREAT 0x200
39386 O_TRUNC 0x400
39387 O_EXCL 0x800
39388 @end smallexample
39389
39390 @node mode_t Values
39391 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
39392 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
39393
39394 All values are given in octal representation.
39395
39396 @smallexample
39397 S_IFREG 0100000
39398 S_IFDIR 040000
39399 S_IRUSR 0400
39400 S_IWUSR 0200
39401 S_IXUSR 0100
39402 S_IRGRP 040
39403 S_IWGRP 020
39404 S_IXGRP 010
39405 S_IROTH 04
39406 S_IWOTH 02
39407 S_IXOTH 01
39408 @end smallexample
39409
39410 @node Errno Values
39411 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
39412 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
39413
39414 All values are given in decimal representation.
39415
39416 @smallexample
39417 EPERM 1
39418 ENOENT 2
39419 EINTR 4
39420 EBADF 9
39421 EACCES 13
39422 EFAULT 14
39423 EBUSY 16
39424 EEXIST 17
39425 ENODEV 19
39426 ENOTDIR 20
39427 EISDIR 21
39428 EINVAL 22
39429 ENFILE 23
39430 EMFILE 24
39431 EFBIG 27
39432 ENOSPC 28
39433 ESPIPE 29
39434 EROFS 30
39435 ENAMETOOLONG 91
39436 EUNKNOWN 9999
39437 @end smallexample
39438
39439 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
39440 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
39441
39442 @node Lseek Flags
39443 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
39444 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
39445
39446 @smallexample
39447 SEEK_SET 0
39448 SEEK_CUR 1
39449 SEEK_END 2
39450 @end smallexample
39451
39452 @node Limits
39453 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
39454 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
39455
39456 All values are given in decimal representation.
39457
39458 @smallexample
39459 INT_MIN -2147483648
39460 INT_MAX 2147483647
39461 UINT_MAX 4294967295
39462 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
39463 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
39464 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
39465 @end smallexample
39466
39467 @node File-I/O Examples
39468 @subsection File-I/O Examples
39469 @cindex file-i/o examples
39470
39471 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39472 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
39473
39474 @smallexample
39475 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
39476 @emph{request memory read from target}
39477 -> @code{m1234,6}
39478 <- XXXXXX
39479 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
39480 -> @code{F6}
39481 @end smallexample
39482
39483 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39484 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
39485
39486 @smallexample
39487 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39488 @emph{request memory write to target}
39489 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39490 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
39491 -> @code{F6}
39492 @end smallexample
39493
39494 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
39495 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
39496
39497 @smallexample
39498 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39499 -> @code{F-1,9}
39500 @end smallexample
39501
39502 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
39503 host is called:
39504
39505 @smallexample
39506 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39507 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
39508 <- @code{T02}
39509 @end smallexample
39510
39511 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
39512 host is called:
39513
39514 @smallexample
39515 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39516 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39517 <- @code{T02}
39518 @end smallexample
39519
39520 @node Library List Format
39521 @section Library List Format
39522 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39523
39524 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
39525 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
39526 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
39527 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
39528 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
39529 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
39530 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
39531 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
39532 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
39533 are loaded.
39534
39535 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
39536 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
39537 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
39538 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
39539
39540 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
39541 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
39542 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
39543 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
39544 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
39545 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
39546
39547 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39548 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39549
39550 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
39551 offset, looks like this:
39552
39553 @smallexample
39554 <library-list>
39555 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
39556 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
39557 </library>
39558 </library-list>
39559 @end smallexample
39560
39561 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
39562 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
39563
39564 @smallexample
39565 <library-list>
39566 <library name="sharedlib.o">
39567 <section address="0x10000000"/>
39568 <section address="0x20000000"/>
39569 <section address="0x30000000"/>
39570 </library>
39571 </library-list>
39572 @end smallexample
39573
39574 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
39575
39576 @smallexample
39577 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
39578 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
39579 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39580 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
39581 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39582 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
39583 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39584 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
39585 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39586 @end smallexample
39587
39588 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
39589 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
39590 section for each library.
39591
39592 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39593 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39594 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39595
39596 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
39597 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
39598 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
39599 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
39600
39601 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
39602 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
39603 target, the following parameters are reported:
39604
39605 @itemize @minus
39606 @item
39607 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
39608 @code{struct link_map}.
39609 @item
39610 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
39611 (Thread Local Storage) access.
39612 @item
39613 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
39614 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
39615 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
39616 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
39617 @item
39618 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
39619 @end itemize
39620
39621 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
39622 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
39623 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
39624
39625 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39626 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39627
39628 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
39629 looks like this:
39630
39631 @smallexample
39632 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
39633 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
39634 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
39635 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
39636 l_ld="0x152350"/>
39637 </library-list-svr>
39638 @end smallexample
39639
39640 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
39641
39642 @smallexample
39643 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
39644 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
39645 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39646 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
39647 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
39648 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39649 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
39650 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
39651 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
39652 @end smallexample
39653
39654 @node Memory Map Format
39655 @section Memory Map Format
39656 @cindex memory map format
39657
39658 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
39659 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
39660 memory map.
39661
39662 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
39663 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
39664 lists memory regions.
39665
39666 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39667 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
39668
39669 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39670
39671 @smallexample
39672 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39673 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
39674 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39675 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
39676 <memory-map>
39677 region...
39678 </memory-map>
39679 @end smallexample
39680
39681 Each region can be either:
39682
39683 @itemize
39684
39685 @item
39686 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
39687 bytes from there:
39688
39689 @smallexample
39690 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39691 @end smallexample
39692
39693
39694 @item
39695 A region of read-only memory:
39696
39697 @smallexample
39698 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39699 @end smallexample
39700
39701
39702 @item
39703 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
39704 bytes in length:
39705
39706 @smallexample
39707 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
39708 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
39709 </memory>
39710 @end smallexample
39711
39712 @end itemize
39713
39714 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
39715 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
39716 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
39717
39718 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
39719
39720 @smallexample
39721 <!-- ................................................... -->
39722 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
39723 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
39724 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
39725 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
39726 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
39727 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
39728 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
39729 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
39730 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
39731 and its type, or device. -->
39732 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
39733 start CDATA #REQUIRED
39734 length CDATA #REQUIRED
39735 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
39736 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
39737 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
39738 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39739 @end smallexample
39740
39741 @node Thread List Format
39742 @section Thread List Format
39743 @cindex thread list format
39744
39745 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
39746 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
39747 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
39748 the following structure:
39749
39750 @smallexample
39751 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39752 <threads>
39753 <thread id="id" core="0">
39754 ... description ...
39755 </thread>
39756 </threads>
39757 @end smallexample
39758
39759 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
39760 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
39761 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
39762 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
39763 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
39764
39765 @node Traceframe Info Format
39766 @section Traceframe Info Format
39767 @cindex traceframe info format
39768
39769 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
39770 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
39771 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
39772 collected in a traceframe.
39773
39774 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39775 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
39776
39777 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39778 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39779
39780 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39781
39782 @smallexample
39783 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39784 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
39785 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39786 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
39787 <traceframe-info>
39788 block...
39789 </traceframe-info>
39790 @end smallexample
39791
39792 Each traceframe block can be either:
39793
39794 @itemize
39795
39796 @item
39797 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
39798 @var{length} bytes from there:
39799
39800 @smallexample
39801 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39802 @end smallexample
39803
39804 @end itemize
39805
39806 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
39807
39808 @smallexample
39809 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory)* >
39810 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39811
39812 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
39813 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
39814 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
39815 @end smallexample
39816
39817 @include agentexpr.texi
39818
39819 @node Target Descriptions
39820 @appendix Target Descriptions
39821 @cindex target descriptions
39822
39823 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
39824 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
39825 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
39826 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
39827 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
39828 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
39829 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
39830
39831 @itemize @bullet
39832 @item
39833 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
39834 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
39835 @item
39836 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
39837 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
39838 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
39839 @item
39840 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
39841 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
39842 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
39843 @end itemize
39844
39845 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
39846 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
39847 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
39848 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
39849 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
39850
39851 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39852 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
39853
39854 @menu
39855 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
39856 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
39857 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
39858 descriptions.
39859 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
39860 @end menu
39861
39862 @node Retrieving Descriptions
39863 @section Retrieving Descriptions
39864
39865 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
39866 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
39867 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
39868 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
39869 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
39870 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
39871 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
39872 Format}.
39873
39874 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
39875 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
39876 specify a file are:
39877
39878 @table @code
39879 @cindex set tdesc filename
39880 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
39881 Read the target description from @var{path}.
39882
39883 @cindex unset tdesc filename
39884 @item unset tdesc filename
39885 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
39886 will use the description supplied by the current target.
39887
39888 @cindex show tdesc filename
39889 @item show tdesc filename
39890 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
39891 @end table
39892
39893
39894 @node Target Description Format
39895 @section Target Description Format
39896 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
39897
39898 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
39899 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
39900 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
39901 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
39902 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
39903 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
39904 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
39905
39906 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
39907 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
39908 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
39909 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
39910 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
39911
39912 Here is a simple target description:
39913
39914 @smallexample
39915 <target version="1.0">
39916 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
39917 </target>
39918 @end smallexample
39919
39920 @noindent
39921 This minimal description only says that the target uses
39922 the x86-64 architecture.
39923
39924 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
39925 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
39926 are explained further below.
39927
39928 @smallexample
39929 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39930 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
39931 <target version="1.0">
39932 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
39933 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
39934 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
39935 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
39936 </target>
39937 @end smallexample
39938
39939 @noindent
39940 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
39941 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
39942 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
39943 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
39944 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
39945 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
39946 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
39947 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
39948 the version mismatch.
39949
39950 @subsection Inclusion
39951 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
39952 @cindex XInclude
39953 @ifnotinfo
39954 @cindex <xi:include>
39955 @end ifnotinfo
39956
39957 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
39958 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
39959 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
39960 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
39961 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
39962
39963 @smallexample
39964 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
39965 @end smallexample
39966
39967 @noindent
39968 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
39969 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
39970 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
39971 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
39972 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
39973 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
39974 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
39975 original description.
39976
39977 @subsection Architecture
39978 @cindex <architecture>
39979
39980 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
39981
39982 @smallexample
39983 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
39984 @end smallexample
39985
39986 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
39987 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
39988
39989 @subsection OS ABI
39990 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
39991
39992 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
39993 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
39994
39995 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
39996
39997 @smallexample
39998 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
39999 @end smallexample
40000
40001 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
40002 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
40003
40004 @subsection Compatible Architecture
40005 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
40006
40007 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40008 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40009
40010 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
40011
40012 @smallexample
40013 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
40014 @end smallexample
40015
40016 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40017 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40018
40019 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
40020 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
40021 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
40022 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
40023 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
40024 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
40025 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
40026
40027 @smallexample
40028 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
40029 <compatible>spu</compatible>
40030 @end smallexample
40031
40032 @subsection Features
40033 @cindex <feature>
40034
40035 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
40036 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
40037 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
40038 has this form:
40039
40040 @smallexample
40041 <feature name="@var{name}">
40042 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
40043 @var{reg}@dots{}
40044 </feature>
40045 @end smallexample
40046
40047 @noindent
40048 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
40049 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
40050 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
40051 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
40052
40053 @subsection Types
40054
40055 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
40056 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
40057 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
40058 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
40059 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
40060
40061 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
40062 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
40063 Types must be defined before they are used.
40064
40065 @cindex <vector>
40066 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
40067 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
40068 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
40069 @var{count}:
40070
40071 @smallexample
40072 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
40073 @end smallexample
40074
40075 @cindex <union>
40076 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
40077 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
40078 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
40079 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
40080
40081 @smallexample
40082 <union id="@var{id}">
40083 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40084 @dots{}
40085 </union>
40086 @end smallexample
40087
40088 @cindex <struct>
40089 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
40090 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
40091 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
40092 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
40093 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
40094 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
40095 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
40096 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
40097
40098 @smallexample
40099 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40100 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
40101 @dots{}
40102 </struct>
40103 @end smallexample
40104
40105 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
40106 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
40107
40108 @smallexample
40109 <struct id="@var{id}">
40110 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40111 @dots{}
40112 </struct>
40113 @end smallexample
40114
40115 @cindex <flags>
40116 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
40117 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
40118 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
40119 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
40120 are supported.
40121
40122 @smallexample
40123 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40124 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
40125 @dots{}
40126 </flags>
40127 @end smallexample
40128
40129 @subsection Registers
40130 @cindex <reg>
40131
40132 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
40133
40134 @smallexample
40135 <reg name="@var{name}"
40136 bitsize="@var{size}"
40137 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
40138 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
40139 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
40140 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
40141 @end smallexample
40142
40143 @noindent
40144 The components are as follows:
40145
40146 @table @var
40147
40148 @item name
40149 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
40150
40151 @item bitsize
40152 The register's size, in bits.
40153
40154 @item regnum
40155 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
40156 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
40157 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
40158 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
40159 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
40160 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
40161 in order of increasing register number.
40162
40163 @item save-restore
40164 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
40165 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
40166 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
40167 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
40168 ABI.
40169
40170 @item type
40171 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
40172 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
40173 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
40174 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
40175 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
40176 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
40177
40178 @item group
40179 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
40180 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
40181 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
40182 in @code{info registers}.
40183
40184 @end table
40185
40186 @node Predefined Target Types
40187 @section Predefined Target Types
40188 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
40189
40190 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
40191 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
40192 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
40193 types. The currently supported types are:
40194
40195 @table @code
40196
40197 @item int8
40198 @itemx int16
40199 @itemx int32
40200 @itemx int64
40201 @itemx int128
40202 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40203
40204 @item uint8
40205 @itemx uint16
40206 @itemx uint32
40207 @itemx uint64
40208 @itemx uint128
40209 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40210
40211 @item code_ptr
40212 @itemx data_ptr
40213 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
40214 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
40215 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
40216 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
40217 may be marked as data pointers.
40218
40219 @item ieee_single
40220 Single precision IEEE floating point.
40221
40222 @item ieee_double
40223 Double precision IEEE floating point.
40224
40225 @item arm_fpa_ext
40226 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
40227
40228 @item i387_ext
40229 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
40230
40231 @item i386_eflags
40232 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
40233
40234 @item i386_mxcsr
40235 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
40236
40237 @end table
40238
40239 @node Standard Target Features
40240 @section Standard Target Features
40241 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
40242
40243 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
40244 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
40245 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
40246 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
40247 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
40248 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
40249 can recognize them.
40250
40251 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
40252 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
40253 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
40254 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
40255 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
40256 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
40257 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
40258 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
40259
40260 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
40261 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
40262 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
40263
40264 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
40265 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
40266 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
40267 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
40268
40269 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
40270 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
40271 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
40272
40273 @menu
40274 * ARM Features::
40275 * i386 Features::
40276 * MIPS Features::
40277 * M68K Features::
40278 * PowerPC Features::
40279 * TIC6x Features::
40280 @end menu
40281
40282
40283 @node ARM Features
40284 @subsection ARM Features
40285 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
40286
40287 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
40288 ARM targets.
40289 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
40290 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40291
40292 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
40293 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
40294 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
40295 and @samp{xpsr}.
40296
40297 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
40298 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
40299
40300 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
40301 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
40302 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
40303 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
40304
40305 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
40306 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
40307 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
40308 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
40309 halves of the double-precision registers.
40310
40311 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
40312 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
40313 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
40314 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
40315 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
40316 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
40317
40318 @node i386 Features
40319 @subsection i386 Features
40320 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
40321
40322 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
40323 targets. It should describe the following registers:
40324
40325 @itemize @minus
40326 @item
40327 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
40328 @item
40329 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
40330 @item
40331 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
40332 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
40333 @item
40334 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
40335 @item
40336 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
40337 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
40338 @end itemize
40339
40340 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
40341
40342 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
40343 describe registers:
40344
40345 @itemize @minus
40346 @item
40347 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
40348 @item
40349 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
40350 @item
40351 @samp{mxcsr}
40352 @end itemize
40353
40354 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
40355 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
40356 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
40357
40358 @itemize @minus
40359 @item
40360 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
40361 @item
40362 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
40363 @end itemize
40364
40365 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
40366 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
40367
40368 @node MIPS Features
40369 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
40370 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
40371
40372 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
40373 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
40374 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
40375 on the target.
40376
40377 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
40378 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
40379 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40380
40381 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
40382 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
40383 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
40384 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40385
40386 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
40387 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
40388 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
40389 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40390
40391 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
40392 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
40393 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
40394
40395 @node M68K Features
40396 @subsection M68K Features
40397 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
40398
40399 @table @code
40400 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
40401 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
40402 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
40403 One of those features must be always present.
40404 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
40405 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
40406 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
40407 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
40408
40409 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
40410 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
40411 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
40412 @samp{fpiaddr}.
40413 @end table
40414
40415 @node PowerPC Features
40416 @subsection PowerPC Features
40417 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
40418
40419 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
40420 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40421 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
40422 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40423
40424 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
40425 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
40426
40427 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
40428 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
40429 and @samp{vrsave}.
40430
40431 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
40432 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
40433 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
40434 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
40435 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
40436 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
40437
40438 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
40439 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
40440 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
40441 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
40442 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
40443 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
40444 user.
40445
40446 @node TIC6x Features
40447 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
40448 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
40449 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
40450 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
40451 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
40452 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
40453
40454 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
40455 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
40456 through @samp{B31}.
40457
40458 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
40459 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
40460
40461 @node Operating System Information
40462 @appendix Operating System Information
40463 @cindex operating system information
40464
40465 @menu
40466 * Process list::
40467 @end menu
40468
40469 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
40470 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
40471 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
40472 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
40473 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
40474 on a different aspect of target.
40475
40476 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
40477 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
40478 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
40479 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
40480
40481 @node Process list
40482 @appendixsection Process list
40483 @cindex operating system information, process list
40484
40485 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
40486 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
40487 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
40488 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
40489
40490 An example document is:
40491
40492 @smallexample
40493 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40494 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
40495 <osdata type="processes">
40496 <item>
40497 <column name="pid">1</column>
40498 <column name="user">root</column>
40499 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
40500 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
40501 </item>
40502 </osdata>
40503 @end smallexample
40504
40505 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
40506 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
40507 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
40508 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
40509 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
40510 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
40511 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
40512
40513 @node Trace File Format
40514 @appendix Trace File Format
40515 @cindex trace file format
40516
40517 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
40518 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
40519
40520 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
40521 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
40522 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
40523 in the future.
40524
40525 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
40526 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
40527 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
40528 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
40529 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
40530 of this section.
40531
40532 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
40533
40534 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
40535 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
40536 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
40537 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
40538 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
40539 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
40540 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
40541 endianness.
40542
40543 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
40544
40545 @table @code
40546 @item R @var{bytes}
40547 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
40548 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
40549 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
40550 hexadecimal encoding.
40551
40552 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
40553 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
40554 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
40555 @var{length} bytes.
40556
40557 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
40558 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
40559 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
40560
40561 @end table
40562
40563 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
40564 of blocks.
40565
40566 @node Index Section Format
40567 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
40568 @cindex .gdb_index section format
40569 @cindex index section format
40570
40571 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
40572 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
40573 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
40574 description.
40575
40576 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
40577 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
40578 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
40579 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
40580 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
40581 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
40582
40583 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
40584
40585 @enumerate
40586 @item
40587 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
40588 unless otherwise noted:
40589
40590 @enumerate
40591 @item
40592 The version number, currently 7. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
40593 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
40594 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
40595 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
40596 symbol table. @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
40597 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
40598
40599 @item
40600 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
40601
40602 @item
40603 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
40604 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
40605 to the next offset.
40606
40607 @item
40608 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
40609
40610 @item
40611 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
40612
40613 @item
40614 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
40615 @end enumerate
40616
40617 @item
40618 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
40619 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
40620 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
40621 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
40622 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
40623 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
40624 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
40625 CU indices.
40626
40627 @item
40628 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
40629 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
40630 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
40631 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
40632
40633 @item
40634 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
40635 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
40636
40637 @enumerate
40638 @item
40639 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
40640
40641 @item
40642 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
40643 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
40644
40645 @item
40646 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
40647 @end enumerate
40648
40649 @item
40650 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
40651 the hash table is always a power of 2.
40652
40653 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
40654 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
40655 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
40656 constant pool.
40657
40658 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
40659 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
40660 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
40661
40662 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
40663 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
40664 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
40665 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
40666 index version:
40667
40668 @table @asis
40669 @item Version 4
40670 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
40671
40672 @item Versions 5 to 7
40673 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
40674 @end table
40675
40676 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
40677
40678 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
40679 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
40680 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
40681 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
40682 collision.
40683
40684 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
40685 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
40686 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
40687 the code.
40688
40689 @item
40690 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
40691 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
40692 strings.
40693
40694 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
40695 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
40696 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
40697 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
40698 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
40699 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
40700
40701 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
40702 @end enumerate
40703
40704 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
40705 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
40706 CU index+attributes value for each use.
40707
40708 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
40709 (bit 0 = LSB):
40710
40711 @table @asis
40712
40713 @item Bits 0-23
40714 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
40715 @item Bits 24-27
40716 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
40717 @item Bits 28-30
40718 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
40719
40720 @table @asis
40721 @item 0
40722 This value is reserved and should not be used.
40723 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
40724 with previous versions of the index.
40725 @item 1
40726 The symbol is a type.
40727 @item 2
40728 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
40729 @item 3
40730 The symbol is a function.
40731 @item 4
40732 Any other kind of symbol.
40733 @item 5,6,7
40734 These values are reserved.
40735 @end table
40736
40737 @item Bit 31
40738 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
40739
40740 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
40741 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
40742 @value{GDBN} sources.
40743
40744 @end table
40745
40746 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
40747 global/static attributes in the index.
40748
40749 @smallexample
40750 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
40751 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
40752 switch (die->tag)
40753 @{
40754 case DW_TAG_typedef:
40755 case DW_TAG_base_type:
40756 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
40757 kind = TYPE;
40758 is_static = 1;
40759 break;
40760 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
40761 kind = VARIABLE;
40762 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
40763 break;
40764 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
40765 kind = FUNCTION;
40766 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
40767 break;
40768 case DW_TAG_constant:
40769 kind = VARIABLE;
40770 is_static = ! is_external;
40771 break;
40772 case DW_TAG_variable:
40773 kind = VARIABLE;
40774 is_static = ! is_external;
40775 break;
40776 case DW_TAG_namespace:
40777 kind = TYPE;
40778 is_static = 0;
40779 break;
40780 case DW_TAG_class_type:
40781 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
40782 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
40783 case DW_TAG_union_type:
40784 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
40785 kind = TYPE;
40786 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
40787 break;
40788 default:
40789 assert (0);
40790 @}
40791 @end smallexample
40792
40793 @include gpl.texi
40794
40795 @node GNU Free Documentation License
40796 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
40797 @include fdl.texi
40798
40799 @node Concept Index
40800 @unnumbered Concept Index
40801
40802 @printindex cp
40803
40804 @node Command and Variable Index
40805 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
40806
40807 @printindex fn
40808
40809 @tex
40810 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
40811 % meantime:
40812 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
40813 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
40814 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
40815 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
40816 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
40817 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
40818 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
40819 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
40820 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
40821 \page\colophon
40822 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
40823 @end tex
40824
40825 @bye
This page took 1.0467 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.